Add self-test framework to gdb
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2662 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2663 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2664 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2665 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2666 information on convenience variables.
2667
2668 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2669 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2670 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2671 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2672 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2673 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2674
2675 @table @code
2676 @kindex add-inferior
2677 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2678 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2679 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2680 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2681 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2682 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2683
2684 @kindex clone-inferior
2685 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2686 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2687 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2688 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2689 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2690
2691 @smallexample
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2695 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2696 Added inferior 2.
2697 1 inferiors added.
2698 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2699 Num Description Executable
2700 2 <null> helloworld
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2705
2706 @kindex remove-inferiors
2707 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2708 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2709 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2710 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2711
2712 @end table
2713
2714 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2715 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2716 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2717 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2721 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2723 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2724 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2725 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2726
2727 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2730 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2731 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2732 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2736 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2737 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2738 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2739
2740
2741 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2742 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex set print inferior-events
2746 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2747 @item set print inferior-events
2748 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2750 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2751 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2752 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2753 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2754
2755 @kindex show print inferior-events
2756 @item show print inferior-events
2757 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2758 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2759 @end table
2760
2761 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2762 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2763 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2764
2765
2766 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2767 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2768 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2769 info program-spaces}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2773 @item maint info program-spaces
2774 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2775 @value{GDBN}.
2776
2777 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2778
2779 @enumerate
2780 @item
2781 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2782
2783 @item
2784 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2785 the @code{file} command.
2786
2787 @end enumerate
2788
2789 @noindent
2790 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2791 indicates the current program space.
2792
2793 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2794 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2795 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2796
2797 @smallexample
2798 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2799 Id Executable
2800 * 1 hello
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 @end smallexample
2804
2805 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2806 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2807 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2808 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2809 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2813 Id Executable
2814 * 1 vfork-test
2815 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2819 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2820 @end table
2821
2822 @node Threads
2823 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2824
2825 @cindex threads of execution
2826 @cindex multiple threads
2827 @cindex switching threads
2828 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2829 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2830 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2831 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2832 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2833 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2834 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2835
2836 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2837 programs:
2838
2839 @itemize @bullet
2840 @item automatic notification of new threads
2841 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2842 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2843 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2844 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2845 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2846 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2847 messages on thread start and exit.
2848 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2849 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2850 isn't compatible with the program.
2851 @end itemize
2852
2853 @cindex focus of debugging
2854 @cindex current thread
2855 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2856 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2857 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2858 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2859 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2860
2861 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2862 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2863 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2864 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2865 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2866 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2867 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2868 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2869 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2870 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2871
2872 @smallexample
2873 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2874 @end smallexample
2875
2876 @noindent
2877 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2878 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2879 further qualifier.
2880
2881 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2882 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2883 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2884 @c program?
2885 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2886 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2887 @c threads ab initio?
2888
2889 @anchor{thread numbers}
2890 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2891 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2892 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2893 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2894 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2895 between threads of different inferiors.
2896
2897 @cindex qualified thread ID
2898 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2899 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2900 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2901 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2902 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2903 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2904 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2905 inferior.
2906
2907 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2908 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2909 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2910 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2911
2912 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2913 @cindex thread ID lists
2914 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2915 argument. A list element can be:
2916
2917 @enumerate
2918 @item
2919 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2920 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2921 @samp{1}.
2922
2923 @item
2924 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2925 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2926 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2927
2928 @item
2929 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2930 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2931 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2932 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2933 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2934
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2938 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2939 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2940 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2941 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2942 7.1}.
2943
2944
2945 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2946 @cindex global thread number
2947 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2948 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2949 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2950 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2951 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2952 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2953
2954 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2955 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2956 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2957
2958 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2959 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2960 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2961 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2962 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2963 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2964 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2965 general information on convenience variables.
2966
2967 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2968 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2969 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2970
2971 @smallexample
2972 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2973 @end smallexample
2974
2975 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2976
2977 @smallexample
2978 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2979 @end smallexample
2980
2981 @table @code
2982 @kindex info threads
2983 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2984
2985 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2986 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2987 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2988 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2989
2990 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2991
2992 @enumerate
2993 @item
2994 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2995
2996 @item
2997 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
2998 option was specified
2999
3000 @item
3001 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3002
3003 @item
3004 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3005 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3006 program itself.
3007
3008 @item
3009 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3010 @end enumerate
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3014 indicates the current thread.
3015
3016 For example,
3017 @end table
3018 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3019
3020 @smallexample
3021 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3022 Id Target Id Frame
3023 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3024 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3025 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3026 at threadtest.c:68
3027 @end smallexample
3028
3029 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3030 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3031 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3032
3033 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3034 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3038 Id GId Target Id Frame
3039 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3040 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3041 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3042 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3046 Solaris-specific command:
3047
3048 @table @code
3049 @item maint info sol-threads
3050 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3051 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3052 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3053 @end table
3054
3055 @table @code
3056 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3057 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3058 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3059 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3060 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3061 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3062
3063 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3064 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3065
3066 @smallexample
3067 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3068 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3069 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3070 8 printf ("hello\n");
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 @noindent
3074 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3075 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3076 threads.
3077
3078 @kindex thread apply
3079 @cindex apply command to several threads
3080 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3081 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3082 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3083 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3084 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3085 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3086 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3087 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3088
3089
3090 @kindex thread name
3091 @cindex name a thread
3092 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3093 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3094 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3095 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3096
3097 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3098 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3099 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3100 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3101 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3102
3103 @kindex thread find
3104 @cindex search for a thread
3105 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3106 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3107 matches the supplied regular expression.
3108
3109 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3110 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3111 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3112 is the LWP id.
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3116 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3117 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3120 @end smallexample
3121
3122 @kindex set print thread-events
3123 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3124 @item set print thread-events
3125 @itemx set print thread-events on
3126 @itemx set print thread-events off
3127 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3128 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3129 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3130 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3131 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3132
3133 @kindex show print thread-events
3134 @item show print thread-events
3135 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3136 have started and exited.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3140 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3141 programs with multiple threads.
3142
3143 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3144 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3145
3146 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3149 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3150 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3151 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3152 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3153 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3154 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3155 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3156 macro.
3157
3158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3159 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3160 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3161 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3162 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3163 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3164
3165 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3166 refers to the default system directories that are
3167 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3168 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3169 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3170
3171 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3172 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3173 was loaded in the inferior process.
3174
3175 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3176 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3177 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3178 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3179 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3180 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3181 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3182
3183 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3184 only on some platforms.
3185
3186 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3187 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3188 Display current libthread_db search path.
3189
3190 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3191 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3192 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3193 @item set debug libthread-db
3194 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3195 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3196 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 @node Forks
3200 @section Debugging Forks
3201
3202 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3203 @cindex multiple processes
3204 @cindex processes, multiple
3205 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3206 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3207 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3208 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3209 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3210 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3211 will cause it to terminate.
3212
3213 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3214 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3215 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3216 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3217 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3218 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3219 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3220 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3221 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3222 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3223
3224 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3225 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3226 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3227 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3228
3229 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3230 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3231 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3232
3233 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3234 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3235
3236 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3237 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3238
3239 @table @code
3240 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3241 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3242 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3243 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3244 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3245
3246 @table @code
3247 @item parent
3248 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3249 unimpeded. This is the default.
3250
3251 @item child
3252 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3253 unimpeded.
3254
3255 @end table
3256
3257 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3258 @item show follow-fork-mode
3259 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3260 @end table
3261
3262 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3263 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3264 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3265
3266 @table @code
3267 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3268 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3269 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3270 retain debugger control over them both.
3271
3272 @table @code
3273 @item on
3274 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3275 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3276 independently. This is the default.
3277
3278 @item off
3279 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3280 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3281 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3282 is held suspended.
3283
3284 @end table
3285
3286 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3287 @item show detach-on-fork
3288 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3289 @end table
3290
3291 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3292 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3293 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3294 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3295 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3296 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3297
3298 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3299 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3300 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3301 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3302 and Programs}.
3303
3304 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3305 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3306 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3307 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3308 the child process's @code{main}.
3309
3310 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3311 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3312
3313 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3314 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3315 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3316 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3317 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3318 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3319 command.
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3323 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3324
3325 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3326 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3327
3328 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3329
3330 @table @code
3331 @item new
3332 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3333 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3334 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3335 original inferior.
3336
3337 For example:
3338
3339 @smallexample
3340 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3341 (gdb) info inferior
3342 Id Description Executable
3343 * 1 <null> prog1
3344 (@value{GDBP}) run
3345 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3346 Program exited normally.
3347 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348 Id Description Executable
3349 1 <null> prog1
3350 * 2 <null> prog2
3351 @end smallexample
3352
3353 @item same
3354 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3355 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3356 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3357 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3358 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3359
3360 For example:
3361
3362 @smallexample
3363 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3364 Id Description Executable
3365 * 1 <null> prog1
3366 (@value{GDBP}) run
3367 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3368 Program exited normally.
3369 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3370 Id Description Executable
3371 * 1 <null> prog2
3372 @end smallexample
3373
3374 @end table
3375 @end table
3376
3377 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3378 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3379
3380 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3381 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3382 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3383
3384 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3385 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3386
3387 @cindex checkpoint
3388 @cindex restart
3389 @cindex bookmark
3390 @cindex snapshot of a process
3391 @cindex rewind program state
3392
3393 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3394 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3395 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3396 later.
3397
3398 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3399 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3400 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3401 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3402 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3403
3404 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3405 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3406 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3407 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3408 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3409 start again from there.
3410
3411 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3412 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3413
3414 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3415
3416 @table @code
3417 @kindex checkpoint
3418 @item checkpoint
3419 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3420 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3421 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3422
3423 @kindex info checkpoints
3424 @item info checkpoints
3425 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3426 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3427 listed:
3428
3429 @table @code
3430 @item Checkpoint ID
3431 @item Process ID
3432 @item Code Address
3433 @item Source line, or label
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3437 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3438 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3439 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3440 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3441 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3442 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3443
3444 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3445 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3446 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3447 the debugger.
3448
3449 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3450 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3451 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3452
3453 @end table
3454
3455 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3456 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3457 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3458 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3459 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3460 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3461 previously read data can be read again.
3462
3463 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3464 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3465 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3466 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3467 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3468 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3469
3470 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3471 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3472 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3473 different execution path this time.
3474
3475 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3476 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3477 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3478 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3479 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3480 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3481 potentially pose a problem.
3482
3483 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3484
3485 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3486 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3487 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3488 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3489 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3490 next.
3491
3492 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3493 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3494 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3495 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3496 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3497
3498 @node Stopping
3499 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3500
3501 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3502 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3503 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3504
3505 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3506 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3507 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3508 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3509 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3510 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3511 explicitly request this information at any time.
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @kindex info program
3515 @item info program
3516 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3517 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3518 @end table
3519
3520 @menu
3521 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3522 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3523 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3524 Skipping over functions and files
3525 * Signals:: Signals
3526 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3527 @end menu
3528
3529 @node Breakpoints
3530 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3531
3532 @cindex breakpoints
3533 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3534 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3535 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3536 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3537 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3538 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3539 program.
3540
3541 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3542 the executable is run.
3543
3544 @cindex watchpoints
3545 @cindex data breakpoints
3546 @cindex memory tracing
3547 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3548 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3549 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3550 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3551 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3552 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3553 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3554 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3555 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3556 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3557 same commands.
3558
3559 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3560 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3561 Automatic Display}.
3562
3563 @cindex catchpoints
3564 @cindex breakpoint on events
3565 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3566 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3567 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3568 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3569 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3570 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3571 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3572
3573 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3574 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3575 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3576 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3577 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3578 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3579 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3580 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3581 enable it again.
3582
3583 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3584 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3585 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3586 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3587 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3588 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3589 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3590
3591 @menu
3592 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3593 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3594 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3595 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3596 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3597 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3598 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3599 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3600 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3601 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3602 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3603 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3604 @end menu
3605
3606 @node Set Breaks
3607 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3608
3609 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3610 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3611 @c
3612 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3613
3614 @kindex break
3615 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3616 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3617 @cindex latest breakpoint
3618 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3619 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3620 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3621 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3622 convenience variables.
3623
3624 @table @code
3625 @item break @var{location}
3626 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3627 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3628 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3629 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3630 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3631
3632 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3633 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3634 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3635 that situation.
3636
3637 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3638 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3639 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3640
3641 @item break
3642 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3643 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3644 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3645 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3646 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3647 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3648 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3649 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3650 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3651 inside loops.
3652
3653 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3654 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3655 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3656 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3657 existed when your program stopped.
3658
3659 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3660 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3661 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3662 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3663 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3664 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3665 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3666
3667 @kindex tbreak
3668 @item tbreak @var{args}
3669 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3670 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3671 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3672 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3673
3674 @kindex hbreak
3675 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3676 @item hbreak @var{args}
3677 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3678 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3679 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3680 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3681 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3682 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3683 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3684 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3685 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3686 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3687 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3688 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3689 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3690 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3691 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3692 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3693 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3694 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3695
3696 @kindex thbreak
3697 @item thbreak @var{args}
3698 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3699 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3700 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3701 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3702 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3703 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3704 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3705 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3706
3707 @kindex rbreak
3708 @cindex regular expression
3709 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3710 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3711 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3712 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3713 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3714 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3715 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3716 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3717 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3718
3719 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3720 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3721 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3722 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3723 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3724 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3725
3726 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3727 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3728 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3729 classes.
3730
3731 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3732 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3733 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3734
3735 @smallexample
3736 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3737 @end smallexample
3738
3739 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3740 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3741 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3742 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3743 every function in a given file:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3747 @end smallexample
3748
3749 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3750 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3751
3752 @kindex info breakpoints
3753 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3754 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3755 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3756 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3757 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3758 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3759 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3760
3761 @table @emph
3762 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3763 @item Type
3764 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3765 @item Disposition
3766 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3767 @item Enabled or Disabled
3768 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3769 that are not enabled.
3770 @item Address
3771 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3772 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3773 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3774 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3775 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3776 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3777 @item What
3778 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3779 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3780 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3781 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3782 @end table
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3786 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3787 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3788 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3789 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3790 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3791
3792 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3793 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3794 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3795 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3796
3797 @noindent
3798 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3799 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3800 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3801 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3802 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3803
3804 @noindent
3805 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3806 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3807 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3808 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3809 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3810 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3811
3812 @noindent
3813 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3814 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3815
3816 @end table
3817
3818 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3819 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3820 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3821 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3822
3823 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3824 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3825 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3826 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3827
3828 @itemize @bullet
3829 @item
3830 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3831
3832 @item
3833 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3834 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3835
3836 @item
3837 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3838 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3839
3840 @item
3841 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3842 several places where that function is inlined.
3843 @end itemize
3844
3845 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3846 the relevant locations.
3847
3848 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3849 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3850 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3851 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3852 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3853 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3854 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3855
3856 For example:
3857
3858 @smallexample
3859 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3860 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3861 stop only if i==1
3862 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3863 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3864 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3865 @end smallexample
3866
3867 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3868 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3869 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3870 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3871 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3872 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3873 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3874 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3875 that belong to that breakpoint.
3876
3877 @cindex pending breakpoints
3878 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3879 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3880 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3881 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3882 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3883 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3884 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3885 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3886 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3887 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3888 is not yet resolved.
3889
3890 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3891 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3892 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3893 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3894 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3895 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3896
3897 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3898 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3899 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3900 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3901
3902 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3903 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3904 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3905
3906 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3907 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3908 address specification to an address:
3909
3910 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3911 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3912 @table @code
3913 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3914 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3915 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3916
3917 @item set breakpoint pending on
3918 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3919 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3920
3921 @item set breakpoint pending off
3922 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3923 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3924 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3925
3926 @item show breakpoint pending
3927 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3928 @end table
3929
3930 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3931 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3932 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3933
3934 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3935 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3936 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3937 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3938 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3939 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3940 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3941 breakpoints.
3942
3943 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3944
3945 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3946 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3947 @table @code
3948 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3949 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3950 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3951 breakpoint must be used.
3952
3953 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3954 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3955 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3956 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3957 @end table
3958
3959 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3960 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3961 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3962 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3963 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3964 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3965 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3966 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3967 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3968
3969 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3970 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3971 @table @code
3972 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3973 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3974 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3975 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3976
3977 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3978 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3979 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3980 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3981 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3982 @end table
3983
3984 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3985 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3986 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3987
3988 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3989 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3990
3991 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3992
3993 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3994 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3995 @table @code
3996 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3997 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3998 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3999 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4000 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4001
4002 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4003 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4004 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4005 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4006 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4007 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4008 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4009 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4010 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4011 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4012 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4013 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4014 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4015
4016 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4017 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4018 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4019 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4020 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4021 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4022 @end table
4023
4024
4025 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4026 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4027 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4028 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4029 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4030 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4031 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4032 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4033
4034
4035 @node Set Watchpoints
4036 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4037
4038 @cindex setting watchpoints
4039 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4040 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4041 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4042 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4043 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4044
4045 @itemize @bullet
4046 @item
4047 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4048
4049 @item
4050 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4051 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4052 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4053
4054 @item
4055 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4056 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4057 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4058 @end itemize
4059
4060 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4061 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4062 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4063 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4064 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4065 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4066 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4067 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4068 the expression changes.
4069
4070 @cindex software watchpoints
4071 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4072 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4073 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4074 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4075 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4076 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4077 culprit.)
4078
4079 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4080 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4081 slow down the running of your program.
4082
4083 @table @code
4084 @kindex watch
4085 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4086 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4087 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4088 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4089 to watch the value of a single variable:
4090
4091 @smallexample
4092 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4093 @end smallexample
4094
4095 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4096 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4097 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4098 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4099 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4100 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4101
4102 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4103 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4104 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4105 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4106 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4107 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4108 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4109 error.
4110
4111 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4112 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4113 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4114 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4115 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4116 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4117 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4118 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4119 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4120 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4121 Examples:
4122
4123 @smallexample
4124 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4125 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4126 @end smallexample
4127
4128 @kindex rwatch
4129 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4130 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4131 by the program.
4132
4133 @kindex awatch
4134 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4135 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4136 or written into by the program.
4137
4138 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4139 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4140 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4141 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4142 @end table
4143
4144 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4145 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4146 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4147 a never-changing value:
4148
4149 @smallexample
4150 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4151 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4152 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4153 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4154 @end smallexample
4155
4156 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4157 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4158 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4159 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4160 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4161 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4162
4163 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4164 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4165 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4166 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4167 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4168 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4169 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4170 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4171
4172 @table @code
4173 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4174 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4175 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4176
4177 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4178 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4179 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4180 @end table
4181
4182 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4183 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4184 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4185
4186 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4187
4188 @smallexample
4189 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4190 @end smallexample
4191
4192 @noindent
4193 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4194
4195 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4196 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4197 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4198 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4199 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4200 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4201 will print a message like this:
4202
4203 @smallexample
4204 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4205 @end smallexample
4206
4207 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4208 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4209 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4210 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4211 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4212 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4213 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4214 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4215
4216 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4217 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4218 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4219 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4220 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4221 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4222
4223 @smallexample
4224 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227 @noindent
4228 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4229
4230 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4231 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4232 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4233 expression with separately allocated resources.
4234
4235 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4236 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4237 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4238
4239 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4240 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4241 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4242 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4243 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4244 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4245 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4246 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4247 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4248
4249 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4250 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4251 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4252 watched expression from every thread.
4253
4254 @quotation
4255 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4256 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4257 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4258 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4259 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4260 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4261 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4262 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4263 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4264 @end quotation
4265
4266 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4267
4268 @node Set Catchpoints
4269 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4270 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4271 @cindex exception handlers
4272 @cindex event handling
4273
4274 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4275 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4276 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @kindex catch
4280 @item catch @var{event}
4281 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4282
4283 @table @code
4284 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4285 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4286 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287 @kindex catch throw
4288 @kindex catch rethrow
4289 @kindex catch catch
4290 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4291 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4292
4293 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4294 regular expression will be caught.
4295
4296 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4297 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4298 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4299 exception being thrown.
4300
4301 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4302 @value{GDBN}:
4303
4304 @itemize @bullet
4305 @item
4306 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4307 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4308 supported.
4309
4310 @item
4311 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4312 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4313 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4314 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4315 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4316 built.
4317
4318 @item
4319 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4320 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4321
4322 @item
4323 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4324 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4325 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4326 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4327
4328 @item
4329 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4330 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4331 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4332 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4333 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4334 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4335 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4336 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4337 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4338
4339 @item
4340 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4341
4342 @item
4343 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4344 @end itemize
4345
4346 @item exception
4347 @kindex catch exception
4348 @cindex Ada exception catching
4349 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4350 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4351 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4352 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4353 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4354
4355 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4356 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4357 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4358 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4359 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4360 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4361 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4362 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4363
4364 @item exception unhandled
4365 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4366 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4367
4368 @item assert
4369 @kindex catch assert
4370 A failed Ada assertion.
4371
4372 @item exec
4373 @kindex catch exec
4374 @cindex break on fork/exec
4375 A call to @code{exec}.
4376
4377 @item syscall
4378 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4379 @kindex catch syscall
4380 @cindex break on a system call.
4381 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4382 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4383 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4384 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4385 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4386 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4387 will be caught.
4388
4389 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4390 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4391 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4392 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4393
4394 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4395 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4396 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4397 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4398
4399 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4400 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4401 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4402 available choices.
4403
4404 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4405 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4406 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4407 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4408 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4409 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4410 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4411 behind the OS upgrades).
4412
4413 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4414 arguments to it:
4415
4416 @smallexample
4417 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4418 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4419 (@value{GDBP}) r
4420 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4421
4422 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4423 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4424 (@value{GDBP}) c
4425 Continuing.
4426
4427 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4428 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4429 (@value{GDBP})
4430 @end smallexample
4431
4432 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4436 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4437 (@value{GDBP}) r
4438 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4439
4440 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4441 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4442 (@value{GDBP}) c
4443 Continuing.
4444
4445 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4446 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4447 (@value{GDBP})
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4451 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4452 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4453
4454 @smallexample
4455 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4456 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4457 (@value{GDBP}) r
4458 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4459
4460 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4461 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4462 (@value{GDBP}) c
4463 Continuing.
4464
4465 Program exited normally.
4466 (@value{GDBP})
4467 @end smallexample
4468
4469 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4470 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4471 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4472 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4473
4474 @smallexample
4475 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4476 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4477 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4478 (@value{GDBP})
4479 @end smallexample
4480
4481 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4482 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4483 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4484 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4485 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4486 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4487
4488 @smallexample
4489 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4490 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4491 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4492 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4493 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4494 (@value{GDBP})
4495 @end smallexample
4496
4497 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4498
4499 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4500 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4504 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4505 @end smallexample
4506
4507 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4508
4509 @item fork
4510 @kindex catch fork
4511 A call to @code{fork}.
4512
4513 @item vfork
4514 @kindex catch vfork
4515 A call to @code{vfork}.
4516
4517 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4518 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4519 @kindex catch load
4520 @kindex catch unload
4521 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4522 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4523 matches one of the affected libraries.
4524
4525 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4526 @kindex catch signal
4527 The delivery of a signal.
4528
4529 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4530 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4531 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4532
4533 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4534 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4535 signal names.
4536
4537 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4538 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4539 will be caught.
4540
4541 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4542 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4543 catchpoint.
4544
4545 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4546 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4547 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4548 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4549 commands.
4550
4551 @end table
4552
4553 @item tcatch @var{event}
4554 @kindex tcatch
4555 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4556 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4557
4558 @end table
4559
4560 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4561
4562
4563 @node Delete Breaks
4564 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4565
4566 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4567 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4568 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4569 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4570 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4571 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4572
4573 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4574 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4575 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4576 their breakpoint numbers.
4577
4578 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4579 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4580 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4581
4582 @table @code
4583 @kindex clear
4584 @item clear
4585 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4586 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4587 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4588 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4589
4590 @item clear @var{location}
4591 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4592 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4593 most useful ones are listed below:
4594
4595 @table @code
4596 @item clear @var{function}
4597 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4598 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4599
4600 @item clear @var{linenum}
4601 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4602 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4603 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4604 @end table
4605
4606 @cindex delete breakpoints
4607 @kindex delete
4608 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4609 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4610 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4611 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4612 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4613 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4614 @end table
4615
4616 @node Disabling
4617 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4618
4619 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4620 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4621 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4622 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4623 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4624
4625 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4626 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4627 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4628 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4629 do not know which numbers to use.
4630
4631 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4632 affects all of its locations.
4633
4634 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4635 different states of enablement:
4636
4637 @itemize @bullet
4638 @item
4639 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4640 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4641 @item
4642 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4643 @item
4644 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4645 disabled.
4646 @item
4647 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4648 N times, then becomes disabled.
4649 @item
4650 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4651 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4652 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4653 @end itemize
4654
4655 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4656 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4657
4658 @table @code
4659 @kindex disable
4660 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4661 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4662 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4663 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4664 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4665 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4666 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4667
4668 @kindex enable
4669 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4670 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4671 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4672
4673 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4674 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4675 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4676
4677 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4678 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4679 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4680 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4681 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4682 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4683 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4684
4685 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4686 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4687 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4688 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4692 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4693 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4694 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4695 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4696 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4697 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4698 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4699 Stepping}.)
4700
4701 @node Conditions
4702 @subsection Break Conditions
4703 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4704 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4705
4706 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4707 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4708 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4709 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4710 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4711 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4712 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4713 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4714
4715 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4716 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4717 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4718 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4719 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4720
4721 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4722 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4723 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4724 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4725 one.
4726
4727 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4728 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4729 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4730 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4731 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4732 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4733 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4734 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4735 conditions for the
4736 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4737 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4738
4739 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4740 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4741 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4742 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4743 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4744 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4745
4746 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4747 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4748 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4749 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4750 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4751
4752 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4753 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4754 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4755 with the @code{condition} command.
4756
4757 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4758 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4759 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4760 catchpoint.
4761
4762 @table @code
4763 @kindex condition
4764 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4765 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4767 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4768 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4769 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4770 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4771 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4772 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4773 prints an error message:
4774
4775 @smallexample
4776 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4777 @end smallexample
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 @value{GDBN} does
4781 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4782 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4783 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4784
4785 @item condition @var{bnum}
4786 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4787 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4788 @end table
4789
4790 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4791 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4792 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4793 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4794 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4795 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4796 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4797 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4798 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4799 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4800 your program reaches it.
4801
4802 @table @code
4803 @kindex ignore
4804 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4805 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4806 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4807 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4808 takes no action.
4809
4810 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4811 a count of zero.
4812
4813 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4814 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4815 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4816 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4817
4818 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4819 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4820 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4821
4822 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4823 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4824 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4825 Variables}.
4826 @end table
4827
4828 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4829
4830
4831 @node Break Commands
4832 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4833
4834 @cindex breakpoint commands
4835 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4836 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4837 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4838 enable other breakpoints.
4839
4840 @table @code
4841 @kindex commands
4842 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4843 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4844 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4845 @itemx end
4846 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4847 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4848 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4849
4850 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4851 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4852
4853 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4854 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4855 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4856 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4857 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4858 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4859 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4860 Expressions}).
4861 @end table
4862
4863 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4864 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4865
4866 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4867 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4868 that resumes execution.
4869
4870 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4871 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4872 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4873 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4874 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4875
4876 @kindex silent
4877 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4878 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4879 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4880 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4881 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4882 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4883
4884 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4885 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4886 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4887
4888 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4889 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 break foo if x>0
4893 commands
4894 silent
4895 printf "x is %d\n",x
4896 cont
4897 end
4898 @end smallexample
4899
4900 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4901 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4902 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4903 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4904 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4905 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4906 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4907
4908 @smallexample
4909 break 403
4910 commands
4911 silent
4912 set x = y + 4
4913 cont
4914 end
4915 @end smallexample
4916
4917 @node Dynamic Printf
4918 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4919
4920 @cindex dynamic printf
4921 @cindex dprintf
4922 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4923 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4924 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4925 having to recompile it.
4926
4927 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4928 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4929 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4930 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4931 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4932 redirects to files and so forth.
4933
4934 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4935 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4936 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4937 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4938 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4939 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4940 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4941
4942 @table @code
4943 @kindex dprintf
4944 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4945 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4946 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4947 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4948
4949 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4950 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4951 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4952 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4953 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4954 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4955
4956 @item gdb
4957 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4958 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4959
4960 @item call
4961 @kindex dprintf-style call
4962 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4963 @code{printf}).
4964
4965 @item agent
4966 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4967 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4968 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4969 support running commands on the target.
4970
4971 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4972 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4973 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4974 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4975 command.
4976
4977 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4978 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4979 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4980 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4981 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4982 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4983
4984 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4985 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4986 you could do the following:
4987
4988 @example
4989 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4990 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4991 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4992 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4993 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4994 (gdb) info break
4995 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4996 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4997 continue
4998 (gdb)
4999 @end example
5000
5001 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5002 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5003 the variable settings.
5004
5005 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5006 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5007 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5008 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5009 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5010 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5011
5012 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5013 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5014 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5015
5016 @end table
5017
5018 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5019 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5020 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5021 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5022 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5023 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5024
5025 @node Save Breakpoints
5026 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5027
5028 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5029 breakpoints}} command.
5030
5031 @table @code
5032 @kindex save breakpoints
5033 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5034 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5035 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5036 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5037 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5038 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5039 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5040 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5041 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5042 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5043 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5044 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5045 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5046 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5047 that can no longer be recreated.
5048 @end table
5049
5050 @node Static Probe Points
5051 @subsection Static Probe Points
5052
5053 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5054 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5055 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5056 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5057 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5058
5059 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5060 ELF-compatible systems:
5061
5062 @itemize @bullet
5063
5064 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5065 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5066 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5067 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5068 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5069 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5070 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5071 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5072
5073 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5074 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5075 C@t{++} languages.
5076 @end itemize
5077
5078 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5079 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5080 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5081 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5082 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5083 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5084 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5085 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5086 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5087
5088 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5089 probes}, with optional arguments:
5090
5091 @table @code
5092 @kindex info probes
5093 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5094 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5095 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5096 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5097
5098 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5099 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5100 probes from all providers are listed.
5101
5102 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5103 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5104 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5105
5106 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5107 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5108 given, all object files are considered.
5109
5110 @item info probes all
5111 List the available static probes, from all types.
5112 @end table
5113
5114 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5115 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5116 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5117 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5118 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5119
5120 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5121 commands, with optional arguments:
5122
5123 @table @code
5124 @kindex enable probes
5125 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5126 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5127 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5128 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5129
5130 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5131 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5132 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5133
5134 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5135 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5136 given, all object files are considered.
5137
5138 @kindex disable probes
5139 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5140 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5141 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5142 @end table
5143
5144 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5145 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5146 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5147 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5148 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5149 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5150 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5151 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5152 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5153 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5154 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5155 at the current probe point.
5156
5157 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5158 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5159 an error message.
5160
5161
5162 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5163 @node Error in Breakpoints
5164 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5165
5166 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5167 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5168
5169 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5170 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5171 @smallexample
5172 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5173 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5174 @end smallexample
5175
5176 @noindent
5177 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5178 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5179 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5180
5181 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5182 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5183
5184 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5185 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5186 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5187
5188 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5189 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5190 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5191 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5192
5193 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5194 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5195 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5196 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5197 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5198 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5199 first in the bundle.
5200
5201 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5202 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5203 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5204 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5205 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5206 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5207 is hit.
5208
5209 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5210 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5211
5212 @smallexample
5213 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5214 @end smallexample
5215
5216 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5217 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5218 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5219 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5220 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5221 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5222 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5223 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5226 adjusted breakpoints:
5227
5228 @smallexample
5229 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5230 to 0x00010410.
5231 @end smallexample
5232
5233 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5234 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5235 frequently than expected.
5236
5237 @node Continuing and Stepping
5238 @section Continuing and Stepping
5239
5240 @cindex stepping
5241 @cindex continuing
5242 @cindex resuming execution
5243 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5244 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5245 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5246 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5247 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5248 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5249 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5250 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5251 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5252 handlers}).)
5253
5254 @table @code
5255 @kindex continue
5256 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5257 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5258 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5259 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5260 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5261 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5262 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5263 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5264 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5265 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5266
5267 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5268 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5269 @code{continue} is ignored.
5270
5271 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5272 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5273 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5274 @code{continue}.
5275 @end table
5276
5277 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5278 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5279 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5280 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5281
5282 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5283 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5284 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5285 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5286 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5287 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5288
5289 @table @code
5290 @kindex step
5291 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5292 @item step
5293 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5294 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5295 abbreviated @code{s}.
5296
5297 @quotation
5298 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5299 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5300 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5301 @c distinction here.
5302 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5303 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5304 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5305 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5306 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5307 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5308 below.
5309 @end quotation
5310
5311 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5312 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5313 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5314 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5315 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5316 called within the line.
5317
5318 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5319 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5320 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5321 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5322 was any debugging information about the routine.
5323
5324 @item step @var{count}
5325 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5326 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5327 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5328
5329 @kindex next
5330 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5331 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5332 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5333 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5334 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5335 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5336 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5337 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5338
5339 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5340
5341
5342 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5343 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5344 @c
5345 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5346 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5347 @c function are executed without stopping.
5348
5349 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5350 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5351 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5352
5353 @kindex set step-mode
5354 @item set step-mode
5355 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5356 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5357 @itemx set step-mode on
5358 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5359 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5360 information rather than stepping over it.
5361
5362 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5363 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5364 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5365
5366 @item set step-mode off
5367 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5368 debug information. This is the default.
5369
5370 @item show step-mode
5371 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5372 source line debug information.
5373
5374 @kindex finish
5375 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5376 @item finish
5377 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5378 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5379 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5380
5381 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5382 ,Returning from a Function}).
5383
5384 @kindex until
5385 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5386 @cindex run until specified location
5387 @item until
5388 @itemx u
5389 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5390 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5391 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5392 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5393 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5394 than the address of the jump.
5395
5396 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5397 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5398 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5399 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5400 through the next iteration.
5401
5402 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5403 stack frame.
5404
5405 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5406 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5407 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5408 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5409 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5410
5411 @smallexample
5412 (@value{GDBP}) f
5413 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5414 206 expand_input();
5415 (@value{GDBP}) until
5416 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5417 @end smallexample
5418
5419 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5420 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5421 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5422 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5423 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5424 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5425 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5426
5427 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5428 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5429 argument.
5430
5431 @item until @var{location}
5432 @itemx u @var{location}
5433 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5434 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5435 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5436 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5437 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5438 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5439 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5440 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5441 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5442 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5443 invocations have returned.
5444
5445 @smallexample
5446 94 int factorial (int value)
5447 95 @{
5448 96 if (value > 1) @{
5449 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5450 98 @}
5451 99 return (value);
5452 100 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455
5456 @kindex advance @var{location}
5457 @item advance @var{location}
5458 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5459 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5460 @ref{Specify Location}.
5461 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5462 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5463 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5464 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5465
5466
5467 @kindex stepi
5468 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5469 @item stepi
5470 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5471 @itemx si
5472 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5473
5474 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5475 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5476 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5477 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5478
5479 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5480
5481 @need 750
5482 @kindex nexti
5483 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5484 @item nexti
5485 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5486 @itemx ni
5487 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5488 proceed until the function returns.
5489
5490 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5491
5492 @end table
5493
5494 @anchor{range stepping}
5495 @cindex range stepping
5496 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5497 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5498 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5499 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5500 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5501 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5502 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5503 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5504 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5505 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5506 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5507 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5508 if necessary:
5509
5510 @table @code
5511 @kindex set range-stepping
5512 @kindex show range-stepping
5513 @item set range-stepping
5514 @itemx show range-stepping
5515 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5516
5517 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5518 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5519 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5520 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5521 default is @code{on}.
5522
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5526 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5527 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5528
5529 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5530 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5531 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5532 a particular file when stepping.
5533
5534 For example, consider the following C function:
5535
5536 @smallexample
5537 101 int func()
5538 102 @{
5539 103 foo(boring());
5540 104 bar(boring());
5541 105 @}
5542 @end smallexample
5543
5544 @noindent
5545 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5546 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5547 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5548 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5549
5550 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5551 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5552 is called from many places.
5553
5554 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5555 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5556 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5557 @code{foo}.
5558
5559 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5560 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5561 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5562
5563 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5564 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5565 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5566 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5567 the underlying system.
5568 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5569 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5570
5571 @table @code
5572 @kindex skip
5573 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5574 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5575 that specify what to skip.
5576 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5577
5578 @table @code
5579 @item -file @var{file}
5580 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5581 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5582
5583 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5584 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5585 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5586 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5587 over when stepping.
5588
5589 @smallexample
5590 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5591 @end smallexample
5592
5593 @item -function @var{linespec}
5594 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5595 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5596 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5597 @xref{Specify Location}.
5598
5599 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5600 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5601 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5602 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5603
5604 This form is useful for complex function names.
5605 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5606 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5607 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5608 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5609 regular expression makes this easier.
5610
5611 @smallexample
5612 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5613 @end smallexample
5614
5615 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5616 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5617
5618 @smallexample
5619 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5620 @end smallexample
5621 @end table
5622
5623 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5624 will be skipped.
5625
5626 @kindex skip function
5627 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5628 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5629 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5630 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5631
5632 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5633 will be skipped.
5634
5635 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5636 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5637
5638 @kindex skip file
5639 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5640 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5641 will be skipped over when stepping.
5642
5643 @smallexample
5644 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5645 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5646 @end smallexample
5647
5648 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5649 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5650 @end table
5651
5652 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5653 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5654
5655 @table @code
5656 @kindex info skip
5657 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5658 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5659 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5660 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5661
5662 @table @emph
5663 @item Identifier
5664 A number identifying this skip.
5665 @item Enabled or Disabled
5666 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5667 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5668 @item Glob
5669 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5670 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5671 @item File
5672 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5673 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5674 @item RE
5675 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5676 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5677 @item Function
5678 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5679 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5680 @end table
5681
5682 @kindex skip delete
5683 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5684 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5685 skips.
5686
5687 @kindex skip enable
5688 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5689 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5690 skips.
5691
5692 @kindex skip disable
5693 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5694 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5695 skips.
5696
5697 @end table
5698
5699 @node Signals
5700 @section Signals
5701 @cindex signals
5702
5703 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5704 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5705 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5706 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5707 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5708 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5709 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5710 requested an alarm).
5711
5712 @cindex fatal signals
5713 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5714 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5715 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5716 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5717 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5718 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5719
5720 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5721 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5722 signal.
5723
5724 @cindex handling signals
5725 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5726 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5727 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5728 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5729 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5730
5731 @table @code
5732 @kindex info signals
5733 @kindex info handle
5734 @item info signals
5735 @itemx info handle
5736 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5737 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5738 the defined types of signals.
5739
5740 @item info signals @var{sig}
5741 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5742
5743 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5744
5745 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5746 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5747 for details about this command.
5748
5749 @kindex handle
5750 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5751 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5752 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5753 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5754 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5755 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5756 say what change to make.
5757 @end table
5758
5759 @c @group
5760 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5761 Their full names are:
5762
5763 @table @code
5764 @item nostop
5765 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5766 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5767
5768 @item stop
5769 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5770 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5771
5772 @item print
5773 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5774
5775 @item noprint
5776 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5777 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5778
5779 @item pass
5780 @itemx noignore
5781 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5782 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5783 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5784
5785 @item nopass
5786 @itemx ignore
5787 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5788 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5789 @end table
5790 @c @end group
5791
5792 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5793 program until you
5794 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5795 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5796 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5797 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5798 program sees that signal when you continue.
5799
5800 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5801 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5802 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5803 erroneous signals.
5804
5805 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5806 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5807 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5808 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5809 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5810 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5811 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5812 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5813 Program a Signal}.
5814
5815 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5816 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5817
5818 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5819 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5820 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5821 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5822 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5823 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5824 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5825 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5826 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5827 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5828 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5829 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5830 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5831
5832 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5833
5834 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5835 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5836 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5837 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5838
5839 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5840 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5841 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5842 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5843
5844 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5845 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5846
5847 @smallexample
5848 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5849 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5850 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5851 (@value{GDBP}) c
5852 Continuing.
5853
5854 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5855 main () sigusr1.c:28
5856 28 p = 0;
5857 (@value{GDBP}) si
5858 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5859 9 @{
5860 @end smallexample
5861
5862 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5863 program to receive the signal first:
5864
5865 @smallexample
5866 (@value{GDBP}) n
5867 28 p = 0;
5868 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5869 (@value{GDBP}) si
5870 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5871 9 @{
5872 (@value{GDBP})
5873 @end smallexample
5874
5875 @cindex extra signal information
5876 @anchor{extra signal information}
5877
5878 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5879 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5880 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5881 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5882 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5883 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5884 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5885 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5886 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5887 system header.
5888
5889 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5890 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5891
5892 @smallexample
5893 @group
5894 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5895 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5896 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5897 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5898 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5899 type = struct @{
5900 int si_signo;
5901 int si_errno;
5902 int si_code;
5903 union @{
5904 int _pad[28];
5905 struct @{...@} _kill;
5906 struct @{...@} _timer;
5907 struct @{...@} _rt;
5908 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5909 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5910 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5911 @} _sifields;
5912 @}
5913 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5914 type = struct @{
5915 void *si_addr;
5916 @}
5917 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5918 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5919 @end group
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5923
5924 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5925 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5926 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5927 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5928 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5929 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5930 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5931 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5932 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5933 information is displayed.
5934
5935 The usual output of a segfault is:
5936 @smallexample
5937 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5938 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5939 68 value = *(p + len);
5940 @end smallexample
5941
5942 While a bound violation is presented as:
5943 @smallexample
5944 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5945 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5946 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5947 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5948 68 value = *(p + len);
5949 @end smallexample
5950
5951 @node Thread Stops
5952 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5953
5954 @cindex stopped threads
5955 @cindex threads, stopped
5956
5957 @cindex continuing threads
5958 @cindex threads, continuing
5959
5960 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5961 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5962 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5963 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5964 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5965 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5966 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5967 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5968 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5969
5970 @menu
5971 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5972 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5973 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5974 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5975 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5976 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5977 @end menu
5978
5979 @node All-Stop Mode
5980 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5981
5982 @cindex all-stop mode
5983
5984 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5985 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5986 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5987 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5988 underfoot.
5989
5990 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5991 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5992 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5993
5994 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5995 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5996 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5997 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5998 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5999 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6000 stops.
6001
6002 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6003 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6004 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6005 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6006
6007 @cindex automatic thread selection
6008 @cindex switching threads automatically
6009 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6010 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6011 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6012 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6013 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6014 thread.
6015
6016 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6017 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6018
6019 @table @code
6020 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6021 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6022 @cindex lock scheduler
6023 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6024 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6025 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6026 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6027 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6028 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6029 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6030 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6031 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6032 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6033 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6034 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6035 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6036 @code{on} in replay mode.
6037
6038 @item show scheduler-locking
6039 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6040 @end table
6041
6042 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6043 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6044 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6045 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6046 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6047 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6048 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6049 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6050 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6051 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6052 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6053 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6054 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6055 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6056
6057 @table @code
6058 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6059 @item set schedule-multiple
6060 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6061 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6062 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6063 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6064 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6065 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6066
6067 @item show schedule-multiple
6068 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6069 multiple processes.
6070 @end table
6071
6072 @node Non-Stop Mode
6073 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6074
6075 @cindex non-stop mode
6076
6077 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6078 @c with more details.
6079
6080 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6081 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6082 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6083 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6084 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6085 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6086
6087 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6088 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6089 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6090 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6091 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6092 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6093 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6094 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6095 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6096 independently and simultaneously.
6097
6098 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6099 or attach to your program:
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6103 set pagination off
6104
6105 # Finally, turn it on!
6106 set non-stop on
6107 @end smallexample
6108
6109 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6110
6111 @table @code
6112 @kindex set non-stop
6113 @item set non-stop on
6114 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6115 @item set non-stop off
6116 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6117 @kindex show non-stop
6118 @item show non-stop
6119 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6120 @end table
6121
6122 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6123 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6124 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6125 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6126 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6127 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6128 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6129 default.
6130
6131 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6132 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6133 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6134
6135 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6136 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6137 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6138 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6139 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6140
6141 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6142 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6143 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6144 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6145 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6146
6147 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6148
6149 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6150 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6151 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6152 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6153 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6154 previously current thread.
6155
6156 @node Background Execution
6157 @subsection Background Execution
6158
6159 @cindex foreground execution
6160 @cindex background execution
6161 @cindex asynchronous execution
6162 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6163
6164 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6165 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6166 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6167 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6168 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6169 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6170
6171 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6172 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6173
6174 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6175 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6176 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6177 are:
6178
6179 @table @code
6180 @kindex run&
6181 @item run
6182 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6183
6184 @item attach
6185 @kindex attach&
6186 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6187
6188 @item step
6189 @kindex step&
6190 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6191
6192 @item stepi
6193 @kindex stepi&
6194 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6195
6196 @item next
6197 @kindex next&
6198 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6199
6200 @item nexti
6201 @kindex nexti&
6202 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6203
6204 @item continue
6205 @kindex continue&
6206 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6207
6208 @item finish
6209 @kindex finish&
6210 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6211
6212 @item until
6213 @kindex until&
6214 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6215
6216 @end table
6217
6218 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6219 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6220 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6221 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6222 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6223 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6224
6225 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6226 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @kindex interrupt
6230 @item interrupt
6231 @itemx interrupt -a
6232
6233 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6234 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6235 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6236 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6237 @end table
6238
6239 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6240 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6241
6242 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6243 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6244 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6245
6246 @table @code
6247 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6248 @cindex thread breakpoints
6249 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6250 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6251 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6252 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6253 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6254 specify some source line.
6255
6256 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6257 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6258 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6259 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6260 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6261
6262 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6263 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6264 program.
6265
6266 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6267 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6268 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6269
6270 @smallexample
6271 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6272 @end smallexample
6273
6274 @end table
6275
6276 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6277 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6278 thread list. For example:
6279
6280 @smallexample
6281 (@value{GDBP}) c
6282 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6283 @end smallexample
6284
6285 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6286 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6287 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6288 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6289 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6290 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6291 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6292 command.
6293
6294 @node Interrupted System Calls
6295 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6296
6297 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6298 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6299 @cindex premature return from system calls
6300 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6301 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6302 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6303 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6304 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6305 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6306 stop execution.
6307
6308 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6309 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6310 style anyways.
6311
6312 For example, do not write code like this:
6313
6314 @smallexample
6315 sleep (10);
6316 @end smallexample
6317
6318 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6319 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6320
6321 Instead, write this:
6322
6323 @smallexample
6324 int unslept = 10;
6325 while (unslept > 0)
6326 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6327 @end smallexample
6328
6329 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6330 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6331 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6332 @value{GDBN}.
6333
6334 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6335 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6336 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6337 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6338
6339 @node Observer Mode
6340 @subsection Observer Mode
6341
6342 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6343 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6344 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6345 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6346 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6347
6348 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6349 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6350 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6351 mode.
6352
6353 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6354 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6355 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6356 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6357 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6358
6359 @table @code
6360
6361 @kindex observer
6362 @item set observer on
6363 @itemx set observer off
6364 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6365 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6366 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6367 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6368
6369 @item show observer
6370 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6371
6372 @kindex may-write-registers
6373 @item set may-write-registers on
6374 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6375 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6376 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6377 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6378
6379 @item show may-write-registers
6380 Show the current permission to write registers.
6381
6382 @kindex may-write-memory
6383 @item set may-write-memory on
6384 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6385 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6386 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6387 defaults to @code{on}.
6388
6389 @item show may-write-memory
6390 Show the current permission to write memory.
6391
6392 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6393 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6394 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6395 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6396 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6397 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6398
6399 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6400 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6401
6402 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6403 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6404 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6405 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6406 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6407 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6408 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6409
6410 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6411 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6412
6413 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6414 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6415 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6416 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6417 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6418 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6419 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6420
6421 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6422 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6423
6424 @kindex may-interrupt
6425 @item set may-interrupt on
6426 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6427 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6428 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6429 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6430 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6431
6432 @item show may-interrupt
6433 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6434
6435 @end table
6436
6437 @node Reverse Execution
6438 @chapter Running programs backward
6439 @cindex reverse execution
6440 @cindex running programs backward
6441
6442 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6443 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6444 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6445 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6446
6447 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6448 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6449 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6450 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6451 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6452 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6453
6454 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6455 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6456 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6457 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6458 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6459 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6460 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6461 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6462 prior values@footnote{
6463 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6464 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6465 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6466
6467 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6468 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6469 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6470 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6471 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6472 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6473 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6474 }.
6475
6476 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6477 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6478
6479 @table @code
6480 @kindex reverse-continue
6481 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6482 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6483 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6484 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6485 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6486 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6487 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6488
6489 @kindex reverse-step
6490 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6491 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6492 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6493 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6494
6495 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6496 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6497 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6498 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6499 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6500 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6501
6502 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6503 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6504
6505 @kindex reverse-stepi
6506 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6507 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6508 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6509 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6510 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6511 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6512 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6513
6514 @kindex reverse-next
6515 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6516 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6517 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6518 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6519 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6520 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6521 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6522 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6523 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6524 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6525
6526 @kindex reverse-nexti
6527 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6528 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6529 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6530 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6531 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6532 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6533 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6534 frame) is reached.
6535
6536 @kindex reverse-finish
6537 @item reverse-finish
6538 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6539 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6540 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6541 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6542
6543 @kindex set exec-direction
6544 @item set exec-direction
6545 Set the direction of target execution.
6546 @item set exec-direction reverse
6547 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6548 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6549 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6550 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6551 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6552 @item set exec-direction forward
6553 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6554 This is the default.
6555 @end table
6556
6557
6558 @node Process Record and Replay
6559 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6560 @cindex process record and replay
6561 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6562
6563 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6564 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6565 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6566
6567 @cindex replay mode
6568 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6569 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6570 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6571 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6572 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6573 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6574 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6575 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6576 execution log.
6577
6578 @cindex record mode
6579 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6580 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6581 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6582 for future replay.
6583
6584 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6585 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6586 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6587 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6588 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6589 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6590
6591 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6592 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6593 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6594 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6595
6596 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6597 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6598
6599 @table @code
6600 @kindex target record
6601 @kindex target record-full
6602 @kindex target record-btrace
6603 @kindex record
6604 @kindex record full
6605 @kindex record btrace
6606 @kindex record btrace bts
6607 @kindex record btrace pt
6608 @kindex record bts
6609 @kindex record pt
6610 @kindex rec
6611 @kindex rec full
6612 @kindex rec btrace
6613 @kindex rec btrace bts
6614 @kindex rec btrace pt
6615 @kindex rec bts
6616 @kindex rec pt
6617 @item record @var{method}
6618 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6619 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6620 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6621 recording methods are available:
6622
6623 @table @code
6624 @item full
6625 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6626 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6627 execution.
6628
6629 @item btrace @var{format}
6630 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6631 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6632 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6633 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6634 execution.
6635
6636 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6637 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6638 formats are available:
6639
6640 @table @code
6641 @item bts
6642 @cindex branch trace store
6643 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6644 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6645 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6646
6647 @item pt
6648 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6649 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6650 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6651 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6652
6653 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6654 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6655 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6656
6657 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6658 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6659 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6660 buffer-size with care.
6661 @end table
6662
6663 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6664 @end table
6665
6666 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6667 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6668 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6669 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6670
6671 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6672 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6673 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6674 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6675 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6676
6677 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6678 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6679 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6680 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6681 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6682 does not support these two modes.
6683
6684 @kindex record stop
6685 @kindex rec s
6686 @item record stop
6687 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6688 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6689 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6690
6691 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6692 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6693 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6694 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6695 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6696
6697 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6698 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6699 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6700 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6701 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6702
6703 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6704 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6705
6706 @kindex record goto
6707 @item record goto
6708 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6709 ways to specify the location to go to:
6710
6711 @table @code
6712 @item record goto begin
6713 @itemx record goto start
6714 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6715
6716 @item record goto end
6717 Go to the end of the execution log.
6718
6719 @item record goto @var{n}
6720 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6721 @end table
6722
6723 @kindex record save
6724 @item record save @var{filename}
6725 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6726 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6727 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6728
6729 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6730
6731 @kindex record restore
6732 @item record restore @var{filename}
6733 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6734 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6735
6736 @kindex set record full
6737 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6738 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6739 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6740 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6741
6742 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6743 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6744 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6745 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6746 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6747 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6748 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6749 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6750
6751 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6752 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6753 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6754
6755 @kindex show record full
6756 @item show record full insn-number-max
6757 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6758 recording method.
6759
6760 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6761 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6762 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6763 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6764 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6765 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6766 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6767 oldest one to be deleted.
6768
6769 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6770 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6771
6772 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6773 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6774
6775 @item set record full memory-query
6776 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6777 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6778 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6779 case.
6780
6781 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6782 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6783 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6784 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6785 results.
6786
6787 @item show record full memory-query
6788 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6789
6790 @kindex set record btrace
6791 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6792 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6793 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6794 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6795 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6796 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6797 You can use the following command for that:
6798
6799 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6800 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6801 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6802 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6803 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6804 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6805 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6806 position.
6807
6808 @kindex show record btrace
6809 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6810 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6811
6812 @kindex set record btrace bts
6813 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6814 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6815 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6816 format. Default is 64KB.
6817
6818 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6819 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6820 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6821 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6822 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6823 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6824 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6825
6826 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6827 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6828
6829 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6830 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6831
6832 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6833 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6834 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6835
6836 @kindex set record btrace pt
6837 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6838 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6839 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6840 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6841
6842 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6843 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6844 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6845 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6846 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6847 actual buffer size for each thread.
6848
6849 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6850 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6851
6852 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6853 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6854
6855 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6856 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6857 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6858
6859 @kindex info record
6860 @item info record
6861 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6862 method:
6863
6864 @table @code
6865 @item full
6866 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6867 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6868
6869 @itemize @bullet
6870 @item
6871 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6872 @item
6873 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6874 @item
6875 Highest recorded instruction number.
6876 @item
6877 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6878 @item
6879 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6880 @item
6881 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6882 @end itemize
6883
6884 @item btrace
6885 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6886
6887 @itemize @bullet
6888 @item
6889 Recording format.
6890 @item
6891 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6892 @item
6893 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6894 instructions.
6895 @item
6896 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6897 @end itemize
6898
6899 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6900 @itemize @bullet
6901 @item
6902 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6903 @end itemize
6904
6905 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6906 @itemize @bullet
6907 @item
6908 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6909 @end itemize
6910 @end table
6911
6912 @kindex record delete
6913 @kindex rec del
6914 @item record delete
6915 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6916 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6917 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6918 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6919
6920 @kindex record instruction-history
6921 @kindex rec instruction-history
6922 @item record instruction-history
6923 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6924 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6925 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6926 are printed in execution order.
6927
6928 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6929 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6930 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6931
6932 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6933 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6934 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6935 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6936 @code{/p} modifier.
6937
6938 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6939 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6940 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6941
6942 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6943 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6944
6945 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6946 disassemble:
6947
6948 @table @code
6949 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6950 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6951 @var{insn}.
6952
6953 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6954 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6955 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6956 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6957 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6958 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6959
6960 @item record instruction-history
6961 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6962
6963 @item record instruction-history -
6964 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6965
6966 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6967 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6968 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6969 number @var{end} is included.
6970 @end table
6971
6972 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6973
6974 @kindex set record
6975 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6976 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6977 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6978 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6979 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6980
6981 @kindex show record
6982 @item show record instruction-history-size
6983 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6984 instruction-history} command.
6985
6986 @kindex record function-call-history
6987 @kindex rec function-call-history
6988 @item record function-call-history
6989 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6990 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6991 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6992 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6993 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6994 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6995 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6996 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6997 given together.
6998
6999 @smallexample
7000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7001 1 void foo (void)
7002 2 @{
7003 3 @}
7004 4
7005 5 void bar (void)
7006 6 @{
7007 7 ...
7008 8 foo ();
7009 9 ...
7010 10 @}
7011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7012 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7013 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7014 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7015 @end smallexample
7016
7017 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7018 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7019 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7020 to print:
7021
7022 @table @code
7023 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7024 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7025
7026 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7027 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7028 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7029 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7030 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7031
7032 @item record function-call-history
7033 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7034
7035 @item record function-call-history -
7036 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7037
7038 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7039 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7040 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7041 @end table
7042
7043 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7044
7045 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7046 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7047 Define how many lines to print in the
7048 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7049 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7050
7051 @item show record function-call-history-size
7052 Show how many lines to print in the
7053 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7054 @end table
7055
7056
7057 @node Stack
7058 @chapter Examining the Stack
7059
7060 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7061 stopped and how it got there.
7062
7063 @cindex call stack
7064 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7065 is generated.
7066 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7067 the arguments of the call,
7068 and the local variables of the function being called.
7069 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7070 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7071 stack}.
7072
7073 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7074 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7075
7076 @cindex selected frame
7077 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7078 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7079 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7080 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7081 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7082 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7083
7084 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7085 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7086 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7087
7088 @menu
7089 * Frames:: Stack frames
7090 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7091 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7092 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7093 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7094
7095 @end menu
7096
7097 @node Frames
7098 @section Stack Frames
7099
7100 @cindex frame, definition
7101 @cindex stack frame
7102 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7103 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7104 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7105 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7106 which the function is executing.
7107
7108 @cindex initial frame
7109 @cindex outermost frame
7110 @cindex innermost frame
7111 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7112 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7113 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7114 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7115 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7116 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7117 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7118 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7119
7120 @cindex frame pointer
7121 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7122 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7123 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7124 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7125 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7126 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7127
7128 @cindex frame number
7129 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7130 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7131 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7132 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7133 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7134
7135 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7136 @c underflow problems.
7137 @cindex frameless execution
7138 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7139 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7140 @smallexample
7141 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7142 @end smallexample
7143 generates functions without a frame.)
7144 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7145 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7146 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7147 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7148 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7149 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7150 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7151
7152 @node Backtrace
7153 @section Backtraces
7154
7155 @cindex traceback
7156 @cindex call stack traces
7157 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7158 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7159 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7160 stack.
7161
7162 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7163 @table @code
7164 @kindex backtrace
7165 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7166 @item backtrace
7167 @itemx bt
7168 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7169 frames in the stack.
7170
7171 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7172 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7173
7174 @item backtrace @var{n}
7175 @itemx bt @var{n}
7176 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7177
7178 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7179 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7180 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7181
7182 @item backtrace full
7183 @itemx bt full
7184 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7185 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7186 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7187 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7188
7189 @item backtrace no-filters
7190 @itemx bt no-filters
7191 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7192 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7193 @itemx bt no-filters full
7194 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7195 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7196 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7197 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7198 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7199 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7200 support.
7201 @end table
7202
7203 @kindex where
7204 @kindex info stack
7205 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7206 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7207
7208 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7209 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7210 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7211 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7212 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7213 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7214 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7215 multi-threaded program.
7216
7217 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7218 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7219 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7220 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7221 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7222 line number.
7223
7224 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7225 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7226
7227 @smallexample
7228 @group
7229 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7230 at builtin.c:993
7231 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7232 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7233 at macro.c:71
7234 (More stack frames follow...)
7235 @end group
7236 @end smallexample
7237
7238 @noindent
7239 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7240 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7241 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7242
7243 @noindent
7244 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7245 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7246 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7247 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7248 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7249
7250 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7251 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7252 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7253 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7254 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7255 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7256 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7257 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7258 such a backtrace might look like:
7259
7260 @smallexample
7261 @group
7262 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7263 at builtin.c:993
7264 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7265 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7266 at macro.c:71
7267 (More stack frames follow...)
7268 @end group
7269 @end smallexample
7270
7271 @noindent
7272 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7273 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7274
7275 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7276 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7277 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7278
7279 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7280 @cindex program entry point
7281 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7282 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7283 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7284 @code{main}@footnote{
7285 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7286 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7287 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7288 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7289 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7290 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7291
7292 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7293 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7294
7295 @table @code
7296 @item set backtrace past-main
7297 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7298 @kindex set backtrace
7299 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7300
7301 @item set backtrace past-main off
7302 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7303 default.
7304
7305 @item show backtrace past-main
7306 @kindex show backtrace
7307 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7308
7309 @item set backtrace past-entry
7310 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7311 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7312 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7313 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7314
7315 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7316 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7317 application. This is the default.
7318
7319 @item show backtrace past-entry
7320 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7321
7322 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7323 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7324 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7325 @cindex backtrace limit
7326 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7327 or zero means unlimited levels.
7328
7329 @item show backtrace limit
7330 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7331 @end table
7332
7333 You can control how file names are displayed.
7334
7335 @table @code
7336 @item set filename-display
7337 @itemx set filename-display relative
7338 @cindex filename-display
7339 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7340
7341 @item set filename-display basename
7342 Display only basename of a filename.
7343
7344 @item set filename-display absolute
7345 Display an absolute filename.
7346
7347 @item show filename-display
7348 Show the current way to display filenames.
7349 @end table
7350
7351 @node Selection
7352 @section Selecting a Frame
7353
7354 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7355 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7356 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7357 of the stack frame just selected.
7358
7359 @table @code
7360 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7361 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7362 @item frame @var{n}
7363 @itemx f @var{n}
7364 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7365 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7366 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7367 @code{main}.
7368
7369 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7370 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7371 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7372 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7373 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7374 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7375 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7376 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7377
7378 @kindex up
7379 @item up @var{n}
7380 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7381 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7382 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7383
7384 @kindex down
7385 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7386 @item down @var{n}
7387 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7388 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7389 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7390 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7391 @end table
7392
7393 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7394 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7395 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7396 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7397
7398 @need 1000
7399 For example:
7400
7401 @smallexample
7402 @group
7403 (@value{GDBP}) up
7404 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7405 at env.c:10
7406 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7407 @end group
7408 @end smallexample
7409
7410 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7411 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7412 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7413 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7414 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7415 for details.
7416
7417 @table @code
7418 @kindex select-frame
7419 @item select-frame
7420 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7421 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7422 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7423 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7424
7425 @kindex down-silently
7426 @kindex up-silently
7427 @item up-silently @var{n}
7428 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7429 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7430 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7431 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7432 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7433 distracting.
7434 @end table
7435
7436 @node Frame Info
7437 @section Information About a Frame
7438
7439 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7440 stack frame.
7441
7442 @table @code
7443 @item frame
7444 @itemx f
7445 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7446 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7447 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7448 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7449 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7450
7451 @kindex info frame
7452 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7453 @item info frame
7454 @itemx info f
7455 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7456 including:
7457
7458 @itemize @bullet
7459 @item
7460 the address of the frame
7461 @item
7462 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7463 @item
7464 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7465 @item
7466 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7467 @item
7468 the address of the frame's arguments
7469 @item
7470 the address of the frame's local variables
7471 @item
7472 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7473 @item
7474 which registers were saved in the frame
7475 @end itemize
7476
7477 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7478 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7479 the usual conventions.
7480
7481 @item info frame @var{addr}
7482 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7483 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7484 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7485 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7486 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7487 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7488
7489 @kindex info args
7490 @item info args
7491 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7492
7493 @item info locals
7494 @kindex info locals
7495 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7496 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7497 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7498
7499 @end table
7500
7501 @node Frame Filter Management
7502 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7503 @cindex managing frame filters
7504
7505 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7506 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7507
7508 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7509 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7510
7511 @table @code
7512 @kindex info frame-filter
7513 @item info frame-filter
7514 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7515 their name, priority and enabled status.
7516
7517 @kindex disable frame-filter
7518 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7519 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7520 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7521 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7522 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7523 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7524 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7525 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7526 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7527 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7528 may be enabled again later.
7529
7530 @kindex enable frame-filter
7531 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7532 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7533 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7534 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7535 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7536 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7537 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7538 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7539 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7540
7541 Example:
7542
7543 @smallexample
7544 (gdb) info frame-filter
7545
7546 global frame-filters:
7547 Priority Enabled Name
7548 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7549 100 Yes Reverse
7550
7551 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7552 Priority Enabled Name
7553 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7554
7555 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7556 Priority Enabled Name
7557 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7558
7559 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7560 (gdb) info frame-filter
7561
7562 global frame-filters:
7563 Priority Enabled Name
7564 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7565 100 Yes Reverse
7566
7567 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7568 Priority Enabled Name
7569 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7570
7571 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7572 Priority Enabled Name
7573 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7574
7575 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7576 (gdb) info frame-filter
7577
7578 global frame-filters:
7579 Priority Enabled Name
7580 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7581 100 Yes Reverse
7582
7583 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7584 Priority Enabled Name
7585 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7586
7587 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7588 Priority Enabled Name
7589 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7590 @end smallexample
7591
7592 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7593 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7594 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7595 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7596 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7597 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7598 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7599
7600 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7601 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7602 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7603 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7604 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7605 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7606 dictionary resides.
7607
7608 Example:
7609
7610 @smallexample
7611 (gdb) info frame-filter
7612
7613 global frame-filters:
7614 Priority Enabled Name
7615 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7616 100 Yes Reverse
7617
7618 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7619 Priority Enabled Name
7620 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7621
7622 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7623 Priority Enabled Name
7624 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7625
7626 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7627 (gdb) info frame-filter
7628
7629 global frame-filters:
7630 Priority Enabled Name
7631 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7632 50 Yes Reverse
7633
7634 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7635 Priority Enabled Name
7636 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7637
7638 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7639 Priority Enabled Name
7640 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7641 @end smallexample
7642 @end table
7643
7644 @node Source
7645 @chapter Examining Source Files
7646
7647 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7648 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7649 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7650 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7651 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7652 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7653 source files by explicit command.
7654
7655 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7656 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7657 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7658
7659 @menu
7660 * List:: Printing source lines
7661 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7662 * Edit:: Editing source files
7663 * Search:: Searching source files
7664 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7665 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7666 @end menu
7667
7668 @node List
7669 @section Printing Source Lines
7670
7671 @kindex list
7672 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7673 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7674 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7675 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7676 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7677
7678 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7679
7680 @table @code
7681 @item list @var{linenum}
7682 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7683 current source file.
7684
7685 @item list @var{function}
7686 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7687 @var{function}.
7688
7689 @item list
7690 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7691 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7692 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7693 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7694 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7695
7696 @item list -
7697 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7698 @end table
7699
7700 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7701 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7702 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7703
7704 @table @code
7705 @kindex set listsize
7706 @item set listsize @var{count}
7707 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7708 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7709 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7710 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7711
7712 @kindex show listsize
7713 @item show listsize
7714 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7715 @end table
7716
7717 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7718 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7719 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7720 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7721 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7722
7723 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7724 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7725 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7726 to specify some source line.
7727
7728 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7729
7730 @table @code
7731 @item list @var{location}
7732 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7733
7734 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7735 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7736 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7737 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7738 the same source file as the first location.
7739
7740 @item list ,@var{last}
7741 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7742
7743 @item list @var{first},
7744 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7745
7746 @item list +
7747 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7748
7749 @item list -
7750 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7751
7752 @item list
7753 As described in the preceding table.
7754 @end table
7755
7756 @node Specify Location
7757 @section Specifying a Location
7758 @cindex specifying location
7759 @cindex location
7760 @cindex source location
7761
7762 @menu
7763 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7764 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7765 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7766 @end menu
7767
7768 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7769 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7770 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7771 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7772 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7773
7774 @node Linespec Locations
7775 @subsection Linespec Locations
7776 @cindex linespec locations
7777
7778 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7779 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7780 specifying a linespec:
7781
7782 @table @code
7783 @item @var{linenum}
7784 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7785
7786 @item -@var{offset}
7787 @itemx +@var{offset}
7788 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7789 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7790 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7791 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7792 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7793 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7794 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7795 linespec.
7796
7797 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7798 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7799 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7800 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7801 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7802 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7803 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7804
7805 @item @var{function}
7806 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7807 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7808
7809 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7810 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7811
7812 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7813 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7814 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7815 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7816 functions in different source files.
7817
7818 @item @var{label}
7819 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7820 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7821 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7822 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7823
7824 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7825 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7826 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7827 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7828 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7829 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7830
7831 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7832 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7833 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7834 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7835 each one of those probes.
7836 @end table
7837
7838 @node Explicit Locations
7839 @subsection Explicit Locations
7840 @cindex explicit locations
7841
7842 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7843 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7844
7845 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7846 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7847 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7848 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7849 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7850
7851 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7852 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7853 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7854 the symbol table to know.
7855
7856 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7857 following table:
7858
7859 @table @code
7860 @item -source @var{filename}
7861 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7862 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7863 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7864 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7865 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7866
7867 @item -function @var{function}
7868 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7869 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7870 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7871 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7872
7873 @item -label @var{label}
7874 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7875 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7876 selected stack frame.
7877
7878 @item -line @var{number}
7879 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7880 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7881 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7882 relative to the current line.
7883 @end table
7884
7885 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7886 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7887
7888 @node Address Locations
7889 @subsection Address Locations
7890 @cindex address locations
7891
7892 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7893 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7894
7895 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7896 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7897 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7898 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7899 source files.
7900
7901 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7902 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7903 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7904 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7905 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7906 of @var{address}:
7907
7908 @table @code
7909 @item @var{expression}
7910 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7911
7912 @item @var{funcaddr}
7913 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7914 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7915 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7916 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7917 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7918 (although the Pascal form also works).
7919
7920 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7921 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7922
7923 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7924 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7925 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7926 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7927 functions with identical names in different source files.
7928 @end table
7929
7930 @node Edit
7931 @section Editing Source Files
7932 @cindex editing source files
7933
7934 @kindex edit
7935 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7936 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7937 The editing program of your choice
7938 is invoked with the current line set to
7939 the active line in the program.
7940 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7941 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7942
7943 @table @code
7944 @item edit @var{location}
7945 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7946 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7947 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7948 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7949 command most commonly used:
7950
7951 @table @code
7952 @item edit @var{number}
7953 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7954
7955 @item edit @var{function}
7956 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7957 @end table
7958
7959 @end table
7960
7961 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7962 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7963 @footnote{
7964 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7965 following command-line syntax:
7966 @smallexample
7967 ex +@var{number} file
7968 @end smallexample
7969 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7970 the file where to start editing.}.
7971 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7972 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7973 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7974 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7975 @smallexample
7976 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7977 export EDITOR
7978 gdb @dots{}
7979 @end smallexample
7980 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7981 @smallexample
7982 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7983 gdb @dots{}
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986 @node Search
7987 @section Searching Source Files
7988 @cindex searching source files
7989
7990 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7991 regular expression.
7992
7993 @table @code
7994 @kindex search
7995 @kindex forward-search
7996 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7997 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7998 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7999 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8000 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8001 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8002 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8003 @code{fo}.
8004
8005 @kindex reverse-search
8006 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8007 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8008 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8009 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8010 this command as @code{rev}.
8011 @end table
8012
8013 @node Source Path
8014 @section Specifying Source Directories
8015
8016 @cindex source path
8017 @cindex directories for source files
8018 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8019 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8020 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8021 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8022 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8023 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8024 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8025
8026 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8027 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8028 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8029 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8030 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8031 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8032 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8033 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8034 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8035 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8036 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8037
8038 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8039 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8040 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8041 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8042 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8043 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8044
8045 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8046 source files.
8047
8048 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8049 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8050 each line is in the file.
8051
8052 @kindex directory
8053 @kindex dir
8054 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8055 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8056 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8057
8058 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8059 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8060
8061 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8062 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8063 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8064 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8065 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8066 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8067 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8068 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8069 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8070 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8071 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8072 name to look up the sources.
8073
8074 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8075 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8076 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8077 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8078 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8079 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8080 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8081 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8082
8083 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8084 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8085 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8086 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8087 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8088 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8089 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8090
8091 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8092 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8093 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8094 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8095 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8096 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8097 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8098 command.
8099
8100 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8101 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8102 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8103 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8104 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8105 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8106 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8107
8108 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8109 @cindex default source path substitution
8110 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8111 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8112 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8113 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8114 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8115 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8116 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8117 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8118 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8119 together.
8120
8121 @table @code
8122 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8123 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8124 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8125 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8126 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8127 part of absolute file names) or
8128 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8129 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8130
8131 @kindex cdir
8132 @kindex cwd
8133 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8134 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8135 @cindex compilation directory
8136 @cindex current directory
8137 @cindex working directory
8138 @cindex directory, current
8139 @cindex directory, compilation
8140 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8141 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8142 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8143 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8144 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8145 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8146
8147 @item directory
8148 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8149
8150 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8151 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8152
8153 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8154 @kindex set directories
8155 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8156 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8157
8158 @item show directories
8159 @kindex show directories
8160 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8161
8162 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8163 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8164 @kindex set substitute-path
8165 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8166 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8167 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8168
8169 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8170 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8171
8172 @smallexample
8173 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8174 @end smallexample
8175
8176 @noindent
8177 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8178 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8179 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8180
8181 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8182 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8183 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8184 the substitution.
8185
8186 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8187
8188 @smallexample
8189 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8190 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8191 @end smallexample
8192
8193 @noindent
8194 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8195 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8196 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8197 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8198
8199
8200 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8201 @kindex unset substitute-path
8202 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8203 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8204 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8205
8206 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8207
8208 @item show substitute-path [path]
8209 @kindex show substitute-path
8210 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8211 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8212
8213 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8214 rules.
8215
8216 @end table
8217
8218 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8219 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8220 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8221
8222 @enumerate
8223 @item
8224 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8225
8226 @item
8227 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8228 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8229 directories in one command.
8230 @end enumerate
8231
8232 @node Machine Code
8233 @section Source and Machine Code
8234 @cindex source line and its code address
8235
8236 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8237 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8238 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8239 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8240 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8241 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8242 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8243 well as hex.
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex info line
8247 @item info line @var{location}
8248 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8249 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8250 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8251 @end table
8252
8253 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8254 the object code for the first line of function
8255 @code{m4_changequote}:
8256
8257 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8258 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8259 @smallexample
8260 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8261 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 @cindex code address and its source line
8266 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8267 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8268 @smallexample
8269 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8270 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8271 @end smallexample
8272
8273 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8274 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8275 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8276 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8277 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8278 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8279 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8280 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8281 Variables}).
8282
8283 @table @code
8284 @kindex disassemble
8285 @cindex assembly instructions
8286 @cindex instructions, assembly
8287 @cindex machine instructions
8288 @cindex listing machine instructions
8289 @item disassemble
8290 @itemx disassemble /m
8291 @itemx disassemble /s
8292 @itemx disassemble /r
8293 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8294 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8295 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8296 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8297 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8298 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8299 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8300 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8301 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8302 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8306 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8307 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8308 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8309 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8310 @end table
8311
8312 @noindent
8313 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8314 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8315
8316 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8317 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8318
8319 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8320 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8321 @end table
8322
8323 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8324 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8325
8326 @smallexample
8327 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8328 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8329 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8330 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8331 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8332 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8333 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8334 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8335 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8336 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8337 End of assembler dump.
8338 @end smallexample
8339
8340 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8341 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8342 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8343
8344 @smallexample
8345 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8346 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8347 5 @{
8348 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8349 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8350 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8351 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8352 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8353
8354 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8355 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8356 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8357
8358 7 return 0;
8359 8 @}
8360 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8361 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8362 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8363
8364 End of assembler dump.
8365 @end smallexample
8366
8367 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8368 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8369 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8370 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8371 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8372 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8373 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8374 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8375 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8376
8377 @file{foo.h}:
8378
8379 @smallexample
8380 int
8381 foo (int a)
8382 @{
8383 if (a < 0)
8384 return a * 2;
8385 if (a == 0)
8386 return 1;
8387 return a + 10;
8388 @}
8389 @end smallexample
8390
8391 @file{foo.c}:
8392
8393 @smallexample
8394 #include "foo.h"
8395 volatile int x, y;
8396 int
8397 main ()
8398 @{
8399 x = foo (y);
8400 return 0;
8401 @}
8402 @end smallexample
8403
8404 @smallexample
8405 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8406 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8407 5 @{
8408
8409 6 x = foo (y);
8410 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8411 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8412
8413 7 return 0;
8414 8 @}
8415 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8416 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8417 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8418 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8419
8420 End of assembler dump.
8421 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8422 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8423 foo.c:
8424 5 @{
8425 6 x = foo (y);
8426 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8427
8428 foo.h:
8429 4 if (a < 0)
8430 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8431 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8432
8433 6 if (a == 0)
8434 7 return 1;
8435 8 return a + 10;
8436 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8437 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8438 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8439 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8440
8441 foo.c:
8442 6 x = foo (y);
8443 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8444
8445 7 return 0;
8446 8 @}
8447 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8448 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8449
8450 foo.h:
8451 5 return a * 2;
8452 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8453 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8454 End of assembler dump.
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8458
8459 @smallexample
8460 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8461 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8462 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8463 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8464 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8465 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8466 End of assembler dump.
8467 @end smallexample
8468
8469 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8470 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8471 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8472 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8473
8474 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8475 mnemonics or other syntax.
8476
8477 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8478 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8479 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8480 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8481 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8482
8483 @table @code
8484 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8485 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8486 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8487 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8488 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8489 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8490
8491 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8492 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8493 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8494 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8495
8496 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8497 @item show disassembly-flavor
8498 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8499 @end table
8500
8501 @table @code
8502 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8503 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8504 @item set disassemble-next-line
8505 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8506 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8507 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8508 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8509 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8510 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8511 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8512 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8513 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8514 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8515 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8516 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8517 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8518 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8519 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8520 instruction.
8521 @end table
8522
8523
8524 @node Data
8525 @chapter Examining Data
8526
8527 @cindex printing data
8528 @cindex examining data
8529 @kindex print
8530 @kindex inspect
8531 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8532 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8533 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8534 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8535 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8536 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8537
8538 @table @code
8539 @item print @var{expr}
8540 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8541 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8542 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8543 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8544 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8545 Formats}.
8546
8547 @item print
8548 @itemx print /@var{f}
8549 @cindex reprint the last value
8550 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8551 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8552 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8553 @end table
8554
8555 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8556 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8557 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8558
8559 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8560 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8561 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8562 Table}.
8563
8564 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8565 @kindex explore
8566 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8567 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8568 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8569 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8570 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8571 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8572 embedded in the higher level data types.
8573
8574 @table @code
8575 @item explore @var{arg}
8576 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8577 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8578 @end table
8579
8580 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8581 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8582 C program as
8583
8584 @smallexample
8585 struct SimpleStruct
8586 @{
8587 int i;
8588 double d;
8589 @};
8590
8591 struct ComplexStruct
8592 @{
8593 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8594 int arr[10];
8595 @};
8596 @end smallexample
8597
8598 @noindent
8599 followed by variable declarations as
8600
8601 @smallexample
8602 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8603 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8604 @end smallexample
8605
8606 @noindent
8607 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8608 @code{explore} command as follows.
8609
8610 @smallexample
8611 (gdb) explore cs
8612 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8613 the following fields:
8614
8615 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8616 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8617
8618 Enter the field number of choice:
8619 @end smallexample
8620
8621 @noindent
8622 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8623 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8624 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8625 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8626 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8627 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8628 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8629 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8630
8631 @smallexample
8632 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8633 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8634 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8635 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8636
8637 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8638 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8639
8640 Press enter to return to parent value:
8641 @end smallexample
8642
8643 @noindent
8644 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8645 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8646 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8647 to explore.
8648
8649 @smallexample
8650 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8651 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8652
8653 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8654
8655 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8656
8657 Press enter to return to parent value:
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8661 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8662 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8663 level data structure).
8664
8665 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8666 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8667 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8668 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8669 same example as above, your can explore the type
8670 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8671 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8675 @end smallexample
8676
8677 @noindent
8678 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8679 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8680 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8681 example.
8682
8683 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8684 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8685 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8686 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8687 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8688
8689 @table @code
8690 @item explore value @var{expr}
8691 @cindex explore value
8692 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8693 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8694 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8695 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8696 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8697
8698 @item explore type @var{arg}
8699 @cindex explore type
8700 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8701 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8702 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8703 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8704 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8705 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8706 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8707 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8708 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8709 @end table
8710
8711 @menu
8712 * Expressions:: Expressions
8713 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8714 * Variables:: Program variables
8715 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8716 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8717 * Memory:: Examining memory
8718 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8719 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8720 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8721 * Value History:: Value history
8722 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8723 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8724 * Registers:: Registers
8725 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8726 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8727 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8728 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8729 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8730 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8731 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8732 character set than GDB does
8733 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8734 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8735 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8736 @end menu
8737
8738 @node Expressions
8739 @section Expressions
8740
8741 @cindex expressions
8742 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8743 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8744 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8745 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8746 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8747 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8748 @ref{Compilation}.
8749
8750 @cindex arrays in expressions
8751 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8752 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8753 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8754 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8755 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8756 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8757
8758 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8759 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8760 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8761 languages.
8762
8763 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8764 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8765
8766 @cindex casts, in expressions
8767 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8768 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8769 at that address in memory.
8770 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8771
8772 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8773 to programming languages:
8774
8775 @table @code
8776 @item @@
8777 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8778 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8779
8780 @item ::
8781 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8782 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8783
8784 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8785 @cindex type casting memory
8786 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8787 @cindex casts, to view memory
8788 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8789 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8790 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8791 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8792 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8793 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8794 @end table
8795
8796 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8797 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8798 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8799
8800 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8801 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8802 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8803 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8804 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8805 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8806 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8807
8808 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8809 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8810 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8811 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8812 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8813 as well.
8814
8815 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8816 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8817 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8818 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8819 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8820 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8821 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8822 choices.
8823
8824 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8825 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8826 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8827
8828 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8829 @smallexample
8830 @group
8831 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8832 [0] cancel
8833 [1] all
8834 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8835 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8836 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8837 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8838 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8839 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8840 > 2 4 6
8841 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8842 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8843 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8844 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8845 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8846 breakpoints.
8847 (@value{GDBP})
8848 @end group
8849 @end smallexample
8850
8851 @table @code
8852 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8853 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8854 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8855
8856 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8857 is ambiguous.
8858
8859 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8860 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8861 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8862 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8863 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8864 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8865 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8866 in the use of the menu.
8867
8868 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8869 when an ambiguity is detected.
8870
8871 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8872 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8873
8874 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8875 @item show multiple-symbols
8876 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8877 @end table
8878
8879 @node Variables
8880 @section Program Variables
8881
8882 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8883 in your program.
8884
8885 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8886 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8887
8888 @itemize @bullet
8889 @item
8890 global (or file-static)
8891 @end itemize
8892
8893 @noindent or
8894
8895 @itemize @bullet
8896 @item
8897 visible according to the scope rules of the
8898 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8899 @end itemize
8900
8901 @noindent This means that in the function
8902
8903 @smallexample
8904 foo (a)
8905 int a;
8906 @{
8907 bar (a);
8908 @{
8909 int b = test ();
8910 bar (b);
8911 @}
8912 @}
8913 @end smallexample
8914
8915 @noindent
8916 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8917 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8918 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8919 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8920
8921 @cindex variable name conflict
8922 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8923 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8924 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8925 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8926 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8927 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8928 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8929
8930 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8931 @ifnotinfo
8932 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8933 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8934 @end ifnotinfo
8935 @smallexample
8936 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8937 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8938 @end smallexample
8939
8940 @noindent
8941 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8942 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8943 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8944 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8945
8946 @smallexample
8947 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8948 @end smallexample
8949
8950 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8951 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8952 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8953 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8954 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8955
8956 @smallexample
8957 void
8958 foo (int a)
8959 @{
8960 if (a < 10)
8961 bar (a);
8962 else
8963 process (a); /* Stop here */
8964 @}
8965
8966 int
8967 bar (int a)
8968 @{
8969 foo (a + 5);
8970 @}
8971 @end smallexample
8972
8973 @noindent
8974 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8975 here is what you might see
8976 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8977
8978 @smallexample
8979 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8980 $1 = 10
8981 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8982 $2 = 5
8983 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8984 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8985 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8986 $3 = 5
8987 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8988 $4 = 0
8989 @end smallexample
8990
8991 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8992 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8993 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8994 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8995 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8996
8997 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8998 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8999 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9000 @code{some_global}.
9001
9002 @smallexample
9003 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9004 $1 = 23
9005 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9006 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9007 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9008 $2 = 27
9009 @end smallexample
9010
9011 @cindex wrong values
9012 @cindex variable values, wrong
9013 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9014 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9015 @quotation
9016 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9017 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9018 scope, and just before exit.
9019 @end quotation
9020 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9021 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9022 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9023 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9024 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9025 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9026 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9027 variable definitions may be gone.
9028
9029 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9030 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9031 when compiling.
9032
9033 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9034 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9035 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9036 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9037 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9038 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9039 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9040
9041 @smallexample
9042 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9043 @end smallexample
9044
9045 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9046 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9047 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9048 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9049 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9050
9051 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9052 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9053 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9054 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9055
9056 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9057 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9058 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9059 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9060 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9061
9062 @smallexample
9063 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9064 29 i++;
9065 (gdb) next
9066 30 e (i);
9067 (gdb) print i
9068 $1 = 31
9069 (gdb) print i@@entry
9070 $2 = 30
9071 @end smallexample
9072
9073 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9074 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9075 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9076 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9077 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9078 For program code
9079
9080 @smallexample
9081 char var0[] = "A";
9082 signed char var1[] = "A";
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 You get during debugging
9086 @smallexample
9087 (gdb) print var0
9088 $1 = "A"
9089 (gdb) print var1
9090 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9091 @end smallexample
9092
9093 @node Arrays
9094 @section Artificial Arrays
9095
9096 @cindex artificial array
9097 @cindex arrays
9098 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9099 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9100 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9101 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9102 program.
9103
9104 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9105 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9106 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9107 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9108 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9109 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9110 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9111 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9112 example. If a program says
9113
9114 @smallexample
9115 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9116 @end smallexample
9117
9118 @noindent
9119 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9120
9121 @smallexample
9122 p *array@@len
9123 @end smallexample
9124
9125 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9126 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9127 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9128 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9129 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9130
9131 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9132 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9133 The value need not be in memory:
9134 @smallexample
9135 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9136 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9137 @end smallexample
9138
9139 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9140 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9141 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9142 @smallexample
9143 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9144 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9145 @end smallexample
9146
9147 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9148 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9149 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9150 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9151 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9152 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9153 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9154 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9155 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9156 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9157
9158 @smallexample
9159 set $i = 0
9160 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9161 @key{RET}
9162 @key{RET}
9163 @dots{}
9164 @end smallexample
9165
9166 @node Output Formats
9167 @section Output Formats
9168
9169 @cindex formatted output
9170 @cindex output formats
9171 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9172 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9173 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9174 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9175 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9176
9177 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9178 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9179 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9180 letters supported are:
9181
9182 @table @code
9183 @item x
9184 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9185 hexadecimal.
9186
9187 @item d
9188 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9189
9190 @item u
9191 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9192
9193 @item o
9194 Print as integer in octal.
9195
9196 @item t
9197 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9198 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9199 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9200 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9201
9202 @item a
9203 @cindex unknown address, locating
9204 @cindex locate address
9205 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9206 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9207 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9208
9209 @smallexample
9210 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9211 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9212 @end smallexample
9213
9214 @noindent
9215 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9216 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9217
9218 @item c
9219 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9220 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9221 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9222 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9223
9224 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9225 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9226 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9227 data.
9228
9229 @item f
9230 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9231 using typical floating point syntax.
9232
9233 @item s
9234 @cindex printing strings
9235 @cindex printing byte arrays
9236 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9237 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9238 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9239 natural types.
9240
9241 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9242 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9243 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9244 array.
9245
9246 @item z
9247 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9248 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9249 to the size of the integer type.
9250
9251 @item r
9252 @cindex raw printing
9253 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9254 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9255 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9256 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9257 pretty-printer which might exist.
9258 @end table
9259
9260 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9261
9262 @smallexample
9263 p/x $pc
9264 @end smallexample
9265
9266 @noindent
9267 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9268 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9269
9270 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9271 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9272 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9273
9274 @node Memory
9275 @section Examining Memory
9276
9277 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9278 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9279
9280 @cindex examining memory
9281 @table @code
9282 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9283 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9284 @itemx x @var{addr}
9285 @itemx x
9286 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9287 @end table
9288
9289 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9290 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9291 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9292 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9293 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9294
9295 @table @r
9296 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9297 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9298 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
9299 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9300 @c 4.1.2.
9301
9302 @item @var{f}, the display format
9303 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9304 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9305 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9306 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9307 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9308
9309 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9310 The unit size is any of
9311
9312 @table @code
9313 @item b
9314 Bytes.
9315 @item h
9316 Halfwords (two bytes).
9317 @item w
9318 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9319 @item g
9320 Giant words (eight bytes).
9321 @end table
9322
9323 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9324 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9325 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9326 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9327 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9328 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9329 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9330 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9331 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9332 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9333 be altered.
9334
9335 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9336 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9337 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9338 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9339 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9340 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9341 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9342 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9343 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9344 a value from memory).
9345 @end table
9346
9347 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9348 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9349 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9350 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9351 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9352
9353 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9354 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9355 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9356 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9357 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9358
9359 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9360 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9361 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9362 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9363 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9364 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9365 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9366 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9367 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9368
9369 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9370 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9371 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9372 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9373 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9374 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9375 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9376
9377 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9378 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9379
9380 @smallexample
9381 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9382 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9383 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9384 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9385 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9386 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9387 @end smallexample
9388
9389 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9390 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9391 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9392 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9393 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9394 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9395 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9396 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9397 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9398
9399 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9400 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9401 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9402
9403 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9404 @cindex addressable memory unit
9405 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9406 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9407 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9408 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9409 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9410 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9411 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9412 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9413 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9414
9415 @cindex remote memory comparison
9416 @cindex target memory comparison
9417 @cindex verify remote memory image
9418 @cindex verify target memory image
9419 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9420 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9421 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9422 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9423 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9424 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9425
9426 @table @code
9427 @kindex compare-sections
9428 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9429 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9430 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9431 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9432 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9433 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9434
9435 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9436 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9437 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9438 @end table
9439
9440 @node Auto Display
9441 @section Automatic Display
9442 @cindex automatic display
9443 @cindex display of expressions
9444
9445 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9446 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9447 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9448 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9449 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9450 The automatic display looks like this:
9451
9452 @smallexample
9453 2: foo = 38
9454 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9455 @end smallexample
9456
9457 @noindent
9458 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9459 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9460 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9461 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9462 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9463 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9464
9465 @table @code
9466 @kindex display
9467 @item display @var{expr}
9468 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9469 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9470
9471 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9472
9473 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9474 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9475 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9476 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9477 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9478
9479 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9480 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9481 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9482 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9483 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9484 @end table
9485
9486 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9487 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9488 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9489
9490 @table @code
9491 @kindex delete display
9492 @kindex undisplay
9493 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9494 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9495 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9496 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9497 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9498 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9499 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9500
9501 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9502 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9503
9504 @kindex disable display
9505 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9506 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9507 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9508 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9509 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9510 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9511 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9512 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9513
9514 @kindex enable display
9515 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9516 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9517 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9518 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9519 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9520 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9521 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9522
9523 @item display
9524 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9525 done when your program stops.
9526
9527 @kindex info display
9528 @item info display
9529 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9530 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9531 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9532 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9533 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9534 @end table
9535
9536 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9537 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9538 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9539 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9540 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9541 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9542 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9543 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9544 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9545 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9546 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9547
9548 @node Print Settings
9549 @section Print Settings
9550
9551 @cindex format options
9552 @cindex print settings
9553 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9554 and symbols are printed.
9555
9556 @noindent
9557 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9558
9559 @table @code
9560 @kindex set print
9561 @item set print address
9562 @itemx set print address on
9563 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9564 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9565 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9566 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9567 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9568 @code{set print address on}:
9569
9570 @smallexample
9571 @group
9572 (@value{GDBP}) f
9573 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9574 at input.c:530
9575 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9576 @end group
9577 @end smallexample
9578
9579 @item set print address off
9580 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9581 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9582
9583 @smallexample
9584 @group
9585 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9586 (@value{GDBP}) f
9587 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9588 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9589 @end group
9590 @end smallexample
9591
9592 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9593 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9594 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9595 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9596
9597 @kindex show print
9598 @item show print address
9599 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9600 @end table
9601
9602 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9603 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9604 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9605 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9606 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9607 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9608 it prints a symbolic address:
9609
9610 @table @code
9611 @item set print symbol-filename on
9612 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9613 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9614 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9615 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9616
9617 @item set print symbol-filename off
9618 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9619 default.
9620
9621 @item show print symbol-filename
9622 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9623 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9624 @end table
9625
9626 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9627 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9628 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9629
9630 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9631 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9632
9633 @table @code
9634 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9635 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9636 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9637 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9638 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9639 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9640 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9641 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9642
9643 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9644 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9645 symbolic address.
9646 @end table
9647
9648 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9649 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9650 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9651 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9652 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9653 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9654 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9655 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9656
9657 @smallexample
9658 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9659 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9660 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9661 @end smallexample
9662
9663 @quotation
9664 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9665 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9666 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9667 @end quotation
9668
9669 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9670 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9671
9672 @table @code
9673 @item set print symbol on
9674 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9675 one exists.
9676
9677 @item set print symbol off
9678 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9679 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9680 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9681
9682 @item show print symbol
9683 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9684 address.
9685 @end table
9686
9687 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9688
9689 @table @code
9690 @item set print array
9691 @itemx set print array on
9692 @cindex pretty print arrays
9693 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9694 but uses more space. The default is off.
9695
9696 @item set print array off
9697 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9698
9699 @item show print array
9700 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9701 arrays.
9702
9703 @cindex print array indexes
9704 @item set print array-indexes
9705 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9706 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9707 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9708 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9709
9710 @item set print array-indexes off
9711 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9712
9713 @item show print array-indexes
9714 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9715 arrays.
9716
9717 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9718 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9719 @cindex number of array elements to print
9720 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9721 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9722 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9723 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9724 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9725 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9726 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9727 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9728
9729 @item show print elements
9730 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9731 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9732
9733 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9734 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9735 @cindex printing frame argument values
9736 @cindex print all frame argument values
9737 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9738 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9739 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9740 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9741 values are:
9742
9743 @table @code
9744 @item all
9745 The values of all arguments are printed.
9746
9747 @item scalars
9748 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9749 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9750 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9751 only scalar arguments are shown:
9752
9753 @smallexample
9754 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9755 at frame-args.c:23
9756 @end smallexample
9757
9758 @item none
9759 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9760 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9761
9762 @smallexample
9763 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9764 at frame-args.c:23
9765 @end smallexample
9766 @end table
9767
9768 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9769 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9770 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9771 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9772 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9773 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9774 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9775 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9776 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9777 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9778
9779 @item show print frame-arguments
9780 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9781
9782 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9783 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9784
9785 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9786 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9787 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9788 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9789 This is the default.
9790
9791 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9792 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9793
9794 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9795 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9796 @kindex set print entry-values
9797 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9798 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9799 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9800 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9801 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9802
9803 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9804 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9805 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9806 @code{no} setting.
9807
9808 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9809 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9810 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9811 this information.
9812
9813 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9814
9815 @table @code
9816 @item no
9817 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9818 point.
9819 @smallexample
9820 #0 equal (val=5)
9821 #0 different (val=6)
9822 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9823 #0 born (val=10)
9824 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9825 @end smallexample
9826
9827 @item only
9828 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9829 values are never printed.
9830 @smallexample
9831 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9832 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9833 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9834 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9835 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9836 @end smallexample
9837
9838 @item preferred
9839 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9840 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9841 value for such parameter.
9842 @smallexample
9843 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9844 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9845 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9846 #0 born (val=10)
9847 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9848 @end smallexample
9849
9850 @item if-needed
9851 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9852 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9853 parameter.
9854 @smallexample
9855 #0 equal (val=5)
9856 #0 different (val=6)
9857 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9858 #0 born (val=10)
9859 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9860 @end smallexample
9861
9862 @item both
9863 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9864 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9865 optimizations.
9866 @smallexample
9867 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9868 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9869 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9870 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9871 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9872 @end smallexample
9873
9874 @item compact
9875 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9876 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9877 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9878 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9879 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9880 @smallexample
9881 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9882 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9883 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9884 #0 born (val=10)
9885 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9886 @end smallexample
9887
9888 @item default
9889 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9890 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9891 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9892 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9893 @smallexample
9894 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9895 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9896 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9897 #0 born (val=10)
9898 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9899 @end smallexample
9900 @end table
9901
9902 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9903 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9904
9905 @item show print entry-values
9906 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9907 entry.
9908
9909 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9910 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9911 @cindex repeated array elements
9912 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9913 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9914 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9915 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9916 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9917 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9918 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9919 is 10.
9920
9921 @item show print repeats
9922 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9923 elements.
9924
9925 @item set print null-stop
9926 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9927 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9928 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9929 contain only short strings.
9930 The default is off.
9931
9932 @item show print null-stop
9933 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9934 @sc{null} character.
9935
9936 @item set print pretty on
9937 @cindex print structures in indented form
9938 @cindex indentation in structure display
9939 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9940 per line, like this:
9941
9942 @smallexample
9943 @group
9944 $1 = @{
9945 next = 0x0,
9946 flags = @{
9947 sweet = 1,
9948 sour = 1
9949 @},
9950 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9951 @}
9952 @end group
9953 @end smallexample
9954
9955 @item set print pretty off
9956 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9957
9958 @smallexample
9959 @group
9960 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9961 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9962 @end group
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 This is the default format.
9967
9968 @item show print pretty
9969 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9970
9971 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9972 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9973 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9974 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9975 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9976 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9977 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9978 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9979
9980 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9981 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9982 international character sets, and is the default.
9983
9984 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9985 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9986
9987 @item set print union on
9988 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9989 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9990 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9991
9992 @item set print union off
9993 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9994 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9995 instead.
9996
9997 @item show print union
9998 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9999 structures and other unions.
10000
10001 For example, given the declarations
10002
10003 @smallexample
10004 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10005 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10006 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10007 Bug_forms;
10008
10009 struct thing @{
10010 Species it;
10011 union @{
10012 Tree_forms tree;
10013 Bug_forms bug;
10014 @} form;
10015 @};
10016
10017 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10018 @end smallexample
10019
10020 @noindent
10021 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10022
10023 @smallexample
10024 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @noindent
10028 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10029
10030 @smallexample
10031 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10032 @end smallexample
10033
10034 @noindent
10035 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10036 and in Pascal.
10037 @end table
10038
10039 @need 1000
10040 @noindent
10041 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10042
10043 @table @code
10044 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10045 @item set print demangle
10046 @itemx set print demangle on
10047 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10048 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10049 linkage. The default is on.
10050
10051 @item show print demangle
10052 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10053
10054 @item set print asm-demangle
10055 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10056 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10057 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10058 The default is off.
10059
10060 @item show print asm-demangle
10061 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10062 or demangled form.
10063
10064 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10065 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10066 @kindex set demangle-style
10067 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10068 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10069 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10070
10071 @table @code
10072 @item auto
10073 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10074 This is the default.
10075
10076 @item gnu
10077 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10078
10079 @item hp
10080 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10081
10082 @item lucid
10083 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10084
10085 @item arm
10086 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10087 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10088 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10089 require further enhancement to permit that.
10090
10091 @end table
10092 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10093
10094 @item show demangle-style
10095 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10096
10097 @item set print object
10098 @itemx set print object on
10099 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10100 @cindex display derived types
10101 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10102 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10103 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10104 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10105 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10106 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10107 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10108
10109 @item set print object off
10110 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10111 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10112
10113 @item show print object
10114 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10115
10116 @item set print static-members
10117 @itemx set print static-members on
10118 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10119 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10120
10121 @item set print static-members off
10122 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10123
10124 @item show print static-members
10125 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10126
10127 @item set print pascal_static-members
10128 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10129 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10130 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10131 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10132
10133 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10134 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10135
10136 @item show print pascal_static-members
10137 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10138
10139 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10140 @item set print vtbl
10141 @itemx set print vtbl on
10142 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10143 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10144 @cindex VTBL display
10145 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10146 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10147 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10148
10149 @item set print vtbl off
10150 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10151
10152 @item show print vtbl
10153 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10154 @end table
10155
10156 @node Pretty Printing
10157 @section Pretty Printing
10158
10159 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10160 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10161 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10162
10163 @menu
10164 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10165 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10166 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10167 @end menu
10168
10169 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10170 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10171
10172 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10173 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10174 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10175
10176 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10177 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10178 pretty-printers with their names.
10179 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10180 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10181 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10182 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10183
10184 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10185 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10186 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10187 do anything special.
10188
10189 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10190
10191 @itemize @bullet
10192 @item
10193 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10194 all inferiors.
10195
10196 @item
10197 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10198 when debugging that program.
10199 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10200
10201 @item
10202 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10203 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10204 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10205 @end itemize
10206
10207 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10208 pretty-printers are selected,
10209
10210 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10211 for new types.
10212
10213 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10214 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10215
10216 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10217
10218 @smallexample
10219 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10220 $1 = @{
10221 static npos = 4294967295,
10222 _M_dataplus = @{
10223 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10224 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10225 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10226 @},
10227 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10228 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10229 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10230 @}
10231 @}
10232 @end smallexample
10233
10234 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10235
10236 @smallexample
10237 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10238 $2 = "abcd"
10239 @end smallexample
10240
10241 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10242 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10243 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10244
10245 @table @code
10246 @kindex info pretty-printer
10247 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10248 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10249 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10250
10251 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10252 whose pretty-printers to list.
10253 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10254 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10255 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10256 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10257 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10258
10259 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10260 to list.
10261
10262 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10263 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10264 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10265 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10266
10267 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10268 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10269 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10270 @end table
10271
10272 Example:
10273
10274 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10275 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10276 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10277 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10278
10279 @smallexample
10280 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10281 library1.so:
10282 foo
10283 library2.so:
10284 bar
10285 bar1
10286 bar2
10287 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10288 library2.so:
10289 bar
10290 bar1
10291 bar2
10292 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10293 1 printer disabled
10294 2 of 3 printers enabled
10295 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10296 library1.so:
10297 foo [disabled]
10298 library2.so:
10299 bar
10300 bar1
10301 bar2
10302 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10303 1 printer disabled
10304 1 of 3 printers enabled
10305 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10306 library1.so:
10307 foo [disabled]
10308 library2.so:
10309 bar
10310 bar1 [disabled]
10311 bar2
10312 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10313 1 printer disabled
10314 0 of 3 printers enabled
10315 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10316 library1.so:
10317 foo [disabled]
10318 library2.so:
10319 bar [disabled]
10320 bar1 [disabled]
10321 bar2
10322 @end smallexample
10323
10324 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10325 as can each individual subprinter.
10326
10327 @node Value History
10328 @section Value History
10329
10330 @cindex value history
10331 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10332 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10333 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10334 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10335 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10336 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10337 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10338 symbol table.
10339
10340 @cindex @code{$}
10341 @cindex @code{$$}
10342 @cindex history number
10343 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10344 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10345 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10346 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10347 history number.
10348
10349 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10350 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10351 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10352 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10353 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10354 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10355 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10356
10357 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10358 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10359
10360 @smallexample
10361 p *$
10362 @end smallexample
10363
10364 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10365 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10366
10367 @smallexample
10368 p *$.next
10369 @end smallexample
10370
10371 @noindent
10372 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10373 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10374
10375 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10376 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10377
10378 @smallexample
10379 print x
10380 set x=5
10381 @end smallexample
10382
10383 @noindent
10384 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10385 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10386
10387 @table @code
10388 @kindex show values
10389 @item show values
10390 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10391 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10392 values} does not change the history.
10393
10394 @item show values @var{n}
10395 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10396
10397 @item show values +
10398 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10399 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10400 @end table
10401
10402 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10403 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10404
10405 @node Convenience Vars
10406 @section Convenience Variables
10407
10408 @cindex convenience variables
10409 @cindex user-defined variables
10410 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10411 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10412 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10413 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10414 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10415
10416 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10417 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10418 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10419 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10420 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10421
10422 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10423 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10424 For example:
10425
10426 @smallexample
10427 set $foo = *object_ptr
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 @noindent
10431 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10432 @code{object_ptr}.
10433
10434 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10435 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10436 value with another assignment at any time.
10437
10438 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10439 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10440 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10441 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10442
10443 @table @code
10444 @kindex show convenience
10445 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10446 @item show convenience
10447 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10448 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10449 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10450
10451 @kindex init-if-undefined
10452 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10453 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10454 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10455 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10456 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10457 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10458 override default values used in a command script.
10459
10460 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10461 any side-effects do not occur.
10462 @end table
10463
10464 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10465 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10466 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10467
10468 @smallexample
10469 set $i = 0
10470 print bar[$i++]->contents
10471 @end smallexample
10472
10473 @noindent
10474 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10475
10476 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10477 values likely to be useful.
10478
10479 @table @code
10480 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10481 @item $_
10482 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10483 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10484 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10485 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10486 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10487 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10488 to the type of @code{$__}.
10489
10490 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10491 @item $__
10492 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10493 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10494 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10495
10496 @item $_exitcode
10497 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10498 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10499 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10500 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10501
10502 @item $_exitsignal
10503 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10504 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10505 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10506 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10507
10508 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10509 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10510 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10511 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10512 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10513
10514 @smallexample
10515 #include <signal.h>
10516
10517 int
10518 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10519 @{
10520 raise (SIGALRM);
10521 return 0;
10522 @}
10523 @end smallexample
10524
10525 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10526 or signalled would be:
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10530 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10531 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10532 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10533 >echo The program has exited\n
10534 >else
10535 >echo The program has signalled\n
10536 >end
10537 >end
10538 (@value{GDBP}) run
10539 Starting program:
10540
10541 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10542 The program no longer exists.
10543 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10544 The program has signalled
10545 @end smallexample
10546
10547 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10548 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10549 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10550 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10551
10552 @smallexample
10553 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10554 The program has exited
10555 @end smallexample
10556
10557 @item $_exception
10558 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10559 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10560
10561 @item $_probe_argc
10562 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10563 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10564
10565 @item $_sdata
10566 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10567 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10568 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10569 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10570 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10571
10572 @item $_siginfo
10573 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10574 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10575 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10576 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10577 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10578
10579 @item $_tlb
10580 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10581 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10582 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10583 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10584 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10585 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10586
10587 @item $_inferior
10588 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10589 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10590
10591 @item $_thread
10592 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10593
10594 @item $_gthread
10595 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10596
10597 @end table
10598
10599 @node Convenience Funs
10600 @section Convenience Functions
10601
10602 @cindex convenience functions
10603 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10604 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10605 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10606 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10607 @value{GDBN}.
10608
10609 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10610 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10611
10612 @table @code
10613
10614 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10615 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10616 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10617 returns zero.
10618
10619 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10620 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10621 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10622 it is @code{void}:
10623
10624 @smallexample
10625 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10626 $1 = void
10627 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10628 $2 = 1
10629 (@value{GDBP}) run
10630 Starting program: ./a.out
10631 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10632 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10633 $3 = 0
10634 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10635 $4 = 0
10636 @end smallexample
10637
10638 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10639 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10640 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10641 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10642 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10643 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10644 anymore.
10645
10646 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10647 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10648
10649 @smallexample
10650 void
10651 foo (void)
10652 @{
10653 @}
10654 @end smallexample
10655
10656 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10657
10658 @smallexample
10659 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10660 $1 = void
10661 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10662 $2 = 1
10663 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10664 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10665 $3 = void
10666 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10667 $4 = 1
10668 @end smallexample
10669
10670 @end table
10671
10672 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10673 @code{Python} support.
10674
10675 @table @code
10676
10677 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10678 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10679 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10680 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10681 Otherwise it returns zero.
10682
10683 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10684 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10685 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10686 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10687 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10688 regular expression support.
10689
10690 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10691 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10692 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10693 Otherwise it returns zero.
10694
10695 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10696 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10697 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10698
10699 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10700 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10701 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10702 Otherwise it returns zero.
10703
10704 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10705 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10706 The default is 1.
10707
10708 Example:
10709
10710 @smallexample
10711 (gdb) backtrace
10712 #0 bottom_func ()
10713 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10714 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10715 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10716 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10717 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10718 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10719 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10720 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10721 $1 = 1
10722 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10723 $1 = 1
10724 @end smallexample
10725
10726 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10727 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10728 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10729 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10730
10731 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10732 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10733 The default is 1.
10734
10735 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10736 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10737 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10738 Otherwise it returns zero.
10739
10740 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10741 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10742 The default is 1.
10743
10744 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10745 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10746 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10747 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10748
10749 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10750 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10751 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10752 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10753
10754 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10755 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10756 The default is 1.
10757
10758 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10759 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10760 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10761 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10762
10763 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10764 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10765 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10766
10767 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10768 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10769 an enumerated type:
10770
10771 @smallexample
10772 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10773 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10774 @end smallexample
10775
10776 @end table
10777
10778 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10779 convenience functions.
10780
10781 @table @code
10782 @item help function
10783 @kindex help function
10784 @cindex show all convenience functions
10785 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10786 @end table
10787
10788 @node Registers
10789 @section Registers
10790
10791 @cindex registers
10792 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10793 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10794 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10795 your machine.
10796
10797 @table @code
10798 @kindex info registers
10799 @item info registers
10800 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10801 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10802
10803 @kindex info all-registers
10804 @cindex floating point registers
10805 @item info all-registers
10806 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10807 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10808
10809 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10810 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10811 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10812 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10813 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10814 @end table
10815
10816 @anchor{standard registers}
10817 @cindex stack pointer register
10818 @cindex program counter register
10819 @cindex process status register
10820 @cindex frame pointer register
10821 @cindex standard registers
10822 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10823 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10824 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10825 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10826 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10827 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10828 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10829 you could print the program counter in hex with
10830
10831 @smallexample
10832 p/x $pc
10833 @end smallexample
10834
10835 @noindent
10836 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10837
10838 @smallexample
10839 x/i $pc
10840 @end smallexample
10841
10842 @noindent
10843 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10844 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10845 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10846 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10847 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10848 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10849 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10850
10851 @smallexample
10852 set $sp += 4
10853 @end smallexample
10854
10855 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10856 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10857 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10858 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10859 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10860 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10861 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10862
10863 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10864 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10865 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10866 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10867 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10868 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10869 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10870
10871 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10872 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10873 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10874 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10875 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10876 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10877 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10878 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10879 prints the data in both formats.
10880
10881 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10882 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10883 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10884 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10885 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10886 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10887 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10888
10889 @smallexample
10890 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10891 $1 = @{
10892 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10893 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10894 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10895 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10896 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10897 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10898 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10899 @}
10900 @end smallexample
10901
10902 @noindent
10903 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10904 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10905 value to a @code{struct} member:
10906
10907 @smallexample
10908 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10909 @end smallexample
10910
10911 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10912 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10913 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10914 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10915 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10916 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10917
10918 @cindex caller-saved registers
10919 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10920 @cindex volatile registers
10921 @cindex <not saved> values
10922 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10923 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10924 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10925 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10926 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10927 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10928 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10929 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10930 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10931 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10932 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10933 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10934 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10935 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10936 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10937 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10938 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10939 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10940 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10941 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10942 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10943 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10944 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10945
10946 @node Floating Point Hardware
10947 @section Floating Point Hardware
10948 @cindex floating point
10949
10950 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10951 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10952
10953 @table @code
10954 @kindex info float
10955 @item info float
10956 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10957 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10958 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10959 the ARM and x86 machines.
10960 @end table
10961
10962 @node Vector Unit
10963 @section Vector Unit
10964 @cindex vector unit
10965
10966 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10967 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10968
10969 @table @code
10970 @kindex info vector
10971 @item info vector
10972 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10973 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10974 @end table
10975
10976 @node OS Information
10977 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10978 @cindex OS information
10979
10980 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10981 you debug your program.
10982
10983 @cindex auxiliary vector
10984 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10985 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10986 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10987 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10988 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10989 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10990 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10991 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10992 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10993 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10994 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10995 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10996
10997 @table @code
10998 @kindex info auxv
10999 @item info auxv
11000 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11001 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11002 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11003 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11004 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11005 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11006 an unrecognized tag.
11007 @end table
11008
11009 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11010 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11011 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11012 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11013 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11014 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11015 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11016
11017 @table @code
11018 @kindex info os
11019 @item info os @var{infotype}
11020
11021 Display OS information of the requested type.
11022
11023 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11024
11025 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11026 @table @code
11027 @kindex info os cpus
11028 @item cpus
11029 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11030 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11031 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11032 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11033 kernel initialization.
11034
11035 @kindex info os files
11036 @item files
11037 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11038 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11039 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11040 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11041
11042 @kindex info os modules
11043 @item modules
11044 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11045 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11046 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11047 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11048 in memory.
11049
11050 @kindex info os msg
11051 @item msg
11052 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11053 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11054 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11055 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11056 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11057 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11058 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11059 the message queue was last changed.
11060
11061 @kindex info os processes
11062 @item processes
11063 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11064 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11065 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11066 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11067 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11068 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11069
11070 @kindex info os procgroups
11071 @item procgroups
11072 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11073 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11074 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11075 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11076 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11077 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11078 and the process group leader is listed first.
11079
11080 @kindex info os semaphores
11081 @item semaphores
11082 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11083 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11084 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11085 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11086 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11087
11088 @kindex info os shm
11089 @item shm
11090 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11091 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11092 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11093 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11094 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11095 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11096 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11097
11098 @kindex info os sockets
11099 @item sockets
11100 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11101 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11102 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11103 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11104 connection.
11105
11106 @kindex info os threads
11107 @item threads
11108 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11109 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11110 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11111 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11112 process is not listed.
11113 @end table
11114
11115 @item info os
11116 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11117 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11118 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11119 types, this command will report an error.
11120 @end table
11121
11122 @node Memory Region Attributes
11123 @section Memory Region Attributes
11124 @cindex memory region attributes
11125
11126 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11127 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11128 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11129 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11130 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11131 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11132 user can override the fetched regions.
11133
11134 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11135 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11136 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11137 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11138 all memory.
11139
11140 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11141 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11142
11143 @table @code
11144 @kindex mem
11145 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11146 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11147 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11148 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11149 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11150 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11151
11152 @item mem auto
11153 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11154 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11155
11156 @kindex delete mem
11157 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11158 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11159 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11160
11161 @kindex disable mem
11162 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11163 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11164 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11165 It may be enabled again later.
11166
11167 @kindex enable mem
11168 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11169 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11170
11171 @kindex info mem
11172 @item info mem
11173 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11174 for each region:
11175
11176 @table @emph
11177 @item Memory Region Number
11178 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11179 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11180 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11181
11182 @item Lo Address
11183 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11184
11185 @item Hi Address
11186 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11187
11188 @item Attributes
11189 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11190 @end table
11191 @end table
11192
11193
11194 @subsection Attributes
11195
11196 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11197 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11198 write accesses to a memory region.
11199
11200 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11201 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11202 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11203
11204 @table @code
11205 @item ro
11206 Memory is read only.
11207 @item wo
11208 Memory is write only.
11209 @item rw
11210 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11211 @end table
11212
11213 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11214 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11215 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11216 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11217 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11218
11219 @table @code
11220 @item 8
11221 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11222 @item 16
11223 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11224 @item 32
11225 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11226 @item 64
11227 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11228 @end table
11229
11230 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11231 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11232 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11233 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11234 @c
11235 @c @table @code
11236 @c @item hwbreak
11237 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11238 @c @item swbreak (default)
11239 @c @end table
11240
11241 @subsubsection Data Cache
11242 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11243 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11244 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11245 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11246 registers.
11247
11248 @table @code
11249 @item cache
11250 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11251 @item nocache
11252 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11253 @end table
11254
11255 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11256 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11257 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11258 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11259 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11260
11261 @table @code
11262 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11263 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11264 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11265 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11266 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11267 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11268 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11269 The default value is @code{on}.
11270 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11271 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11272 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11273 @end table
11274
11275
11276 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11277 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11278 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11279 @c
11280 @c @table @code
11281 @c @item verify
11282 @c @item noverify (default)
11283 @c @end table
11284
11285 @node Dump/Restore Files
11286 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11287 @cindex dump/restore files
11288 @cindex append data to a file
11289 @cindex dump data to a file
11290 @cindex restore data from a file
11291
11292 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11293 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11294 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11295 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11296 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11297 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11298 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11299
11300 @table @code
11301
11302 @kindex dump
11303 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11304 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11305 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11306 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11307
11308 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11309 @table @code
11310 @item binary
11311 Raw binary form.
11312 @item ihex
11313 Intel hex format.
11314 @item srec
11315 Motorola S-record format.
11316 @item tekhex
11317 Tektronix Hex format.
11318 @item verilog
11319 Verilog Hex format.
11320 @end table
11321
11322 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11323 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11324 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11325 form.
11326
11327 @kindex append
11328 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11329 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11330 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11331 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11332 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11333
11334 @kindex restore
11335 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11336 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11337 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11338 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11339 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11340
11341 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11342 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11343 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11344 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11345 from that location.
11346
11347 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11348 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11349 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11350 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11351
11352 @end table
11353
11354 @node Core File Generation
11355 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11356 @cindex dump core from inferior
11357
11358 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11359 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11360 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11361 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11362 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11363 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11364 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11365
11366 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11367 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11368 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11369
11370 @table @code
11371 @kindex gcore
11372 @kindex generate-core-file
11373 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11374 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11375 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11376 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11377 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11378 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11379
11380 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11381 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11382
11383 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11384 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11385 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11386
11387 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11388 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11389 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11390 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11391 Enable or disable the use of the file
11392 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11393 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11394 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11395 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11396
11397 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11398 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11399 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11400 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11401 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11402 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11403 about the bits that can be set in the
11404 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11405 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11406
11407 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11408 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11409 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11410 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11411 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11412 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11413 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11414 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11415 @end table
11416
11417 @node Character Sets
11418 @section Character Sets
11419 @cindex character sets
11420 @cindex charset
11421 @cindex translating between character sets
11422 @cindex host character set
11423 @cindex target character set
11424
11425 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11426 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11427 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11428 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11429 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11430 @dfn{target character set}.
11431
11432 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11433 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11434 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11435 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11436 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11437 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11438 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11439 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11440 character and string literals in expressions.
11441
11442 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11443 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11444 target-charset} command, described below.
11445
11446 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11447 support:
11448
11449 @table @code
11450 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11451 @kindex set target-charset
11452 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11453 list of supported target character sets, type
11454 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11455
11456 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11457 @kindex set host-charset
11458 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11459
11460 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11461 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11462 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11463 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11464 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11465
11466 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11467 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11468 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11469
11470 @item set charset @var{charset}
11471 @kindex set charset
11472 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11473 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11474 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11475 for both host and target.
11476
11477 @item show charset
11478 @kindex show charset
11479 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11480
11481 @item show host-charset
11482 @kindex show host-charset
11483 Show the name of the current host character set.
11484
11485 @item show target-charset
11486 @kindex show target-charset
11487 Show the name of the current target character set.
11488
11489 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11490 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11491 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11492 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11493 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11494 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11495
11496 @item show target-wide-charset
11497 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11498 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11499 @end table
11500
11501 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11502 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11503 @file{charset-test.c}:
11504
11505 @smallexample
11506 #include <stdio.h>
11507
11508 char ascii_hello[]
11509 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11510 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11511 char ibm1047_hello[]
11512 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11513 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11514
11515 main ()
11516 @{
11517 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11518 @}
11519 @end smallexample
11520
11521 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11522 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11523 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11524
11525 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11526
11527 @smallexample
11528 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11529 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11530 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11531 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11532 @dots{}
11533 (@value{GDBP})
11534 @end smallexample
11535
11536 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11537 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11538 strings:
11539
11540 @smallexample
11541 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11542 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11543 (@value{GDBP})
11544 @end smallexample
11545
11546 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11547 initial character set:
11548 @smallexample
11549 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11550 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11551 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11552 (@value{GDBP})
11553 @end smallexample
11554
11555 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11556 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11557 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11558 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11559 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11560
11561 @smallexample
11562 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11563 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11564 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11565 $2 = 72 'H'
11566 (@value{GDBP})
11567 @end smallexample
11568
11569 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11570 literals you use in expressions:
11571
11572 @smallexample
11573 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11574 $3 = 43 '+'
11575 (@value{GDBP})
11576 @end smallexample
11577
11578 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11579 character.
11580
11581 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11582 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11583 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11584
11585 @smallexample
11586 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11587 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11588 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11589 $5 = 200 '\310'
11590 (@value{GDBP})
11591 @end smallexample
11592
11593 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11594 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11595
11596 @smallexample
11597 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11598 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11599 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11600 @end smallexample
11601
11602 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11603 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11604 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11605 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11606 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11607
11608 @smallexample
11609 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11610 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11611 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11612 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11613 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11614 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11615 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11616 $7 = 72 '\110'
11617 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11618 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11619 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11620 $9 = 200 'H'
11621 (@value{GDBP})
11622 @end smallexample
11623
11624 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11625 string literals you use in expressions:
11626
11627 @smallexample
11628 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11629 $10 = 78 '+'
11630 (@value{GDBP})
11631 @end smallexample
11632
11633 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11634 character.
11635
11636 @node Caching Target Data
11637 @section Caching Data of Targets
11638 @cindex caching data of targets
11639
11640 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11641 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11642 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11643 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11644 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11645 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11646 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11647 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11648 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11649 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11650 is executing.
11651 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11652 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11653 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11654 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11655 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11656 in the code segment.
11657 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11658 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11659
11660 @table @code
11661 @kindex set remotecache
11662 @item set remotecache on
11663 @itemx set remotecache off
11664 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11665 with old scripts.
11666
11667 @kindex show remotecache
11668 @item show remotecache
11669 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11670
11671 @kindex set stack-cache
11672 @item set stack-cache on
11673 @itemx set stack-cache off
11674 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11675 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11676
11677 @kindex show stack-cache
11678 @item show stack-cache
11679 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11680
11681 @kindex set code-cache
11682 @item set code-cache on
11683 @itemx set code-cache off
11684 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11685 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11686 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11687
11688 @kindex show code-cache
11689 @item show code-cache
11690 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11691 accesses.
11692
11693 @kindex info dcache
11694 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11695 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11696 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11697 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11698 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11699 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11700
11701 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11702 printed in hex.
11703
11704 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11705 @cindex dcache size
11706 @kindex set dcache size
11707 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11708
11709 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11710 @cindex dcache line-size
11711 @kindex set dcache line-size
11712 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11713 Must be a power of 2.
11714
11715 @item show dcache size
11716 @kindex show dcache size
11717 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11718
11719 @item show dcache line-size
11720 @kindex show dcache line-size
11721 Show default size of dcache lines.
11722
11723 @end table
11724
11725 @node Searching Memory
11726 @section Search Memory
11727 @cindex searching memory
11728
11729 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11730 @code{find} command.
11731
11732 @table @code
11733 @kindex find
11734 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11735 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11736 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11737 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11738 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11739 @end table
11740
11741 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11742 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11743
11744 @table @r
11745 @item @var{s}, search query size
11746 The size of each search query value.
11747
11748 @table @code
11749 @item b
11750 bytes
11751 @item h
11752 halfwords (two bytes)
11753 @item w
11754 words (four bytes)
11755 @item g
11756 giant words (eight bytes)
11757 @end table
11758
11759 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11760 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11761 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11762
11763 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11764 value's type in the current language.
11765 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11766 pattern as a mixture of types.
11767 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11768 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11769 which is typically four bytes.
11770
11771 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11772 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11773 @end table
11774
11775 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11776 (@code{"}).
11777 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11778 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11779
11780 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11781 number of matches found.
11782
11783 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11784 @samp{$_}.
11785 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11786
11787 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11788
11789 @smallexample
11790 void
11791 hello ()
11792 @{
11793 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11794 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11795 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11796 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11797 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11798 @}
11799 @end smallexample
11800
11801 @noindent
11802 you get during debugging:
11803
11804 @smallexample
11805 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11806 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11807 1 pattern found
11808 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11809 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11810 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11811 2 patterns found
11812 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11813 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11814 1 pattern found
11815 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11816 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11817 1 pattern found
11818 (gdb) print $numfound
11819 $1 = 1
11820 (gdb) print $_
11821 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11822 @end smallexample
11823
11824 @node Value Sizes
11825 @section Value Sizes
11826
11827 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11828 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11829 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11830 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11831 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11832
11833 @table @code
11834 @kindex set max-value-size
11835 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11836 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11837 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11838 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11839 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11840
11841 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11842 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11843
11844 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11845 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11846 currently 16 bytes.
11847
11848 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11849 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11850 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11851 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11852 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11853 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11854 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11855 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11856
11857 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11858
11859 @kindex show max-value-size
11860 @item show max-value-size
11861 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11862 allocate for the contents of a value.
11863 @end table
11864
11865 @node Optimized Code
11866 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11867 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11868 @cindex debugging optimized code
11869
11870 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11871 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11872 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11873 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11874 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11875 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11876 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11877
11878 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11879 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11880 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11881 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11882
11883 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11884 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11885 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11886 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11887 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11888 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11889
11890 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11891 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11892 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11893 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11894 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11895
11896 @menu
11897 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11898 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11899 @end menu
11900
11901 @node Inline Functions
11902 @section Inline Functions
11903 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11904
11905 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11906 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11907 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11908 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11909 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11910 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11911 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11912 @code{info frame} command.
11913
11914 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11915 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11916 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11917 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11918 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11919 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11920 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11921 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11922 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11923 local variables in the caller.
11924
11925 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11926 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11927 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11928 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11929 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11930 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11931 instructions are executed.
11932
11933 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11934 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11935 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11936 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11937
11938 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11939 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11940
11941 @itemize @bullet
11942 @item
11943 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11944 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11945 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11946 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11947 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11948 or inside the inlined function instead.
11949
11950 @item
11951 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11952 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11953 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11954 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11955
11956 @end itemize
11957
11958 @node Tail Call Frames
11959 @section Tail Call Frames
11960 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11961
11962 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11963 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11964 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11965 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11966 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11967
11968 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11969 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11970 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11971 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11972 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11973 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11974 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11975
11976 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11977 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11978 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11979 this information.
11980
11981 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11982 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11983
11984 @smallexample
11985 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11986 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11987 (gdb) info frame
11988 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11989 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11990 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11991 source language c++.
11992 Arglist at unknown address.
11993 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11994 @end smallexample
11995
11996 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11997 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11998 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11999 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12000 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12001 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12002
12003 @table @code
12004 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12005 @item set debug entry-values
12006 @kindex set debug entry-values
12007 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12008 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12009 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12010 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12011 result.
12012
12013 @item show debug entry-values
12014 @kindex show debug entry-values
12015 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12016 values at function entry and tail calls.
12017 @end table
12018
12019 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12020 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12021 reference by variable @code{x}):
12022
12023 @smallexample
12024 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12025 void (*x) (void) = c;
12026 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12027 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12028 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12029
12030 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
12031 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
12032 a () at t.c:3
12033 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12034 (gdb) bt
12035 #0 a () at t.c:3
12036 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12037 @end smallexample
12038
12039 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12040
12041 @smallexample
12042 int i;
12043 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12044 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12045 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12046 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12047 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12048 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12049 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12050 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12051
12052 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12053 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12054 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12055 (gdb) bt
12056 #0 f () at t.c:2
12057 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12058 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12059 @end smallexample
12060
12061 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12062 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12063
12064 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12065 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12066 @set ARROW @click{}
12067 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12068 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12069 @end ifset
12070 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12071 @set ARROW ->
12072 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12073 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12074 @end ifclear
12075
12076 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12077 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12078 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12079
12080 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12081 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12082 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12083 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12084 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12085 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12086
12087 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12088 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12089 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12090 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12091 omitted.
12092
12093 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12094 entry may fail:
12095
12096 @smallexample
12097 int v;
12098 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12099 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12100 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12101 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12102 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12103 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12104
12105 (gdb) bt
12106 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12107 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12108 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12109 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12110 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12111 @end smallexample
12112
12113 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12114 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12115 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12116 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12117 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12118
12119 @node Macros
12120 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12121
12122 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12123 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12124 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12125 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12126 where it was defined.
12127
12128 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12129 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12130 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12131 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12132
12133 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12134 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12135 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12136 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12137 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12138 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12139 see @ref{List}.
12140
12141 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12142 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12143 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12144
12145 @table @code
12146
12147 @kindex macro expand
12148 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12149 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12150 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12151 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12152 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12153 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12154 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12155 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12156 it can be any string of tokens.
12157
12158 @kindex macro exp1
12159 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12160 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12161 @cindex expand macro once
12162 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12163 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12164 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12165 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12166 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12167 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12168 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12169 can be any string of tokens.
12170
12171 @kindex info macro
12172 @cindex macro definition, showing
12173 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12174 @cindex macros, from debug info
12175 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12176 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12177 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12178 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12179 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12180 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12181
12182 @kindex info macros
12183 @item info macros @var{location}
12184 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12185 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12186 command-line where those definitions were established.
12187
12188 @kindex macro define
12189 @cindex user-defined macros
12190 @cindex defining macros interactively
12191 @cindex macros, user-defined
12192 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12193 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12194 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12195 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12196 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12197 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12198 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12199 @var{arglist}.
12200
12201 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12202 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12203 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12204 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12205 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12206
12207 @kindex macro undef
12208 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12209 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12210 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12211 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12212 in the program being debugged.
12213
12214 @kindex macro list
12215 @item macro list
12216 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12217 @end table
12218
12219 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12220 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12221 show our source files:
12222
12223 @smallexample
12224 $ cat sample.c
12225 #include <stdio.h>
12226 #include "sample.h"
12227
12228 #define M 42
12229 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12230
12231 main ()
12232 @{
12233 #define N 28
12234 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12235 #undef N
12236 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12237 #define N 1729
12238 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12239 @}
12240 $ cat sample.h
12241 #define Q <
12242 $
12243 @end smallexample
12244
12245 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12246 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12247 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12248 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12249 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12250 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12251 information.
12252
12253 @smallexample
12254 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12255 $
12256 @end smallexample
12257
12258 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12259
12260 @smallexample
12261 $ gdb -nw sample
12262 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12263 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12264 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12265 (@value{GDBP})
12266 @end smallexample
12267
12268 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12269 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12270 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12271
12272 @smallexample
12273 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12274 3
12275 4 #define M 42
12276 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12277 6
12278 7 main ()
12279 8 @{
12280 9 #define N 28
12281 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12282 11 #undef N
12283 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12284 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12285 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12286 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12287 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12288 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12289 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12290 #define Q <
12291 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12292 expands to: (42 + 1)
12293 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12294 expands to: once (M + 1)
12295 (@value{GDBP})
12296 @end smallexample
12297
12298 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12299 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12300 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12301 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12302
12303 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12304 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12305
12306 @smallexample
12307 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12308 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12309 (@value{GDBP}) run
12310 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12311
12312 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12313 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12314 (@value{GDBP})
12315 @end smallexample
12316
12317 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12318
12319 @smallexample
12320 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12321 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12322 #define N 28
12323 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12324 expands to: 28 < 42
12325 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12326 $1 = 1
12327 (@value{GDBP})
12328 @end smallexample
12329
12330 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12331 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12332 thereof) in force at each point:
12333
12334 @smallexample
12335 (@value{GDBP}) next
12336 Hello, world!
12337 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12338 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12339 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12340 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12341 (@value{GDBP}) next
12342 We're so creative.
12343 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12344 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12345 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12346 #define N 1729
12347 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12348 expands to: 1729 < 42
12349 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12350 $2 = 0
12351 (@value{GDBP})
12352 @end smallexample
12353
12354 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12355 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12356 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12357 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12358
12359 @smallexample
12360 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12361 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12362 -D__STDC__=1
12363 (@value{GDBP})
12364 @end smallexample
12365
12366
12367 @node Tracepoints
12368 @chapter Tracepoints
12369 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12370 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12371
12372 @cindex tracepoints
12373 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12374 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12375 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12376 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12377 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12378 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12379 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12380
12381 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12382 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12383 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12384 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12385 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12386 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12387 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12388 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12389 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12390 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12391 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12392
12393 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12394 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12395 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12396 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12397 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12398 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12399 Packets}.
12400
12401 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12402 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12403 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12404
12405 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12406
12407 @menu
12408 * Set Tracepoints::
12409 * Analyze Collected Data::
12410 * Tracepoint Variables::
12411 * Trace Files::
12412 @end menu
12413
12414 @node Set Tracepoints
12415 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12416
12417 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12418 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12419 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12420 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12421 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12422 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12423 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12424
12425 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12426 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12427 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12428 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12429 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12430 tracepoint was hit.
12431
12432 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12433 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12434 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12435 either.
12436
12437 @cindex fast tracepoints
12438 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12439 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12440 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12441
12442 @cindex static tracepoints
12443 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12444 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12445 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12446 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12447 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12448 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12449 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12450 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12451 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12452 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12453 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12454 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12455 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12456 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12457 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12458 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12459 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12460 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12461 static tracepoint marker.
12462
12463 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12464 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12465
12466 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12467 conditions and actions.
12468
12469 @menu
12470 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12471 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12472 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12473 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12474 * Trace State Variables::
12475 * Tracepoint Actions::
12476 * Listing Tracepoints::
12477 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12478 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12479 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12480 @end menu
12481
12482 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12483 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12484
12485 @table @code
12486 @cindex set tracepoint
12487 @kindex trace
12488 @item trace @var{location}
12489 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12490 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12491 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12492 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12493 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12494 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12495 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12496 in tracing}).
12497 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12498 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12499 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12500 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12501 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12502 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12503 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12504 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12505 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12506 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12507 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12508 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12509
12510 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12511
12512 @smallexample
12513 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12514
12515 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12516
12517 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12518
12519 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12520
12521 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12522 @end smallexample
12523
12524 @noindent
12525 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12526
12527 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12528 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12529 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12530 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12531 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12532 information on tracepoint conditions.
12533
12534 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12535 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12536 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12537 @kindex ftrace
12538 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12539 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12540 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12541 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12542 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12543 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12544 message.
12545
12546 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12547 @code{trace}.
12548
12549 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12550 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12551 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12552 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12553 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12554 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12555 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12556 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12557
12558 @example
12559 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12560 @end example
12561
12562 @noindent
12563 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12564 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12565
12566 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12567 @cindex set static tracepoint
12568 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12569 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12570 @kindex strace
12571 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12572 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12573 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12574 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12575 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12576
12577 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12578 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12579 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12580 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12581 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12582 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12583 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12584 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12585 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12586 tracing engine:
12587
12588 @smallexample
12589 main ()
12590 @{
12591 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12592 @}
12593 @end smallexample
12594
12595 @noindent
12596 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12597 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12598
12599 @smallexample
12600 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12601 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12602 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12603 Data: "str %s"
12604 [etc...]
12605 @end smallexample
12606
12607 @noindent
12608 so you may probe the marker above with:
12609
12610 @smallexample
12611 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12612 @end smallexample
12613
12614 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12615 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12616 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12617 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12618 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12619 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12620 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12621 the @samp{Data:} field.
12622
12623 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12624 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12625 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12626
12627 @vindex $tpnum
12628 @cindex last tracepoint number
12629 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12630 @cindex tracepoint number
12631 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12632 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12633
12634 @kindex delete tracepoint
12635 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12636 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12637 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12638 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12639 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12640
12641 Examples:
12642
12643 @smallexample
12644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12645
12646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12647 @end smallexample
12648
12649 @noindent
12650 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12651 @end table
12652
12653 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12654 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12655
12656 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12657
12658 @table @code
12659 @kindex disable tracepoint
12660 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12661 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12662 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12663 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12664 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12665 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12666 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12667 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12668 next trace experiment.
12669
12670 @kindex enable tracepoint
12671 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12672 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12673 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12674 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12675 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12676 next time a trace experiment is run.
12677 @end table
12678
12679 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12680 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12681
12682 @table @code
12683 @kindex passcount
12684 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12685 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12686 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12687 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12688 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12689 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12690 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12691 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12692 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12693 user.
12694
12695 Examples:
12696
12697 @smallexample
12698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12699 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12700
12701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12702 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12709 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12710 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12711 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12712 @end smallexample
12713 @end table
12714
12715 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12716 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12717 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12718 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12719
12720 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12721 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12722 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12723 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12724 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12725 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12726 is true.
12727
12728 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12729 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12730 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12731 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12732 just as with breakpoints.
12733
12734 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12735 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12736 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12737 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12738 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12739 accesses, and so forth.
12740
12741 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12742 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12743 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12744 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12745 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12746 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12747 search through.
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12751 @end smallexample
12752
12753 @node Trace State Variables
12754 @subsection Trace State Variables
12755 @cindex trace state variables
12756
12757 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12758 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12759 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12760 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12761 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12762 integers.
12763
12764 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12765 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12766 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12767 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12768
12769 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12770 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12771 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12772 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12773 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12774 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12775 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12776 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12777 variable with the same name.
12778
12779 @table @code
12780
12781 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12782 @kindex tvariable
12783 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12784 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12785 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12786 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12787 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12788 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12789 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12790 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12791 value. The default initial value is 0.
12792
12793 @item info tvariables
12794 @kindex info tvariables
12795 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12796 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12797 currently running.
12798
12799 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12800 @kindex delete tvariable
12801 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12802 are specified.
12803
12804 @end table
12805
12806 @node Tracepoint Actions
12807 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12808
12809 @table @code
12810 @kindex actions
12811 @cindex tracepoint actions
12812 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12813 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12814 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12815 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12816 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12817 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12818 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12819 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12820 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12821 @code{while-stepping}.
12822
12823 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12824 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12825 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12826
12827 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12828 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12829 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12830
12831 @smallexample
12832 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12833
12834 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12835
12836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12837 @end smallexample
12838
12839 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12840 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12841 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12842 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12843 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12844 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12845 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12846 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12847
12848 @smallexample
12849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12850 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12851 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12852 > collect bar,baz
12853 > collect $regs
12854 > while-stepping 12
12855 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12856 > end
12857 end
12858 @end smallexample
12859
12860 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12861 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12862 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12863 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12864 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12865 special arguments are supported:
12866
12867 @table @code
12868 @item $regs
12869 Collect all registers.
12870
12871 @item $args
12872 Collect all function arguments.
12873
12874 @item $locals
12875 Collect all local variables.
12876
12877 @item $_ret
12878 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12879 of a backtrace.
12880
12881 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12882 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12883 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12884 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12885 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12886 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12887
12888 @item $_probe_argc
12889 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12890 tracepoint is located.
12891 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12892
12893 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12894 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12895 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12896 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12897
12898 @item $_sdata
12899 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12900 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12901 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12902 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12903 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12904 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12905 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12906 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12907 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12908
12909 @smallexample
12910 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12911 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12912 @end smallexample
12913
12914 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12915 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12916 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12917 @value{GDBN}.
12918 @end table
12919
12920 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12921 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12922 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12923
12924 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12925 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12926 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12927 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12928 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12929 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12930 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12931 @samp{mystr}.
12932
12933 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12934 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12935
12936 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12937 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12938 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12939 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12940 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12941 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12942 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12943 action were used.
12944
12945 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12946 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12947 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12948 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12949 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12950 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12951
12952 @smallexample
12953 > while-stepping 12
12954 > collect $regs, myglobal
12955 > end
12956 >
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959 @noindent
12960 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12961 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12962 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12963 @code{stepping}.
12964
12965 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12966 @kindex set default-collect
12967 @cindex default collection action
12968 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12969 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12970 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12971 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12972 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12973 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12974
12975 @item show default-collect
12976 @kindex show default-collect
12977 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12978 tracepoint hit.
12979
12980 @end table
12981
12982 @node Listing Tracepoints
12983 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12984
12985 @table @code
12986 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12987 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12988 @cindex information about tracepoints
12989 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12990 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12991 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12992 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12993 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12994 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12995
12996 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12997 tracing:
12998
12999 @itemize @bullet
13000 @item
13001 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13002
13003 @item
13004 the state about installed on target of each location
13005 @end itemize
13006
13007 @smallexample
13008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13009 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13010 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13011 while-stepping 20
13012 collect globfoo, $regs
13013 end
13014 collect globfoo2
13015 end
13016 pass count 1200
13017 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13018 collect $eip
13019 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13020 installed on target
13021 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13022 installed on target
13023 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13024 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13025 not installed on target
13026 (@value{GDBP})
13027 @end smallexample
13028
13029 @noindent
13030 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13031 @end table
13032
13033 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13034 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13035
13036 @table @code
13037 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13038 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13039 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13040 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13041 program.
13042
13043 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13044
13045 @table @emph
13046 @item Count
13047 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13048 stable identifier.
13049 @item ID
13050 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13051 @item Enabled or Disabled
13052 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13053 that are not enabled.
13054 @item Address
13055 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13056 @item What
13057 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13058 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13059 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13060 will be left blank.
13061 @end table
13062
13063 @noindent
13064 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13065
13066 @table @emph
13067 @item Data
13068 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13069 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13070 marker call.
13071 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13072 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13073 @end table
13074
13075 @smallexample
13076 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13077 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13078 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13079 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13080 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13081 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13082 Data: str %s
13083 (@value{GDBP})
13084 @end smallexample
13085 @end table
13086
13087 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13088 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13089
13090 @table @code
13091 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13092 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13093 @cindex collected data discarded
13094 @item tstart
13095 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13096 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13097 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13098 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13099 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13100 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13101 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13102 information, and so forth.
13103
13104 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13105 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13106 @item tstop
13107 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13108 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13109 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13110 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13111 needs to be stopped quickly.
13112
13113 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13114 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13115 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13116
13117 @kindex tstatus
13118 @cindex status of trace data collection
13119 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13120 @item tstatus
13121 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13122 collection.
13123 @end table
13124
13125 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13126
13127 @smallexample
13128 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13129 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13130 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13131 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13132 > while-stepping 11
13133 > collect $regs
13134 > end
13135 > end
13136 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13137 [time passes @dots{}]
13138 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13139 @end smallexample
13140
13141 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13142 @cindex disconnected tracing
13143 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13144 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13145 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13146 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13147 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13148 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13149 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13150 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13151
13152 @table @code
13153 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13154 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13155 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13156 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13157 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13158 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13159 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13160 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13161
13162 @item show disconnected-tracing
13163 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13164 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13165
13166 @end table
13167
13168 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13169 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13170 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13171 it will continue after reconnection.
13172
13173 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13174 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13175 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13176 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13177 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13178 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13179 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13180 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13181 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13182 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13183
13184 @cindex circular trace buffer
13185 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13186 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13187 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13188 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13189 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13190 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13191 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13192 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13193 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13194 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13195 the next run.
13196
13197 @table @code
13198 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13199 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13200 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13201 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13202 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13203 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13204 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13205
13206 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13207 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13208 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13209 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13210 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13211 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13212
13213 @end table
13214
13215 @table @code
13216 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13217 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13218 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13219 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13220 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13221 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13222 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13223 likes. This is also the default.
13224
13225 @item show trace-buffer-size
13226 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13227 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13228 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13229 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13230 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13231 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13232 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13233 @end table
13234
13235 @table @code
13236 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13237 @kindex set trace-user
13238
13239 @item show trace-user
13240 @kindex show trace-user
13241
13242 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13243 @kindex set trace-notes
13244 Set the trace run's notes.
13245
13246 @item show trace-notes
13247 @kindex show trace-notes
13248 Show the trace run's notes.
13249
13250 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13251 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13252 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13253 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13254 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13255
13256 @item show trace-stop-notes
13257 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13258 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13259
13260 @end table
13261
13262 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13263 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13264
13265 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13266 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13267 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13268 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13269 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13270 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13271 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13272 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13273 mentioned here.
13274
13275 @itemize @bullet
13276
13277 @item
13278 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13279 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13280 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13281 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13282 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13283 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13284 cannot be collected either.
13285
13286 @item
13287 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13288 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13289 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13290 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13291 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13292 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13293 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13294 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13295 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13296 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13297
13298 @item
13299 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13300 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13301 in a misleading way.
13302
13303 @item
13304 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13305 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13306 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13307 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13308 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13309 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13310 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13311 by @code{ptr}.
13312
13313 @item
13314 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13315 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13316 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13317 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13318 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13319 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13320 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13321 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13322 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13323 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13324 invalid address.
13325
13326 @item
13327 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13328 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13329 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13330 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13331 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13332 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13333 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13334 it to zero.
13335
13336 @end itemize
13337
13338 @node Analyze Collected Data
13339 @section Using the Collected Data
13340
13341 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13342 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13343 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13344 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13345 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13346 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13347 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13348 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13349 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13350 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13351 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13352 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13353 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13354 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13355 the buffer will fail.
13356
13357 @menu
13358 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13359 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13360 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13361 @end menu
13362
13363 @node tfind
13364 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13365
13366 @kindex tfind
13367 @cindex select trace snapshot
13368 @cindex find trace snapshot
13369 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13370 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13371 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13372 snapshot is selected.
13373
13374 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13375
13376 @table @code
13377 @item tfind start
13378 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13379 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13380
13381 @item tfind none
13382 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13383
13384 @item tfind end
13385 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13386
13387 @item tfind
13388 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13389 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13390
13391 @item tfind -
13392 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13393 retracing earlier steps.
13394
13395 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13396 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13397 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13398 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13399 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13400
13401 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13402 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13403 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13404 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13405 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13406
13407 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13408 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13409 addresses (exclusive).
13410
13411 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13412 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13413 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13414
13415 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13416 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13417 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13418 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13419 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13420 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13421 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13422 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13423 @end table
13424
13425 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13426 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13427 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13428 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13429 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13430 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13431 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13432 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13433 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13434 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13435 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13436 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13437 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13438 tracepoint as the current one.
13439
13440 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13441 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13442 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13443 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13444 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13445
13446 @smallexample
13447 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13448 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13449 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13450 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13451 > tfind
13452 > end
13453
13454 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13455 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13456 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13457 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13458 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13459 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13460 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13461 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13462 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13463 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13464 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13465 @end smallexample
13466
13467 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13468 the buffer:
13469
13470 @smallexample
13471 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13472 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13473 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13474 > tfind line
13475 > end
13476
13477 Frame 0, X = 1
13478 Frame 7, X = 2
13479 Frame 13, X = 255
13480 @end smallexample
13481
13482 @node tdump
13483 @subsection @code{tdump}
13484 @kindex tdump
13485 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13486 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13487
13488 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13489 the current trace snapshot.
13490
13491 @smallexample
13492 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13493 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13494 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13495 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13496 > end
13497
13498 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13499
13500 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13501 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13502 at gdb_test.c:444
13503 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13504
13505 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13506 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13507 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13508 d1 0x18 24
13509 d2 0x80 128
13510 d3 0x33 51
13511 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13512 d5 0x22 34
13513 d6 0xe0 224
13514 d7 0x380035 3670069
13515 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13516 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13517 a2 0x100 256
13518 a3 0x322000 3284992
13519 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13520 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13521 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13522 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13523 ps 0x0 0
13524 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13525 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13526 fpstatus 0x0 0
13527 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13528 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13529 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13530 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13531 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13532 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13533 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13534 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13535 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13536
13537 (@value{GDBP})
13538 @end smallexample
13539
13540 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13541 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13542 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13543 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13544
13545 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13546 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13547 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13548 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13549 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13550 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13551 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13552 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13553 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13554 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13555
13556 @node save tracepoints
13557 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13558 @kindex save tracepoints
13559 @kindex save-tracepoints
13560 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13561
13562 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13563 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13564 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13565 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13566 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13567 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13568
13569 @node Tracepoint Variables
13570 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13571 @cindex tracepoint variables
13572 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13573
13574 @table @code
13575 @vindex $trace_frame
13576 @item (int) $trace_frame
13577 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13578 snapshot is selected.
13579
13580 @vindex $tracepoint
13581 @item (int) $tracepoint
13582 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13583
13584 @vindex $trace_line
13585 @item (int) $trace_line
13586 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13587
13588 @vindex $trace_file
13589 @item (char []) $trace_file
13590 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13591
13592 @vindex $trace_func
13593 @item (char []) $trace_func
13594 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13595 @end table
13596
13597 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13598 use @code{output} instead.
13599
13600 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13601 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13602 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13603 which are managed by the target.
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13607
13608 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13609 > output $trace_file
13610 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13611 > tfind
13612 > end
13613 @end smallexample
13614
13615 @node Trace Files
13616 @section Using Trace Files
13617 @cindex trace files
13618
13619 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13620 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13621 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13622 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13623 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13624
13625 @table @code
13626
13627 @kindex tsave
13628 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13629 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13630 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13631 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13632 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13633 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13634 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13635 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13636 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13637 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13638 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13639 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13640 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13641 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13642 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13643
13644 @kindex target tfile
13645 @kindex tfile
13646 @kindex target ctf
13647 @kindex ctf
13648 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13649 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13650 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13651 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13652 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13653 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13654 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13655 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13656 the host.
13657
13658 @smallexample
13659 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13660 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13661 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13662 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13663 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13664 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13665 i = 0
13666 a = 0
13667 b = 1 '\001'
13668 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13669 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13670 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13671 $1 = 1
13672 @end smallexample
13673
13674 @end table
13675
13676 @node Overlays
13677 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13678 @cindex overlays
13679
13680 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13681 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13682 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13683 use overlays.
13684
13685 @menu
13686 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13687 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13688 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13689 mapped by asking the inferior.
13690 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13691 @end menu
13692
13693 @node How Overlays Work
13694 @section How Overlays Work
13695 @cindex mapped overlays
13696 @cindex unmapped overlays
13697 @cindex load address, overlay's
13698 @cindex mapped address
13699 @cindex overlay area
13700
13701 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13702 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13703 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13704 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13705 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13706
13707 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13708 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13709 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13710 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13711 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13712 largest overlay as well.
13713
13714 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13715 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13716 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13717 there.
13718
13719 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13720 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13721 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13722
13723 @smallexample
13724 @group
13725 Data Instruction Larger
13726 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13727 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13728 | | | | | |
13729 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13730 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13731 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13732 | and heap | | | | | |
13733 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13734 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13735 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13736 | | | | | |
13737 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13738 address | | | | | |
13739 | overlay | <-' | | |
13740 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13741 | | <---. | | load address
13742 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13743 | | | |
13744 +-----------+ | |
13745 +-----------+
13746 | |
13747 +-----------+
13748
13749 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13750 @end group
13751 @end smallexample
13752
13753 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13754 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13755 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13756 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13757 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13758 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13759 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13760 program and the overlay area.
13761
13762 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13763 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13764 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13765 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13766 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13767 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13768 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13769
13770 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13771 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13772 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13773
13774 @itemize @bullet
13775
13776 @item
13777 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13778 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13779 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13780 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13781
13782 @item
13783 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13784 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13785 your program's performance.
13786
13787 @item
13788 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13789 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13790 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13791 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13792 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13793 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13794 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13795
13796 @item
13797 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13798 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13799 instruction and data spaces.
13800
13801 @end itemize
13802
13803 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13804 improved in many ways:
13805
13806 @itemize @bullet
13807
13808 @item
13809 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13810 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13811 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13812 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13813 area in the usual way.
13814
13815 @item
13816 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13817 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13818
13819 @item
13820 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13821 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13822 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13823 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13824 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13825 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13826 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13827
13828 @end itemize
13829
13830
13831 @node Overlay Commands
13832 @section Overlay Commands
13833
13834 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13835 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13836 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13837 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13838 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13839 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13840
13841 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13842 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13843
13844 @table @code
13845 @item overlay off
13846 @kindex overlay
13847 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13848 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13849 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13850 overlay support is disabled.
13851
13852 @item overlay manual
13853 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13854 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13855 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13856 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13857 commands described below.
13858
13859 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13860 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13861 @cindex map an overlay
13862 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13863 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13864 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13865 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13866 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13867 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13868
13869 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13870 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13871 @cindex unmap an overlay
13872 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13873 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13874 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13875 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13876
13877 @item overlay auto
13878 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13879 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13880 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13881 Overlay Debugging}.
13882
13883 @item overlay load-target
13884 @itemx overlay load
13885 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13886 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13887 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13888 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13889 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13890 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13891
13892 @item overlay list-overlays
13893 @itemx overlay list
13894 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13895 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13896 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13897
13898 @end table
13899
13900 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13901 of the function the address falls in:
13902
13903 @smallexample
13904 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13905 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13906 @end smallexample
13907 @noindent
13908 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13909 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13910 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13911 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13912
13913 @smallexample
13914 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13915 No sections are mapped.
13916 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13917 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13918 @end smallexample
13919 @noindent
13920 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13921 name normally:
13922
13923 @smallexample
13924 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13925 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13926 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13927 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13928 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13929 @end smallexample
13930
13931 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13932 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13933 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13934 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13935 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13936
13937 @itemize @bullet
13938 @item
13939 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13940 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13941 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13942 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13943 @item
13944 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13945 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13946 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13947 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13948 breakpoints properly.
13949 @end itemize
13950
13951
13952 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13953 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13954 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13955
13956 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13957 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13958 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13959 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13960 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13961 current state of the overlays.
13962
13963 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13964 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13965
13966 @table @asis
13967
13968 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13969 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13970
13971 @smallexample
13972 struct
13973 @{
13974 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13975 unsigned long vma;
13976
13977 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13978 unsigned long size;
13979
13980 /* The overlay's load address. */
13981 unsigned long lma;
13982
13983 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13984 zero otherwise. */
13985 unsigned long mapped;
13986 @}
13987 @end smallexample
13988
13989 @item @code{_novlys}:
13990 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13991 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13992
13993 @end table
13994
13995 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13996 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13997 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13998 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13999 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14000 currently mapped.
14001
14002 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14003 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14004 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14005 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14006 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14007 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14008 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14009 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14010 are not being executed.
14011
14012 @node Overlay Sample Program
14013 @section Overlay Sample Program
14014 @cindex overlay example program
14015
14016 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14017 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14018 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14019 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14020 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14021 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14022 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14023
14024 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14025 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14026 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14027 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14028
14029 @table @file
14030 @item overlays.c
14031 The main program file.
14032 @item ovlymgr.c
14033 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14034 @item foo.c
14035 @itemx bar.c
14036 @itemx baz.c
14037 @itemx grbx.c
14038 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14039 @item d10v.ld
14040 @itemx m32r.ld
14041 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14042 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14043 @end table
14044
14045 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14046 cross-compiler like this:
14047
14048 @smallexample
14049 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14050 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14051 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14052 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14053 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14054 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14055 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14056 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14057 @end smallexample
14058
14059 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14060 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14061 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14062
14063
14064 @node Languages
14065 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14066 @cindex languages
14067
14068 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14069 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14070 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14071 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14072 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14073 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14074
14075 @cindex working language
14076 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14077 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14078 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14079 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14080 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14081 language}.
14082
14083 @menu
14084 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14085 * Show:: Displaying the language
14086 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14087 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14088 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14089 @end menu
14090
14091 @node Setting
14092 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14093
14094 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14095 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14096 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14097 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14098 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14099 are printed, etc.
14100
14101 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14102 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14103 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14104 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14105 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14106 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14107 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14108 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14109 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14110 Displaying the Language}.
14111
14112 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14113 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14114 another language. In that case, make the
14115 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14116 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14117 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14118
14119 @menu
14120 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14121 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14122 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14123 @end menu
14124
14125 @node Filenames
14126 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14127
14128 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14129 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14130
14131 @table @file
14132 @item .ada
14133 @itemx .ads
14134 @itemx .adb
14135 @itemx .a
14136 Ada source file.
14137
14138 @item .c
14139 C source file
14140
14141 @item .C
14142 @itemx .cc
14143 @itemx .cp
14144 @itemx .cpp
14145 @itemx .cxx
14146 @itemx .c++
14147 C@t{++} source file
14148
14149 @item .d
14150 D source file
14151
14152 @item .m
14153 Objective-C source file
14154
14155 @item .f
14156 @itemx .F
14157 Fortran source file
14158
14159 @item .mod
14160 Modula-2 source file
14161
14162 @item .s
14163 @itemx .S
14164 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14165 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14166 @end table
14167
14168 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14169 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14170
14171 @node Manually
14172 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14173
14174 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14175 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14176 your program.
14177
14178 @kindex set language
14179 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14180 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14181 a language, such as
14182 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14183 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14184
14185 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14186 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14187 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14188 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14189 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14190 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14191 command such as:
14192
14193 @smallexample
14194 print a = b + c
14195 @end smallexample
14196
14197 @noindent
14198 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14199 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14200 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14201 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14202
14203 @node Automatically
14204 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14205
14206 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14207 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14208 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14209 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14210 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14211 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14212 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14213 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14214 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14215
14216 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14217 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14218 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14219 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14220 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14221
14222 @node Show
14223 @section Displaying the Language
14224
14225 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14226 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14227
14228 @table @code
14229 @item show language
14230 @anchor{show language}
14231 @kindex show language
14232 Display the current working language. This is the
14233 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14234 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14235
14236 @item info frame
14237 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14238 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14239 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14240 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14241 information listed here.
14242
14243 @item info source
14244 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14245 Display the source language of this source file.
14246 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14247 information listed here.
14248 @end table
14249
14250 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14251 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14252 with a language explicitly:
14253
14254 @table @code
14255 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14256 @kindex set extension-language
14257 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14258 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14259
14260 @item info extensions
14261 @kindex info extensions
14262 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14263 @end table
14264
14265 @node Checks
14266 @section Type and Range Checking
14267
14268 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14269 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14270 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14271 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14272 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14273 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14274 errors when your program is running.
14275
14276 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14277 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14278 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14279 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14280
14281 @menu
14282 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14283 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14284 @end menu
14285
14286 @cindex type checking
14287 @cindex checks, type
14288 @node Type Checking
14289 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14290
14291 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14292 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14293 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14294 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14295
14296 @smallexample
14297 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14298
14299 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14300 $1 = 2
14301 @exdent but
14302 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14303 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14304 @end smallexample
14305
14306 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14307 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14308
14309 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14310 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14311 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14312 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14313 expressions like the second example above.
14314
14315 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14316 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14317 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14318 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14319 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14320 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14321
14322 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14323
14324 @kindex set check type
14325 @kindex show check type
14326 @table @code
14327 @item set check type on
14328 @itemx set check type off
14329 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14330 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14331 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14332
14333 @item show check type
14334 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14335 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14336 @end table
14337
14338 @cindex range checking
14339 @cindex checks, range
14340 @node Range Checking
14341 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14342
14343 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14344 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14345 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14346 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14347 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14348
14349 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14350 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14351 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14352 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14353
14354 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14355 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14356 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14357 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14358 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14359 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14360
14361 @smallexample
14362 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14363 @end smallexample
14364
14365 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14366 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14367 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14368
14369 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14370
14371 @kindex set check range
14372 @kindex show check range
14373 @table @code
14374 @item set check range auto
14375 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14376 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14377 each language.
14378
14379 @item set check range on
14380 @itemx set check range off
14381 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14382 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14383 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14384 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14385
14386 @item set check range warn
14387 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14388 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14389 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14390 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14391 systems).
14392
14393 @item show range
14394 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14395 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14396 @end table
14397
14398 @node Supported Languages
14399 @section Supported Languages
14400
14401 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14402 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14403 @c This is false ...
14404 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14405 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14406 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14407 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14408 language.
14409
14410 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14411 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14412 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14413 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14414 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14415 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14416 language reference or tutorial.
14417
14418 @menu
14419 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14420 * D:: D
14421 * Go:: Go
14422 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14423 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14424 * Fortran:: Fortran
14425 * Pascal:: Pascal
14426 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14427 * Ada:: Ada
14428 @end menu
14429
14430 @node C
14431 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14432
14433 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14434 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14435
14436 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14437 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14438 together.
14439
14440 @cindex C@t{++}
14441 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14442 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14443 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14444 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14445 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14446 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14447 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14448
14449 @menu
14450 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14451 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14452 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14453 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14454 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14455 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14456 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14457 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14458 @end menu
14459
14460 @node C Operators
14461 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14462
14463 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14464
14465 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14466 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14467 often defined on groups of types.
14468
14469 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14470
14471 @itemize @bullet
14472
14473 @item
14474 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14475 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14476
14477 @item
14478 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14479 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14480
14481 @item
14482 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14483
14484 @item
14485 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14486
14487 @end itemize
14488
14489 @noindent
14490 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14491 in order of increasing precedence:
14492
14493 @table @code
14494 @item ,
14495 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14496 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14497 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14498
14499 @item =
14500 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14501 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14502
14503 @item @var{op}=
14504 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14505 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14506 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14507 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14508 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14509
14510 @item ?:
14511 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14512 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14513 should be of an integral type.
14514
14515 @item ||
14516 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14517
14518 @item &&
14519 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14520
14521 @item |
14522 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14523
14524 @item ^
14525 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14526
14527 @item &
14528 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14529
14530 @item ==@r{, }!=
14531 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14532 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14533
14534 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14535 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14536 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14537 and non-zero for true.
14538
14539 @item <<@r{, }>>
14540 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14541
14542 @item @@
14543 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14544
14545 @item +@r{, }-
14546 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14547 pointer types.
14548
14549 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14550 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14551 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14552 integral types.
14553
14554 @item ++@r{, }--
14555 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14556 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14557 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14558 operation takes place.
14559
14560 @item *
14561 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14562 @code{++}.
14563
14564 @item &
14565 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14566
14567 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14568 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14569 to examine the address
14570 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14571 stored.
14572
14573 @item -
14574 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14575 precedence as @code{++}.
14576
14577 @item !
14578 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14579 @code{++}.
14580
14581 @item ~
14582 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14583 @code{++}.
14584
14585
14586 @item .@r{, }->
14587 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14588 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14589 pointer based on the stored type information.
14590 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14591
14592 @item .*@r{, }->*
14593 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14594
14595 @item []
14596 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14597 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14598
14599 @item ()
14600 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14601
14602 @item ::
14603 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14604 and @code{class} types.
14605
14606 @item ::
14607 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14608 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14609 above.
14610 @end table
14611
14612 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14613 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14614 predefined meaning.
14615
14616 @node C Constants
14617 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14618
14619 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14620
14621 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14622 following ways:
14623
14624 @itemize @bullet
14625 @item
14626 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14627 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14628 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14629 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14630 @code{long} value.
14631
14632 @item
14633 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14634 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14635 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14636 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14637 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14638 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14639 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14640 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14641 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14642 constant.
14643
14644 @item
14645 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14646 integral equivalents.
14647
14648 @item
14649 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14650 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14651 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14652 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14653 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14654 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14655 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14656 @samp{\n} for newline.
14657
14658 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14659 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14660 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14661 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14662
14663 @item
14664 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14665 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14666 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14667 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14668 characters.
14669
14670 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14671 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14672 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14673
14674 @item
14675 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14676 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14677
14678 @item
14679 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14680 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14681 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14682 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14683 @end itemize
14684
14685 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14686 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14687
14688 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14689 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14690
14691 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14692 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14693 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14694 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14695 @quotation
14696 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14697 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14698 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14699 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14700 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14701 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14702 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14703 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14704 @end quotation
14705
14706 @enumerate
14707
14708 @cindex member functions
14709 @item
14710 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14711
14712 @smallexample
14713 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14714 @end smallexample
14715
14716 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14717 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14718 @item
14719 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14720 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14721 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14722 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14723 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14724
14725 @cindex call overloaded functions
14726 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14727 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14728 @item
14729 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14730 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14731 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14732 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14733 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14734 default arguments.
14735
14736 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14737 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14738 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14739 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14740 number of function arguments.
14741
14742 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14743 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14744 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14745
14746 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14747 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14748 @smallexample
14749 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14750 @end smallexample
14751
14752 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14753 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14754
14755 @cindex reference declarations
14756 @item
14757 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14758 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14759 dereferenced.
14760
14761 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14762 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14763 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14764 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14765 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14766
14767 @item
14768 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14769 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14770 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14771 necessary, for example in an expression like
14772 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14773 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14774 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14775
14776 @item
14777 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14778 specification.
14779 @end enumerate
14780
14781 @node C Defaults
14782 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14783
14784 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14785
14786 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14787 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14788 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14789 selects the working language.
14790
14791 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14792 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14793 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14794 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14795 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14796 for further details.
14797
14798 @node C Checks
14799 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14800
14801 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14802
14803 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14804 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14805 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14806 constants to pointers.
14807
14808 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14809 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14810 that is not itself an array.
14811
14812 @node Debugging C
14813 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14814
14815 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14816 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14817 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14818 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14819
14820 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14821 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14822 ,Expressions}.
14823
14824 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14825 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14826
14827 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14828
14829 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14830 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14831
14832 @table @code
14833 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14834 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14835 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14836 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14837 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14838 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14839
14840 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14841 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14842 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14843 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14844 classes.
14845 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14846
14847 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14848 @item catch throw
14849 @itemx catch rethrow
14850 @itemx catch catch
14851 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14852 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14853
14854 @cindex inheritance
14855 @item ptype @var{typename}
14856 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14857 @var{typename}.
14858 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14859
14860 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14861 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14862 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14863 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14864 multiple inheritance is in use.
14865
14866 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14867 @item demangle @var{name}
14868 Demangle @var{name}.
14869 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14870
14871 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14872 @item set print demangle
14873 @itemx show print demangle
14874 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14875 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14876 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14877 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14878 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14879
14880 @item set print object
14881 @itemx show print object
14882 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14883 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14884
14885 @item set print vtbl
14886 @itemx show print vtbl
14887 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14888 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14889 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14890 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14891
14892 @kindex set overload-resolution
14893 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14894 @item set overload-resolution on
14895 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14896 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14897 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14898 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14899 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14900 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14901
14902 @item set overload-resolution off
14903 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14904 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14905 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14906 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14907 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14908 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14909 argument types.
14910
14911 @kindex show overload-resolution
14912 @item show overload-resolution
14913 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14914
14915 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14916 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14917 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14918 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14919 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14920 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14921 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14922 @end table
14923
14924 @node Decimal Floating Point
14925 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14926 @cindex decimal floating point format
14927
14928 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14929 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14930 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14931 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14932
14933 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14934 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14935 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14936 configured target.
14937
14938 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14939 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14940 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14941
14942 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14943 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14944 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14945
14946 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14947 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14948 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14949
14950 @node D
14951 @subsection D
14952
14953 @cindex D
14954 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14955 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14956 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14957
14958 @node Go
14959 @subsection Go
14960
14961 @cindex Go (programming language)
14962 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14963 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14964
14965 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14966
14967 @table @code
14968 @cindex current Go package
14969 @item The current Go package
14970 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14971 specifying global variables and functions.
14972
14973 For example, given the program:
14974
14975 @example
14976 package main
14977 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14978 func main () @{
14979 // ...
14980 @}
14981 @end example
14982
14983 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14984
14985 @example
14986 (gdb) p myglob
14987 (gdb) p main.myglob
14988 @end example
14989
14990 @cindex builtin Go types
14991 @item Builtin Go types
14992 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14993 as a string.
14994
14995 @cindex builtin Go functions
14996 @item Builtin Go functions
14997 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14998 function and handles it internally.
14999
15000 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15001 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15002 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15003 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15004 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15005 @end table
15006
15007 @node Objective-C
15008 @subsection Objective-C
15009
15010 @cindex Objective-C
15011 This section provides information about some commands and command
15012 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15013 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15014 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15015
15016 @menu
15017 * Method Names in Commands::
15018 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15019 @end menu
15020
15021 @node Method Names in Commands
15022 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15023
15024 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15025 names as line specifications:
15026
15027 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15028 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15029 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15030 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15031 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15032 @itemize
15033 @item @code{clear}
15034 @item @code{break}
15035 @item @code{info line}
15036 @item @code{jump}
15037 @item @code{list}
15038 @end itemize
15039
15040 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15041
15042 @smallexample
15043 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15044 @end smallexample
15045
15046 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15047 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15048 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15049 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15050 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15051 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15052 debugged, enter:
15053
15054 @smallexample
15055 break -[Fruit create]
15056 @end smallexample
15057
15058 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15059 enter:
15060
15061 @smallexample
15062 list +[NSText initialize]
15063 @end smallexample
15064
15065 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15066 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15067 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15068 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15069
15070 @smallexample
15071 break create
15072 @end smallexample
15073
15074 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15075 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15076 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15077 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15078 none apply.
15079
15080 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15081 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15082
15083 @smallexample
15084 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15085 @end smallexample
15086
15087 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15088 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15089 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15090 @kindex print-object
15091 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15092
15093 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15094
15095 @smallexample
15096 print -[@var{object} hash]
15097 @end smallexample
15098
15099 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15100 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15101 @noindent
15102 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15103 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15104 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15105 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15106 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15107 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15108
15109 @node OpenCL C
15110 @subsection OpenCL C
15111
15112 @cindex OpenCL C
15113 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15114
15115 @menu
15116 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15117 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15118 * OpenCL C Operators::
15119 @end menu
15120
15121 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15122 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15123
15124 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15125 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15126 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15127 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15128 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15129
15130 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15131 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15132
15133 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15134 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15135 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15136 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15137
15138 @node OpenCL C Operators
15139 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15140
15141 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15142 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15143 vector data types.
15144
15145 @node Fortran
15146 @subsection Fortran
15147 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15148
15149 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15150 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15151
15152 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15153 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15154 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15155 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15156 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15157 underscore.
15158
15159 @menu
15160 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15161 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15162 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15163 @end menu
15164
15165 @node Fortran Operators
15166 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15167
15168 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15169
15170 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15171 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15172 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15173
15174 @table @code
15175 @item **
15176 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15177 of the second one.
15178
15179 @item :
15180 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15181 represent a section of array.
15182
15183 @item %
15184 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15185 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15186 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15187 union type.
15188 @end table
15189
15190 @node Fortran Defaults
15191 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15192
15193 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15194
15195 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15196 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15197 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15198 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15199
15200 @node Special Fortran Commands
15201 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15202
15203 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15204
15205 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15206 such as displaying common blocks.
15207
15208 @table @code
15209 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15210 @kindex info common
15211 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15212 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15213 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15214 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15215 printed.
15216 @end table
15217
15218 @node Pascal
15219 @subsection Pascal
15220
15221 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15222 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15223 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15224 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15225 syntax.
15226
15227 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15228 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15229 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15230
15231 @node Modula-2
15232 @subsection Modula-2
15233
15234 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15235
15236 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15237 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15238 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15239 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15240 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15241 table.
15242
15243 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15244 @menu
15245 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15246 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15247 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15248 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15249 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15250 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15251 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15252 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15253 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15254 @end menu
15255
15256 @node M2 Operators
15257 @subsubsection Operators
15258 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15259
15260 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15261 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15262 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15263 following definitions hold:
15264
15265 @itemize @bullet
15266
15267 @item
15268 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15269 their subranges.
15270
15271 @item
15272 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15273
15274 @item
15275 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15276
15277 @item
15278 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15279 @var{type}}.
15280
15281 @item
15282 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15283
15284 @item
15285 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15286
15287 @item
15288 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15289 @end itemize
15290
15291 @noindent
15292 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15293 increasing precedence:
15294
15295 @table @code
15296 @item ,
15297 Function argument or array index separator.
15298
15299 @item :=
15300 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15301 @var{value}.
15302
15303 @item <@r{, }>
15304 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15305 types.
15306
15307 @item <=@r{, }>=
15308 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15309 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15310 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15311
15312 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15313 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15314 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15315 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15316 comment character.
15317
15318 @item IN
15319 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15320 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15321
15322 @item OR
15323 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15324
15325 @item AND@r{, }&
15326 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15327
15328 @item @@
15329 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15330
15331 @item +@r{, }-
15332 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15333 and difference on set types.
15334
15335 @item *
15336 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15337 on set types.
15338
15339 @item /
15340 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15341 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15342
15343 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15344 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15345 precedence as @code{*}.
15346
15347 @item -
15348 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15349
15350 @item ^
15351 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15352
15353 @item NOT
15354 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15355 @code{^}.
15356
15357 @item .
15358 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15359 precedence as @code{^}.
15360
15361 @item []
15362 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15363
15364 @item ()
15365 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15366 as @code{^}.
15367
15368 @item ::@r{, }.
15369 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15370 @end table
15371
15372 @quotation
15373 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15374 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15375 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15376 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15377 @end quotation
15378
15379
15380 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15381 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15382 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15383
15384 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15385 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15386
15387 @table @var
15388
15389 @item a
15390 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15391
15392 @item c
15393 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15394
15395 @item i
15396 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15397
15398 @item m
15399 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15400 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15401 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15402
15403 @item n
15404 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15405
15406 @item r
15407 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15408
15409 @item t
15410 represents a type.
15411
15412 @item v
15413 represents a variable.
15414
15415 @item x
15416 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15417 explanation of the function for details.
15418 @end table
15419
15420 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15421
15422 @table @code
15423 @item ABS(@var{n})
15424 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15425
15426 @item CAP(@var{c})
15427 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15428 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15429
15430 @item CHR(@var{i})
15431 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15432
15433 @item DEC(@var{v})
15434 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15435
15436 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15437 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15438 new value.
15439
15440 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15441 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15442 set.
15443
15444 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15445 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15446
15447 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15448 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15449
15450 @item INC(@var{v})
15451 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15452
15453 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15454 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15455 new value.
15456
15457 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15458 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15459 there. Returns the new set.
15460
15461 @item MAX(@var{t})
15462 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15463
15464 @item MIN(@var{t})
15465 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15466
15467 @item ODD(@var{i})
15468 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15469
15470 @item ORD(@var{x})
15471 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15472 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15473 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15474 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15475
15476 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15477 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15478 variable or a type.
15479
15480 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15481 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15482
15483 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15484 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15485 variable or a type.
15486
15487 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15488 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15489 @end table
15490
15491 @quotation
15492 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15493 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15494 an error.
15495 @end quotation
15496
15497 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15498 @node M2 Constants
15499 @subsubsection Constants
15500
15501 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15502 ways:
15503
15504 @itemize @bullet
15505
15506 @item
15507 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15508 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15509 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15510 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15511
15512 @item
15513 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15514 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15515 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15516 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15517 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15518 digits.
15519
15520 @item
15521 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15522 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15523 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15524 followed by a @samp{C}.
15525
15526 @item
15527 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15528 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15529 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15530 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15531 sequences.
15532
15533 @item
15534 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15535
15536 @item
15537 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15538 @code{FALSE}.
15539
15540 @item
15541 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15542
15543 @item
15544 Set constants are not yet supported.
15545 @end itemize
15546
15547 @node M2 Types
15548 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15549 @cindex Modula-2 types
15550
15551 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15552 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15553 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15554 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15555 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15556 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15557
15558 The first example contains the following section of code:
15559
15560 @smallexample
15561 VAR
15562 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15563 r: [20..40] ;
15564 @end smallexample
15565
15566 @noindent
15567 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15568 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15569
15570 @smallexample
15571 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15572 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15573 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15574 SET OF CHAR
15575 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15576 21
15577 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15578 [20..40]
15579 @end smallexample
15580
15581 @noindent
15582 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15583
15584 @smallexample
15585 VAR
15586 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15587 @end smallexample
15588
15589 @noindent
15590 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15591
15592 @smallexample
15593 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15594 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15595 @end smallexample
15596
15597 @noindent
15598 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15599 expressions using the debugger.
15600
15601 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15602 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15603
15604 @smallexample
15605 VAR
15606 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15607 @end smallexample
15608
15609 @smallexample
15610 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15611 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15612 @end smallexample
15613
15614 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15615 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15616 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15617 above.
15618
15619 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15620
15621 @smallexample
15622 TYPE
15623 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15624 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15625 VAR
15626 s: t ;
15627 BEGIN
15628 s := blue ;
15629 @end smallexample
15630
15631 @noindent
15632 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15633 and value of a variable.
15634
15635 @smallexample
15636 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15637 $1 = blue
15638 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15639 type = [blue..yellow]
15640 @end smallexample
15641
15642 @noindent
15643 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15644 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15645 their @code{C} counterparts.
15646
15647 @smallexample
15648 VAR
15649 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15650 BEGIN
15651 s[1] := 1 ;
15652 @end smallexample
15653
15654 @smallexample
15655 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15656 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15657 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15658 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15659 @end smallexample
15660
15661 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15662 pointer types as shown in this example:
15663
15664 @smallexample
15665 VAR
15666 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15667 BEGIN
15668 NEW(s) ;
15669 s^[1] := 1 ;
15670 @end smallexample
15671
15672 @noindent
15673 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15674
15675 @smallexample
15676 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15677 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15678 @end smallexample
15679
15680 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15681 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15682 types:
15683
15684 @smallexample
15685 TYPE
15686 foo = RECORD
15687 f1: CARDINAL ;
15688 f2: CHAR ;
15689 f3: myarray ;
15690 END ;
15691
15692 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15693 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15694 VAR
15695 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15696 @end smallexample
15697
15698 @noindent
15699 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15700 below.
15701
15702 @smallexample
15703 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15704 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15705 f1 : CARDINAL;
15706 f2 : CHAR;
15707 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15708 END
15709 @end smallexample
15710
15711 @node M2 Defaults
15712 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15713 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15714
15715 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15716 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15717 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15718 selected the working language.
15719
15720 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15721 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15722 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15723 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15724
15725 @node Deviations
15726 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15727 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15728
15729 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15730 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15731
15732 @itemize @bullet
15733 @item
15734 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15735 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15736 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15737 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15738 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15739 returned a pointer.)
15740
15741 @item
15742 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15743 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15744 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15745 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15746
15747 @item
15748 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15749 argument.
15750
15751 @item
15752 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15753 @end itemize
15754
15755 @node M2 Checks
15756 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15757 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15758
15759 @quotation
15760 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15761 range checking.
15762 @end quotation
15763 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15764
15765 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15766
15767 @itemize @bullet
15768 @item
15769 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15770 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15771
15772 @item
15773 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15774 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15775 @end itemize
15776
15777 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15778 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15779
15780 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15781 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15782
15783 @node M2 Scope
15784 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15785 @cindex scope
15786 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15787 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15788 @ifinfo
15789 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15790 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15791 @end ifinfo
15792 @ifnotinfo
15793 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15794 @end ifnotinfo
15795
15796 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15797 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15798 similar syntax:
15799
15800 @smallexample
15801
15802 @var{module} . @var{id}
15803 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15804 @end smallexample
15805
15806 @noindent
15807 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15808 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15809 identifier within your program, except another module.
15810
15811 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15812 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15813 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15814 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15815
15816 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15817 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15818 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15819 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15820 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15821 @var{module}.
15822
15823 @node GDB/M2
15824 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15825
15826 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15827 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15828 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15829 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15830 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15831 analogue in Modula-2.
15832
15833 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15834 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15835 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15836 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15837 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15838 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15839
15840 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15841 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15842 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15843
15844 @node Ada
15845 @subsection Ada
15846 @cindex Ada
15847
15848 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15849 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15850 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15851 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15852 to be difficult.
15853
15854
15855 @cindex expressions in Ada
15856 @menu
15857 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15858 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15859 in @value{GDBN}.
15860 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15861 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15862 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15863 subprograms.
15864 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15865 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15866 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15867 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15868 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15869 Profile
15870 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15871 @end menu
15872
15873 @node Ada Mode Intro
15874 @subsubsection Introduction
15875 @cindex Ada mode, general
15876
15877 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15878 syntax, with some extensions.
15879 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15880
15881 @itemize @bullet
15882 @item
15883 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15884 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15885 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15886 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15887
15888 @item
15889 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15890 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15891
15892 @item
15893 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15894 @end itemize
15895
15896 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15897 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15898 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15899 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15900 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15901
15902 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15903 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15904 was translated from an Ada source file.
15905
15906 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15907 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15908 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15909 middle (to allow based literals).
15910
15911 @node Omissions from Ada
15912 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15913 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15914
15915 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15916
15917 @itemize @bullet
15918 @item
15919 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15920
15921 @itemize @minus
15922 @item
15923 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15924 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15925
15926 @item
15927 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15928
15929 @item
15930 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15931
15932 @item
15933 @t{'Tag}.
15934
15935 @item
15936 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15937 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15938
15939 @item
15940 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15941 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15942
15943 @item
15944 @t{'Address}.
15945 @end itemize
15946
15947 @item
15948 The names in
15949 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15950 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15951 not currently available.
15952
15953 @item
15954 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15955 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15956 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15957 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15958 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15959 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15960 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15961 indeterminate values.
15962
15963 @item
15964 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15965 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15966 are not implemented.
15967
15968 @item
15969 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15970 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15971 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15972 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15973 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15974
15975 @smallexample
15976 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15977 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15978 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15979 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15980 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15981 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15982 @end smallexample
15983
15984 Changing a
15985 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15986 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15987 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15988 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15989 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15990 declared to have a type such as:
15991
15992 @smallexample
15993 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15994 Id : Integer;
15995 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15996 end record;
15997 @end smallexample
15998
15999 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16000 assignments:
16001
16002 @smallexample
16003 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16004 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16005 @end smallexample
16006
16007 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16008 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16009 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16010 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16011 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16012 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16013 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16014 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16015
16016 @item
16017 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16018
16019 @item
16020 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16021 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16022 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16023 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16024 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16025 the proper resolution.
16026
16027 @item
16028 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16029
16030 @item
16031 Entry calls are not implemented.
16032
16033 @item
16034 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16035 formats are not supported.
16036
16037 @item
16038 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16039
16040 @item
16041 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16042 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16043 context.
16044 Should your program
16045 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16046 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16047 @end itemize
16048
16049 @node Additions to Ada
16050 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16051 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16052
16053 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16054 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16055
16056 @itemize @bullet
16057 @item
16058 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16059 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16060 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16061 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16062 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16063 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16064 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16065 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16066
16067 @item
16068 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16069 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16070 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16071
16072 @item
16073 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16074 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16075
16076 @item
16077 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16078 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16079 @end itemize
16080
16081 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16082 additions specific to Ada:
16083
16084 @itemize @bullet
16085 @item
16086 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16087 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16088
16089 @smallexample
16090 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16091 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16092 @end smallexample
16093
16094 @item
16095 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16096 the value of its right-hand operand.
16097 This allows, for example,
16098 complex conditional breaks:
16099
16100 @smallexample
16101 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16102 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16103 @end smallexample
16104
16105 @item
16106 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16107 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16108 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16109 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16110 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16111 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16112 in strings. For example,
16113 @smallexample
16114 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16115 @end smallexample
16116 @noindent
16117 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16118 after each period.
16119
16120 @item
16121 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16122 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16123 to write
16124
16125 @smallexample
16126 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16127 @end smallexample
16128
16129 @item
16130 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16131 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16132 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16133 of 3 might print as
16134
16135 @smallexample
16136 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16137 @end smallexample
16138
16139 @noindent
16140 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16141 clause.
16142
16143 @item
16144 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16145 multi-character subsequence of
16146 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16147 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16148 in place of @t{a'length}.
16149
16150 @item
16151 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16152 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16153 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16154 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16155 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16156 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16157 For example,
16158 @smallexample
16159 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16160 @end smallexample
16161
16162 @item
16163 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16164 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16165 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16166 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16167 object.
16168
16169 @end itemize
16170
16171 @node Overloading support for Ada
16172 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16173 @cindex overloading, Ada
16174
16175 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16176 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16177 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16178 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16179 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16180 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16181
16182 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16183 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16184 use, for instance:
16185
16186 @smallexample
16187 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16188 Multiple matches for f
16189 [0] cancel
16190 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16191 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16192 >
16193 @end smallexample
16194
16195 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16196 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16197 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16198
16199 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16200 case:
16201
16202 @table @code
16203
16204 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16205 @item set ada print-signatures
16206 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16207 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16208 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16209
16210 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16211 @item show ada print-signatures
16212 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16213 overloads selection menu.
16214 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16215
16216 @end table
16217
16218 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16219 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16220
16221 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16222 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16223 before reaching the main procedure.
16224 As defined in the Ada Reference
16225 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16226 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16227 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16228 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16229
16230 @node Ada Exceptions
16231 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16232
16233 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16234
16235 @table @code
16236 @kindex info exceptions
16237 @item info exceptions
16238 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16239 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16240 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16241 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16242 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16243 @end table
16244
16245 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16246 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16247 argument.
16248
16249 @smallexample
16250 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16251 All defined Ada exceptions:
16252 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16253 program_error: 0x613d20
16254 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16255 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16256 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16257 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16258 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16259 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16260 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16261 @end smallexample
16262
16263 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16264 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16265
16266 @node Ada Tasks
16267 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16268 @cindex Ada, tasking
16269
16270 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16271 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16272
16273 @table @code
16274 @kindex info tasks
16275 @item info tasks
16276 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16277
16278
16279 @smallexample
16280 @iftex
16281 @leftskip=0.5cm
16282 @end iftex
16283 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16284 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16285 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16286 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16287 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16288 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16289
16290 @end smallexample
16291
16292 @noindent
16293 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16294 task currently being inspected.
16295
16296 @table @asis
16297 @item ID
16298 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16299
16300 @item TID
16301 The Ada task ID.
16302
16303 @item P-ID
16304 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16305
16306 @item Pri
16307 The base priority of the task.
16308
16309 @item State
16310 Current state of the task.
16311
16312 @table @code
16313 @item Unactivated
16314 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16315 executing.
16316
16317 @item Runnable
16318 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16319 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16320
16321 @item Terminated
16322 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16323 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16324 terminated themselves.
16325
16326 @item Child Activation Wait
16327 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16328
16329 @item Accept Statement
16330 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16331
16332 @item Waiting on entry call
16333 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16334
16335 @item Async Select Wait
16336 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16337 select statement.
16338
16339 @item Delay Sleep
16340 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16341 alternative open.
16342
16343 @item Child Termination Wait
16344 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16345 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16346 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16347
16348 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16349 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16350 finish terminating.
16351
16352 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16353 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16354 @end table
16355
16356 @item Name
16357 Name of the task in the program.
16358
16359 @end table
16360
16361 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16362 @item info task @var{taskno}
16363 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16364 the following example:
16365 @smallexample
16366 @iftex
16367 @leftskip=0.5cm
16368 @end iftex
16369 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16370 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16371 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16372 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16373 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16374 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16375 Name: task_1
16376 Thread: 0x807f378
16377 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16378 Base Priority: 15
16379 State: Runnable
16380 @end smallexample
16381
16382 @item task
16383 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16384 @cindex current Ada task ID
16385 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16386
16387 @smallexample
16388 @iftex
16389 @leftskip=0.5cm
16390 @end iftex
16391 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16392 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16393 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16394 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16395 (@value{GDBP}) task
16396 [Current task is 2]
16397 @end smallexample
16398
16399 @item task @var{taskno}
16400 @cindex Ada task switching
16401 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16402 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16403 from the current task to the given task.
16404
16405 @smallexample
16406 @iftex
16407 @leftskip=0.5cm
16408 @end iftex
16409 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16410 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16411 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16412 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16413 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16414 [Switching to task 1]
16415 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16416 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16417 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16418 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16419 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16420 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16421 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16422 @end smallexample
16423
16424 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16425 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16426 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16427 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16428 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16429 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16430 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16431 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16432 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16433
16434 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16435 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16436 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16437 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16438 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16439
16440 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16441 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16442 program.
16443
16444 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16445 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16446 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16447
16448 For example,
16449
16450 @smallexample
16451 @iftex
16452 @leftskip=0.5cm
16453 @end iftex
16454 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16455 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16456 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16457 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16458 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16459 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16460 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16461 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16462 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16463 Continuing.
16464 task # 1 running
16465 task # 2 running
16466
16467 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16468 15 flush;
16469 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16470 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16471 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16472 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16473 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16474 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16475 @end smallexample
16476 @end table
16477
16478 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16479 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16480 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16481
16482 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16483 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16484 the platform being used.
16485 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16486 switching is not supported.
16487
16488 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16489 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16490 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16491 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16492 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16493 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16494
16495 @node Ravenscar Profile
16496 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16497 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16498
16499 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16500 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16501 requirements.
16502
16503 @table @code
16504 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16505 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16506 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16507 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16508 Profile. This is the default.
16509
16510 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16511 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16512 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16513 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16514 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16515 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16516 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16517
16518 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16519 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16520 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16521 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16522
16523 @end table
16524
16525 @node Ada Glitches
16526 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16527 @cindex Ada, problems
16528
16529 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16530 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16531 @value{GDBN},
16532 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16533 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16534
16535 @itemize @bullet
16536 @item
16537 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16538 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16539
16540 @item
16541 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16542 argument lists are treated as positional).
16543
16544 @item
16545 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16546
16547 @item
16548 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16549 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16550 the host machine.
16551
16552 @item
16553 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16554 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16555 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16556 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16557 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16558 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16559 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16560 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16561 you can usually resolve the confusion
16562 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16563 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16564 @end itemize
16565
16566 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16567 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16568 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16569 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16570 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16571 enabled.
16572
16573 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16574 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16575 @table @code
16576
16577 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16578 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16579 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16580 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16581 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16582 This is the default.
16583
16584 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16585 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16586 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16587 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16588 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16589 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16590 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16591
16592 @end table
16593
16594 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16595 @cindex GNAT encoding
16596 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16597 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16598 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16599 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16600 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16601 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16602
16603 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16604 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16605 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16606 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16607 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16608 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16609 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16610 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16611
16612 @table @code
16613
16614 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16615 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16616 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16617 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16618
16619 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16620 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16621 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16622
16623 @end table
16624
16625 @node Unsupported Languages
16626 @section Unsupported Languages
16627
16628 @cindex unsupported languages
16629 @cindex minimal language
16630 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16631 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16632 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16633 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16634 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16635 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16636
16637 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16638 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16639 language.
16640
16641 @node Symbols
16642 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16643
16644 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16645 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16646 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16647 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16648 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16649 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16650 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16651
16652 @cindex symbol names
16653 @cindex names of symbols
16654 @cindex quoting names
16655 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16656 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16657 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16658 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16659 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16660 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16661 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16662 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16663
16664 @smallexample
16665 p 'foo.c'::x
16666 @end smallexample
16667
16668 @noindent
16669 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16670
16671 @table @code
16672 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16673 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16674 @kindex set case-sensitive
16675 @item set case-sensitive on
16676 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16677 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16678 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16679 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16680 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16681 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16682 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16683 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16684 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16685 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16686 case-insensitive matches.
16687
16688 @kindex show case-sensitive
16689 @item show case-sensitive
16690 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16691 lookups.
16692
16693 @kindex set print type methods
16694 @item set print type methods
16695 @itemx set print type methods on
16696 @itemx set print type methods off
16697 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16698 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16699 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16700 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16701 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16702 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16703
16704 @kindex show print type methods
16705 @item show print type methods
16706 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16707 classes.
16708
16709 @kindex set print type typedefs
16710 @item set print type typedefs
16711 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16712 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16713
16714 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16715 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16716 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16717 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16718 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16719 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16720 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16721 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16722 types.
16723
16724 @kindex show print type typedefs
16725 @item show print type typedefs
16726 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16727 printing classes.
16728
16729 @kindex info address
16730 @cindex address of a symbol
16731 @item info address @var{symbol}
16732 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16733 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16734 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16735 is always stored.
16736
16737 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16738 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16739 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16740
16741 @kindex info symbol
16742 @cindex symbol from address
16743 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16744 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16745 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16746 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16747 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16748
16749 @smallexample
16750 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16751 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16752 @end smallexample
16753
16754 @noindent
16755 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16756 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16757
16758 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16759 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16760
16761 @smallexample
16762 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16763 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16764 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16765 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16766 @end smallexample
16767
16768 @kindex demangle
16769 @cindex demangle
16770 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16771 Demangle @var{name}.
16772 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16773 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16774
16775 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16776 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16777
16778 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16779 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16780
16781 @kindex whatis
16782 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16783 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16784 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16785 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16786
16787 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16788 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16789 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16790
16791 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16792 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16793 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16794 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16795 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16796 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16797 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16798 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16799 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16800
16801 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16802 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16803 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16804 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16805 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16806 unroll it.
16807
16808 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16809 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16810 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16811
16812 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16813 Available flags are:
16814
16815 @table @code
16816 @item r
16817 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16818 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16819 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16820
16821 @item m
16822 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16823
16824 @item M
16825 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16826 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16827
16828 @item t
16829 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16830 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16831 names are substituted when printing other types.
16832
16833 @item T
16834 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16835 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16836 @end table
16837
16838 @kindex ptype
16839 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16840 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16841 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16842 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16843
16844 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16845 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16846 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16847 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16848 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16849 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16850 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16851 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16852
16853 For example, for this variable declaration:
16854
16855 @smallexample
16856 typedef double real_t;
16857 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16858 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16859 complex_t var;
16860 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16861 @end smallexample
16862
16863 @noindent
16864 the two commands give this output:
16865
16866 @smallexample
16867 @group
16868 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16869 type = complex_t
16870 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16871 type = struct complex @{
16872 real_t real;
16873 double imag;
16874 @}
16875 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16876 type = struct complex
16877 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16878 type = struct complex
16879 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16880 type = struct complex @{
16881 real_t real;
16882 double imag;
16883 @}
16884 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16885 type = real_t *
16886 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16887 type = double *
16888 @end group
16889 @end smallexample
16890
16891 @noindent
16892 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16893 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16894
16895 @cindex incomplete type
16896 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16897 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16898 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16899 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16900 given these declarations:
16901
16902 @smallexample
16903 struct foo;
16904 struct foo *fooptr;
16905 @end smallexample
16906
16907 @noindent
16908 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16909
16910 @smallexample
16911 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16912 $1 = <incomplete type>
16913 @end smallexample
16914
16915 @noindent
16916 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16917 completely specified.
16918
16919 @kindex info types
16920 @item info types @var{regexp}
16921 @itemx info types
16922 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16923 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16924 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16925 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16926 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16927 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16928 name is @code{value}.
16929
16930 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16931 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16932 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16933
16934 @kindex info type-printers
16935 @item info type-printers
16936 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16937 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16938 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16939 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16940 type printers.
16941
16942 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16943
16944 @kindex enable type-printer
16945 @kindex disable type-printer
16946 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16947 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16948 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16949
16950 @kindex info scope
16951 @cindex local variables
16952 @item info scope @var{location}
16953 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16954 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16955 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16956 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16957 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16958
16959 @smallexample
16960 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16961 Scope for command_line_handler:
16962 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16963 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16964 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16965 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16966 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16967 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16968 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16969 @end smallexample
16970
16971 @noindent
16972 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16973 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16974 collect}.
16975
16976 @kindex info source
16977 @item info source
16978 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16979 the function containing the current point of execution:
16980 @itemize @bullet
16981 @item
16982 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16983 @item
16984 the directory it was compiled in,
16985 @item
16986 its length, in lines,
16987 @item
16988 which programming language it is written in,
16989 @item
16990 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16991 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16992 @item
16993 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16994 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16995 @item
16996 whether the debugging information includes information about
16997 preprocessor macros.
16998 @end itemize
16999
17000
17001 @kindex info sources
17002 @item info sources
17003 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17004 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17005 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17006
17007 @kindex info functions
17008 @item info functions
17009 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17010
17011 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17012 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17013 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17014 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17015 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17016 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17017 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17018 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17019
17020 @kindex info variables
17021 @item info variables
17022 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17023 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17024
17025 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17026 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17027 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17028 @var{regexp}.
17029
17030 @kindex info classes
17031 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17032 @item info classes
17033 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17034 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17035 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17036 expression.
17037
17038 @kindex info selectors
17039 @item info selectors
17040 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17041 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17042 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17043 expression.
17044
17045 @ignore
17046 This was never implemented.
17047 @kindex info methods
17048 @item info methods
17049 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17050 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17051 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17052 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17053 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17054 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17055 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17056 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17057 @end ignore
17058
17059 @cindex opaque data types
17060 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17061 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17062 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17063 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17064 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17065 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17066 another source file. The default is on.
17067
17068 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17069 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17070
17071 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17072 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17073 is printed as follows:
17074 @smallexample
17075 @{<no data fields>@}
17076 @end smallexample
17077
17078 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17079 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17080 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17081
17082 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17083 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17084 @item set print symbol-loading
17085 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17086 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17087 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17088 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17089 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17090 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17091 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17092 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17093 can be annoying.
17094 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17095 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17096 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17097 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17098
17099 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17100 @item show print symbol-loading
17101 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17102 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17103
17104 @kindex maint print symbols
17105 @cindex symbol dump
17106 @kindex maint print psymbols
17107 @cindex partial symbol dump
17108 @kindex maint print msymbols
17109 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17110 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
17111 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
17112 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
17113 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
17114 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
17115 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
17116 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
17117 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
17118 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
17119 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
17120 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
17121 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
17122 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
17123 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
17124 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
17125 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17126 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17127
17128 @kindex maint info symtabs
17129 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17130 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17131 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17132 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17133 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17134 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17135 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17136
17137 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17138 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17139 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17140 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17141 structure in more detail. For example:
17142
17143 @smallexample
17144 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17145 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17146 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17147 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17148 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17149 readin no
17150 fullname (null)
17151 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17152 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17153 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17154 dependencies (none)
17155 @}
17156 @}
17157 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17158 (@value{GDBP})
17159 @end smallexample
17160 @noindent
17161 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17162 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17163 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17164 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17165 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17166
17167 @smallexample
17168 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17169 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17170 line 1574.
17171 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17172 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17173 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17174 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17175 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17176 dirname (null)
17177 fullname (null)
17178 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17179 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17180 debugformat DWARF 2
17181 @}
17182 @}
17183 (@value{GDBP})
17184 @end smallexample
17185
17186 @kindex maint info line-table
17187 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17188 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17189 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17190
17191 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17192 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17193 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17194
17195 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17196 @cindex symbol cache size
17197 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17198 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17199 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17200 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17201 with different sizes.
17202
17203 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17204 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17205 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17206
17207 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17208 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17209 @item maint print symbol-cache
17210 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17211 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17212
17213 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17214 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17215 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17216 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17217 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17218
17219 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17220 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17221 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17222 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17223 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17224 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17225
17226 @end table
17227
17228 @node Altering
17229 @chapter Altering Execution
17230
17231 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17232 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17233 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17234 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17235 program.
17236
17237 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17238 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17239 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17240
17241 @menu
17242 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17243 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17244 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17245 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17246 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17247 * Patching:: Patching your program
17248 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17249 @end menu
17250
17251 @node Assignment
17252 @section Assignment to Variables
17253
17254 @cindex assignment
17255 @cindex setting variables
17256 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17257 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17258
17259 @smallexample
17260 print x=4
17261 @end smallexample
17262
17263 @noindent
17264 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17265 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17266 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17267 information on operators in supported languages.
17268
17269 @kindex set variable
17270 @cindex variables, setting
17271 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17272 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17273 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17274 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17275 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17276
17277 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17278 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17279 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17280 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17281 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17282 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17283 command @code{set width}:
17284
17285 @smallexample
17286 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17287 type = double
17288 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17289 $4 = 13
17290 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17291 Invalid syntax in expression.
17292 @end smallexample
17293
17294 @noindent
17295 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17296 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17297
17298 @smallexample
17299 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17300 @end smallexample
17301
17302 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17303 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17304 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17305 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17306 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17307 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17308
17309 @smallexample
17310 @group
17311 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17312 type = double
17313 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17314 $1 = 1
17315 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17316 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17317 $2 = 1
17318 (@value{GDBP}) r
17319 The program being debugged has been started already.
17320 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17321 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17322 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17323 Invalid bfd target.
17324 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17325 The current BFD target is "=4".
17326 @end group
17327 @end smallexample
17328
17329 @noindent
17330 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17331 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17332 @code{g}, use
17333
17334 @smallexample
17335 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17336 @end smallexample
17337
17338 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17339 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17340 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17341 same length or shorter.
17342 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17343 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17344
17345 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17346 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17347 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17348 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17349 and representation in memory), and
17350
17351 @smallexample
17352 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17353 @end smallexample
17354
17355 @noindent
17356 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17357
17358 @node Jumping
17359 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17360
17361 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17362 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17363 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17364
17365 @table @code
17366 @kindex jump
17367 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17368 @item jump @var{location}
17369 @itemx j @var{location}
17370 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17371 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17372 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17373 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17374 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17375
17376 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17377 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17378 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17379 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17380 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17381 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17382 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17383 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17384 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17385 @end table
17386
17387 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17388 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17389 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17390 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17391 example,
17392
17393 @smallexample
17394 set $pc = 0x485
17395 @end smallexample
17396
17397 @noindent
17398 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17399 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17400 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17401
17402 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17403 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17404 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17405 detail.
17406
17407 @c @group
17408 @node Signaling
17409 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17410 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17411
17412 @table @code
17413 @kindex signal
17414 @item signal @var{signal}
17415 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17416 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17417 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17418 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17419
17420 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17421 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17422 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17423 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17424 signal.
17425
17426 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17427 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17428 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17429 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17430 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17431 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17432 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17433 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17434
17435 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17436 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17437 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17438 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17439 passes the signal directly to your program.
17440
17441 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17442 after executing the command.
17443
17444 @kindex queue-signal
17445 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17446 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17447 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17448 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17449 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17450 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17451 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17452 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17453 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17454
17455 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17456 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17457 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17458 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17459 @code{continue} command.
17460
17461 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17462 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17463 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17464 (@pxref{Signals}).
17465 @end table
17466 @c @end group
17467
17468 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17469 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17470
17471 @node Returning
17472 @section Returning from a Function
17473
17474 @table @code
17475 @cindex returning from a function
17476 @kindex return
17477 @item return
17478 @itemx return @var{expression}
17479 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17480 command. If you give an
17481 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17482 value.
17483 @end table
17484
17485 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17486 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17487 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17488 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17489
17490 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17491 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17492 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17493 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17494 of functions.
17495
17496 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17497 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17498 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17499 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17500 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17501
17502 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17503 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17504 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17505 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17506 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17507 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17508 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17509 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17510 assignment into the right register(s).
17511
17512 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17513 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17514 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17515 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17516 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17517 into a @code{long long int}:
17518
17519 @smallexample
17520 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17521 29 return 31;
17522 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17523 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17524 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17525 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17526 (@value{GDBP})
17527 @end smallexample
17528
17529 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17530 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17531 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17532 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17533 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17534 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17535 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17536 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17537
17538 @smallexample
17539 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17540 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17541 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17542 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17543 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17544 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17545 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17546 (@value{GDBP})
17547 @end smallexample
17548
17549 @node Calling
17550 @section Calling Program Functions
17551
17552 @table @code
17553 @cindex calling functions
17554 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17555 @item print @var{expr}
17556 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17557 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17558 debugged.
17559
17560 @kindex call
17561 @item call @var{expr}
17562 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17563 returned values.
17564
17565 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17566 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17567 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17568 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17569 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17570 value history.
17571 @end table
17572
17573 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17574 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17575 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17576 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17577
17578 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17579 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17580 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17581 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17582 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17583 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17584 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17585 in that case is controlled by the
17586 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17587
17588 @table @code
17589 @item set unwindonsignal
17590 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17591 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17592 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17593 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17594 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17595 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17596 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17597 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17598 received.
17599
17600 @item show unwindonsignal
17601 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17602 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17603 @value{GDBN}.
17604
17605 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17606 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17607 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17608 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17609 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17610 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17611 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17612 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17613 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17614 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17615
17616 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17617 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17618 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17619 @value{GDBN}.
17620
17621 @end table
17622
17623 @cindex weak alias functions
17624 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17625 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17626 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17627 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17628 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17629 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17630 function instead.
17631
17632 @node Patching
17633 @section Patching Programs
17634
17635 @cindex patching binaries
17636 @cindex writing into executables
17637 @cindex writing into corefiles
17638
17639 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17640 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17641 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17642 patching your program's binary.
17643
17644 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17645 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17646 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17647 repairs.
17648
17649 @table @code
17650 @kindex set write
17651 @item set write on
17652 @itemx set write off
17653 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17654 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17655 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17656
17657 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17658 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17659 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17660
17661 @item show write
17662 @kindex show write
17663 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17664 as well as reading.
17665 @end table
17666
17667 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17668 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17669 @cindex injecting code
17670 @cindex writing into executables
17671 @cindex compiling code
17672
17673 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17674 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17675 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17676 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17677
17678 @table @code
17679 @kindex compile code
17680 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17681 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17682 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17683 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17684 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17685 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17686 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17687 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17688 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17689 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17690 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17691 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17692
17693 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17694 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17695 E.g.:
17696
17697 @smallexample
17698 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17699 @end smallexample
17700
17701 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17702 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17703 from actual source code. E.g.:
17704
17705 @smallexample
17706 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17707 @end smallexample
17708
17709 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17710 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17711 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17712 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17713 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17714 editor.
17715
17716 @smallexample
17717 compile code
17718 >printf ("hello\n");
17719 >printf ("world\n");
17720 >end
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17724 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17725 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17726 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17727 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17728 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17729 inferior symbols otherwise.
17730
17731 @kindex compile file
17732 @item compile file @var{filename}
17733 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17734 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17735
17736 @smallexample
17737 compile file /home/user/example.c
17738 @end smallexample
17739 @end table
17740
17741 @table @code
17742 @item compile print @var{expr}
17743 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17744 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17745 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17746 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17747 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17748 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17749 Formats}.
17750
17751 @item compile print
17752 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17753 @cindex reprint the last value
17754 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17755 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17756 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17757 multiple-line editor.
17758 @end table
17759
17760 @noindent
17761 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17762
17763 @table @code
17764 @anchor{set debug compile}
17765 @item set debug compile
17766 @cindex compile command debugging info
17767 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17768 injecting the code. The default is off.
17769
17770 @item show debug compile
17771 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17772 compiling and injecting the code.
17773 @end table
17774
17775 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17776
17777 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17778 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17779 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17780 injecting process.
17781
17782 @noindent
17783 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17784
17785 @table @asis
17786 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17787 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17788 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17789 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17790
17791 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17792 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17793 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17794 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17795 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17796 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17797 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17798 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17799
17800 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17801 @end table
17802
17803 @noindent
17804 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17805
17806 @table @code
17807 @item set compile-args
17808 @cindex compile command options override
17809 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17810 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17811 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17812 compilation.
17813
17814 @item show compile-args
17815 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17816 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17817 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17818 @end table
17819
17820 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17821
17822 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17823 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17824 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17825
17826 @table @asis
17827 @item C code examples and caveats
17828 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17829 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17830 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17831 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17832 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17833
17834 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17835 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17836 much like any other normal debugging session.
17837
17838 @smallexample
17839 void function1 (void)
17840 @{
17841 int i = 42;
17842 printf ("function 1\n");
17843 @}
17844
17845 void function2 (void)
17846 @{
17847 int j = 12;
17848 function1 ();
17849 @}
17850
17851 int main(void)
17852 @{
17853 int k = 6;
17854 int *p;
17855 function2 ();
17856 return 0;
17857 @}
17858 @end smallexample
17859
17860 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17861 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17862 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17863
17864 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17865 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17866 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17867 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17868 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17869
17870 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17871 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17872 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17873 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17874 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17875 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17876 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17877 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17878 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17879 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17880
17881 @smallexample
17882 compile code k = 3;
17883 @end smallexample
17884
17885 @noindent
17886 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17887 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17888 @code{compile} command changes it.
17889
17890 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17891 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17892 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17893 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17894 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17895
17896 @smallexample
17897 compile code j = 3;
17898 @end smallexample
17899
17900 @noindent
17901 will result in a compilation error message.
17902
17903 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17904 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17905 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17906
17907 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17908 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17909 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17910 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17911
17912 @smallexample
17913 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17914 @end smallexample
17915
17916 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17917 command has completed:
17918
17919 @smallexample
17920 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17921 @end smallexample
17922
17923 @noindent
17924 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17925 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17926 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17927 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17928 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17929
17930 @smallexample
17931 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17932 @end smallexample
17933
17934 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17935 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17936 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17937 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17938 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17939 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17940 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17941 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17942
17943 @smallexample
17944 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17945 @end smallexample
17946
17947 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17948 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17949 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17950 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17951 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17952 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17953 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17954
17955 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17956 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17957 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17958 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17959 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17960 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17961
17962 @smallexample
17963 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17964 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17965 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17966 Compilation failed.
17967 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17968 42
17969 @end smallexample
17970
17971 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17972 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17973 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17974 will print to the console.
17975 @end table
17976
17977 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17978
17979 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17980 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17981 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17982 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17983 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17984 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17985 target architecture and operating system.
17986
17987 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17988 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17989 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17990 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17991 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17992 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17993 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17994
17995 @node GDB Files
17996 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17997
17998 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17999 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18000 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18001 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18002
18003 @menu
18004 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18005 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18006 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18007 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18008 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18009 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18010 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18011 @end menu
18012
18013 @node Files
18014 @section Commands to Specify Files
18015
18016 @cindex symbol table
18017 @cindex core dump file
18018
18019 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18020 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18021 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18022 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18023
18024 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18025 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18026 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18027 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18028 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18029 new files are useful.
18030
18031 @table @code
18032 @cindex executable file
18033 @kindex file
18034 @item file @var{filename}
18035 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18036 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18037 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18038 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18039 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18040 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18041 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18042 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18043
18044 @cindex unlinked object files
18045 @cindex patching object files
18046 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18047 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18048 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18049 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18050 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18051 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18052 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18053 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18054
18055 @item file
18056 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18057 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18058
18059 @kindex exec-file
18060 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18061 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18062 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18063 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18064 discard information on the executable file.
18065
18066 @kindex symbol-file
18067 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18068 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18069 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18070 table and program to run from the same file.
18071
18072 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18073 program's symbol table.
18074
18075 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18076 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18077 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18078 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18079 @value{GDBN}.
18080
18081 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18082 executing it once.
18083
18084 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18085 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18086 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18087 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18088 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18089 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18090 optimized code.
18091
18092 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18093 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18094 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18095 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18096 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18097
18098 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18099 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18100 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18101 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18102 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18103 Warnings and Messages}.)
18104
18105 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18106 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18107 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18108 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18109 in stabs format.
18110
18111 @kindex readnow
18112 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18113 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18114 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18115 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18116 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18117 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18118 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18119 entire symbol table available.
18120
18121 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18122 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18123 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18124 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18125 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18126 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18127 @c files.
18128
18129 @kindex core-file
18130 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18131 @itemx core
18132 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18133 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18134 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18135 executable file itself for other parts.
18136
18137 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18138 to be used.
18139
18140 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18141 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18142 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18143 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18144 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18145
18146 @kindex add-symbol-file
18147 @cindex dynamic linking
18148 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18149 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18150 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18151 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18152 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18153 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18154 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18155 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18156 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18157 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18158 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18159 @var{address} as an expression.
18160
18161 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18162 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18163 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18164 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18165
18166 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18167
18168 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18169 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18170 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18171 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18172 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18173 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18174 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18175 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18176 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18177
18178 @itemize @bullet
18179 @item
18180 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18181 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18182 @item
18183 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18184 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18185 @item
18186 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18187 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18188 @end itemize
18189
18190 @noindent
18191 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18192 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18193 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18194 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18195 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18196 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18197 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18198 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18199 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18200 way.
18201
18202 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18203
18204 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18205 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18206 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18207 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18208 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18209 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18210
18211 @smallexample
18212 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18213 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18214 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18215 (y or n) y
18216 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18217 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18218 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18219 (gdb)
18220 @end smallexample
18221
18222
18223 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18224
18225 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18226 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18227 @cindex load symbols from memory
18228 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18229 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18230 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18231 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18232 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18233 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18234 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18235 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18236 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18237
18238 @kindex section
18239 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18240 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18241 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18242 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18243 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18244 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18245 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18246 their addresses.
18247
18248 @kindex info files
18249 @kindex info target
18250 @item info files
18251 @itemx info target
18252 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18253 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18254 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18255 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18256 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18257 current ones.
18258
18259 @kindex maint info sections
18260 @item maint info sections
18261 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18262 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18263 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18264 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18265 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18266 may be arbitrarily combined):
18267
18268 @table @code
18269 @item ALLOBJ
18270 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18271 @item @var{sections}
18272 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18273 @item @var{section-flags}
18274 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18275 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18276 @table @code
18277 @item ALLOC
18278 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18279 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18280 @item LOAD
18281 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18282 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18283 @item RELOC
18284 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18285 @item READONLY
18286 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18287 @item CODE
18288 Section contains executable code only.
18289 @item DATA
18290 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18291 @item ROM
18292 Section will reside in ROM.
18293 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18294 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18295 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18296 Section is not empty.
18297 @item NEVER_LOAD
18298 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18299 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18300 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18301 COFF shared library information.
18302 @item IS_COMMON
18303 Section contains common symbols.
18304 @end table
18305 @end table
18306 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18307 @cindex read-only sections
18308 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18309 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18310 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18311 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18312 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18313 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18314 enhancement to debugging performance.
18315
18316 The default is off.
18317
18318 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18319 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18320 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18321 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18322
18323 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18324 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18325 @end table
18326
18327 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18328 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18329 name and remembers it that way.
18330
18331 @cindex shared libraries
18332 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18333 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18334 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18335 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18336
18337 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18338 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18339
18340 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18341 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18342 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18343 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18344 debugging a core file).
18345
18346 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18347 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18348 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18349
18350 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18351 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18352 particularly large or there are many of them.
18353
18354 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18355 commands:
18356
18357 @table @code
18358 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18359 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18360 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18361 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18362 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18363 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18364 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18365 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18366
18367 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18368 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18369 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18370 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18371 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18372 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18373 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18374 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18375 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18376
18377 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18378 @item show auto-solib-add
18379 Display the current autoloading mode.
18380 @end table
18381
18382 @cindex load shared library
18383 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18384 command:
18385
18386 @table @code
18387 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18388 @kindex info share
18389 @item info share @var{regex}
18390 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18391 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18392 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18393 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18394
18395 @kindex info dll
18396 @item info dll @var{regex}
18397 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18398
18399 @kindex sharedlibrary
18400 @kindex share
18401 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18402 @itemx share @var{regex}
18403 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18404 Unix regular expression.
18405 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18406 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18407 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18408 loaded.
18409
18410 @item nosharedlibrary
18411 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18412 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18413 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18414 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18415 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18416 discarded.
18417 @end table
18418
18419 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18420 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18421 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18422 Catchpoints}).
18423
18424 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18425 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18426 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18427 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18428
18429 @table @code
18430 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18431 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18432 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18433 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18434 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18435 shared library.
18436
18437 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18438 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18439 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18440 library events happen.
18441 @end table
18442
18443 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18444 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18445 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18446 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18447 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18448 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18449 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18450 not.
18451
18452 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18453 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18454 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18455 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18456 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18457
18458 @table @code
18459 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18460 @cindex system root, alternate
18461 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18462 @kindex set sysroot
18463 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18464 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18465 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18466 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18467 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18468 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18469 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18470 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18471 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18472 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18473 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18474 @var{path}.
18475
18476 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18477 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18478 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18479 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18480 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18481 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18482 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18483 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18484 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18485 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18486 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18487 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18488 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18489 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18490
18491 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18492 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18493 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18494 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18495 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18496
18497 @smallexample
18498 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18499 @end smallexample
18500
18501 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18502 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18503 system:
18504
18505 @smallexample
18506 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18507 @end smallexample
18508
18509 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18510 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18511 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18512 colons:
18513
18514 @smallexample
18515 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18516 @end smallexample
18517
18518 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18519 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18520 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18521 @samp{z}):
18522
18523 @smallexample
18524 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18525 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18526 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18527 @end smallexample
18528
18529 @noindent
18530 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18531 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18532 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18533
18534 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18535 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18536
18537 @smallexample
18538 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18539 @end smallexample
18540
18541 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18542 if you don't want or need to.
18543
18544 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18545 sysroot}.
18546
18547 @cindex default system root
18548 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18549 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18550 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18551 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18552 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18553 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18554 location.
18555
18556 @kindex show sysroot
18557 @item show sysroot
18558 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18559
18560 @kindex set solib-search-path
18561 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18562 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18563 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18564 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18565 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18566 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18567 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18568 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18569 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18570 of shared library symbols.
18571
18572 @kindex show solib-search-path
18573 @item show solib-search-path
18574 Display the current shared library search path.
18575
18576 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18577 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18578 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18579 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18580 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18581
18582 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18583 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18584 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18585 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18586 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18587 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18588 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18589 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18590 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18591 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18592 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18593 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18594 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18595 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18596 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18597 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18598 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18599 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18600 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18601 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18602 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18603 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18604
18605 @table @code
18606 @item unix
18607 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18608 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18609 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18610 the forward slash.
18611
18612 @item dos-based
18613 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18614 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18615 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18616 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18617 considered directory separators.
18618
18619 @item auto
18620 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18621 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18622 This is the default.
18623 @end table
18624 @end table
18625
18626 @cindex file name canonicalization
18627 @cindex base name differences
18628 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18629 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18630 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18631 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18632 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18633 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18634 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18635 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18636 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18637 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18638 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18639 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18640 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18641 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18642 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18643
18644 @table @code
18645 @item set basenames-may-differ
18646 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18647 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18648
18649 @item show basenames-may-differ
18650 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18651 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18652 @end table
18653
18654 @node File Caching
18655 @section File Caching
18656 @cindex caching of opened files
18657 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18658
18659 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18660 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18661 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18662 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18663
18664 @table @code
18665 @kindex maint info bfds
18666 @item maint info bfds
18667 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18668 @value{GDBN}.
18669
18670 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18671 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18672 @kindex bfd caching
18673 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18674 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18675 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18676 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18677 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18678 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18679 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18680 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18681 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18682
18683 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18684 @kindex bfd caching
18685 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18686 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18687
18688 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18689 @kindex bfd caching
18690 @item show debug bfd-cache
18691 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18692 @end table
18693
18694 @node Separate Debug Files
18695 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18696 @cindex separate debugging information files
18697 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18698 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18699 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18700 @cindex global debugging information directories
18701 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18702 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18703
18704 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18705 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18706 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18707 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18708 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18709 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18710 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18711
18712 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18713 file:
18714
18715 @itemize @bullet
18716 @item
18717 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18718 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18719 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18720 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18721 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18722 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18723 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18724 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18725
18726 @item
18727 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18728 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18729 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18730 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18731 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18732 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18733 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18734 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18735 below.
18736 @end itemize
18737
18738 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18739 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18740
18741 @itemize @bullet
18742 @item
18743 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18744 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18745 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18746 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18747 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18748
18749 @item
18750 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18751 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18752 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18753 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18754 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18755 hex characters, not 10.)
18756 @end itemize
18757
18758 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18759 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18760 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18761 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18762 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18763 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18764
18765 @itemize @minus
18766 @item
18767 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18768 @item
18769 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18770 @item
18771 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18772 @item
18773 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18774 @end itemize
18775
18776 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18777 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18778 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18779 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18780 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18781
18782 @table @code
18783
18784 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18785 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18786 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18787 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18788 concatenating them by a path separator.
18789
18790 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18791 @item show debug-file-directory
18792 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18793 information files.
18794
18795 @end table
18796
18797 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18798 @cindex debug link sections
18799 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18800 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18801
18802 @itemize
18803 @item
18804 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18805 a zero byte,
18806 @item
18807 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18808 boundary within the section, and
18809 @item
18810 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18811 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18812 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18813 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18814 @end itemize
18815
18816 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18817 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18818 described above.
18819
18820 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18821 @cindex build ID sections
18822 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18823 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18824 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18825 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18826 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18827 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18828 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18829 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18830 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18831
18832 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18833 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18834 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18835 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18836 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18837 in an ordinary executable.
18838
18839 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18840 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18841 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18842 following commands:
18843
18844 @smallexample
18845 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18846 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18847 @end smallexample
18848
18849 @noindent
18850 These commands remove the debugging
18851 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18852 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18853 two files:
18854
18855 @itemize @bullet
18856 @item
18857 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18858 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18859
18860 @smallexample
18861 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18862 @end smallexample
18863
18864 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18865 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18866 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18867 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18868
18869 @item
18870 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18871 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18872 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18873 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18874 @end itemize
18875
18876 @noindent
18877
18878 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18879 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18880 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18881
18882 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18883 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18884 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18885 @c different ways!
18886 @ifhtml
18887 @display
18888 @html
18889 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18890 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18891 @end html
18892 @end display
18893 @end ifhtml
18894 @ifnothtml
18895 @display
18896 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18897 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18898 @end display
18899 @end ifnothtml
18900
18901 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18902 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18903 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18904 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18905 CRC.
18906
18907 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18908 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18909 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18910 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18911 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18912
18913 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18914 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18915 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18916 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18917 @code{0xffffffff}.
18918
18919 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18920 @smallexample
18921 unsigned long
18922 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18923 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18924 @{
18925 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18926 @{
18927 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18928 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18929 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18930 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18931 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18932 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18933 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18934 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18935 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18936 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18937 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18938 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18939 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18940 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18941 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18942 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18943 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18944 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18945 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18946 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18947 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18948 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18949 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18950 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18951 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18952 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18953 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18954 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18955 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18956 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18957 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18958 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18959 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18960 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18961 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18962 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18963 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18964 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18965 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18966 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18967 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18968 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18969 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18970 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18971 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18972 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18973 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18974 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18975 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18976 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18977 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18978 0x2d02ef8d
18979 @};
18980 unsigned char *end;
18981
18982 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18983 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18984 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18985 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18986 @}
18987 @end smallexample
18988
18989 @noindent
18990 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18991
18992 @node MiniDebugInfo
18993 @section Debugging information in a special section
18994 @cindex separate debug sections
18995 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18996
18997 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18998 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18999 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19000 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19001
19002 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19003 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19004 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19005 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19006 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19007 debugging information might be included in the section.
19008
19009 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19010 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19011 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19012
19013 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19014 standard utilities:
19015
19016 @smallexample
19017 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19018 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19019 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19020 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19021
19022 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19023 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19024 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19025 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19026 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19027 | sort > funcsyms
19028
19029 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19030 # table.
19031 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19032
19033 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19034 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19035
19036 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19037 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19038 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19039 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19040
19041 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19042 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19043
19044 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19045 # original binary.
19046 xz mini_debuginfo
19047 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19048 @end smallexample
19049
19050 @node Index Files
19051 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19052 @cindex index files
19053 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19054
19055 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19056 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19057 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19058 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19059 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19060 startup.
19061
19062 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19063 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19064 using @command{objcopy}.
19065
19066 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19067
19068 @table @code
19069 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19070 @kindex save gdb-index
19071 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19072 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19073 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19074 @var{directory}.
19075 @end table
19076
19077 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19078 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19079
19080 @smallexample
19081 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19082 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19083 @end smallexample
19084
19085 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19086 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19087 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19088 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19089 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19090 The default is @code{off}.
19091 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19092 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19093
19094 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19095 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19096
19097 @smallexample
19098 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19099 @end smallexample
19100
19101 Instead you must do, for example,
19102
19103 @smallexample
19104 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19105 @end smallexample
19106
19107 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19108 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19109 currently work for programs using Ada.
19110
19111 @node Symbol Errors
19112 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19113
19114 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19115 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19116 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19117 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19118 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19119 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19120 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19121 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19122 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19123 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19124 Messages}).
19125
19126 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19127
19128 @table @code
19129 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19130
19131 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19132 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19133 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19134 in its outer scope blocks.
19135
19136 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19137 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19138 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19139 function.
19140
19141 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19142
19143 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19144 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19145 do so.
19146
19147 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19148 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19149 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19150 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19151 Messages}.)
19152
19153 @item bad block start address patched
19154
19155 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19156 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19157 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19158
19159 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19160 starting on the previous source line.
19161
19162 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19163
19164 @cindex foo
19165 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19166 larger than the size of the string table.
19167
19168 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19169 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19170 with this name.
19171
19172 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19173
19174 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19175 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19176 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19177
19178 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19179 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19180 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19181 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19182 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19183 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19184
19185 @item stub type has NULL name
19186
19187 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19188
19189 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19190 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19191 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19192 it.
19193
19194 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19195
19196 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19197
19198 @end table
19199
19200 @node Data Files
19201 @section GDB Data Files
19202
19203 @cindex prefix for data files
19204 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19205 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19206
19207 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19208 is currently using.
19209
19210 @table @code
19211 @kindex set data-directory
19212 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19213 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19214 to @var{directory}.
19215
19216 @kindex show data-directory
19217 @item show data-directory
19218 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19219 @end table
19220
19221 @cindex default data directory
19222 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19223 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19224 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19225 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19226 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19227 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19228 location.
19229
19230 The data directory may also be specified with the
19231 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19232 @xref{Mode Options}.
19233
19234 @node Targets
19235 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19236
19237 @cindex debugging target
19238 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19239
19240 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19241 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19242 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19243 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19244 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19245 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19246 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19247 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19248
19249 @cindex target architecture
19250 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19251 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19252 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19253 command.
19254
19255 @table @code
19256 @kindex set architecture
19257 @kindex show architecture
19258 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19259 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19260 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19261 supported architectures.
19262
19263 @item show architecture
19264 Show the current target architecture.
19265
19266 @item set processor
19267 @itemx processor
19268 @kindex set processor
19269 @kindex show processor
19270 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19271 and @code{show architecture}.
19272 @end table
19273
19274 @menu
19275 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19276 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19277 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19278 @end menu
19279
19280 @node Active Targets
19281 @section Active Targets
19282
19283 @cindex stacking targets
19284 @cindex active targets
19285 @cindex multiple targets
19286
19287 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19288 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19289 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19290 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19291 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19292 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19293 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19294 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19295 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19296
19297 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19298 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19299 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19300 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19301
19302 @node Target Commands
19303 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19304
19305 @table @code
19306 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19307 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19308 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19309 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19310 protocol of the target machine.
19311
19312 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19313 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19314 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19315
19316 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19317 after executing the command.
19318
19319 @kindex help target
19320 @item help target
19321 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19322 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19323 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19324
19325 @item help target @var{name}
19326 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19327 select it.
19328
19329 @kindex set gnutarget
19330 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19331 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19332 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19333 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19334 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19335 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19336
19337 @quotation
19338 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19339 you must know the actual BFD name.
19340 @end quotation
19341
19342 @noindent
19343 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19344
19345 @kindex show gnutarget
19346 @item show gnutarget
19347 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19348 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19349 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19350 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19351 @end table
19352
19353 @cindex common targets
19354 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19355 configuration):
19356
19357 @table @code
19358 @kindex target
19359 @item target exec @var{program}
19360 @cindex executable file target
19361 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19362 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19363
19364 @item target core @var{filename}
19365 @cindex core dump file target
19366 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19367 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19368
19369 @item target remote @var{medium}
19370 @cindex remote target
19371 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19372 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19373 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19374
19375 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19376 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19377
19378 @smallexample
19379 target remote /dev/ttya
19380 @end smallexample
19381
19382 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19383 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19384 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19385 clobbered by the download.
19386
19387 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19388 @cindex built-in simulator target
19389 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19390 In general,
19391 @smallexample
19392 target sim
19393 load
19394 run
19395 @end smallexample
19396 @noindent
19397 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19398 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19399 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19400 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19401 Processors}.
19402
19403 @item target native
19404 @cindex native target
19405 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19406 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19407 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19408 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19409
19410 @end table
19411
19412 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19413 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19414
19415 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19416 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19417 various aspects of this process.
19418
19419 @table @code
19420
19421 @item set hash
19422 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19423 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19424 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19425 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19426 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19427 monitor.
19428
19429 @item show hash
19430 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19431 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19432
19433 @item set debug monitor
19434 @kindex set debug monitor
19435 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19436 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19437 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19438
19439 @item show debug monitor
19440 @kindex show debug monitor
19441 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19442 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19443 @end table
19444
19445 @table @code
19446
19447 @kindex load @var{filename}
19448 @item load @var{filename}
19449 @anchor{load}
19450 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19451 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19452 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19453 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19454 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19455 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19456
19457 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19458 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19459 target is @dots{}}''
19460
19461 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19462 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19463 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19464 specifies a fixed address.
19465 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19466
19467 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19468 load programs into flash memory.
19469
19470 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19471 @end table
19472
19473 @node Byte Order
19474 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19475
19476 @cindex choosing target byte order
19477 @cindex target byte order
19478
19479 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19480 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19481 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19482 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19483 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19484 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19485
19486 @table @code
19487 @kindex set endian
19488 @item set endian big
19489 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19490
19491 @item set endian little
19492 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19493
19494 @item set endian auto
19495 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19496 executable.
19497
19498 @item show endian
19499 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19500
19501 @end table
19502
19503 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19504 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19505 target system.
19506
19507
19508 @node Remote Debugging
19509 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19510 @cindex remote debugging
19511
19512 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19513 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19514 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19515 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19516 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19517
19518 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19519 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19520 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19521 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19522 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19523 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19524
19525 Other remote targets may be available in your
19526 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19527
19528 @menu
19529 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19530 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19531 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19532 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19533 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19534 @end menu
19535
19536 @node Connecting
19537 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19538 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19539 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19540 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19541 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19542 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19543 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19544
19545 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19546 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19547 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19548 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19549
19550 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19551
19552 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19553 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19554 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19555 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19556
19557 @table @asis
19558
19559 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19560 @item Result of detach or program exit
19561 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19562 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19563 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19564
19565 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19566 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19567 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19568 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19569
19570 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19571 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19572 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19573 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19574
19575 @item Specifying the program to debug
19576 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19577 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19578 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19579 target.
19580
19581 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19582 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19583 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19584
19585 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19586 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19587 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19588 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19589
19590 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19591 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19592 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19593 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19594 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19595 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19596 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19597 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19598 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19599
19600 @item The @code{run} command
19601 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19602 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19603 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19604 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19605 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19606
19607 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19608 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19609 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19610 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19611 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19612
19613 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19614 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19615 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19616 @code{target remote} mode.
19617
19618 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19619 @item Attaching
19620 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19621 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19622 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19623
19624 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19625 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19626 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19627 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19628 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19629
19630 @end table
19631
19632 @anchor{Host and target files}
19633 @subsection Host and Target Files
19634 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19635 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19636
19637 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19638 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19639 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19640 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19641 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19642
19643 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19644 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19645 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19646 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19647 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19648
19649 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19650 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19651 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19652 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19653 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19654 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19655 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19656 target libraries.
19657
19658 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19659 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19660 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19661 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19662 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19663 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19664 programs.
19665
19666 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19667 @cindex remote connection commands
19668 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19669 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19670 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19671 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19672 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19673 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19674 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19675
19676 @table @code
19677
19678 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19679 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19680 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19681 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19682 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19683
19684 @smallexample
19685 target remote /dev/ttyb
19686 @end smallexample
19687
19688 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19689 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19690 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19691 @code{target} command.
19692
19693 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19694 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19695 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19696 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19697 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19698 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19699 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19700 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19701 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19702 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19703 target.
19704
19705 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19706 @code{manyfarms}:
19707
19708 @smallexample
19709 target remote manyfarms:2828
19710 @end smallexample
19711
19712 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19713 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19714 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19715 port 1234 on your local machine:
19716
19717 @smallexample
19718 target remote :1234
19719 @end smallexample
19720 @noindent
19721
19722 Note that the colon is still required here.
19723
19724 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19725 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19726 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19727 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19728 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19729
19730 @smallexample
19731 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19732 @end smallexample
19733
19734 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19735 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19736 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19737 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19738
19739 @item target remote | @var{command}
19740 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19741 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19742 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19743 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19744 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19745 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19746 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19747 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19748 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19749
19750 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19751 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19752 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19753
19754 @end table
19755
19756 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19757 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19758 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19759 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19760 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19761 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19762 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19763
19764 @smallexample
19765 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19766 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19767 @end smallexample
19768
19769 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19770 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19771 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19772 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19773
19774 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19775 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19776
19777 @table @code
19778 @kindex detach (remote)
19779 @item detach
19780 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19781 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19782 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19783 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19784 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19785 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19786 still connected to the target.
19787
19788 @kindex disconnect
19789 @item disconnect
19790 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19791 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19792 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19793 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19794 another target.
19795
19796 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19797 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19798 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19799 @kindex monitor
19800 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19801 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19802 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19803 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19804 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19805 and implement.
19806 @end table
19807
19808 @node File Transfer
19809 @section Sending files to a remote system
19810 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19811 @cindex file transfer
19812 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19813
19814 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19815 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19816 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19817 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19818 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19819 the only way to upload or download files.
19820
19821 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19822
19823 @table @code
19824 @kindex remote put
19825 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19826 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19827 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19828
19829 @kindex remote get
19830 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19831 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19832 on the host system.
19833
19834 @kindex remote delete
19835 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19836 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19837
19838 @end table
19839
19840 @node Server
19841 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19842
19843 @kindex gdbserver
19844 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19845 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19846 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19847 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19848 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19849
19850 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19851 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19852 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19853 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19854 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19855 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19856 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19857 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19858 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19859 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19860 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19861 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19862 choice for debugging.
19863
19864 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19865 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19866 protocol.
19867
19868 @quotation
19869 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19870 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19871 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19872 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19873 @code{gdbserver}.
19874 @end quotation
19875
19876 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
19877 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19878 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19879 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19880
19881 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19882 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19883 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19884 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19885 system does all the symbol handling.
19886
19887 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19888 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19889 syntax is:
19890
19891 @smallexample
19892 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19893 @end smallexample
19894
19895 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19896 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19897 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19898 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19899 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19900 @file{/dev/com1}:
19901
19902 @smallexample
19903 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19904 @end smallexample
19905
19906 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19907 with it.
19908
19909 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19910
19911 @smallexample
19912 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19913 @end smallexample
19914
19915 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19916 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19917 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19918 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19919 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19920 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19921 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19922 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19923 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19924 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19925 @code{target remote} command.
19926
19927 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19928 with ssh:
19929
19930 @smallexample
19931 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19932 @end smallexample
19933
19934 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19935 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19936 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19937 You could elide it if you want to.
19938
19939 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19940 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19941 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19942 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19943
19944 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
19945 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19946 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19947 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19948
19949 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19950 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19951
19952 @smallexample
19953 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19954 @end smallexample
19955
19956 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
19957 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19958
19959 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
19960 @value{GDBN} attach command
19961 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
19962
19963 @pindex pidof
19964 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19965 @code{pidof} utility:
19966
19967 @smallexample
19968 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19969 @end smallexample
19970
19971 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19972 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19973 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19974
19975 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19976
19977 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
19978 port.
19979
19980 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19981 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19982 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19983 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19984 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19985 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19986 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19987 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19988
19989 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19990 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19991 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19992
19993 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19994 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19995 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19996 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19997 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19998 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19999 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20000 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20001 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20002 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20003 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20004 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20005
20006 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20007 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20008
20009 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20010 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20011 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20012 program. For more information,
20013 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20014
20015 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20016 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20017 status information about the debugging process.
20018 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20019 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20020 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20021 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20022
20023 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20024 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20025 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20026 Possible options are:
20027
20028 @table @code
20029 @item none
20030 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20031 @item all
20032 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20033 @item timestamps
20034 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20035 @end table
20036
20037 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20038 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20039
20040 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20041 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20042 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20043 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20044 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20045
20046 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20047 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20048 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20049 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20050
20051 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20052 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20053 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20054 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20055
20056 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20057 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20058 environment:
20059
20060 @smallexample
20061 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20062 @end smallexample
20063
20064 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20065
20066 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20067 @itemize
20068
20069 @item
20070 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20071
20072 @item
20073 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20074 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20075 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20076 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20077 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20078 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20079
20080 @item
20081 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20082 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20083 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20084 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20085 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20086 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20087 program is already on the target.
20088
20089 @end itemize
20090
20091 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20092 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20093 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20094
20095 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20096 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20097 Here are the available commands.
20098
20099 @table @code
20100 @item monitor help
20101 List the available monitor commands.
20102
20103 @item monitor set debug 0
20104 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20105 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20106
20107 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20108 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20109 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20110 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20111
20112 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20113 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20114 Possible options are:
20115
20116 @table @code
20117 @item none
20118 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20119 @item all
20120 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20121 @item timestamps
20122 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20123 @end table
20124
20125 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20126 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20127
20128 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20129 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20130 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20131 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20132 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20133 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20134
20135 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20136 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20137
20138 @item monitor exit
20139 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20140 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20141 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20142 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20143 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20144
20145 @end table
20146
20147 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20148 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20149
20150 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20151 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20152
20153 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20154 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20155 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20156 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20157 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20158 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20159 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20160 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20161 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20162 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20163 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20164 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20165
20166 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20167
20168 @table @code
20169 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20170
20171 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20172 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20173 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20174
20175 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20176
20177 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20178 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20179 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20180 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20181 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20182 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20183
20184 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20185
20186 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20187 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20188 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20189 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20190 command for that. For example:
20191
20192 @smallexample
20193 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20194 @end smallexample
20195
20196 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20197 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20198 @end table
20199
20200 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20201 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20202 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20203 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20204 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20205 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20206 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20207 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20208 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20209 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20210
20211 @smallexample
20212 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20213 @end smallexample
20214
20215 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 $ gdb myprogram
20219 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20220 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20221 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20222 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20226 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20227 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20228 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20229 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20230 tracing.
20231
20232 @node Remote Configuration
20233 @section Remote Configuration
20234
20235 @kindex set remote
20236 @kindex show remote
20237 This section documents the configuration options available when
20238 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20239 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20240 system-call-allowed}.
20241
20242 @table @code
20243 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20244 @cindex address size for remote targets
20245 @cindex bits in remote address
20246 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20247 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20248 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20249 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20250
20251 @item show remoteaddresssize
20252 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20253
20254 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20255 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20256 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20257 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20258 remote targets.
20259
20260 @item show serial baud
20261 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20262
20263 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20264 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20265 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20266
20267 @item show serial parity
20268 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20269
20270 @item set remotebreak
20271 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20272 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20273 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20274 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20275 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20276 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20277 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20278 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20279
20280 @item show remotebreak
20281 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20282 interrupt the remote program.
20283
20284 @item set remoteflow on
20285 @itemx set remoteflow off
20286 @kindex set remoteflow
20287 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20288 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20289
20290 @item show remoteflow
20291 @kindex show remoteflow
20292 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20293
20294 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20295 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20296 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20297 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20298 @code{ascii}.
20299
20300 @item show remotelogbase
20301 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20302 protocol.
20303
20304 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20305 @cindex record serial communications on file
20306 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20307 default is not to record at all.
20308
20309 @item show remotelogfile.
20310 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20311 serial communications.
20312
20313 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20314 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20315 @cindex remote timeout
20316 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20317 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20318
20319 @item show remotetimeout
20320 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20321 responses.
20322
20323 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20324 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20325 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20326 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20327 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20328 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20329 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20330 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20331
20332 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20333 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20334 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20335 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20336 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20337 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20338 as unlimited.
20339
20340 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20341 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20342 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20343
20344 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20345 @itemx show remote exec-file
20346 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20347 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20348 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20349 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20350 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20351 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20352
20353 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20354 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20355 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20356 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20357 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20358 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20359 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20360 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20361 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20362 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20363
20364 @item show interrupt-sequence
20365 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20366 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20367 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20368 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20369
20370 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20371 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20372 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20373 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20374 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20375 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20376
20377 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20378 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20379 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20380
20381 @kindex set tcp
20382 @kindex show tcp
20383 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20384 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20385 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20386 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20387 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20388 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20389 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20390 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20391 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20392
20393 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20394 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20395
20396 @item show tcp auto-retry
20397 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20398
20399 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20400 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20401 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20402 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20403 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20404 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20405 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20406 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20407 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20408 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20409 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20410
20411 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20412 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20413 @end table
20414
20415 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20416 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20417 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20418 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20419 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20420 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20421 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20422 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20423 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20424
20425 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20426 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20427 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20428 @value{GDBN} developers.
20429
20430 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20431 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20432 are:
20433
20434 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20435 @item Command Name
20436 @tab Remote Packet
20437 @tab Related Features
20438
20439 @item @code{fetch-register}
20440 @tab @code{p}
20441 @tab @code{info registers}
20442
20443 @item @code{set-register}
20444 @tab @code{P}
20445 @tab @code{set}
20446
20447 @item @code{binary-download}
20448 @tab @code{X}
20449 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20450
20451 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20452 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20453 @tab @code{info auxv}
20454
20455 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20456 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20457 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20458
20459 @item @code{attach}
20460 @tab @code{vAttach}
20461 @tab @code{attach}
20462
20463 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20464 @tab @code{vCont}
20465 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20466
20467 @item @code{run}
20468 @tab @code{vRun}
20469 @tab @code{run}
20470
20471 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20472 @tab @code{Z0}
20473 @tab @code{break}
20474
20475 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20476 @tab @code{Z1}
20477 @tab @code{hbreak}
20478
20479 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20480 @tab @code{Z2}
20481 @tab @code{watch}
20482
20483 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20484 @tab @code{Z3}
20485 @tab @code{rwatch}
20486
20487 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20488 @tab @code{Z4}
20489 @tab @code{awatch}
20490
20491 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20492 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20493 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20494
20495 @item @code{target-features}
20496 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20497 @tab @code{set architecture}
20498
20499 @item @code{library-info}
20500 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20501 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20502
20503 @item @code{memory-map}
20504 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20505 @tab @code{info mem}
20506
20507 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20508 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20509 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20510
20511 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20512 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20513 @tab @code{info spu}
20514
20515 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20516 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20517 @tab @code{info spu}
20518
20519 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20520 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20521 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20522
20523 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20524 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20525 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20526
20527 @item @code{threads}
20528 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20529 @tab @code{info threads}
20530
20531 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20532 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20533 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20534
20535 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20536 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20537 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20538
20539 @item @code{search-memory}
20540 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20541 @tab @code{find}
20542
20543 @item @code{supported-packets}
20544 @tab @code{qSupported}
20545 @tab Remote communications parameters
20546
20547 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20548 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20549 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20550
20551 @item @code{pass-signals}
20552 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20553 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20554
20555 @item @code{program-signals}
20556 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20557 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20558
20559 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20560 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20561 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20562
20563 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20564 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20565 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20566
20567 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20568 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20569 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20570
20571 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20572 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20573 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20574
20575 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20576 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20577 @tab @code{remote delete}
20578
20579 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20580 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20581 @tab Host I/O
20582
20583 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20584 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20585 @tab Host I/O
20586
20587 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20588 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20589 @tab Host I/O
20590
20591 @item @code{noack-packet}
20592 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20593 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20594
20595 @item @code{osdata}
20596 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20597 @tab @code{info os}
20598
20599 @item @code{query-attached}
20600 @tab @code{qAttached}
20601 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20602
20603 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20604 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20605 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20606
20607 @item @code{trace-status}
20608 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20609 @tab @code{tstatus}
20610
20611 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20612 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20613 @tab Traceframe info
20614
20615 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20616 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20617 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20618
20619 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20620 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20621 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20622
20623 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20624 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20625 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20626
20627 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20628 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20629 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20630
20631 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20632 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20633 @tab @code{break}
20634
20635 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20636 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20637 @tab @code{hbreak}
20638
20639 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20640 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20641 @tab @code{fork}
20642
20643 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20644 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20645 @tab @code{vfork}
20646
20647 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20648 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20649 @tab @code{exec}
20650
20651 @item @code{thread-events}
20652 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20653 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20654
20655 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20656 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20657 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20658
20659 @end multitable
20660
20661 @node Remote Stub
20662 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20663
20664 @cindex debugging stub, example
20665 @cindex remote stub, example
20666 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20667 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20668 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20669 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20670 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20671 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20672 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20673 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20674
20675 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20676 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20677 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20678 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20679 program, you need:
20680
20681 @enumerate
20682 @item
20683 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20684 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20685 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20686
20687 @item
20688 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20689 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20690
20691 @item
20692 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20693 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20694 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20695 documentation.
20696 @end enumerate
20697
20698 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20699 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20700 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20701
20702 @table @emph
20703 @item On the host,
20704 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20705 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20706 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20707
20708 @item On the target,
20709 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20710 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20711 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20712
20713 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20714 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20715 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20716 @end table
20717
20718 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20719 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20720 @sc{sparc} boards.
20721
20722 @cindex remote serial stub list
20723 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20724
20725 @table @code
20726
20727 @item i386-stub.c
20728 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20729 @cindex Intel
20730 @cindex i386
20731 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20732
20733 @item m68k-stub.c
20734 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20735 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20736 @cindex m680x0
20737 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20738
20739 @item sh-stub.c
20740 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20741 @cindex Renesas
20742 @cindex SH
20743 For Renesas SH architectures.
20744
20745 @item sparc-stub.c
20746 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20747 @cindex Sparc
20748 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20749
20750 @item sparcl-stub.c
20751 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20752 @cindex Fujitsu
20753 @cindex SparcLite
20754 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20755
20756 @end table
20757
20758 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20759 recently added stubs.
20760
20761 @menu
20762 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20763 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20764 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20765 @end menu
20766
20767 @node Stub Contents
20768 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20769
20770 @cindex remote serial stub
20771 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20772 subroutines:
20773
20774 @table @code
20775 @item set_debug_traps
20776 @findex set_debug_traps
20777 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20778 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20779 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20780 program's startup code.
20781
20782 @item handle_exception
20783 @findex handle_exception
20784 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20785 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20786 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20787 run when a trap is triggered.
20788
20789 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20790 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20791 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20792 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20793 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20794 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20795 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20796 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20797 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20798 machine.
20799
20800 @item breakpoint
20801 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20802 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20803 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20804 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20805 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20806 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20807 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20808 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20809 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20810 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20811 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20812
20813 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20814 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20815 start of your debugging session.
20816 @end table
20817
20818 @node Bootstrapping
20819 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20820
20821 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20822 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20823 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20824 debugging target machine.
20825
20826 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20827 serial port.
20828
20829 @table @code
20830 @item int getDebugChar()
20831 @findex getDebugChar
20832 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20833 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20834 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20835
20836 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20837 @findex putDebugChar
20838 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20839 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20840 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20841 @end table
20842
20843 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20844 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20845 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20846 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20847 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20848 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20849 remote system to stop.
20850
20851 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20852 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20853 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20854 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20855
20856 Other routines you need to supply are:
20857
20858 @table @code
20859 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20860 @findex exceptionHandler
20861 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20862 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20863 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20864 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20865 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20866 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20867 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20868 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20869 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20870 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20871 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20872 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20873 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20874
20875 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20876 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20877 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20878 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20879 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20880
20881 @item void flush_i_cache()
20882 @findex flush_i_cache
20883 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20884 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20885 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20886
20887 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20888 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20889 @end table
20890
20891 @noindent
20892 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20893
20894 @table @code
20895 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20896 @findex memset
20897 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20898 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20899 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20900 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20901 @end table
20902
20903 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20904 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20905 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20906 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20907
20908
20909 @node Debug Session
20910 @subsection Putting it All Together
20911
20912 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20913 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20914 steps.
20915
20916 @enumerate
20917 @item
20918 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20919 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20920 @display
20921 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20922 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20923 @end display
20924
20925 @item
20926 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20927 procedure is called:
20928
20929 @smallexample
20930 set_debug_traps();
20931 breakpoint();
20932 @end smallexample
20933
20934 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20935 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20936 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20937 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20938 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20939 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20940 progress.
20941
20942 @item
20943 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20944 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20945
20946 @smallexample
20947 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20948 @end smallexample
20949
20950 @noindent
20951 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20952 function in your program, that function is called when
20953 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20954 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20955 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20956
20957 @item
20958 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20959 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20960
20961 @item
20962 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20963 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20964
20965 @item
20966 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20967 @c document that. FIXME.
20968 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20969 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20970
20971 @item
20972 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20973 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20974
20975 @end enumerate
20976
20977 @node Configurations
20978 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20979
20980 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20981 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20982 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20983
20984 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20985 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20986 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20987 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20988 are quite different from each other.
20989
20990 @menu
20991 * Native::
20992 * Embedded OS::
20993 * Embedded Processors::
20994 * Architectures::
20995 @end menu
20996
20997 @node Native
20998 @section Native
20999
21000 This section describes details specific to particular native
21001 configurations.
21002
21003 @menu
21004 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21005 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21006 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21007 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21008 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21009 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21010 @end menu
21011
21012 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21013 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21014
21015 @cindex libkvm
21016 @cindex kernel memory image
21017 @cindex kernel crash dump
21018
21019 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21020 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21021 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21022 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21023 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21024 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21025 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21026 @code{kvm} target:
21027
21028 @smallexample
21029 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21030 @end smallexample
21031
21032 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21033 argument:
21034
21035 @smallexample
21036 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21037 @end smallexample
21038
21039 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21040 available:
21041
21042 @table @code
21043 @kindex kvm
21044 @item kvm pcb
21045 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21046
21047 @item kvm proc
21048 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21049 modern FreeBSD systems.
21050 @end table
21051
21052 @node SVR4 Process Information
21053 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21054 @cindex /proc
21055 @cindex examine process image
21056 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21057
21058 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21059 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21060 process using file-system subroutines.
21061
21062 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21063 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21064 information about the process running your program, or about any
21065 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21066 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21067
21068 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21069 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21070
21071 @table @code
21072 @kindex info proc
21073 @cindex process ID
21074 @item info proc
21075 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21076 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21077 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21078 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21079 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21080 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21081 executable file's absolute file name.
21082
21083 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21084 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21085 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21086 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21087 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21088 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21089
21090 @item info proc cmdline
21091 @cindex info proc cmdline
21092 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21093 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21094
21095 @item info proc cwd
21096 @cindex info proc cwd
21097 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21098 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21099
21100 @item info proc exe
21101 @cindex info proc exe
21102 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21103 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21104
21105 @item info proc mappings
21106 @cindex memory address space mappings
21107 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21108 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21109 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21110 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21111 memory access rights to that range.
21112
21113 @item info proc stat
21114 @itemx info proc status
21115 @cindex process detailed status information
21116 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21117 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21118 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21119 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21120 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21121 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21122 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21123
21124 @item info proc all
21125 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21126 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21127
21128 @ignore
21129 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21130 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21131 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21132 @kindex info proc times
21133 @item info proc times
21134 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21135 its children.
21136
21137 @kindex info proc id
21138 @item info proc id
21139 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21140 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21141 @end ignore
21142
21143 @item set procfs-trace
21144 @kindex set procfs-trace
21145 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21146 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21147
21148 @item show procfs-trace
21149 @kindex show procfs-trace
21150 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21151
21152 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21153 @kindex set procfs-file
21154 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21155 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21156 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21157 standard output.
21158
21159 @item show procfs-file
21160 @kindex show procfs-file
21161 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21162
21163 @item proc-trace-entry
21164 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21165 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21166 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21167 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21168 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21169 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21170 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21171 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21172 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21173
21174 @item info pidlist
21175 @kindex info pidlist
21176 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21177 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21178 processes and all the threads within each process.
21179
21180 @item info meminfo
21181 @kindex info meminfo
21182 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21183 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21184 @end table
21185
21186 @node DJGPP Native
21187 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21188 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21189 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21190 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21191
21192 @cindex DPMI
21193 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21194 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21195 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21196 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21197
21198 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21199 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21200 subsection describes those commands.
21201
21202 @table @code
21203 @kindex info dos
21204 @item info dos
21205 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21206 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21207
21208 @kindex sysinfo
21209 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21210 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21211 @item info dos sysinfo
21212 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21213 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21214 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21215
21216 @cindex GDT
21217 @cindex LDT
21218 @cindex IDT
21219 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21220 @cindex descriptor tables display
21221 @item info dos gdt
21222 @itemx info dos ldt
21223 @itemx info dos idt
21224 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21225 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21226 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21227 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21228 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21229 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21230 rights.
21231
21232 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21233 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21234 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21235 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21236 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21237
21238 @cindex garbled pointers
21239 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21240 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21241 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21242 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21243 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21244 debugged program's data segment:
21245
21246 @smallexample
21247 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21248 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21249 @end smallexample
21250
21251 @noindent
21252 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21253 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21254
21255 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21256 @item info dos pde
21257 @itemx info dos pte
21258 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21259 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21260 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21261 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21262 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21263 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21264 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21265 that is currently in use.
21266
21267 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21268 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21269 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21270 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21271 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21272 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21273 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21274
21275 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21276 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21277 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21278 controller.
21279
21280 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21281
21282 @cindex physical address from linear address
21283 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21284 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21285 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21286 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21287 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21288 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21289 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21290
21291 @smallexample
21292 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21293 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21294 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21295 @end smallexample
21296
21297 @noindent
21298 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21299 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21300 attributes of that page.
21301
21302 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21303 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21304 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21305 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21306 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21307 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21308
21309 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21310 transfer buffer:
21311
21312 @smallexample
21313 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21314 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21315 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21316 @end smallexample
21317
21318 @noindent
21319 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21320 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21321 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21322 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21323 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21324
21325 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21326 @end table
21327
21328 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21329 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21330 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21331 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21332
21333 @table @code
21334 @kindex set com1base
21335 @kindex set com1irq
21336 @kindex set com2base
21337 @kindex set com2irq
21338 @kindex set com3base
21339 @kindex set com3irq
21340 @kindex set com4base
21341 @kindex set com4irq
21342 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21343 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21344 port.
21345
21346 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21347 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21348 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21349
21350 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21351 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21352 other 3 COM ports.
21353
21354 @kindex show com1base
21355 @kindex show com1irq
21356 @kindex show com2base
21357 @kindex show com2irq
21358 @kindex show com3base
21359 @kindex show com3irq
21360 @kindex show com4base
21361 @kindex show com4irq
21362 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21363 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21364 lines used by the COM ports.
21365
21366 @item info serial
21367 @kindex info serial
21368 @cindex DOS serial port status
21369 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21370 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21371 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21372 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21373 @end table
21374
21375
21376 @node Cygwin Native
21377 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21378 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21379 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21380 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21381
21382 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21383 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21384
21385 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21386 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21387 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21388 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21389 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21390 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21391 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21392 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21393
21394 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21395 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21396 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21397
21398 @table @code
21399 @kindex info w32
21400 @item info w32
21401 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21402 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21403
21404 @item info w32 selector
21405 This command displays information returned by
21406 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21407 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21408 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21409 Without argument, this command displays information
21410 about the six segment registers.
21411
21412 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21413 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21414 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21415 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21416
21417 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21418 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21419 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21420 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21421 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21422 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21423 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21424 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21425 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21426 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21427 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21428
21429 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21430 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21431 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21432 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21433
21434 @kindex set new-console
21435 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21436 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21437 be started in a new console on next start.
21438 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21439 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21440
21441 @kindex show new-console
21442 @item show new-console
21443 Displays whether a new console is used
21444 when the debuggee is started.
21445
21446 @kindex set new-group
21447 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21448 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21449 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21450 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21451 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21452
21453 @kindex show new-group
21454 @item show new-group
21455 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21456
21457 @kindex set debugevents
21458 @item set debugevents
21459 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21460 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21461 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21462 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21463 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21464
21465 @kindex set debugexec
21466 @item set debugexec
21467 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21468 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21469
21470 @kindex set debugexceptions
21471 @item set debugexceptions
21472 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21473 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21474
21475 @kindex set debugmemory
21476 @item set debugmemory
21477 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21478 and writes by the debugger.
21479
21480 @kindex set shell
21481 @item set shell
21482 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21483 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21484
21485 @kindex show shell
21486 @item show shell
21487 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21488
21489 @end table
21490
21491 @menu
21492 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21493 @end menu
21494
21495 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21496 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21497 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21498 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21499
21500 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21501 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21502 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21503 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21504 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21505 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21506 ``minimal symbols''.
21507
21508 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21509 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21510 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21511 program run once to completion.
21512
21513 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21514
21515 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21516 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21517 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21518 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21519 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21520 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21521 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21522 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21523 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21524
21525 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21526 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21527 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21528 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21529 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21530 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21531
21532 @smallexample
21533 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21534 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21535
21536 Non-debugging symbols:
21537 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21538 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21539 @end smallexample
21540
21541 @smallexample
21542 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21543 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21544
21545 Non-debugging symbols:
21546 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21547 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21548 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21549 [etc...]
21550 @end smallexample
21551
21552 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21553
21554 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21555 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21556 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21557 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21558 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21559 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21560 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21561
21562 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21563 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21564 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21565 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21566 problem:
21567
21568 @smallexample
21569 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21570 $1 = 268572168
21571 @end smallexample
21572
21573 @smallexample
21574 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21575 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21576 @end smallexample
21577
21578 And two possible solutions:
21579
21580 @smallexample
21581 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21582 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21583 @end smallexample
21584
21585 @smallexample
21586 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21587 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21588 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21589 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21590 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21591 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21592 @end smallexample
21593
21594 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21595 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21596 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21597 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21598 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21599
21600 @smallexample
21601 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21602 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21603 @end smallexample
21604
21605 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21606 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21607 safe.
21608
21609 @node Hurd Native
21610 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21611 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21612
21613 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21614 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21615
21616 @table @code
21617 @item set signals
21618 @itemx set sigs
21619 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21620 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21621 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21622 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21623 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21624 @code{signals}.
21625
21626 @item show signals
21627 @itemx show sigs
21628 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21629 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21630 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21631
21632 @item set signal-thread
21633 @itemx set sigthread
21634 @kindex set signal-thread
21635 @kindex set sigthread
21636 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21637 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21638 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21639 signal-thread}.
21640
21641 @item show signal-thread
21642 @itemx show sigthread
21643 @kindex show signal-thread
21644 @kindex show sigthread
21645 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21646 delivered a signal.
21647
21648 @item set stopped
21649 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21650 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21651 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21652 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21653
21654 @item show stopped
21655 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21656 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21657 stopped.
21658
21659 @item set exceptions
21660 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21661 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21662 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21663 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21664 trapping on.
21665
21666 @item show exceptions
21667 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21668 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21669
21670 @item set task pause
21671 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21672 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21673 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21674 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21675 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21676 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21677 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21678 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21679 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21680
21681 @item show task pause
21682 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21683 Show the current state of task suspension.
21684
21685 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21686 @cindex task suspend count
21687 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21688 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21689 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21690
21691 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21692 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21693
21694 @item set task exception-port
21695 @itemx set task excp
21696 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21697 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21698 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21699 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21700
21701 @item set noninvasive
21702 @cindex noninvasive task options
21703 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21704 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21705 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21706 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21707
21708 @item info send-rights
21709 @itemx info receive-rights
21710 @itemx info port-rights
21711 @itemx info port-sets
21712 @itemx info dead-names
21713 @itemx info ports
21714 @itemx info psets
21715 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21716 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21717 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21718 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21719 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21720 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21721 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21722 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21723 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21724
21725 @item set thread pause
21726 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21727 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21728 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21729 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21730 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21731 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21732 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21733 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21734 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21735 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21736 only the current thread.
21737
21738 @item show thread pause
21739 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21740 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21741
21742 @item set thread run
21743 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21744
21745 @item show thread run
21746 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21747
21748 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21749 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21750 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21751 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21752 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21753 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21754 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21755
21756 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21757 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21758 detaching.
21759
21760 @item set thread exception-port
21761 @itemx set thread excp
21762 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21763 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21764 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21765
21766 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21767 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21768 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21769 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21770
21771 @item set thread default
21772 @itemx show thread default
21773 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21774 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21775 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21776 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21777 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21778 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21779 the non-default commands.
21780 @end table
21781
21782 @node Darwin
21783 @subsection Darwin
21784 @cindex Darwin
21785
21786 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21787
21788 @table @code
21789 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21790 @kindex set debug darwin
21791 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21792 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21793
21794 @item show debug darwin
21795 @kindex show debug darwin
21796 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21797
21798 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21799 @kindex set debug mach-o
21800 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21801 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21802 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21803 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21804 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21805 usage.
21806
21807 @item show debug mach-o
21808 @kindex show debug mach-o
21809 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21810
21811 @item set mach-exceptions on
21812 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21813 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21814 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21815 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21816 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21817 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21818
21819 @item show mach-exceptions
21820 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21821 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21822 @end table
21823
21824
21825 @node Embedded OS
21826 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21827
21828 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21829 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21830 architectures.
21831
21832 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21833 various real-time operating systems.
21834
21835 @node Embedded Processors
21836 @section Embedded Processors
21837
21838 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21839 configurations.
21840
21841 @cindex send command to simulator
21842 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21843 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21844
21845 @table @code
21846 @item sim @var{command}
21847 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21848 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21849 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21850 acceptable commands.
21851 @end table
21852
21853
21854 @menu
21855 * ARM:: ARM
21856 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21857 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21858 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21859 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21860 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21861 * CRIS:: CRIS
21862 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21863 @end menu
21864
21865 @node ARM
21866 @subsection ARM
21867
21868 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21869
21870 @table @code
21871 @item set arm disassembler
21872 @kindex set arm
21873 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21874 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21875
21876 @item show arm disassembler
21877 @kindex show arm
21878 Show the current disassembly style.
21879
21880 @item set arm apcs32
21881 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21882 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21883
21884 @item show arm apcs32
21885 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21886
21887 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21888 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21889 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21890
21891 @table @code
21892 @item auto
21893 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21894 @item softfpa
21895 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21896 processors.
21897 @item fpa
21898 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21899 @item softvfp
21900 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21901 @item vfp
21902 VFP co-processor.
21903 @end table
21904
21905 @item show arm fpu
21906 Show the current type of the FPU.
21907
21908 @item set arm abi
21909 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21910
21911 @item show arm abi
21912 Show the currently used ABI.
21913
21914 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21915 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21916 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21917 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21918 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21919 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21920 register).
21921
21922 @item show arm fallback-mode
21923 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21924
21925 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21926 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21927 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21928 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21929 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21930
21931 @item show arm force-mode
21932 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21933
21934 @item set debug arm
21935 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21936 target support subsystem.
21937
21938 @item show debug arm
21939 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21940 @end table
21941
21942 @table @code
21943 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21944 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21945
21946 @table @code
21947 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21948 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21949 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21950 The default value is @code{all}.
21951
21952 @table @code
21953 @item none
21954 @item demon
21955 @item angel
21956 @item redboot
21957 @item all
21958 @end table
21959 @end table
21960 @end table
21961
21962 @node M68K
21963 @subsection M68k
21964
21965 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
21966
21967 @node MicroBlaze
21968 @subsection MicroBlaze
21969 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21970 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21971
21972 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21973 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21974 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21975 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21976 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21977 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21978 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21979 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21980 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21981 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21982 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21983
21984 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21985
21986 @table @code
21987 @item target remote :1234
21988 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21989 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21990
21991 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21992 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21993 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21994
21995 @item load
21996 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21997
21998 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21999 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22000
22001 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22002 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22003 @end table
22004
22005 @node MIPS Embedded
22006 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22007
22008 @noindent
22009 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22010
22011 @table @code
22012 @item set mipsfpu double
22013 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22014 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22015 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22016 @itemx show mipsfpu
22017 @kindex set mipsfpu
22018 @kindex show mipsfpu
22019 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22020 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22021 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22022 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22023 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22024 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22025 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22026 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22027 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22028 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22029 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22030 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22031 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22032
22033 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22034 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22035 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22036
22037 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22038 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22039 @end table
22040
22041 @node PowerPC Embedded
22042 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22043
22044 @cindex DVC register
22045 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22046 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22047
22048 @smallexample
22049 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22050 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22051 @end smallexample
22052
22053 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22054 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22055 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22056 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22057 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22058 or newer.
22059
22060 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22061 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22062 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22063 watching variables of scalar types.
22064
22065 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22066 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22067
22068 @smallexample
22069 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22070 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22071 @end smallexample
22072
22073 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22074 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22075
22076 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22077 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22078 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22079 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22080 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22081 use the @code{break-range} command.
22082
22083 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22084
22085 @table @code
22086 @kindex break-range
22087 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22088 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22089 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22090 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22091 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22092 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22093 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22094 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22095 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22096
22097 @kindex set powerpc
22098 @item set powerpc soft-float
22099 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22100 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22101 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22102 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22103
22104 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22105 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22106 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22107 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22108 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22109 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22110 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22111 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22112
22113 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22114 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22115 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22116 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22117 address of its first byte.
22118
22119 @end table
22120
22121 @node AVR
22122 @subsection Atmel AVR
22123 @cindex AVR
22124
22125 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22126 following AVR-specific commands:
22127
22128 @table @code
22129 @item info io_registers
22130 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22131 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22132 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22133 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22134 @end table
22135
22136 @node CRIS
22137 @subsection CRIS
22138 @cindex CRIS
22139
22140 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22141 following CRIS-specific commands:
22142
22143 @table @code
22144 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22145 @cindex CRIS version
22146 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22147 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22148 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22149
22150 @item show cris-version
22151 Show the current CRIS version.
22152
22153 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22154 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22155 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22156 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22157 @code{R59}.
22158
22159 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22160 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22161
22162 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22163 @cindex CRIS mode
22164 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22165 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22166 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22167
22168 @item show cris-mode
22169 Show the current CRIS mode.
22170 @end table
22171
22172 @node Super-H
22173 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22174 @cindex Super-H
22175
22176 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22177 commands:
22178
22179 @table @code
22180 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22181 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22182 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22183 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22184 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22185 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22186 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22187 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22188 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22189 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22190 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22191 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22192
22193 @item show sh calling-convention
22194 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22195 Show the current calling convention setting.
22196
22197 @end table
22198
22199
22200 @node Architectures
22201 @section Architectures
22202
22203 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22204 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22205
22206 @menu
22207 * AArch64::
22208 * i386::
22209 * Alpha::
22210 * MIPS::
22211 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22212 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22213 * PowerPC::
22214 * Nios II::
22215 @end menu
22216
22217 @node AArch64
22218 @subsection AArch64
22219 @cindex AArch64 support
22220
22221 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22222 following special commands:
22223
22224 @table @code
22225 @item set debug aarch64
22226 @kindex set debug aarch64
22227 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22228 messages are to be displayed.
22229
22230 @item show debug aarch64
22231 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22232
22233 @end table
22234
22235 @node i386
22236 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22237
22238 @table @code
22239 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22240 @kindex set struct-convention
22241 @cindex struct return convention
22242 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22243 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22244 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22245 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22246 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22247 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22248 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22249 be returned in a register.
22250
22251 @item show struct-convention
22252 @kindex show struct-convention
22253 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22254 from functions.
22255 @end table
22256
22257
22258 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22259 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22260
22261 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22262 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22263 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22264 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22265 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22266 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22267 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22268
22269 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22270 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22271 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22272 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22273 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22274 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22275
22276 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22277 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22278 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22279
22280 @smallexample
22281 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22282 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22283 @end smallexample
22284
22285 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22286 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22287 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22288 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22289 the pointer.
22290
22291 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22292 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22293 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22294 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22295 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22296
22297 @table @code
22298 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22299 @kindex show mpx bound
22300 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22301
22302 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22303 @kindex set mpx bound
22304 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22305 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22306 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22307 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22308 @end table
22309
22310 @node Alpha
22311 @subsection Alpha
22312
22313 See the following section.
22314
22315 @node MIPS
22316 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22317
22318 @cindex stack on Alpha
22319 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22320 @cindex Alpha stack
22321 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22322 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22323 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22324 find the beginning of a function.
22325
22326 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22327 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22328 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22329 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22330 commands:
22331
22332 @table @code
22333 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22334 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22335 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22336 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22337 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22338 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22339 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22340 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22341
22342 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22343 Display the current limit.
22344 @end table
22345
22346 @noindent
22347 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22348 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22349
22350 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22351 programs:
22352
22353 @table @code
22354 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22355 @kindex set mips abi
22356 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22357 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22358 values of @var{arg} are:
22359
22360 @table @samp
22361 @item auto
22362 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22363 default).
22364 @item o32
22365 @item o64
22366 @item n32
22367 @item n64
22368 @item eabi32
22369 @item eabi64
22370 @end table
22371
22372 @item show mips abi
22373 @kindex show mips abi
22374 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22375
22376 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22377 @kindex set mips compression
22378 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22379 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22380 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22381 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22382 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22383 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22384 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22385 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22386 provided by the executable.
22387
22388 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22389 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22390 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22391 identified as such.
22392
22393 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22394 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22395 implicitly from an executable.
22396
22397 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22398 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22399 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22400 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22401 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22402
22403 @item show mips compression
22404 @kindex show mips compression
22405 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22406 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22407
22408 @item set mipsfpu
22409 @itemx show mipsfpu
22410 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22411
22412 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22413 @kindex set mips mask-address
22414 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22415 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22416 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22417 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22418 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22419
22420 @item show mips mask-address
22421 @kindex show mips mask-address
22422 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22423 not.
22424
22425 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22426 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22427 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22428 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22429 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22430 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22431
22432 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22433 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22434 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22435
22436 @item set debug mips
22437 @kindex set debug mips
22438 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22439 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22440
22441 @item show debug mips
22442 @kindex show debug mips
22443 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22444 @end table
22445
22446
22447 @node HPPA
22448 @subsection HPPA
22449 @cindex HPPA support
22450
22451 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22452 following special commands:
22453
22454 @table @code
22455 @item set debug hppa
22456 @kindex set debug hppa
22457 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22458 messages are to be displayed.
22459
22460 @item show debug hppa
22461 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22462
22463 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22464 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22465 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22466 given @var{address}.
22467
22468 @end table
22469
22470
22471 @node SPU
22472 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22473 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22474 @cindex SPU
22475
22476 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22477 it provides the following special commands:
22478
22479 @table @code
22480 @item info spu event
22481 @kindex info spu
22482 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22483 and pending event status.
22484
22485 @item info spu signal
22486 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22487 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22488 notification channels.
22489
22490 @item info spu mailbox
22491 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22492 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22493 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22494
22495 @item info spu dma
22496 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22497 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22498 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22499
22500 @item info spu proxydma
22501 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22502 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22503 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22504
22505 @end table
22506
22507 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22508 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22509 special commands:
22510
22511 @table @code
22512 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22513 @kindex set spu
22514 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22515 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22516 function. The default is @code{off}.
22517
22518 @item show spu stop-on-load
22519 @kindex show spu
22520 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22521
22522 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22523 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22524 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22525 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22526 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22527 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22528
22529 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22530 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22531
22532 @end table
22533
22534 @node PowerPC
22535 @subsection PowerPC
22536 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22537
22538 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22539 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22540 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22541 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22542 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22543
22544 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22545 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22546 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22547
22548 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22549 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22550
22551 @node Nios II
22552 @subsection Nios II
22553 @cindex Nios II architecture
22554
22555 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22556 it provides the following special commands:
22557
22558 @table @code
22559
22560 @item set debug nios2
22561 @kindex set debug nios2
22562 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22563 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22564
22565 @item show debug nios2
22566 @kindex show debug nios2
22567 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22568 @end table
22569
22570 @node Controlling GDB
22571 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22572
22573 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22574 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22575 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22576 described here.
22577
22578 @menu
22579 * Prompt:: Prompt
22580 * Editing:: Command editing
22581 * Command History:: Command history
22582 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22583 * Numbers:: Numbers
22584 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22585 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22586 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22587 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22588 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22589 @end menu
22590
22591 @node Prompt
22592 @section Prompt
22593
22594 @cindex prompt
22595
22596 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22597 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22598 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22599 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22600 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22601 which one you are talking to.
22602
22603 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22604 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22605 or a prompt that does not.
22606
22607 @table @code
22608 @kindex set prompt
22609 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22610 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22611
22612 @kindex show prompt
22613 @item show prompt
22614 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22615 @end table
22616
22617 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22618 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22619 are:
22620
22621 @table @code
22622 @kindex set extended-prompt
22623 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22624 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22625 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22626 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22627 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22628 is displayed.
22629
22630 For example:
22631
22632 @smallexample
22633 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22634 @end smallexample
22635
22636 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22637 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22638
22639 @kindex show extended-prompt
22640 @item show extended-prompt
22641 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22642 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22643 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22644 @end table
22645
22646 @node Editing
22647 @section Command Editing
22648 @cindex readline
22649 @cindex command line editing
22650
22651 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22652 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22653 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22654 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22655 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22656 debugging sessions.
22657
22658 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22659 command @code{set}.
22660
22661 @table @code
22662 @kindex set editing
22663 @cindex editing
22664 @item set editing
22665 @itemx set editing on
22666 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22667
22668 @item set editing off
22669 Disable command line editing.
22670
22671 @kindex show editing
22672 @item show editing
22673 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22674 @end table
22675
22676 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22677 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22678 @end ifset
22679 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22680 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22681 @end ifclear
22682 for more details about the Readline
22683 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22684 encouraged to read that chapter.
22685
22686 @node Command History
22687 @section Command History
22688 @cindex command history
22689
22690 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22691 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22692 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22693 history facility.
22694
22695 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22696 package, to provide the history facility.
22697 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22698 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22699 @end ifset
22700 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22701 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22702 @end ifclear
22703 for the detailed description of the History library.
22704
22705 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22706 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22707 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22708 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22709 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22710 pressed on a line by itself.
22711
22712 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22713 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22714 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22715 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22716
22717 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22718 history.
22719
22720 @table @code
22721 @cindex history substitution
22722 @cindex history file
22723 @kindex set history filename
22724 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22725 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22726 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22727 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22728 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22729 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22730 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22731 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22732 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22733 is not set.
22734
22735 @cindex save command history
22736 @kindex set history save
22737 @item set history save
22738 @itemx set history save on
22739 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22740 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22741
22742 @item set history save off
22743 Stop recording command history in a file.
22744
22745 @cindex history size
22746 @kindex set history size
22747 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22748 @item set history size @var{size}
22749 @itemx set history size unlimited
22750 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22751 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22752 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22753 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22754 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22755 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22756
22757 @cindex remove duplicate history
22758 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22759 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22760 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22761 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22762 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22763 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22764 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22765 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22766 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22767
22768 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22769 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22770
22771 @end table
22772
22773 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22774 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22775 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22776 @end ifset
22777 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22778 @xref{Event Designators},
22779 @end ifclear
22780 for more details.
22781
22782 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22783 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22784 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22785 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22786 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22787 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22788 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22789 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22790
22791 The commands to control history expansion are:
22792
22793 @table @code
22794 @item set history expansion on
22795 @itemx set history expansion
22796 @kindex set history expansion
22797 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22798
22799 @item set history expansion off
22800 Disable history expansion.
22801
22802 @c @group
22803 @kindex show history
22804 @item show history
22805 @itemx show history filename
22806 @itemx show history save
22807 @itemx show history size
22808 @itemx show history expansion
22809 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22810 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22811 @c @end group
22812 @end table
22813
22814 @table @code
22815 @kindex show commands
22816 @cindex show last commands
22817 @cindex display command history
22818 @item show commands
22819 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22820
22821 @item show commands @var{n}
22822 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22823
22824 @item show commands +
22825 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22826 @end table
22827
22828 @node Screen Size
22829 @section Screen Size
22830 @cindex size of screen
22831 @cindex screen size
22832 @cindex pagination
22833 @cindex page size
22834 @cindex pauses in output
22835
22836 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22837 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22838 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22839 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22840 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22841 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22842 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22843 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22844
22845 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22846 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22847 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22848 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22849 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22850 width} commands:
22851
22852 @table @code
22853 @kindex set height
22854 @kindex set width
22855 @kindex show width
22856 @kindex show height
22857 @item set height @var{lpp}
22858 @itemx set height unlimited
22859 @itemx show height
22860 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22861 @itemx set width unlimited
22862 @itemx show width
22863 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22864 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22865 commands display the current settings.
22866
22867 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22868 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22869 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22870 buffer.
22871
22872 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22873 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22874
22875 @item set pagination on
22876 @itemx set pagination off
22877 @kindex set pagination
22878 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22879 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22880 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22881 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22882
22883 @item show pagination
22884 @kindex show pagination
22885 Show the current pagination mode.
22886 @end table
22887
22888 @node Numbers
22889 @section Numbers
22890 @cindex number representation
22891 @cindex entering numbers
22892
22893 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22894 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22895 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22896 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22897 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22898 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22899 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22900 both input and output with the commands described below.
22901
22902 @table @code
22903 @kindex set input-radix
22904 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22905 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22906 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22907 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22908 example, any of
22909
22910 @smallexample
22911 set input-radix 012
22912 set input-radix 10.
22913 set input-radix 0xa
22914 @end smallexample
22915
22916 @noindent
22917 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22918 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22919 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22920 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22921 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22922 change the radix.
22923
22924 @kindex set output-radix
22925 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22926 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22927 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22928 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22929
22930 @kindex show input-radix
22931 @item show input-radix
22932 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22933
22934 @kindex show output-radix
22935 @item show output-radix
22936 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22937
22938 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22939 @itemx show radix
22940 @kindex set radix
22941 @kindex show radix
22942 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22943 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22944 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22945 default value of 10.
22946
22947 @end table
22948
22949 @node ABI
22950 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22951
22952 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22953 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22954 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22955 current ABI.
22956
22957 @cindex OS ABI
22958 @kindex set osabi
22959 @kindex show osabi
22960 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22961
22962 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22963 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22964 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22965 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22966 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22967 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22968 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22969 platform provides.
22970
22971 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22972 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22973 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22974 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22975
22976 @table @code
22977 @item show osabi
22978 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22979
22980 @item set osabi
22981 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22982
22983 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22984 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22985 @end table
22986
22987 @cindex float promotion
22988
22989 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22990 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22991 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22992 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22993 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22994 @code{double} and then passed.
22995
22996 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22997 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22998 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22999
23000 @table @code
23001 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23002 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23003 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23004 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23005 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23006
23007 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23008 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23009 functions.
23010
23011 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23012 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23013 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23014 @end table
23015
23016 @kindex set cp-abi
23017 @kindex show cp-abi
23018 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23019 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23020 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23021 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23022 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23023 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23024 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23025 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23026 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23027 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23028 ``auto''.
23029
23030 @table @code
23031 @item show cp-abi
23032 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23033
23034 @item set cp-abi
23035 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23036
23037 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23038 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23039 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23040 @end table
23041
23042 @node Auto-loading
23043 @section Automatically loading associated files
23044 @cindex auto-loading
23045
23046 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23047 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23048 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23049 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23050 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23051 sources).
23052
23053 @menu
23054 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23055 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23056
23057 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23058 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23059 @end menu
23060
23061 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23062 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23063 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23064
23065 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23066 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23067 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23068
23069 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23070 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23071
23072 @table @code
23073 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23074 @kindex set auto-load off
23075 @item set auto-load off
23076 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23077 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23078 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23079 @smallexample
23080 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23081 @end smallexample
23082
23083 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23084 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23085 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23086 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23087 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23088 @code{set auto-load no}.
23089
23090 @anchor{show auto-load}
23091 @kindex show auto-load
23092 @item show auto-load
23093 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23094 or disabled.
23095
23096 @smallexample
23097 (gdb) show auto-load
23098 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23099 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23100 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23101 is on.
23102 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23103 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23104 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23105 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23106 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23107 @end smallexample
23108
23109 @anchor{info auto-load}
23110 @kindex info auto-load
23111 @item info auto-load
23112 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23113 not.
23114
23115 @smallexample
23116 (gdb) info auto-load
23117 gdb-scripts:
23118 Loaded Script
23119 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23120 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23121 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23122 loaded.
23123 python-scripts:
23124 Loaded Script
23125 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23126 @end smallexample
23127 @end table
23128
23129 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23130
23131 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23132 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23133 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23134 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23135 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23136 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23137 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23138 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23139 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23140 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23141 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23142 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23143 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23144 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23145 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23146 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23147 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23148 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23149 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23150 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23151 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23152 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23153 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23154 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23155 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23156 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23157 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23158 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23159 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23160 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23161 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23162 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23163 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23164 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23165 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23166 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23167 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23168 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23169 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23170 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23171 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23172 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23173 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23174 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23175 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23176 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23177 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23178 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23179 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23180 @end multitable
23181
23182 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23183 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23184 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23185
23186 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23187 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23188 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23189
23190 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23191 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23192
23193 @table @code
23194 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23195 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23196 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23197 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23198 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23199
23200 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23201 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23202 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23203 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23204 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23205
23206 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23207 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23208 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23209 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23210 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23211 @end table
23212
23213 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23214 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23215 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23216
23217 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23218
23219 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23220 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23221
23222 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23223 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23224 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23225 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23226 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23227 library.
23228
23229 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23230 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23231
23232 @table @code
23233 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23234 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23235 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23236 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23237
23238 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23239 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23240 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23241 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23242 enabled or disabled.
23243
23244 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23245 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23246 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23247 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23248 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23249 @end table
23250
23251 @node Auto-loading safe path
23252 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23253 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23254
23255 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23256 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23257 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23258 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23259 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23260
23261 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23262 get loaded:
23263
23264 @smallexample
23265 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23266 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23267 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23268 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23269 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23270 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23271 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23272 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23273 @end smallexample
23274
23275 @noindent
23276 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23277 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23278
23279 @smallexample
23280 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23281 @end smallexample
23282
23283 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23284
23285 @table @code
23286 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23287 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23288 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23289 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23290 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23291 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23292 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23293 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23294 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23295 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23296
23297 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23298 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23299 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23300
23301 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23302 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23303 @item show auto-load safe-path
23304 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23305 scripts.
23306
23307 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23308 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23309 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23310 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23311 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23312 by the host platform path separator in use.
23313 @end table
23314
23315 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23316 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23317 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23318 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23319 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23320
23321 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23322 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23323 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23324 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23325 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23326 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23327 init file in the current directory
23328 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23329
23330 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23331 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23332
23333 @table @asis
23334 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23335 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23336 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23337 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23338
23339 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23340 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23341 @value{GDBN} session.
23342
23343 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23344 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23345 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23346 from trusted sources.
23347
23348 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23349 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23350 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23351 trusted sources.
23352 @end table
23353
23354 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23355 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23356
23357 @table @asis
23358 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23359 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23360
23361 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23362 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23363 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23364 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23365 @end table
23366
23367 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23368 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23369 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23370 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23371 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23372 recommended to be entered.
23373
23374 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23375 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23376 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23377
23378 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23379 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23380 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23381 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23382 be printed.
23383
23384 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23385 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23386 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23387
23388 @smallexample
23389 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23390 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23391 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23392 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23393 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23394 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23395 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23396 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23397 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23398 @end smallexample
23399
23400 @table @code
23401 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23402 @kindex set debug auto-load
23403 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23404 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23405
23406 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23407 @kindex show debug auto-load
23408 @item show debug auto-load
23409 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23410 on or off.
23411 @end table
23412
23413 @node Messages/Warnings
23414 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23415
23416 @cindex verbose operation
23417 @cindex optional warnings
23418 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23419 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23420 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23421 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23422
23423 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23424 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23425 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23426
23427 @table @code
23428 @kindex set verbose
23429 @item set verbose on
23430 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23431
23432 @item set verbose off
23433 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23434
23435 @kindex show verbose
23436 @item show verbose
23437 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23438 @end table
23439
23440 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23441 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23442 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23443 Symbol Files}).
23444
23445 @table @code
23446
23447 @kindex set complaints
23448 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23449 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23450 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23451 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23452 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23453
23454 @kindex show complaints
23455 @item show complaints
23456 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23457
23458 @end table
23459
23460 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23461 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23462 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23463 you try to run a program which is already running:
23464
23465 @smallexample
23466 (@value{GDBP}) run
23467 The program being debugged has been started already.
23468 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23469 @end smallexample
23470
23471 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23472 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23473
23474 @table @code
23475
23476 @kindex set confirm
23477 @cindex flinching
23478 @cindex confirmation
23479 @cindex stupid questions
23480 @item set confirm off
23481 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23482 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23483 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23484
23485 @item set confirm on
23486 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23487
23488 @kindex show confirm
23489 @item show confirm
23490 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23491
23492 @end table
23493
23494 @cindex command tracing
23495 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23496 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23497 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23498 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23499
23500 @table @code
23501 @kindex set trace-commands
23502 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23503 @item set trace-commands on
23504 Enable command tracing.
23505 @item set trace-commands off
23506 Disable command tracing.
23507 @item show trace-commands
23508 Display the current state of command tracing.
23509 @end table
23510
23511 @node Debugging Output
23512 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23513 @cindex optional debugging messages
23514
23515 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23516 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23517 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23518 section documents those commands.
23519
23520 @table @code
23521 @kindex set exec-done-display
23522 @item set exec-done-display
23523 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23524 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23525 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23526 @kindex show exec-done-display
23527 @item show exec-done-display
23528 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23529 notification.
23530 @kindex set debug
23531 @cindex ARM AArch64
23532 @item set debug aarch64
23533 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23534 The default is off.
23535 @kindex show debug
23536 @item show debug aarch64
23537 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23538 ARM AArch64.
23539 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23540 @cindex architecture debugging info
23541 @item set debug arch
23542 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23543 @item show debug arch
23544 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23545 @item set debug aix-solib
23546 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23547 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23548 support module. The default is off.
23549 @item show debug aix-thread
23550 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23551 @item set debug aix-thread
23552 @cindex AIX threads
23553 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23554 module.
23555 @item show debug aix-thread
23556 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23557 @item set debug check-physname
23558 @cindex physname
23559 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23560 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23561 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23562 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23563 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23564 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23565 @item show debug check-physname
23566 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23567 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23568 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23569 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23570 exported symbols. The default is off.
23571 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23572 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23573 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23574 @item set debug dwarf-die
23575 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23576 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23577 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23578 A value of zero turns off the display.
23579 @item show debug dwarf-die
23580 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23581 @item set debug dwarf-line
23582 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23583 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23584 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23585 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23586 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23587 @item show debug dwarf-line
23588 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23589 @item set debug dwarf-read
23590 @cindex DWARF Reading
23591 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23592 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23593 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23594 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23595 @item show debug dwarf-read
23596 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23597 @item set debug displaced
23598 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23599 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23600 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23601 @item show debug displaced
23602 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23603 related to displaced stepping.
23604 @item set debug event
23605 @cindex event debugging info
23606 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23607 default is off.
23608 @item show debug event
23609 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23610 info.
23611 @item set debug expression
23612 @cindex expression debugging info
23613 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23614 expression parsing. The default is off.
23615 @item show debug expression
23616 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23617 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23618 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23619 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23620 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23621 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23622 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23623 @item set debug frame
23624 @cindex frame debugging info
23625 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23626 default is off.
23627 @item show debug frame
23628 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23629 info.
23630 @item set debug gnu-nat
23631 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23632 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23633 @item show debug gnu-nat
23634 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23635 @item set debug infrun
23636 @cindex inferior debugging info
23637 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23638 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23639 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23640 @item show debug infrun
23641 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23642 @item set debug jit
23643 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23644 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23645 @item show debug jit
23646 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23647 @item set debug lin-lwp
23648 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23649 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23650 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23651 @item show debug lin-lwp
23652 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23653 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23654 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23655 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23656 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23657 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23658 @item set debug mach-o
23659 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23660 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23661 processing. The default is off.
23662 @item show debug mach-o
23663 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23664 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23665 @item set debug notification
23666 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23667 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23668 The default is off.
23669 @item show debug notification
23670 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23671 @item set debug observer
23672 @cindex observer debugging info
23673 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23674 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23675 @item show debug observer
23676 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23677 @item set debug overload
23678 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23679 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23680 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23681 is off.
23682 @item show debug overload
23683 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23684 debugging info.
23685 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23686 @cindex debug expression parser
23687 @item set debug parser
23688 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23689 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23690 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23691 details. The default is off.
23692 @item show debug parser
23693 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23694 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23695 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23696 @cindex debug remote protocol
23697 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23698 @cindex display remote packets
23699 @item set debug remote
23700 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23701 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23702 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23703 @item show debug remote
23704 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23705 @item set debug serial
23706 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23707 default is off.
23708 @item show debug serial
23709 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23710 info.
23711 @item set debug solib-frv
23712 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23713 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23714 @item show debug solib-frv
23715 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23716 messages.
23717 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23718 @cindex symbol lookup
23719 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23720 The default is 0 (off).
23721 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23722 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23723 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23724 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23725 @item set debug symfile
23726 @cindex symbol file functions
23727 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23728 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23729 @item show debug symfile
23730 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23731 @item set debug symtab-create
23732 @cindex symbol table creation
23733 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23734 The default is 0 (off).
23735 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23736 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23737 @item show debug symtab-create
23738 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23739 @item set debug target
23740 @cindex target debugging info
23741 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23742 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23743 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23744 value of large memory transfers.
23745 @item show debug target
23746 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23747 info.
23748 @item set debug timestamp
23749 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23750 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23751 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23752 message.
23753 @item show debug timestamp
23754 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23755 debugging info.
23756 @item set debug varobj
23757 @cindex variable object debugging info
23758 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23759 info. The default is off.
23760 @item show debug varobj
23761 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23762 debugging info.
23763 @item set debug xml
23764 @cindex XML parser debugging
23765 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23766 @item show debug xml
23767 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23768 @end table
23769
23770 @node Other Misc Settings
23771 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23772 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23773
23774 @table @code
23775 @kindex set interactive-mode
23776 @item set interactive-mode
23777 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23778 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23779 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23780 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23781 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23782 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23783 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23784 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23785
23786 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23787 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23788 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23789 inside a cygwin window.
23790
23791 @kindex show interactive-mode
23792 @item show interactive-mode
23793 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23794 @end table
23795
23796 @node Extending GDB
23797 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23798 @cindex extending GDB
23799
23800 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23801 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23802 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23803 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23804 being debugged.
23805
23806 @menu
23807 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23808 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23809 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23810 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23811 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23812 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23813 @end menu
23814
23815 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23816 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23817 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23818 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23819 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23820 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23821
23822 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23823 setting:
23824
23825 @table @code
23826 @kindex set script-extension
23827 @kindex show script-extension
23828 @item set script-extension off
23829 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23830
23831 @item set script-extension soft
23832 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23833 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23834 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23835 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23836
23837 @item set script-extension strict
23838 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23839 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23840 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23841
23842 @item show script-extension
23843 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23844
23845 @end table
23846
23847 @node Sequences
23848 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23849
23850 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23851 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23852 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23853 files.
23854
23855 @menu
23856 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23857 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23858 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23859 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23860 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23861 @end menu
23862
23863 @node Define
23864 @subsection User-defined Commands
23865
23866 @cindex user-defined command
23867 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23868 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23869 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23870 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23871 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23872 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23873
23874 @smallexample
23875 define adder
23876 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23877 end
23878 @end smallexample
23879
23880 @noindent
23881 To execute the command use:
23882
23883 @smallexample
23884 adder 1 2 3
23885 @end smallexample
23886
23887 @noindent
23888 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23889 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23890 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23891 functions calls.
23892
23893 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23894 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23895 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23896 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23897
23898 @smallexample
23899 define adder
23900 if $argc == 2
23901 print $arg0 + $arg1
23902 end
23903 if $argc == 3
23904 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23905 end
23906 end
23907 @end smallexample
23908
23909 @table @code
23910
23911 @kindex define
23912 @item define @var{commandname}
23913 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23914 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23915 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23916 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23917 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23918 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23919
23920 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23921 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23922 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23923
23924 @kindex document
23925 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23926 @item document @var{commandname}
23927 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23928 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23929 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23930 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23931 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23932 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23933
23934 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23935 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23936 does not change the documentation.
23937
23938 @kindex dont-repeat
23939 @cindex don't repeat command
23940 @item dont-repeat
23941 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23942 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23943 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23944
23945 @kindex help user-defined
23946 @item help user-defined
23947 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23948 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23949 included (if any).
23950
23951 @kindex show user
23952 @item show user
23953 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23954 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23955 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23956 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23957 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23958
23959 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23960 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23961 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23962 @item show max-user-call-depth
23963 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23964 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23965 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23966 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23967 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23968 @end table
23969
23970 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23971 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23972
23973 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23974 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23975 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23976
23977 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23978 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23979 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23980 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23981
23982 @node Hooks
23983 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23984 @cindex command hooks
23985 @cindex hooks, for commands
23986 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23987
23988 @kindex hook
23989 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23990 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23991 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23992 before that command.
23993
23994 @cindex hooks, post-command
23995 @kindex hookpost
23996 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23997 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23998 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23999 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24000 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24001
24002 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24003 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24004
24005 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24006 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24007
24008 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24009 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24010 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24011 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24012 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24013
24014 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24015 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24016 you could define:
24017
24018 @smallexample
24019 define hook-stop
24020 handle SIGALRM nopass
24021 end
24022
24023 define hook-run
24024 handle SIGALRM pass
24025 end
24026
24027 define hook-continue
24028 handle SIGALRM pass
24029 end
24030 @end smallexample
24031
24032 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24033 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24034 you could define:
24035
24036 @smallexample
24037 define hook-echo
24038 echo <<<---
24039 end
24040
24041 define hookpost-echo
24042 echo --->>>\n
24043 end
24044
24045 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24046 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24047 (@value{GDBP})
24048
24049 @end smallexample
24050
24051 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24052 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24053 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24054 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24055 @c or not?
24056 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24057 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24058 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24059
24060 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24061 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24062 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24063
24064 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24065 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24066
24067 @node Command Files
24068 @subsection Command Files
24069
24070 @cindex command files
24071 @cindex scripting commands
24072 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24073 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24074 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24075 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24076 terminal.
24077
24078 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24079 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24080 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24081 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24082 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24083
24084 @table @code
24085 @kindex source
24086 @cindex execute commands from a file
24087 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24088 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24089 @end table
24090
24091 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24092 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24093 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24094 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24095 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24096
24097 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24098 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24099 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24100 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24101 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24102 is not relevant to scripts.
24103
24104 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24105 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24106 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24107 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24108 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24109 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24110 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24111 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24112 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24113 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24114 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24115 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24116 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24117 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24118
24119 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24120 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24121 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24122
24123 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24124 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24125 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24126 when called from command files.
24127
24128 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24129 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24130 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24131 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24132 the next command.
24133
24134 @smallexample
24135 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24136 @end smallexample
24137
24138 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24139 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24140 would be directed to @file{log}.
24141
24142 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24143 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24144 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24145 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24146 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24147 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24148 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24149 conditionally, etc.
24150
24151 @table @code
24152 @kindex if
24153 @kindex else
24154 @item if
24155 @itemx else
24156 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24157 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24158 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24159 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24160 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24161 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24162 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24163
24164 @kindex while
24165 @item while
24166 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24167 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24168 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24169 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24170 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24171 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24172
24173 @kindex loop_break
24174 @item loop_break
24175 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24176 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24177 line.
24178
24179 @kindex loop_continue
24180 @item loop_continue
24181 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24182 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24183 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24184 the controlling expression.
24185
24186 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24187 @item end
24188 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24189 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24190 @end table
24191
24192
24193 @node Output
24194 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24195
24196 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24197 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24198 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24199 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24200 want.
24201
24202 @table @code
24203 @kindex echo
24204 @item echo @var{text}
24205 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24206 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24207 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24208 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24209 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24210 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24211 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24212 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24213 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24214 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24215 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24216
24217 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24218 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24219
24220 @smallexample
24221 echo This is some text\n\
24222 which is continued\n\
24223 onto several lines.\n
24224 @end smallexample
24225
24226 produces the same output as
24227
24228 @smallexample
24229 echo This is some text\n
24230 echo which is continued\n
24231 echo onto several lines.\n
24232 @end smallexample
24233
24234 @kindex output
24235 @item output @var{expression}
24236 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24237 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24238 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24239 on expressions.
24240
24241 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24242 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24243 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24244 Formats}, for more information.
24245
24246 @kindex printf
24247 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24248 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24249 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24250 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24251 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24252 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24253 executing the code below:
24254
24255 @smallexample
24256 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24257 @end smallexample
24258
24259 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24260 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24261 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24262 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24263 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24264 printed.
24265
24266 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24267
24268 @smallexample
24269 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24270 @end smallexample
24271
24272 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24273 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24274 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24275
24276 @itemize @bullet
24277 @item
24278 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24279
24280 @item
24281 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24282 width.
24283
24284 @item
24285 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24286 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24287
24288 @item
24289 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24290 supported.
24291
24292 @item
24293 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24294
24295 @item
24296 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24297 @end itemize
24298
24299 @noindent
24300 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24301 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24302 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24303 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24304
24305 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24306 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24307 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24308 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24309 supported.
24310
24311 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24312 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24313 together with a floating point specifier.
24314 letters:
24315
24316 @itemize @bullet
24317 @item
24318 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24319
24320 @item
24321 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24322
24323 @item
24324 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24325 @end itemize
24326
24327 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24328 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24329 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24330
24331 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24332 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24333
24334 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24335 @smallexample
24336 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24337 @end smallexample
24338
24339 @kindex eval
24340 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24341 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24342 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24343
24344 @end table
24345
24346 @node Auto-loading sequences
24347 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24348 @cindex native script auto-loading
24349
24350 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24351 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24352 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24353 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24354
24355 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24356 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24357
24358 @table @code
24359 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24360 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24361 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24362 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24363
24364 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24365 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24366 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24367 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24368 disabled.
24369
24370 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24371 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24372 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24373 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24374 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24375 auto-loaded.
24376 @end table
24377
24378 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24379 matching names are printed.
24380
24381 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24382 @include python.texi
24383
24384 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24385 @include guile.texi
24386
24387 @node Auto-loading extensions
24388 @section Auto-loading extensions
24389 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24390
24391 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24392 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24393 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24394 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24395 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24396
24397 @menu
24398 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24399 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24400 * Which flavor to choose?::
24401 @end menu
24402
24403 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24404 debugging commands and features.
24405
24406 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24407 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24408 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24409 for more information.
24410 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24411 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24412
24413 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24414 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24415
24416 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24417 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24418 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24419 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24420 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24421
24422 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24423 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24424 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24425 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24426
24427 @table @code
24428 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24429 GDB's own command language
24430 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24431 Python
24432 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24433 Guile
24434 @end table
24435
24436 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24437 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24438 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24439 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24440 script in the specified extension language.
24441
24442 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24443 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24444
24445 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24446 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24447
24448 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24449 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24450 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24451 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24452 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24453 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24454
24455 @table @code
24456 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24457 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24458 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24459 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24460 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24461 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24462
24463 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24464 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24465
24466 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24467 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24468 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24469 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24470
24471 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24472 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24473 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24474 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24475 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24476 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24477 platform.
24478
24479 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24480 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24481 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24482
24483 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24484 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24485 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24486 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24487
24488 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24489 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24490 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24491 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24492 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24493 @end table
24494
24495 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24496 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24497 @var{objfile} is opened.
24498 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24499 is evaluated more than once.
24500
24501 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24502 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24503 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24504
24505 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24506 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24507 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24508 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24509 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24510 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24511 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24512
24513 The following entries are supported:
24514
24515 @table @code
24516 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24517 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24518 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24519 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24520 @end table
24521
24522 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24523
24524 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24525 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24526 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24527 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24528 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24529
24530 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24531 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24532
24533 @example
24534 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24535 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24536 asm("\
24537 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24538 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24539 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24540 .popsection \n\
24541 ");
24542 @end example
24543
24544 @noindent
24545 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24546 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24547
24548 @example
24549 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24550 @end example
24551
24552 The script name may include directories if desired.
24553
24554 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24555 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24556
24557 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24558 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24559 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24560 will remove duplicates.
24561
24562 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24563
24564 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24565 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24566 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24567 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24568 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24569 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24570 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24571 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24572 on its name.
24573
24574 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24575 testsuite.
24576
24577 @example
24578 #include "symcat.h"
24579 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24580 asm(
24581 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24582 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24583 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24584 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24585 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24586 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24587 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24588 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24589 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24590 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24591 ".byte 0\n"
24592 ".popsection\n"
24593 );
24594 @end example
24595
24596 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24597 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24598 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24599 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24600
24601 @node Which flavor to choose?
24602 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24603
24604 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24605 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24606
24607 @noindent
24608 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24609
24610 @itemize @bullet
24611 @item
24612 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24613
24614 @item
24615 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24616
24617 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24618 in the source search path.
24619 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24620 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24621
24622 @item
24623 Doesn't require source code additions.
24624 @end itemize
24625
24626 @noindent
24627 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24628
24629 @itemize @bullet
24630 @item
24631 Works with static linking.
24632
24633 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24634 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24635 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24636 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24637 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24638
24639 @item
24640 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24641
24642 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24643 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24644
24645 @item
24646 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24647
24648 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24649 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24650 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24651 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24652 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24653 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24654 @end itemize
24655
24656 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24657 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24658
24659 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24660 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24661 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24662
24663 @subsection Python comes first
24664
24665 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24666 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24667 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24668 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24669 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24670 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24671 pretty-printed form of a value).
24672 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24673 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24674 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24675
24676 @node Aliases
24677 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24678 @cindex aliases for commands
24679
24680 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24681 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24682 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24683 that involves less typing.
24684
24685 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24686 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24687 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24688
24689 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24690 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24691 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24692
24693 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24694
24695 @table @code
24696
24697 @kindex alias
24698 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24699
24700 @end table
24701
24702 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24703 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24704 underscores.
24705
24706 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24707 that is being aliased.
24708
24709 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24710 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24711 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24712
24713 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24714 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24715
24716 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24717 of a command so that there is less to type.
24718 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24719 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24720 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24721 The following will accomplish this.
24722
24723 @smallexample
24724 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24725 @end smallexample
24726
24727 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24728 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24729 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24730 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24731
24732 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24733 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24734 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24735 of a command.
24736
24737 @smallexample
24738 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24739 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24740 (gdb) set p elms 20
24741 (gdb) show p elms
24742 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24743 @end smallexample
24744
24745 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24746 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24747 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24748
24749 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24750 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24751
24752 @smallexample
24753 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24754 @end smallexample
24755
24756 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24757 alias for a more complex command.
24758 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24759
24760 @smallexample
24761 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24762 (gdb) spe 20
24763 @end smallexample
24764
24765 @node Interpreters
24766 @chapter Command Interpreters
24767 @cindex command interpreters
24768
24769 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24770 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24771 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24772
24773 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24774 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24775 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24776 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24777
24778 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24779 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24780 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24781 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24782
24783 @table @code
24784 @item console
24785 @cindex console interpreter
24786 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24787 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24788 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24789
24790 @item mi
24791 @cindex mi interpreter
24792 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24793 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24794 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24795 Interface}.
24796
24797 @item mi2
24798 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24799 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24800
24801 @item mi1
24802 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24803 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24804
24805 @end table
24806
24807 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24808 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24809 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24810 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24811 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24812 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24813 the IDE inoperable!
24814
24815 @kindex interpreter-exec
24816 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24817 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24818 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24819 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24820
24821 @smallexample
24822 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24823 @end smallexample
24824
24825 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24826 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24827
24828 @node TUI
24829 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24830 @cindex TUI
24831 @cindex Text User Interface
24832
24833 @menu
24834 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24835 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24836 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24837 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24838 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24839 @end menu
24840
24841 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24842 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24843 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24844 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24845 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24846 is available.
24847
24848 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24849 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24850 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24851 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24852 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24853 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24854
24855 @node TUI Overview
24856 @section TUI Overview
24857
24858 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24859
24860 @table @emph
24861 @item command
24862 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24863 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24864 managed using readline.
24865
24866 @item source
24867 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24868 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24869
24870 @item assembly
24871 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24872
24873 @item register
24874 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24875 when their values change.
24876 @end table
24877
24878 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24879 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24880 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24881 indicates the breakpoint type:
24882
24883 @table @code
24884 @item B
24885 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24886
24887 @item b
24888 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24889
24890 @item H
24891 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24892
24893 @item h
24894 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24895 @end table
24896
24897 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24898
24899 @table @code
24900 @item +
24901 Breakpoint is enabled.
24902
24903 @item -
24904 Breakpoint is disabled.
24905 @end table
24906
24907 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24908 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24909 changes.
24910
24911 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24912 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24913 layouts:
24914
24915 @itemize @bullet
24916 @item
24917 source only,
24918
24919 @item
24920 assembly only,
24921
24922 @item
24923 source and assembly,
24924
24925 @item
24926 source and registers, or
24927
24928 @item
24929 assembly and registers.
24930 @end itemize
24931
24932 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24933
24934 @table @emph
24935 @item target
24936 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24937 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24938
24939 @item process
24940 Gives the current process or thread number.
24941 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24942
24943 @item function
24944 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24945 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24946 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24947 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24948
24949 @item line
24950 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24951 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24952
24953 @item pc
24954 Indicates the current program counter address.
24955 @end table
24956
24957 @node TUI Keys
24958 @section TUI Key Bindings
24959 @cindex TUI key bindings
24960
24961 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24962 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24963 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24964 @end ifset
24965 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24966 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24967 @end ifclear
24968 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24969 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24970
24971 @table @kbd
24972 @kindex C-x C-a
24973 @item C-x C-a
24974 @kindex C-x a
24975 @itemx C-x a
24976 @kindex C-x A
24977 @itemx C-x A
24978 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24979 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24980 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24981 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24982 The screen is then refreshed.
24983
24984 @kindex C-x 1
24985 @item C-x 1
24986 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24987 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24988 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24989
24990 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24991
24992 @kindex C-x 2
24993 @item C-x 2
24994 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24995 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24996 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24997 previous layout and the new one.
24998
24999 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25000
25001 @kindex C-x o
25002 @item C-x o
25003 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25004 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25005 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25006
25007 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25008
25009 @kindex C-x s
25010 @item C-x s
25011 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25012 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25013 @end table
25014
25015 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25016
25017 @table @asis
25018 @kindex PgUp
25019 @item @key{PgUp}
25020 Scroll the active window one page up.
25021
25022 @kindex PgDn
25023 @item @key{PgDn}
25024 Scroll the active window one page down.
25025
25026 @kindex Up
25027 @item @key{Up}
25028 Scroll the active window one line up.
25029
25030 @kindex Down
25031 @item @key{Down}
25032 Scroll the active window one line down.
25033
25034 @kindex Left
25035 @item @key{Left}
25036 Scroll the active window one column left.
25037
25038 @kindex Right
25039 @item @key{Right}
25040 Scroll the active window one column right.
25041
25042 @kindex C-L
25043 @item @kbd{C-L}
25044 Refresh the screen.
25045 @end table
25046
25047 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25048 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25049 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25050 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25051 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25052
25053 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25054 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25055 @cindex TUI single key mode
25056
25057 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25058 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25059 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25060
25061 @table @kbd
25062 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25063 @item c
25064 continue
25065
25066 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25067 @item d
25068 down
25069
25070 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25071 @item f
25072 finish
25073
25074 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25075 @item n
25076 next
25077
25078 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25079 @item q
25080 exit the SingleKey mode.
25081
25082 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25083 @item r
25084 run
25085
25086 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25087 @item s
25088 step
25089
25090 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25091 @item u
25092 up
25093
25094 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25095 @item v
25096 info locals
25097
25098 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25099 @item w
25100 where
25101 @end table
25102
25103 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25104 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25105 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25106 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25107 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25108 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25109
25110
25111 @node TUI Commands
25112 @section TUI-specific Commands
25113 @cindex TUI commands
25114
25115 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25116 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25117 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25118 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25119
25120 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25121 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25122 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25123 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25124 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25125
25126 @table @code
25127 @item tui enable
25128 @kindex tui enable
25129 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25130 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25131 otherwise a default layout is used.
25132
25133 @item tui disable
25134 @kindex tui disable
25135 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25136
25137 @item info win
25138 @kindex info win
25139 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25140
25141 @item layout @var{name}
25142 @kindex layout
25143 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25144 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25145 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25146
25147 @table @code
25148 @item next
25149 Display the next layout.
25150
25151 @item prev
25152 Display the previous layout.
25153
25154 @item src
25155 Display the source and command windows.
25156
25157 @item asm
25158 Display the assembly and command windows.
25159
25160 @item split
25161 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25162
25163 @item regs
25164 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25165 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25166 register, assembler, and command windows.
25167 @end table
25168
25169 @item focus @var{name}
25170 @kindex focus
25171 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25172 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25173
25174 @table @code
25175 @item next
25176 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25177
25178 @item prev
25179 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25180
25181 @item src
25182 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25183
25184 @item asm
25185 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25186
25187 @item regs
25188 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25189
25190 @item cmd
25191 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25192 @end table
25193
25194 @item refresh
25195 @kindex refresh
25196 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25197
25198 @item tui reg @var{group}
25199 @kindex tui reg
25200 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25201 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25202 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25203 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25204 following groups are available on most targets:
25205 @table @code
25206 @item next
25207 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25208 through all of the available register groups.
25209
25210 @item prev
25211 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25212 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25213 @var{next}.
25214
25215 @item general
25216 Display the general registers.
25217 @item float
25218 Display the floating point registers.
25219 @item system
25220 Display the system registers.
25221 @item vector
25222 Display the vector registers.
25223 @item all
25224 Display all registers.
25225 @end table
25226
25227 @item update
25228 @kindex update
25229 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25230
25231 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25232 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25233 @kindex winheight
25234 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25235 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25236 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25237 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25238 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25239
25240 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25241 @kindex tabset
25242 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25243 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25244 assembly windows.
25245 @end table
25246
25247 @node TUI Configuration
25248 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25249 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25250
25251 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25252
25253 @table @code
25254 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25255 @kindex set tui border-kind
25256 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25257 The possible values are the following:
25258 @table @code
25259 @item space
25260 Use a space character to draw the border.
25261
25262 @item ascii
25263 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25264
25265 @item acs
25266 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25267 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25268 @end table
25269
25270 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25271 @kindex set tui border-mode
25272 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25273 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25274 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25275 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25276 @table @code
25277 @item normal
25278 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25279
25280 @item standout
25281 Use standout mode.
25282
25283 @item reverse
25284 Use reverse video mode.
25285
25286 @item half
25287 Use half bright mode.
25288
25289 @item half-standout
25290 Use half bright and standout mode.
25291
25292 @item bold
25293 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25294
25295 @item bold-standout
25296 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25297 @end table
25298 @end table
25299
25300 @node Emacs
25301 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25302
25303 @cindex Emacs
25304 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25305 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25306 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25307 @value{GDBN}.
25308
25309 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25310 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25311 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25312 created Emacs buffer.
25313 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25314
25315 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25316 things:
25317
25318 @itemize @bullet
25319 @item
25320 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25321 the GUD buffer.
25322
25323 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25324 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25325
25326 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25327 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25328 in this way.
25329
25330 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25331 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25332 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25333 stop.
25334
25335 @item
25336 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25337
25338 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25339 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25340 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25341 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25342 and the source.
25343
25344 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25345 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25346 @end itemize
25347
25348 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25349 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25350 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25351 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25352
25353 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25354 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25355 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25356 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25357 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25358 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25359 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25360 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25361 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25362
25363 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25364 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25365 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25366 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25367
25368 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25369 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25370 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25371 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25372 one you want.
25373
25374 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25375 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25376
25377 @table @kbd
25378 @item C-h m
25379 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25380
25381 @item C-c C-s
25382 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25383 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25384
25385 @item C-c C-n
25386 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25387 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25388 to show the current file and location.
25389
25390 @item C-c C-i
25391 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25392 display window accordingly.
25393
25394 @item C-c C-f
25395 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25396 @code{finish} command.
25397
25398 @item C-c C-r
25399 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25400 command.
25401
25402 @item C-c <
25403 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25404 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25405 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25406
25407 @item C-c >
25408 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25409 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25410 @end table
25411
25412 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25413 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25414
25415 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25416 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25417 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25418 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25419 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25420 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25421 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25422
25423 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25424 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25425 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25426 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25427 frame.
25428
25429 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25430 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25431 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25432 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25433 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25434 to correspond properly with the code.
25435
25436 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25437 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25438 Emacs Manual}).
25439
25440 @node GDB/MI
25441 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25442
25443 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25444
25445 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25446 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25447 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25448 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25449 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25450 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25451
25452 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25453 in the form of a reference manual.
25454
25455 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25456 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25457 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25458
25459 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25460
25461 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25462 This chapter uses the following notation:
25463
25464 @itemize @bullet
25465 @item
25466 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25467
25468 @item
25469 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25470 it may or may not be given.
25471
25472 @item
25473 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25474 may repeat zero or more times.
25475
25476 @item
25477 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25478 may repeat one or more times.
25479
25480 @item
25481 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25482 @end itemize
25483
25484 @ignore
25485 @heading Dependencies
25486 @end ignore
25487
25488 @menu
25489 * GDB/MI General Design::
25490 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25491 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25492 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25493 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25494 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25495 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25496 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25497 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25498 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25499 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25500 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25501 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25502 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25503 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25504 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25505 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25506 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25507 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25508 @ignore
25509 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25510 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25511 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25512 @end ignore
25513 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25514 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25515 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25516 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25517 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25518 @end menu
25519
25520 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25521 @node GDB/MI General Design
25522 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25523 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25524
25525 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25526 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25527 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25528 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25529 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25530 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25531 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25532 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25533 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25534 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25535
25536 The important examples of notifications are:
25537 @itemize @bullet
25538
25539 @item
25540 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25541 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25542 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25543 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25544 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25545 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25546 command itself was successfully executed.
25547
25548 @item
25549 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25550 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25551 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25552 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25553 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25554 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25555
25556 @item
25557 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25558 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25559 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25560 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25561 orthogonal frontend design.
25562
25563 @end itemize
25564
25565 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25566 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25567 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25568 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25569 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25570 the user interface.
25571
25572
25573 @menu
25574 * Context management::
25575 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25576 * Thread groups::
25577 @end menu
25578
25579 @node Context management
25580 @subsection Context management
25581
25582 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25583
25584 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25585 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25586 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25587 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25588 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25589 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25590 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25591 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25592 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25593
25594 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25595 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25596 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25597 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25598 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25599 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25600 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25601 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25602 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25603 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25604 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25605
25606 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25607 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25608 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25609 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25610 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25611 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25612 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25613 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25614 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25615 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25616
25617 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25618 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25619 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25620 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25621 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25622 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25623 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25624 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25625 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25626 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25627 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25628 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25629 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25630 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25631 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25632 @samp{--frame} options.
25633
25634 @subsubsection Language
25635
25636 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25637 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25638 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25639 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25640 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25641 For instance:
25642
25643 @smallexample
25644 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25645 ^done,value="4"
25646 (gdb)
25647 @end smallexample
25648
25649 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25650 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25651 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25652
25653 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25654 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25655
25656 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25657 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25658 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25659 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25660 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25661 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25662 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25663 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25664 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25665
25666 @table @code
25667 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25668 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25669 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25670
25671 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25672 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25673 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25674
25675 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25676 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25677 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25678 MI commands even while the target is running.
25679
25680 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25681 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25682 @end table
25683
25684 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25685 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25686 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25687 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25688 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25689 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25690
25691 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25692 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25693 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25694 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25695 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25696 are running.
25697
25698 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25699 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25700 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25701 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25702 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25703 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25704 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25705 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25706 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25707 @samp{--thread} option).
25708
25709 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25710 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25711 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25712 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25713
25714 @node Thread groups
25715 @subsection Thread groups
25716 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25717 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25718 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25719 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25720 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25721
25722 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25723 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25724 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25725 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25726 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25727 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25728 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25729 into processes.
25730
25731 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25732 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25733 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25734 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25735 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25736 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25737 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25738 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25739 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25740 the members of specific thread group.
25741
25742 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25743 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25744 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25745 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25746 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25747 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25748 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25749 after attaching to that thread group.
25750
25751 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25752 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25753 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25754 such thread groups.
25755
25756 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25757 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25758 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25759
25760 @menu
25761 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25762 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25763 @end menu
25764
25765 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25766 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25767
25768 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25769 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25770 @table @code
25771 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25772 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25773
25774 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25775 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25776 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25777
25778 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25779 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25780 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25781
25782 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25783 "any sequence of digits"
25784
25785 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25786 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25787
25788 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25789 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25790
25791 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25792 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25793
25794 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25795 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25796 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25797
25798 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25799 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25800
25801 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25802 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25803 @end table
25804
25805 @noindent
25806 Notes:
25807
25808 @itemize @bullet
25809 @item
25810 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25811 output is described below.
25812
25813 @item
25814 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25815 finishes.
25816
25817 @item
25818 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25819 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25820 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25821 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25822 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25823 @end itemize
25824
25825 Pragmatics:
25826
25827 @itemize @bullet
25828 @item
25829 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25830
25831 @item
25832 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25833 @end itemize
25834
25835 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25836 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25837
25838 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25839 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25840 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25841 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25842 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25843 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25844
25845 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25846 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25847 @var{token}.
25848
25849 @table @code
25850 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25851 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25852
25853 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25854 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25855
25856 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25857 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25858
25859 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25860 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25861
25862 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25863 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25864
25865 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25866 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25867
25868 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25869 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25870
25871 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25872 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25873
25874 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25875 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25876
25877 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25878 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25879 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25880
25881 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25882 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25883
25884 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25885 @code{ @var{string} }
25886
25887 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25888 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25889
25890 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25891 @code{@var{c-string}}
25892
25893 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25894 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25895
25896 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25897 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25898 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25899
25900 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25901 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25902
25903 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25904 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25905
25906 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25907 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25908
25909 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25910 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25911
25912 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25913 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25914
25915 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25916 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25917 @end table
25918
25919 @noindent
25920 Notes:
25921
25922 @itemize @bullet
25923 @item
25924 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25925
25926 @item
25927 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25928 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25929 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25930 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25931 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25932 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25933 prior command.
25934
25935 @item
25936 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25937 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25938 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25939 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25940
25941 @item
25942 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25943 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25944 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25945 @samp{*}.
25946
25947 @item
25948 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25949 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25950 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25951 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25952
25953 @item
25954 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25955 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25956 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25957 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25958
25959 @item
25960 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25961 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25962 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25963
25964 @item
25965 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25966 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25967 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25968 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25969
25970 @item
25971 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25972 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25973 @var{values}.
25974
25975
25976 @end itemize
25977
25978 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25979 details about the various output records.
25980
25981 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25982 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25983 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25984
25985 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25986 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25987
25988 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25989 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25990 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25991 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25992 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25993 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25994
25995 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25996 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25997 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25998
25999 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26000 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26001 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26002 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26003
26004 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26005 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26006
26007 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26008 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26009 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26010 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26011 might change.
26012
26013 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26014 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26015 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26016 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26017
26018 @itemize @bullet
26019 @item
26020 New MI commands may be added.
26021
26022 @item
26023 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26024
26025 @item
26026 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26027 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26028
26029 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26030 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26031
26032 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26033 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26034 @end itemize
26035
26036 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26037 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26038 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26039 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26040 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26041
26042 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26043 @c version?
26044
26045 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26046 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26047 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26048 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26049 @cindex mailing lists
26050
26051 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26052 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26053 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26054
26055 @menu
26056 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26057 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26058 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26059 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26060 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26061 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26062 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26063 @end menu
26064
26065 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26066 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26067
26068 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26069 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26070 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26071 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26072
26073 @table @code
26074 @findex ^done
26075 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26076 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26077 values.
26078
26079 @item "^running"
26080 @findex ^running
26081 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26082 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26083 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26084 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26085 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26086 which threads are resumed.
26087
26088 @item "^connected"
26089 @findex ^connected
26090 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26091
26092 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26093 @findex ^error
26094 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26095 the corresponding error message.
26096
26097 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26098 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26099 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26100
26101 @table @samp
26102 @item "undefined-command"
26103 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26104 @end table
26105
26106 @item "^exit"
26107 @findex ^exit
26108 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26109
26110 @end table
26111
26112 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26113 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26114
26115 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26116 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26117 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26118 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26119 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26120
26121 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26122 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26123 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26124 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26125 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26126
26127 @table @code
26128 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26129 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26130 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26131
26132 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26133 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26134 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26135 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26136
26137 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26138 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26139 internals.
26140 @end table
26141
26142 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26143 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26144
26145 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26146 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26147 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26148 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26149 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26150 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26151
26152 The following is the list of possible async records:
26153
26154 @table @code
26155
26156 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26157 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26158 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26159 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26160 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26161 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26162 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26163 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26164 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26165 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26166 it run freely.
26167
26168 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26169 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26170 following values:
26171
26172 @table @code
26173 @item breakpoint-hit
26174 A breakpoint was reached.
26175 @item watchpoint-trigger
26176 A watchpoint was triggered.
26177 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26178 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26179 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26180 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26181 @item function-finished
26182 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26183 @item location-reached
26184 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26185 @item watchpoint-scope
26186 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26187 @item end-stepping-range
26188 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26189 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26190 @item exited-signalled
26191 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26192 @item exited
26193 The inferior exited.
26194 @item exited-normally
26195 The inferior exited normally.
26196 @item signal-received
26197 A signal was received by the inferior.
26198 @item solib-event
26199 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26200 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26201 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26202 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26203 @item fork
26204 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26205 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26206 @item vfork
26207 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26208 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26209 @item syscall-entry
26210 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26211 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26212 @item syscall-return
26213 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26214 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26215 @item exec
26216 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26217 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26218 @end table
26219
26220 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26221 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26222 Depending on whether all-stop
26223 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26224 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26225 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26226 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26227 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26228 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26229 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26230 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26231 if such information is not available.
26232
26233 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26234 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26235 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26236 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26237 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26238 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26239 cannot be used in any way.
26240
26241 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26242 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26243 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26244 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26245 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26246 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26247
26248 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26249 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26250 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26251 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26252 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26253 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26254
26255 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26256 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26257 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26258 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26259 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26260
26261 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26262 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26263 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26264 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26265 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26266 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26267 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26268
26269 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26270 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26271 that thread.
26272
26273 @item =library-loaded,...
26274 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26275 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26276 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26277 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26278 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26279 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26280 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26281 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26282 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26283 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26284 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26285 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26286 thread groups.
26287
26288 @item =library-unloaded,...
26289 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26290 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26291 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26292 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26293 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26294 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26295 thread groups.
26296
26297 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26298 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26299 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26300 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26301 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26302
26303 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26304 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26305 initial value @var{initial}.
26306
26307 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26308 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26309 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26310 trace state variables are deleted.
26311
26312 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26313 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26314 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26315 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26316 value of trace state variable is known.
26317
26318 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26319 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26320 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26321 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26322 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26323 user.
26324
26325 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26326 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26327 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26328
26329 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26330 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26331
26332 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26333 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26334 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26335 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26336 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26337
26338 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26339 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26340 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26341 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26342 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26343 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26344
26345 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26346 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26347 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26348 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26349 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26350 executable code.
26351 @end table
26352
26353 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26354 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26355
26356 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26357 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26358 following fields:
26359
26360 @table @code
26361 @item number
26362 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26363 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26364 @samp{1.2}.
26365
26366 @item type
26367 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26368 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26369
26370 @item catch-type
26371 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26372 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26373
26374 @item disp
26375 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26376 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26377 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26378
26379 @item enabled
26380 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26381 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26382 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26383
26384 @item addr
26385 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26386 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26387 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26388 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26389 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26390
26391 @item func
26392 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26393 If not known, this field is not present.
26394
26395 @item filename
26396 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26397 If not known, this field is not present.
26398
26399 @item fullname
26400 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26401 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26402
26403 @item line
26404 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26405 If not known, this field is not present.
26406
26407 @item at
26408 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26409 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26410 by a symbol name.
26411
26412 @item pending
26413 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26414 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26415
26416 @item evaluated-by
26417 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26418 @samp{target}.
26419
26420 @item thread
26421 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26422 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26423
26424 @item task
26425 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26426 field will hold the task identifier.
26427
26428 @item cond
26429 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26430
26431 @item ignore
26432 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26433
26434 @item enable
26435 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26436
26437 @item traceframe-usage
26438 FIXME.
26439
26440 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26441 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26442
26443 @item mask
26444 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26445
26446 @item pass
26447 A tracepoint's pass count.
26448
26449 @item original-location
26450 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26451 This field is optional.
26452
26453 @item times
26454 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26455
26456 @item installed
26457 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26458 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26459 is not.
26460
26461 @item what
26462 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26463
26464 @end table
26465
26466 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26467 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26468
26469 @smallexample
26470 -> -break-insert main
26471 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26472 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26473 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26474 times="0"@}
26475 <- (gdb)
26476 @end smallexample
26477
26478 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26479 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26480
26481 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26482 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26483 fields:
26484
26485 @table @code
26486 @item level
26487 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26488 zero. This field is always present.
26489
26490 @item func
26491 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26492 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26493
26494 @item addr
26495 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26496
26497 @item file
26498 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26499 address. This field may be absent.
26500
26501 @item line
26502 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26503 may be absent.
26504
26505 @item from
26506 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26507 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26508
26509 @end table
26510
26511 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26512 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26513
26514 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26515 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26516
26517 @table @code
26518 @item id
26519 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26520 always present.
26521
26522 @item target-id
26523 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26524
26525 @item details
26526 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26527 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26528 frontend. This field is optional.
26529
26530 @item state
26531 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26532 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26533
26534 @item core
26535 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26536 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26537 @end table
26538
26539 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26540 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26541
26542 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26543 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26544 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26545 the @code{exception-name} field.
26546
26547 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26548 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26549 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26550 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26551
26552 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26553 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26554 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26555 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26556
26557 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26558 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26559
26560 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26561
26562 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26563 information of the breakpoint.
26564
26565 @smallexample
26566 -> -break-insert main
26567 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26568 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26569 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26570 times="0"@}
26571 <- (gdb)
26572 @end smallexample
26573
26574 @subheading Program Execution
26575
26576 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26577 reason that execution stopped.
26578
26579 @smallexample
26580 -> -exec-run
26581 <- ^running
26582 <- (gdb)
26583 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26584 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26585 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26586 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26587 <- (gdb)
26588 -> -exec-continue
26589 <- ^running
26590 <- (gdb)
26591 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26592 <- (gdb)
26593 @end smallexample
26594
26595 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26596
26597 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26598
26599 @smallexample
26600 -> (gdb)
26601 <- -gdb-exit
26602 <- ^exit
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26606 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26607 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26608 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26609 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26610 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26611
26612 @subheading A Bad Command
26613
26614 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26615
26616 @smallexample
26617 -> -rubbish
26618 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26619 <- (gdb)
26620 @end smallexample
26621
26622
26623 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26624 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26625 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26626
26627 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26628 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26629
26630 @subheading Motivation
26631
26632 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26633
26634 @subheading Introduction
26635
26636 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26637
26638 @subheading Commands
26639
26640 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26641
26642 @subsubheading Synopsis
26643
26644 @smallexample
26645 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26646 @end smallexample
26647
26648 @subsubheading Result
26649
26650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26651
26652 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26653
26654 @subsubheading Example
26655
26656 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26657 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26658
26659
26660 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26661 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26662 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26663
26664 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26665 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26666 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26667 breakpoints.
26668
26669 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26670 @findex -break-after
26671
26672 @subsubheading Synopsis
26673
26674 @smallexample
26675 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26676 @end smallexample
26677
26678 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26679 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26680 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26681 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26682
26683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26684
26685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26686
26687 @subsubheading Example
26688
26689 @smallexample
26690 (gdb)
26691 -break-insert main
26692 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26693 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26694 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26695 times="0"@}
26696 (gdb)
26697 -break-after 1 3
26698 ~
26699 ^done
26700 (gdb)
26701 -break-list
26702 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26703 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26704 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26705 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26706 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26707 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26708 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26709 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26710 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26711 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26712 (gdb)
26713 @end smallexample
26714
26715 @ignore
26716 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26717 @findex -break-catch
26718 @end ignore
26719
26720 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26721 @findex -break-commands
26722
26723 @subsubheading Synopsis
26724
26725 @smallexample
26726 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26727 @end smallexample
26728
26729 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26730 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26731 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26732 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26733 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26734 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26735
26736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26737
26738 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26739
26740 @subsubheading Example
26741
26742 @smallexample
26743 (gdb)
26744 -break-insert main
26745 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26746 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26747 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26748 times="0"@}
26749 (gdb)
26750 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26751 ^done
26752 (gdb)
26753 @end smallexample
26754
26755 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26756 @findex -break-condition
26757
26758 @subsubheading Synopsis
26759
26760 @smallexample
26761 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26762 @end smallexample
26763
26764 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26765 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26766 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26767 command below).
26768
26769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26770
26771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26772
26773 @subsubheading Example
26774
26775 @smallexample
26776 (gdb)
26777 -break-condition 1 1
26778 ^done
26779 (gdb)
26780 -break-list
26781 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26782 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26783 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26784 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26785 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26786 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26787 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26788 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26789 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26790 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26791 (gdb)
26792 @end smallexample
26793
26794 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26795 @findex -break-delete
26796
26797 @subsubheading Synopsis
26798
26799 @smallexample
26800 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26801 @end smallexample
26802
26803 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26804 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26805
26806 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26807
26808 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26809
26810 @subsubheading Example
26811
26812 @smallexample
26813 (gdb)
26814 -break-delete 1
26815 ^done
26816 (gdb)
26817 -break-list
26818 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26819 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26820 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26821 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26822 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26823 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26824 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26825 body=[]@}
26826 (gdb)
26827 @end smallexample
26828
26829 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26830 @findex -break-disable
26831
26832 @subsubheading Synopsis
26833
26834 @smallexample
26835 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26836 @end smallexample
26837
26838 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26839 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26840
26841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26842
26843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26844
26845 @subsubheading Example
26846
26847 @smallexample
26848 (gdb)
26849 -break-disable 2
26850 ^done
26851 (gdb)
26852 -break-list
26853 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26854 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26855 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26856 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26857 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26858 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26859 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26860 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26861 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26862 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26863 (gdb)
26864 @end smallexample
26865
26866 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26867 @findex -break-enable
26868
26869 @subsubheading Synopsis
26870
26871 @smallexample
26872 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26873 @end smallexample
26874
26875 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26876
26877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26878
26879 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26880
26881 @subsubheading Example
26882
26883 @smallexample
26884 (gdb)
26885 -break-enable 2
26886 ^done
26887 (gdb)
26888 -break-list
26889 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26890 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26891 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26892 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26893 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26894 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26895 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26896 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26897 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26898 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26899 (gdb)
26900 @end smallexample
26901
26902 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26903 @findex -break-info
26904
26905 @subsubheading Synopsis
26906
26907 @smallexample
26908 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26909 @end smallexample
26910
26911 @c REDUNDANT???
26912 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26913
26914 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26915 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26916 table.
26917
26918 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26919
26920 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26921
26922 @subsubheading Example
26923 N.A.
26924
26925 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26926 @findex -break-insert
26927 @anchor{-break-insert}
26928
26929 @subsubheading Synopsis
26930
26931 @smallexample
26932 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26933 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26934 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26935 @end smallexample
26936
26937 @noindent
26938 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26939
26940 @table @var
26941 @item linespec location
26942 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
26943
26944 @item explicit location
26945 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
26946 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
26947 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
26948
26949 @table @samp
26950 @item --source @var{filename}
26951 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
26952 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
26953
26954 @item --function @var{function}
26955 The name of a function or method.
26956
26957 @item --label @var{label}
26958 The name of a label.
26959
26960 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
26961 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
26962 @end table
26963
26964 @item address location
26965 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
26966 @end table
26967
26968 @noindent
26969 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26970
26971 @table @samp
26972 @item -t
26973 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26974 @item -h
26975 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26976 @item -f
26977 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26978 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26979 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26980 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26981 cannot be parsed.
26982 @item -d
26983 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26984 @item -a
26985 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26986 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26987 @item -c @var{condition}
26988 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26989 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26990 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26991 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26992 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
26993 @var{thread-id}.
26994 @end table
26995
26996 @subsubheading Result
26997
26998 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26999 resulting breakpoint.
27000
27001 Note: this format is open to change.
27002 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27003
27004 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27005
27006 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27007 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27008
27009 @subsubheading Example
27010
27011 @smallexample
27012 (gdb)
27013 -break-insert main
27014 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27015 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27016 times="0"@}
27017 (gdb)
27018 -break-insert -t foo
27019 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27020 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27021 times="0"@}
27022 (gdb)
27023 -break-list
27024 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27025 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27026 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27027 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27028 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27029 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27030 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27031 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27032 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27033 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27034 times="0"@},
27035 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27036 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27037 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27038 times="0"@}]@}
27039 (gdb)
27040 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27041 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27042 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27043 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27044 @c times="0"@}
27045 @c (gdb)
27046 @end smallexample
27047
27048 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27049 @findex -dprintf-insert
27050
27051 @subsubheading Synopsis
27052
27053 @smallexample
27054 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27055 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27056 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27057 [ @var{argument} ]
27058 @end smallexample
27059
27060 @noindent
27061 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27062 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27063
27064 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27065
27066 @table @samp
27067 @item -t
27068 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27069 @item -f
27070 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27071 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27072 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27073 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27074 cannot be parsed.
27075 @item -d
27076 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27077 @item -c @var{condition}
27078 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27079 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27080 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27081 to @var{ignore-count}.
27082 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27083 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27084 @var{thread-id}.
27085 @end table
27086
27087 @subsubheading Result
27088
27089 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27090 resulting breakpoint.
27091
27092 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27093
27094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27095
27096 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27097
27098 @subsubheading Example
27099
27100 @smallexample
27101 (gdb)
27102 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27103 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27104 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27105 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27106 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27107 original-location="foo"@}
27108 (gdb)
27109 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27110 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27111 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27112 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27113 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27114 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27115 (gdb)
27116 @end smallexample
27117
27118 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27119 @findex -break-list
27120
27121 @subsubheading Synopsis
27122
27123 @smallexample
27124 -break-list
27125 @end smallexample
27126
27127 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27128
27129 @table @samp
27130 @item Number
27131 number of the breakpoint
27132 @item Type
27133 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27134 @item Disposition
27135 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27136 or @samp{nokeep}
27137 @item Enabled
27138 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27139 @item Address
27140 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27141 @item What
27142 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27143 name, line number
27144 @item Thread-groups
27145 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27146 @item Times
27147 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27148 @end table
27149
27150 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27151 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27152
27153 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27154
27155 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27156
27157 @subsubheading Example
27158
27159 @smallexample
27160 (gdb)
27161 -break-list
27162 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27163 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27164 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27165 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27166 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27167 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27168 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27169 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27170 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27171 times="0"@},
27172 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27173 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27174 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27175 (gdb)
27176 @end smallexample
27177
27178 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27179
27180 @smallexample
27181 (gdb)
27182 -break-list
27183 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27184 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27185 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27186 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27187 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27188 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27189 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27190 body=[]@}
27191 (gdb)
27192 @end smallexample
27193
27194 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27195 @findex -break-passcount
27196
27197 @subsubheading Synopsis
27198
27199 @smallexample
27200 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27201 @end smallexample
27202
27203 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27204 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27205 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27206 command @samp{passcount}.
27207
27208 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27209 @findex -break-watch
27210
27211 @subsubheading Synopsis
27212
27213 @smallexample
27214 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27215 @end smallexample
27216
27217 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27218 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27219 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27220 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27221 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27222 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27223 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27224 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27225
27226 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27227 breakpoints inserted.
27228
27229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27230
27231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27232 @samp{rwatch}.
27233
27234 @subsubheading Example
27235
27236 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27237
27238 @smallexample
27239 (gdb)
27240 -break-watch x
27241 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27242 (gdb)
27243 -exec-continue
27244 ^running
27245 (gdb)
27246 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27247 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27248 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27249 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27250 (gdb)
27251 @end smallexample
27252
27253 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27254 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27255 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27256
27257 @smallexample
27258 (gdb)
27259 -break-watch C
27260 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27261 (gdb)
27262 -exec-continue
27263 ^running
27264 (gdb)
27265 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27266 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27267 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27268 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27269 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27270 (gdb)
27271 -exec-continue
27272 ^running
27273 (gdb)
27274 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27275 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27276 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27278 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27279 (gdb)
27280 @end smallexample
27281
27282 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27283 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27284 deleted.
27285
27286 @smallexample
27287 (gdb)
27288 -break-watch C
27289 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27290 (gdb)
27291 -break-list
27292 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27293 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27294 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27295 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27296 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27297 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27298 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27299 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27300 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27301 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27302 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27303 times="1"@},
27304 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27305 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27306 (gdb)
27307 -exec-continue
27308 ^running
27309 (gdb)
27310 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27311 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27312 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27313 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27314 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27315 (gdb)
27316 -break-list
27317 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27318 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27319 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27320 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27321 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27322 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27323 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27324 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27325 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27326 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27327 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27328 times="1"@},
27329 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27330 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27331 (gdb)
27332 -exec-continue
27333 ^running
27334 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27335 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27336 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27337 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27338 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27339 (gdb)
27340 -break-list
27341 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27342 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27343 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27344 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27345 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27346 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27347 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27348 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27349 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27350 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27351 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27352 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27353 (gdb)
27354 @end smallexample
27355
27356
27357 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27358 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27359 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27360
27361 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27362 catchpoints.
27363
27364 @menu
27365 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27366 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27367 @end menu
27368
27369 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27370 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27371
27372 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27373 @findex -catch-load
27374
27375 @subsubheading Synopsis
27376
27377 @smallexample
27378 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27379 @end smallexample
27380
27381 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27382 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27383 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27384 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27385 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27386
27387
27388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27389
27390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27391
27392 @subsubheading Example
27393
27394 @smallexample
27395 -catch-load -t foo.so
27396 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27397 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27398 (gdb)
27399 @end smallexample
27400
27401
27402 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27403 @findex -catch-unload
27404
27405 @subsubheading Synopsis
27406
27407 @smallexample
27408 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27409 @end smallexample
27410
27411 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27412 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27413 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27414 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27415 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27416
27417 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27418
27419 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27420
27421 @subsubheading Example
27422
27423 @smallexample
27424 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27425 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27426 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27427 (gdb)
27428 @end smallexample
27429
27430 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27431 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27432
27433 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27434 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27435
27436 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27437 @findex -catch-assert
27438
27439 @subsubheading Synopsis
27440
27441 @smallexample
27442 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27443 @end smallexample
27444
27445 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27446
27447 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27448
27449 @table @samp
27450 @item -c @var{condition}
27451 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27452 @item -d
27453 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27454 @item -t
27455 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27456 @end table
27457
27458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27459
27460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27461
27462 @subsubheading Example
27463
27464 @smallexample
27465 -catch-assert
27466 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27467 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27468 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27469 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27470 (gdb)
27471 @end smallexample
27472
27473 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27474 @findex -catch-exception
27475
27476 @subsubheading Synopsis
27477
27478 @smallexample
27479 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27480 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27481 @end smallexample
27482
27483 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27484 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27485 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27486 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27487 catchpoints.
27488
27489 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27490
27491 @table @samp
27492 @item -c @var{condition}
27493 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27494 @item -d
27495 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27496 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27497 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27498 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27499 @item -t
27500 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27501 @item -u
27502 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27503 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27504 @end table
27505
27506 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27507
27508 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27509 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27510
27511 @subsubheading Example
27512
27513 @smallexample
27514 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27515 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27516 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27517 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27518 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27519 (gdb)
27520 @end smallexample
27521
27522 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27523 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27524 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27525
27526 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27527 @findex -exec-arguments
27528
27529
27530 @subsubheading Synopsis
27531
27532 @smallexample
27533 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27534 @end smallexample
27535
27536 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27537 @samp{-exec-run}.
27538
27539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27540
27541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27542
27543 @subsubheading Example
27544
27545 @smallexample
27546 (gdb)
27547 -exec-arguments -v word
27548 ^done
27549 (gdb)
27550 @end smallexample
27551
27552
27553 @ignore
27554 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27555 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27556
27557 @subsubheading Synopsis
27558
27559 @smallexample
27560 -exec-show-arguments
27561 @end smallexample
27562
27563 Print the arguments of the program.
27564
27565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27566
27567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27568
27569 @subsubheading Example
27570 N.A.
27571 @end ignore
27572
27573
27574 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27575 @findex -environment-cd
27576
27577 @subsubheading Synopsis
27578
27579 @smallexample
27580 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27581 @end smallexample
27582
27583 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27584
27585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27586
27587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27588
27589 @subsubheading Example
27590
27591 @smallexample
27592 (gdb)
27593 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27594 ^done
27595 (gdb)
27596 @end smallexample
27597
27598
27599 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27600 @findex -environment-directory
27601
27602 @subsubheading Synopsis
27603
27604 @smallexample
27605 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27606 @end smallexample
27607
27608 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27609 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27610 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27611 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27612 occurs as normal.
27613 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27614 multiple directories in a single command
27615 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27616 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27617 If blanks are needed as
27618 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27619 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27620 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27621 character must not be used
27622 in any directory name.
27623 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27624
27625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27626
27627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27628
27629 @subsubheading Example
27630
27631 @smallexample
27632 (gdb)
27633 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27634 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27635 (gdb)
27636 -environment-directory ""
27637 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27638 (gdb)
27639 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27640 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27641 (gdb)
27642 -environment-directory -r
27643 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27644 (gdb)
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647
27648 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27649 @findex -environment-path
27650
27651 @subsubheading Synopsis
27652
27653 @smallexample
27654 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27655 @end smallexample
27656
27657 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27658 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27659 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27660 supplied in addition to the
27661 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27662 occurs as normal.
27663 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27664 multiple directories in a single command
27665 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27666 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27667 If blanks are needed as
27668 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27669 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27670 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27671 character must not be used
27672 in any directory name.
27673 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27674
27675
27676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27677
27678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27679
27680 @subsubheading Example
27681
27682 @smallexample
27683 (gdb)
27684 -environment-path
27685 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27686 (gdb)
27687 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27688 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27689 (gdb)
27690 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27691 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27692 (gdb)
27693 @end smallexample
27694
27695
27696 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27697 @findex -environment-pwd
27698
27699 @subsubheading Synopsis
27700
27701 @smallexample
27702 -environment-pwd
27703 @end smallexample
27704
27705 Show the current working directory.
27706
27707 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27708
27709 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27710
27711 @subsubheading Example
27712
27713 @smallexample
27714 (gdb)
27715 -environment-pwd
27716 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27717 (gdb)
27718 @end smallexample
27719
27720 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27721 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27722 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27723
27724
27725 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27726 @findex -thread-info
27727
27728 @subsubheading Synopsis
27729
27730 @smallexample
27731 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27732 @end smallexample
27733
27734 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27735 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27736 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
27737 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27738 current thread.
27739
27740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27741
27742 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27743 about all threads.
27744
27745 @subsubheading Result
27746
27747 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27748 defined for a given thread:
27749
27750 @table @samp
27751 @item current
27752 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27753
27754 @item id
27755 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27756
27757 @item target-id
27758 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27759
27760 @item details
27761 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27762 field is optional.
27763
27764 @item name
27765 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27766 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27767 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27768 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27769 field is omitted.
27770
27771 @item frame
27772 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27773
27774 @item state
27775 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27776 values:
27777
27778 @table @code
27779 @item stopped
27780 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27781 threads.
27782
27783 @item running
27784 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27785 threads.
27786
27787 @end table
27788
27789 @item core
27790 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27791 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27792
27793 @end table
27794
27795 @subsubheading Example
27796
27797 @smallexample
27798 -thread-info
27799 ^done,threads=[
27800 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27801 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27802 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27803 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27804 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27805 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27806 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27807 state="running"@}],
27808 current-thread-id="1"
27809 (gdb)
27810 @end smallexample
27811
27812 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27813 @findex -thread-list-ids
27814
27815 @subsubheading Synopsis
27816
27817 @smallexample
27818 -thread-list-ids
27819 @end smallexample
27820
27821 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
27822 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
27823 threads.
27824
27825 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27826 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27827
27828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27829
27830 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27831
27832 @subsubheading Example
27833
27834 @smallexample
27835 (gdb)
27836 -thread-list-ids
27837 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27838 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27839 (gdb)
27840 @end smallexample
27841
27842
27843 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27844 @findex -thread-select
27845
27846 @subsubheading Synopsis
27847
27848 @smallexample
27849 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
27850 @end smallexample
27851
27852 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
27853 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
27854 topmost frame for that thread.
27855
27856 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27857 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27858
27859 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27860
27861 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27862
27863 @subsubheading Example
27864
27865 @smallexample
27866 (gdb)
27867 -exec-next
27868 ^running
27869 (gdb)
27870 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27871 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27872 (gdb)
27873 -thread-list-ids
27874 ^done,
27875 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27876 number-of-threads="3"
27877 (gdb)
27878 -thread-select 3
27879 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27880 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27881 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27882 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27883 (gdb)
27884 @end smallexample
27885
27886 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27887 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27888 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27889
27890 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27891 @findex -ada-task-info
27892
27893 @subsubheading Synopsis
27894
27895 @smallexample
27896 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27897 @end smallexample
27898
27899 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27900 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27901
27902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27903
27904 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27905 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27906
27907 @subsubheading Result
27908
27909 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27910 defined for each Ada task:
27911
27912 @table @samp
27913 @item current
27914 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27915
27916 @item id
27917 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27918
27919 @item task-id
27920 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27921
27922 @item thread-id
27923 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
27924 task.
27925
27926 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27927 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27928 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27929
27930 @item parent-id
27931 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27932 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27933
27934 @item priority
27935 The base priority of the task.
27936
27937 @item state
27938 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27939 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27940
27941 @item name
27942 The name of the task.
27943
27944 @end table
27945
27946 @subsubheading Example
27947
27948 @smallexample
27949 -ada-task-info
27950 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27951 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27952 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27953 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27954 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27955 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27956 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27957 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27958 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27959 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27960 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27961 (gdb)
27962 @end smallexample
27963
27964 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27965 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27966 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27967
27968 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27969 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27970 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27971 other cases.
27972
27973 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27974 @findex -exec-continue
27975
27976 @subsubheading Synopsis
27977
27978 @smallexample
27979 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27980 @end smallexample
27981
27982 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27983 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27984 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27985 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27986 @itemize @bullet
27987 @item
27988 breakpoints or watchpoints
27989 @item
27990 signals or exceptions
27991 @item
27992 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27993 @item
27994 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27995 @end itemize
27996 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27997 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27998 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27999 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28000 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28001 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28002
28003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28004
28005 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28006
28007 @subsubheading Example
28008
28009 @smallexample
28010 -exec-continue
28011 ^running
28012 (gdb)
28013 @@Hello world
28014 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28015 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28016 line="13"@}
28017 (gdb)
28018 @end smallexample
28019
28020
28021 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28022 @findex -exec-finish
28023
28024 @subsubheading Synopsis
28025
28026 @smallexample
28027 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28028 @end smallexample
28029
28030 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28031 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28032 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28033 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28034 function was called.
28035
28036 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28037
28038 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28039
28040 @subsubheading Example
28041
28042 Function returning @code{void}.
28043
28044 @smallexample
28045 -exec-finish
28046 ^running
28047 (gdb)
28048 @@hello from foo
28049 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28050 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28051 (gdb)
28052 @end smallexample
28053
28054 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28055 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28056 value itself.
28057
28058 @smallexample
28059 -exec-finish
28060 ^running
28061 (gdb)
28062 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28063 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28064 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28065 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28066 (gdb)
28067 @end smallexample
28068
28069
28070 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28071 @findex -exec-interrupt
28072
28073 @subsubheading Synopsis
28074
28075 @smallexample
28076 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28077 @end smallexample
28078
28079 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28080 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28081 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28082 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28083 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28084
28085 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28086 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28087 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28088 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28089
28090 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28091 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28092 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28093 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28094
28095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28096
28097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28098
28099 @subsubheading Example
28100
28101 @smallexample
28102 (gdb)
28103 111-exec-continue
28104 111^running
28105
28106 (gdb)
28107 222-exec-interrupt
28108 222^done
28109 (gdb)
28110 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28111 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28112 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28113 (gdb)
28114
28115 (gdb)
28116 -exec-interrupt
28117 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28118 (gdb)
28119 @end smallexample
28120
28121 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28122 @findex -exec-jump
28123
28124 @subsubheading Synopsis
28125
28126 @smallexample
28127 -exec-jump @var{location}
28128 @end smallexample
28129
28130 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28131 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28132 different forms of @var{location}.
28133
28134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28135
28136 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28137
28138 @subsubheading Example
28139
28140 @smallexample
28141 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28142 *running,thread-id="all"
28143 ^running
28144 @end smallexample
28145
28146
28147 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28148 @findex -exec-next
28149
28150 @subsubheading Synopsis
28151
28152 @smallexample
28153 -exec-next [--reverse]
28154 @end smallexample
28155
28156 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28157 of the next source line is reached.
28158
28159 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28160 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28161 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28162 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28163 source line where the function was called.
28164
28165
28166 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28167
28168 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28169
28170 @subsubheading Example
28171
28172 @smallexample
28173 -exec-next
28174 ^running
28175 (gdb)
28176 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28177 (gdb)
28178 @end smallexample
28179
28180
28181 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28182 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28183
28184 @subsubheading Synopsis
28185
28186 @smallexample
28187 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28188 @end smallexample
28189
28190 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28191 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28192 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28193 printed as well.
28194
28195 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28196 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28197 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28198 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28199 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28200
28201 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28202
28203 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28204
28205 @subsubheading Example
28206
28207 @smallexample
28208 (gdb)
28209 -exec-next-instruction
28210 ^running
28211
28212 (gdb)
28213 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28214 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28215 (gdb)
28216 @end smallexample
28217
28218
28219 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28220 @findex -exec-return
28221
28222 @subsubheading Synopsis
28223
28224 @smallexample
28225 -exec-return
28226 @end smallexample
28227
28228 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28229 Displays the new current frame.
28230
28231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28232
28233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28234
28235 @subsubheading Example
28236
28237 @smallexample
28238 (gdb)
28239 200-break-insert callee4
28240 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28241 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28242 (gdb)
28243 000-exec-run
28244 000^running
28245 (gdb)
28246 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28247 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28248 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28249 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28250 (gdb)
28251 205-break-delete
28252 205^done
28253 (gdb)
28254 111-exec-return
28255 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28256 args=[@{name="strarg",
28257 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28258 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28259 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28260 (gdb)
28261 @end smallexample
28262
28263
28264 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28265 @findex -exec-run
28266
28267 @subsubheading Synopsis
28268
28269 @smallexample
28270 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28271 @end smallexample
28272
28273 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28274 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28275 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28276 the program has exited exceptionally.
28277
28278 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28279 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28280 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28281 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28282 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28283
28284 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28285 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28286 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28287 (@pxref{Starting}).
28288
28289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28290
28291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28292
28293 @subsubheading Examples
28294
28295 @smallexample
28296 (gdb)
28297 -break-insert main
28298 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28299 (gdb)
28300 -exec-run
28301 ^running
28302 (gdb)
28303 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28304 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28305 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28306 (gdb)
28307 @end smallexample
28308
28309 @noindent
28310 Program exited normally:
28311
28312 @smallexample
28313 (gdb)
28314 -exec-run
28315 ^running
28316 (gdb)
28317 x = 55
28318 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28319 (gdb)
28320 @end smallexample
28321
28322 @noindent
28323 Program exited exceptionally:
28324
28325 @smallexample
28326 (gdb)
28327 -exec-run
28328 ^running
28329 (gdb)
28330 x = 55
28331 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28332 (gdb)
28333 @end smallexample
28334
28335 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28336 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28337
28338 @smallexample
28339 (gdb)
28340 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28341 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28342 @end smallexample
28343
28344
28345 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28346
28347
28348 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28349 @findex -exec-step
28350
28351 @subsubheading Synopsis
28352
28353 @smallexample
28354 -exec-step [--reverse]
28355 @end smallexample
28356
28357 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28358 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28359 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28360 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28361 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28362 previously executed source line.
28363
28364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28365
28366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28367
28368 @subsubheading Example
28369
28370 Stepping into a function:
28371
28372 @smallexample
28373 -exec-step
28374 ^running
28375 (gdb)
28376 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28377 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28378 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28379 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28380 (gdb)
28381 @end smallexample
28382
28383 Regular stepping:
28384
28385 @smallexample
28386 -exec-step
28387 ^running
28388 (gdb)
28389 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28390 (gdb)
28391 @end smallexample
28392
28393
28394 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28395 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28396
28397 @subsubheading Synopsis
28398
28399 @smallexample
28400 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28401 @end smallexample
28402
28403 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28404 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28405 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28406 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28407 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28408 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28409 as well.
28410
28411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28412
28413 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28414
28415 @subsubheading Example
28416
28417 @smallexample
28418 (gdb)
28419 -exec-step-instruction
28420 ^running
28421
28422 (gdb)
28423 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28424 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28425 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28426 (gdb)
28427 -exec-step-instruction
28428 ^running
28429
28430 (gdb)
28431 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28432 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28433 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28434 (gdb)
28435 @end smallexample
28436
28437
28438 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28439 @findex -exec-until
28440
28441 @subsubheading Synopsis
28442
28443 @smallexample
28444 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28445 @end smallexample
28446
28447 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28448 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28449 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28450 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28451
28452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28453
28454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28455
28456 @subsubheading Example
28457
28458 @smallexample
28459 (gdb)
28460 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28461 ^running
28462 (gdb)
28463 x = 55
28464 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28465 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28466 (gdb)
28467 @end smallexample
28468
28469 @ignore
28470 @subheading -file-clear
28471 Is this going away????
28472 @end ignore
28473
28474 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28475 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28476 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28477
28478 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28479 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28480
28481 @smallexample
28482 -enable-frame-filters
28483 @end smallexample
28484
28485 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28486 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28487 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28488 request that this functionality be enabled.
28489
28490 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28491
28492 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28493 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28494
28495 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28496 @findex -stack-info-frame
28497
28498 @subsubheading Synopsis
28499
28500 @smallexample
28501 -stack-info-frame
28502 @end smallexample
28503
28504 Get info on the selected frame.
28505
28506 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28507
28508 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28509 (without arguments).
28510
28511 @subsubheading Example
28512
28513 @smallexample
28514 (gdb)
28515 -stack-info-frame
28516 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28517 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28518 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28519 (gdb)
28520 @end smallexample
28521
28522 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28523 @findex -stack-info-depth
28524
28525 @subsubheading Synopsis
28526
28527 @smallexample
28528 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28529 @end smallexample
28530
28531 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28532 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28533
28534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28535
28536 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28537
28538 @subsubheading Example
28539
28540 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28541
28542 @smallexample
28543 (gdb)
28544 -stack-info-depth
28545 ^done,depth="12"
28546 (gdb)
28547 -stack-info-depth 4
28548 ^done,depth="4"
28549 (gdb)
28550 -stack-info-depth 12
28551 ^done,depth="12"
28552 (gdb)
28553 -stack-info-depth 11
28554 ^done,depth="11"
28555 (gdb)
28556 -stack-info-depth 13
28557 ^done,depth="12"
28558 (gdb)
28559 @end smallexample
28560
28561 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28562 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28563 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28564
28565 @subsubheading Synopsis
28566
28567 @smallexample
28568 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28569 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28570 @end smallexample
28571
28572 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28573 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28574 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28575 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28576 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28577 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28578 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28579 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28580
28581 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28582 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28583 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28584 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28585 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28586 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28587
28588 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28589 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28590 are still displayed, however.
28591
28592 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28593 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28594
28595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28596
28597 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28598 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28599 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28600
28601 @subsubheading Example
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 (gdb)
28605 -stack-list-frames
28606 ^done,
28607 stack=[
28608 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28609 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28610 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28611 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28612 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28613 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28614 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28615 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28616 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28617 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28618 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28619 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28620 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28621 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28622 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28623 (gdb)
28624 -stack-list-arguments 0
28625 ^done,
28626 stack-args=[
28627 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28628 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28629 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28630 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28631 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28632 (gdb)
28633 -stack-list-arguments 1
28634 ^done,
28635 stack-args=[
28636 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28637 frame=@{level="1",
28638 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28639 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28640 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28641 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28642 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28643 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28644 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28645 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28646 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28647 (gdb)
28648 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28649 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28650 (gdb)
28651 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28652 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28653 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28654 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28655 (gdb)
28656 @end smallexample
28657
28658 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28659
28660
28661 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28662 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28663 @findex -stack-list-frames
28664
28665 @subsubheading Synopsis
28666
28667 @smallexample
28668 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28669 @end smallexample
28670
28671 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28672 following info:
28673
28674 @table @samp
28675 @item @var{level}
28676 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28677 @item @var{addr}
28678 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28679 @item @var{func}
28680 Function name.
28681 @item @var{file}
28682 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28683 @item @var{fullname}
28684 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28685 @item @var{line}
28686 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28687 @item @var{from}
28688 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28689 if the frame's function is not known.
28690 @end table
28691
28692 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28693 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28694 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28695 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28696 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28697 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28698 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28699 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28700 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28701
28702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28703
28704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28705
28706 @subsubheading Example
28707
28708 Full stack backtrace:
28709
28710 @smallexample
28711 (gdb)
28712 -stack-list-frames
28713 ^done,stack=
28714 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28715 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28716 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28717 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28718 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28719 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28720 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28721 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28722 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28723 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28724 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28725 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28726 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28727 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28728 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28729 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28730 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28731 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28732 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28733 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28734 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28735 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28736 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28737 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28738 (gdb)
28739 @end smallexample
28740
28741 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28742
28743 @smallexample
28744 (gdb)
28745 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28746 ^done,stack=
28747 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28748 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28749 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28750 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28751 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28752 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28753 (gdb)
28754 @end smallexample
28755
28756 Show a single frame:
28757
28758 @smallexample
28759 (gdb)
28760 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28761 ^done,stack=
28762 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28763 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28764 (gdb)
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767
28768 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28769 @findex -stack-list-locals
28770 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28771
28772 @subsubheading Synopsis
28773
28774 @smallexample
28775 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28776 @end smallexample
28777
28778 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28779 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28780 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28781 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28782 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28783 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28784 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28785 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28786 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28787 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28788
28789 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28790 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28791 variables are still displayed, however.
28792
28793 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28794 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28795
28796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28797
28798 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28799
28800 @subsubheading Example
28801
28802 @smallexample
28803 (gdb)
28804 -stack-list-locals 0
28805 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28806 (gdb)
28807 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28808 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28809 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28810 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28811 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28812 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28813 (gdb)
28814 @end smallexample
28815
28816 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28817 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28818 @findex -stack-list-variables
28819
28820 @subsubheading Synopsis
28821
28822 @smallexample
28823 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28824 @end smallexample
28825
28826 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28827 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28828 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28829 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28830 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28831 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28832 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28833
28834 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28835 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28836 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28837
28838 @subsubheading Example
28839
28840 @smallexample
28841 (gdb)
28842 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28843 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28844 (gdb)
28845 @end smallexample
28846
28847
28848 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28849 @findex -stack-select-frame
28850
28851 @subsubheading Synopsis
28852
28853 @smallexample
28854 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28855 @end smallexample
28856
28857 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28858 the stack.
28859
28860 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28861 option to every command.
28862
28863 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28864
28865 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28866 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28867
28868 @subsubheading Example
28869
28870 @smallexample
28871 (gdb)
28872 -stack-select-frame 2
28873 ^done
28874 (gdb)
28875 @end smallexample
28876
28877 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28878 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28879 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28880
28881 @ignore
28882
28883 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28884
28885 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28886 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28887 used by @code{Insight}.
28888
28889 The two main reasons for that are:
28890
28891 @enumerate 1
28892 @item
28893 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28894
28895 @item
28896 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28897 now).
28898 @end enumerate
28899
28900 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28901 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28902 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28903 hints about their use.
28904
28905 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28906 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28907 least, the following operations:
28908
28909 @itemize @bullet
28910 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28911 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28912 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28913 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28914 @end itemize
28915
28916 @end ignore
28917
28918 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28919
28920 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28921
28922 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28923 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28924 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28925 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28926 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28927 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28928 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28929 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28930 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28931 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28932 object, or to change display format.
28933
28934 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28935 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28936 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28937 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28938 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28939 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28940 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28941 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28942 child will be created.
28943
28944 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28945 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28946 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28947 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28948 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28949
28950 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28951 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28952 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28953 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28954 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28955 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28956 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28957 variables that frontend has created.
28958
28959 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28960 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28961 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28962 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28963 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28964 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28965 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28966 implicitly updated.
28967
28968 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28969 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28970 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28971 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28972 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28973 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28974 frame. Consider this example:
28975
28976 @smallexample
28977 void do_work(...)
28978 @{
28979 struct work_state state;
28980
28981 if (...)
28982 do_work(...);
28983 @}
28984 @end smallexample
28985
28986 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28987 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28988 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28989 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28990 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28991
28992 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28993 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28994 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28995 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28996 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28997 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28998
28999 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29000 access this functionality:
29001
29002 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29003 @item @strong{Operation}
29004 @tab @strong{Description}
29005
29006 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29007 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29008 @item @code{-var-create}
29009 @tab create a variable object
29010 @item @code{-var-delete}
29011 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29012 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29013 @tab set the display format of this variable
29014 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29015 @tab show the display format of this variable
29016 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29017 @tab tells how many children this object has
29018 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29019 @tab return a list of the object's children
29020 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29021 @tab show the type of this variable object
29022 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29023 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29024 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29025 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29026 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29027 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29028 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29029 @tab get the value of this variable
29030 @item @code{-var-assign}
29031 @tab set the value of this variable
29032 @item @code{-var-update}
29033 @tab update the variable and its children
29034 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29035 @tab set frozeness attribute
29036 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29037 @tab set range of children to display on update
29038 @end multitable
29039
29040 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29041 how it can be used.
29042
29043 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29044
29045 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29046 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29047
29048 @smallexample
29049 -enable-pretty-printing
29050 @end smallexample
29051
29052 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29053 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29054 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29055 request that this functionality be enabled.
29056
29057 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29058
29059 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29060 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29061
29062 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29063 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29064
29065 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29066 @findex -var-create
29067
29068 @subsubheading Synopsis
29069
29070 @smallexample
29071 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29072 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29073 @end smallexample
29074
29075 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29076 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29077 register.
29078
29079 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29080 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29081 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29082 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29083 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29084
29085 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29086 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29087 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29088 object must be created.
29089
29090 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29091 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29092
29093 @itemize @bullet
29094 @item
29095 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29096
29097 @item
29098 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29099
29100 @item
29101 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29102 @end itemize
29103
29104 @cindex dynamic varobj
29105 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29106 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29107 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29108 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29109 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29110 compatibility for existing clients.
29111
29112 @subsubheading Result
29113
29114 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29115 are:
29116
29117 @table @samp
29118 @item name
29119 The name of the varobj.
29120
29121 @item numchild
29122 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29123 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29124 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29125
29126 @item value
29127 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29128 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29129 will not be interesting.
29130
29131 @item type
29132 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29133 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29134 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29135 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29136 @emph{declared} one.
29137
29138 @item thread-id
29139 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29140 thread's global identifier.
29141
29142 @item has_more
29143 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29144 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29145
29146 @item dynamic
29147 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29148 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29149 then this attribute will not be present.
29150
29151 @item displayhint
29152 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29153 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29154 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29155 @end table
29156
29157 Typical output will look like this:
29158
29159 @smallexample
29160 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29161 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29162 @end smallexample
29163
29164
29165 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29166 @findex -var-delete
29167
29168 @subsubheading Synopsis
29169
29170 @smallexample
29171 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29172 @end smallexample
29173
29174 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29175 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29176
29177 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29178
29179
29180 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29181 @findex -var-set-format
29182
29183 @subsubheading Synopsis
29184
29185 @smallexample
29186 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29187 @end smallexample
29188
29189 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29190 @var{format-spec}.
29191
29192 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29193 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29194
29195 @smallexample
29196 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29197 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29198 @end smallexample
29199
29200 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29201 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29202 for pointers, etc.).
29203
29204 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29205 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29206 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29207 zero-hexadecimal format.
29208
29209 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29210 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29211
29212 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29213 @findex -var-show-format
29214
29215 @subsubheading Synopsis
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 -var-show-format @var{name}
29219 @end smallexample
29220
29221 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29222
29223 @smallexample
29224 @var{format} @expansion{}
29225 @var{format-spec}
29226 @end smallexample
29227
29228
29229 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29230 @findex -var-info-num-children
29231
29232 @subsubheading Synopsis
29233
29234 @smallexample
29235 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29236 @end smallexample
29237
29238 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29239
29240 @smallexample
29241 numchild=@var{n}
29242 @end smallexample
29243
29244 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29245 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29246 be available.
29247
29248
29249 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29250 @findex -var-list-children
29251
29252 @subsubheading Synopsis
29253
29254 @smallexample
29255 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29256 @end smallexample
29257 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29258
29259 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29260 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29261 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29262 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29263 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29264 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29265 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29266 and unions.
29267
29268 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29269 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29270 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29271 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29272 reported.
29273
29274 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29275 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29276 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29277 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29278 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29279 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29280 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29281 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29282 the visible items.
29283
29284 For each child the following results are returned:
29285
29286 @table @var
29287
29288 @item name
29289 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29290
29291 @item exp
29292 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29293 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29294
29295 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29296 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29297
29298 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29299 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29300 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29301 type and value are not present.
29302
29303 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29304 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29305 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29306
29307 @item numchild
29308 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29309 0.
29310
29311 @item type
29312 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29313 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29314 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29315 @emph{declared} one.
29316
29317 @item value
29318 If values were requested, this is the value.
29319
29320 @item thread-id
29321 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29322 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29323
29324 @item frozen
29325 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29326
29327 @item displayhint
29328 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29329 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29330 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29331
29332 @item dynamic
29333 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29334 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29335 then this attribute will not be present.
29336
29337 @end table
29338
29339 The result may have its own attributes:
29340
29341 @table @samp
29342 @item displayhint
29343 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29344 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29345 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29346
29347 @item has_more
29348 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29349 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29350 @end table
29351
29352 @subsubheading Example
29353
29354 @smallexample
29355 (gdb)
29356 -var-list-children n
29357 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29358 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29359 (gdb)
29360 -var-list-children --all-values n
29361 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29362 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29363 @end smallexample
29364
29365
29366 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29367 @findex -var-info-type
29368
29369 @subsubheading Synopsis
29370
29371 @smallexample
29372 -var-info-type @var{name}
29373 @end smallexample
29374
29375 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29376 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29377 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29378
29379 @smallexample
29380 type=@var{typename}
29381 @end smallexample
29382
29383
29384 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29385 @findex -var-info-expression
29386
29387 @subsubheading Synopsis
29388
29389 @smallexample
29390 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29391 @end smallexample
29392
29393 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29394 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29395 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29396
29397 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29398 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29399
29400 @smallexample
29401 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29402 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29403 @end smallexample
29404
29405 @noindent
29406 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29407 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29408
29409 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29410 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29411 is of limited use.
29412
29413 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29414 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29415
29416 @subsubheading Synopsis
29417
29418 @smallexample
29419 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29420 @end smallexample
29421
29422 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29423 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29424 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29425 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29426 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29427 watchpoint from a variable object.
29428
29429 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29430 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29431
29432 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29433 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29434 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29435 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29436 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29437 @smallexample
29438 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29439 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29440 @end smallexample
29441
29442 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29443 @findex -var-show-attributes
29444
29445 @subsubheading Synopsis
29446
29447 @smallexample
29448 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29449 @end smallexample
29450
29451 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29452
29453 @smallexample
29454 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29455 @end smallexample
29456
29457 @noindent
29458 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29459
29460 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29461 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29462
29463 @subsubheading Synopsis
29464
29465 @smallexample
29466 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29467 @end smallexample
29468
29469 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29470 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29471 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29472 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29473 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29474 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29475 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29476
29477 @smallexample
29478 value=@var{value}
29479 @end smallexample
29480
29481 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29482 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29483
29484 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29485 @findex -var-assign
29486
29487 @subsubheading Synopsis
29488
29489 @smallexample
29490 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29491 @end smallexample
29492
29493 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29494 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29495 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29496 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29497
29498 @subsubheading Example
29499
29500 @smallexample
29501 (gdb)
29502 -var-assign var1 3
29503 ^done,value="3"
29504 (gdb)
29505 -var-update *
29506 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29507 (gdb)
29508 @end smallexample
29509
29510 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29511 @findex -var-update
29512
29513 @subsubheading Synopsis
29514
29515 @smallexample
29516 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29517 @end smallexample
29518
29519 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29520 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29521 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29522 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29523 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29524 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29525 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29526 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29527 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29528 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29529 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29530 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29531 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29532
29533 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29534 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29535 diagnostic.
29536
29537 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29538 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29539
29540 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29541 @samp{changelist}.
29542
29543 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29544
29545 @table @samp
29546 @item name
29547 The name of the varobj.
29548
29549 @item value
29550 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29551 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29552
29553 @item in_scope
29554 @anchor{-var-update}
29555 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29556
29557 @table @code
29558 @item "true"
29559 The variable object's current value is valid.
29560
29561 @item "false"
29562 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29563 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29564 scope.
29565
29566 @item "invalid"
29567 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29568 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29569 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29570 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29571 objects.
29572 @end table
29573
29574 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29575 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29576
29577 @item type_changed
29578 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29579 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29580 be @samp{false}.
29581
29582 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29583 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29584 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29585 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29586 unset.
29587
29588 @item new_type
29589 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29590 hold the new type.
29591
29592 @item new_num_children
29593 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29594 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29595
29596 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29597 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29598 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29599 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29600 children which may be available.
29601
29602 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29603 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29604 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29605 only happen at the end of the update range).
29606
29607 @item displayhint
29608 The display hint, if any.
29609
29610 @item has_more
29611 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29612 available outside the varobj's update range.
29613
29614 @item dynamic
29615 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29616 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29617 then this attribute will not be present.
29618
29619 @item new_children
29620 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29621 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29622 be listed in this attribute.
29623 @end table
29624
29625 @subsubheading Example
29626
29627 @smallexample
29628 (gdb)
29629 -var-assign var1 3
29630 ^done,value="3"
29631 (gdb)
29632 -var-update --all-values var1
29633 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29634 type_changed="false"@}]
29635 (gdb)
29636 @end smallexample
29637
29638 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29639 @findex -var-set-frozen
29640 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29641
29642 @subsubheading Synopsis
29643
29644 @smallexample
29645 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29646 @end smallexample
29647
29648 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29649 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29650 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29651 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29652 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29653 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29654 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29655 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29656 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29657 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29658 @code{-var-update} does.
29659
29660 @subsubheading Example
29661
29662 @smallexample
29663 (gdb)
29664 -var-set-frozen V 1
29665 ^done
29666 (gdb)
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29670 @findex -var-set-update-range
29671 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29672
29673 @subsubheading Synopsis
29674
29675 @smallexample
29676 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29677 @end smallexample
29678
29679 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29680 @code{-var-update}.
29681
29682 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29683 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29684 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29685 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29686
29687 @subsubheading Example
29688
29689 @smallexample
29690 (gdb)
29691 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29692 ^done
29693 @end smallexample
29694
29695 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29696 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29697 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29698
29699 @subsubheading Synopsis
29700
29701 @smallexample
29702 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29706
29707 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29708 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29709
29710 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29711 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29712 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29713 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29714 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29715 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29716 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29717
29718 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29719 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29720 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29721 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29722
29723 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29724 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29725 can be used to check this.
29726
29727 @subsubheading Example
29728
29729 Resetting the visualizer:
29730
29731 @smallexample
29732 (gdb)
29733 -var-set-visualizer V None
29734 ^done
29735 @end smallexample
29736
29737 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29738
29739 @smallexample
29740 (gdb)
29741 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29742 ^done
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29746 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29747
29748 @smallexample
29749 (gdb)
29750 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29751 ^done
29752 @end smallexample
29753
29754 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29755 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29756 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29757
29758 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29759 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29760 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29761 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29762
29763 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29764 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29765
29766 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29767 @c @subheading -data-assign
29768 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29769 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29770 @c set variable
29771 @c @subsubheading Example
29772 @c N.A.
29773
29774 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29775 @findex -data-disassemble
29776
29777 @subsubheading Synopsis
29778
29779 @smallexample
29780 -data-disassemble
29781 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29782 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29783 -- @var{mode}
29784 @end smallexample
29785
29786 @noindent
29787 Where:
29788
29789 @table @samp
29790 @item @var{start-addr}
29791 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29792 @item @var{end-addr}
29793 is the end address
29794 @item @var{filename}
29795 is the name of the file to disassemble
29796 @item @var{linenum}
29797 is the line number to disassemble around
29798 @item @var{lines}
29799 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29800 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29801 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29802 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29803 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29804 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29805 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29806 are displayed.
29807 @item @var{mode}
29808 is one of:
29809 @itemize @bullet
29810 @item 0 disassembly only
29811 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29812 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29813 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29814 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29815 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29816 @end itemize
29817
29818 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29819 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29820 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29821 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29822 @end table
29823
29824 @subsubheading Result
29825
29826 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29827 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29828 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29829
29830 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29831 following fields:
29832
29833 @table @code
29834 @item address
29835 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29836
29837 @item func-name
29838 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29839
29840 @item offset
29841 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29842
29843 @item inst
29844 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29845
29846 @item opcodes
29847 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
29848 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29849
29850 @end table
29851
29852 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29853 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29854
29855 @table @code
29856 @item line
29857 The line number within @samp{file}.
29858
29859 @item file
29860 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29861 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29862 used.
29863
29864 @item fullname
29865 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29866 using the source file search path
29867 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29868 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29869
29870 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29871 present in the debug information.
29872
29873 @item line_asm_insn
29874 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29875 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29876 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29877 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29878 @samp{opcodes}.
29879
29880 @end table
29881
29882 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29883 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29884 adjust its format.
29885
29886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29887
29888 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29889
29890 @subsubheading Example
29891
29892 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29893
29894 @smallexample
29895 (gdb)
29896 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29897 ^done,
29898 asm_insns=[
29899 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29900 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29901 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29902 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29903 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29904 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29905 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29906 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29907 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29908 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29909 (gdb)
29910 @end smallexample
29911
29912 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29913 @code{main}.
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29917 ^done,asm_insns=[
29918 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29919 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29920 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29921 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29922 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29923 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29924 [@dots{}]
29925 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29926 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29927 (gdb)
29928 @end smallexample
29929
29930 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29931
29932 @smallexample
29933 (gdb)
29934 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29935 ^done,asm_insns=[
29936 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29937 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29938 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29939 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29940 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29941 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29942 (gdb)
29943 @end smallexample
29944
29945 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29946
29947 @smallexample
29948 (gdb)
29949 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29950 ^done,asm_insns=[
29951 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29952 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29953 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29954 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29955 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29956 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29957 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29958 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29959 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29960 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29961 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29962 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29963 (gdb)
29964 @end smallexample
29965
29966
29967 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29968 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29969
29970 @subsubheading Synopsis
29971
29972 @smallexample
29973 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29974 @end smallexample
29975
29976 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29977 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29978 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29979
29980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29981
29982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29983 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29984 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29985
29986 @subsubheading Example
29987
29988 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29989 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29990 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29991 output.
29992
29993 @smallexample
29994 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29995 211^done,value="1"
29996 (gdb)
29997 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29998 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29999 (gdb)
30000 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30001 411^done,value="4"
30002 (gdb)
30003 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30004 511^done,value="4"
30005 (gdb)
30006 @end smallexample
30007
30008
30009 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30010 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30011
30012 @subsubheading Synopsis
30013
30014 @smallexample
30015 -data-list-changed-registers
30016 @end smallexample
30017
30018 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30019
30020 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30021
30022 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30023 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30024
30025 @subsubheading Example
30026
30027 On a PPC MBX board:
30028
30029 @smallexample
30030 (gdb)
30031 -exec-continue
30032 ^running
30033
30034 (gdb)
30035 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30036 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30037 line="5"@}
30038 (gdb)
30039 -data-list-changed-registers
30040 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30041 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30042 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30043 (gdb)
30044 @end smallexample
30045
30046
30047 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30048 @findex -data-list-register-names
30049
30050 @subsubheading Synopsis
30051
30052 @smallexample
30053 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30054 @end smallexample
30055
30056 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30057 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30058 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30059 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30060 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30061 include empty register names.
30062
30063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30064
30065 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30066 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30067 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30068
30069 @subsubheading Example
30070
30071 For the PPC MBX board:
30072 @smallexample
30073 (gdb)
30074 -data-list-register-names
30075 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30076 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30077 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30078 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30079 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30080 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30081 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30082 (gdb)
30083 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30084 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30085 (gdb)
30086 @end smallexample
30087
30088 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30089 @findex -data-list-register-values
30090
30091 @subsubheading Synopsis
30092
30093 @smallexample
30094 -data-list-register-values
30095 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30096 @end smallexample
30097
30098 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30099 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30100 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30101 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30102 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30103 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30104
30105 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30106
30107 @table @code
30108 @item x
30109 Hexadecimal
30110 @item o
30111 Octal
30112 @item t
30113 Binary
30114 @item d
30115 Decimal
30116 @item r
30117 Raw
30118 @item N
30119 Natural
30120 @end table
30121
30122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30123
30124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30125 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30126
30127 @subsubheading Example
30128
30129 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30130 don't appear in the actual output):
30131
30132 @smallexample
30133 (gdb)
30134 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30135 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30136 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30137 (gdb)
30138 -data-list-register-values x
30139 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30140 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30141 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30142 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30143 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30144 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30145 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30146 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30147 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30148 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30149 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30150 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30151 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30152 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30153 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30154 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30155 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30156 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30157 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30158 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30159 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30160 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30161 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30162 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30163 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30164 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30165 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30166 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30167 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30168 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30169 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30170 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30171 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30172 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30173 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30174 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30175 (gdb)
30176 @end smallexample
30177
30178
30179 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30180 @findex -data-read-memory
30181
30182 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30183
30184 @subsubheading Synopsis
30185
30186 @smallexample
30187 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30188 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30189 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30190 @end smallexample
30191
30192 @noindent
30193 where:
30194
30195 @table @samp
30196 @item @var{address}
30197 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30198 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30199 quoted using the C convention.
30200
30201 @item @var{word-format}
30202 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30203 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30204 ,Output Formats}).
30205
30206 @item @var{word-size}
30207 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30208
30209 @item @var{nr-rows}
30210 The number of rows in the output table.
30211
30212 @item @var{nr-cols}
30213 The number of columns in the output table.
30214
30215 @item @var{aschar}
30216 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30217 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30218 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30219 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30220
30221 @item @var{byte-offset}
30222 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30223 @end table
30224
30225 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30226 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30227 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30228 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30229 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30230 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30231 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30232 @samp{addr}.
30233
30234 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30235 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30236 @samp{prev-page}.
30237
30238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30239
30240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30241 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30242
30243 @subsubheading Example
30244
30245 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30246 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30247 word. Display each word in hex.
30248
30249 @smallexample
30250 (gdb)
30251 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30252 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30253 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30254 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30255 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30256 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30257 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30258 (gdb)
30259 @end smallexample
30260
30261 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30262 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30263
30264 @smallexample
30265 (gdb)
30266 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30267 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30268 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30269 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30270 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30271 (gdb)
30272 @end smallexample
30273
30274 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30275 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30276 used as the non-printable character.
30277
30278 @smallexample
30279 (gdb)
30280 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30281 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30282 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30283 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30284 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30285 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30286 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30287 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30288 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30289 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30290 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30291 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30292 (gdb)
30293 @end smallexample
30294
30295 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30296 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30297
30298 @subsubheading Synopsis
30299
30300 @smallexample
30301 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30302 @var{address} @var{count}
30303 @end smallexample
30304
30305 @noindent
30306 where:
30307
30308 @table @samp
30309 @item @var{address}
30310 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30311 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30312 quoted using the C convention.
30313
30314 @item @var{count}
30315 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30316 literal.
30317
30318 @item @var{offset}
30319 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30320 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30321 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30322 arithmetics itself.
30323
30324 @end table
30325
30326 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30327 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30328 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30329 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30330 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30331 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30332
30333 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30334 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30335 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30336 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30337 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30338 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30339 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30340 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30341
30342 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30343 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30344 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30345 and has the following fields:
30346
30347 @table @code
30348 @item begin
30349 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30350
30351 @item end
30352 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30353
30354 @item offset
30355 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30356 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30357
30358 @item contents
30359 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30360
30361 @end table
30362
30363
30364
30365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30366
30367 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30368
30369 @subsubheading Example
30370
30371 @smallexample
30372 (gdb)
30373 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30374 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30375 end="0xbffff15e",
30376 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30377 (gdb)
30378 @end smallexample
30379
30380
30381 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30382 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30383
30384 @subsubheading Synopsis
30385
30386 @smallexample
30387 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30388 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30389 @end smallexample
30390
30391 @noindent
30392 where:
30393
30394 @table @samp
30395 @item @var{address}
30396 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30397 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30398 be quoted using the C convention.
30399
30400 @item @var{contents}
30401 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30402 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30403
30404 @item @var{count}
30405 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30406 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30407 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30408 @var{count} memory units.
30409
30410 @end table
30411
30412 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30413
30414 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30415
30416 @subsubheading Example
30417
30418 @smallexample
30419 (gdb)
30420 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30421 ^done
30422 (gdb)
30423 @end smallexample
30424
30425 @smallexample
30426 (gdb)
30427 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30428 ^done
30429 (gdb)
30430 @end smallexample
30431
30432 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30433 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30434 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30435
30436 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30437 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30438
30439 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30440 @findex -trace-find
30441
30442 @subsubheading Synopsis
30443
30444 @smallexample
30445 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30446 @end smallexample
30447
30448 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30449 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30450 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30451
30452 @table @samp
30453
30454 @item none
30455 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30456
30457 @item frame-number
30458 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30459 that index.
30460
30461 @item tracepoint-number
30462 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30463 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30464
30465 @item pc
30466 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30467 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30468 address.
30469
30470 @item pc-inside-range
30471 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30472 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30473 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30474
30475 @item pc-outside-range
30476 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30477 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30478 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30479
30480 @item line
30481 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30482 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30483 the specified location.
30484
30485 @end table
30486
30487 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30488 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30489
30490 @table @samp
30491 @item found
30492 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30493 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30494
30495 @item traceframe
30496 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30497 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30498
30499 @item tracepoint
30500 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30501 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30502
30503 @item frame
30504 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30505 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30506 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30507
30508 @end table
30509
30510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30511
30512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30513
30514 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30515 @findex -trace-define-variable
30516
30517 @subsubheading Synopsis
30518
30519 @smallexample
30520 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30521 @end smallexample
30522
30523 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30524 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30525 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30526 with the @samp{$} character.
30527
30528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30529
30530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30531
30532 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30533 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30534
30535 @subsubheading Synopsis
30536
30537 @smallexample
30538 -trace-frame-collected
30539 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30540 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30541 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30542 [--memory-contents]
30543 @end smallexample
30544
30545 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30546 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30547 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30548 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30549 See the output description table below for more details.
30550
30551 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30552 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30553 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30554 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30555 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30556
30557 For instance, if the actions were
30558 @smallexample
30559 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30560 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30561 @end smallexample
30562
30563 @noindent
30564 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30565 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30566 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30567 objects would be computed expressions.
30568
30569 An example output would be:
30570
30571 @smallexample
30572 (gdb)
30573 -trace-frame-collected
30574 ^done,
30575 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30576 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30577 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30578 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30579 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30580 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30581 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30582 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30583 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30584 ...
30585 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30586 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30587 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30588 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30589 (gdb)
30590 @end smallexample
30591
30592 Where:
30593
30594 @table @code
30595 @item explicit-variables
30596 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30597 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30598 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30599 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30600 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30601 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30602 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30603 arrays, structures and unions.
30604
30605 @item computed-expressions
30606 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30607 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30608 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30609 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30610
30611 @item registers
30612 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30613 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30614 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30615 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30616 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30617
30618 @item tvars
30619 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30620 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30621 current value are returned.
30622
30623 @item memory
30624 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30625 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30626 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30627
30628 @table @code
30629 @item address
30630 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30631
30632 @item length
30633 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30634
30635 @item contents
30636 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30637 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30638
30639 @end table
30640
30641 @end table
30642
30643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30644
30645 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30646
30647 @subsubheading Example
30648
30649 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30650 @findex -trace-list-variables
30651
30652 @subsubheading Synopsis
30653
30654 @smallexample
30655 -trace-list-variables
30656 @end smallexample
30657
30658 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30659 table has the following fields:
30660
30661 @table @samp
30662 @item name
30663 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30664
30665 @item initial
30666 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30667 field is always present.
30668
30669 @item current
30670 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30671 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30672 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30673 presently running.
30674
30675 @end table
30676
30677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30678
30679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30680
30681 @subsubheading Example
30682
30683 @smallexample
30684 (gdb)
30685 -trace-list-variables
30686 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30687 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30688 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30689 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30690 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30691 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30692 (gdb)
30693 @end smallexample
30694
30695 @subheading -trace-save
30696 @findex -trace-save
30697
30698 @subsubheading Synopsis
30699
30700 @smallexample
30701 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30702 @end smallexample
30703
30704 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30705 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30706 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30707 to perform the save.
30708
30709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30710
30711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30712
30713
30714 @subheading -trace-start
30715 @findex -trace-start
30716
30717 @subsubheading Synopsis
30718
30719 @smallexample
30720 -trace-start
30721 @end smallexample
30722
30723 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30724 have any fields.
30725
30726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30727
30728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30729
30730 @subheading -trace-status
30731 @findex -trace-status
30732
30733 @subsubheading Synopsis
30734
30735 @smallexample
30736 -trace-status
30737 @end smallexample
30738
30739 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30740 the following fields:
30741
30742 @table @samp
30743
30744 @item supported
30745 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30746 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30747 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30748 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30749 started. This field is always present.
30750
30751 @item running
30752 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30753 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30754 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30755
30756 @item stop-reason
30757 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30758 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30759 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30760 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30761 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30762 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30763 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30764 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30765 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30766
30767 @item stopping-tracepoint
30768 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30769 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30770 @samp{passcount}.
30771
30772 @item frames
30773 @itemx frames-created
30774 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30775 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30776 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30777 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30778
30779 @item buffer-size
30780 @itemx buffer-free
30781 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30782 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30783
30784 @item circular
30785 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30786 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30787 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30788 and may fill up.
30789
30790 @item disconnected
30791 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30792 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30793 that the trace run will stop.
30794
30795 @item trace-file
30796 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30797 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30798
30799 @end table
30800
30801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30802
30803 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30804
30805 @subheading -trace-stop
30806 @findex -trace-stop
30807
30808 @subsubheading Synopsis
30809
30810 @smallexample
30811 -trace-stop
30812 @end smallexample
30813
30814 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30815 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30816 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30817
30818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30819
30820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30821
30822
30823 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30824 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30825 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30826
30827
30828 @ignore
30829 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30830 @findex -symbol-info-address
30831
30832 @subsubheading Synopsis
30833
30834 @smallexample
30835 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30836 @end smallexample
30837
30838 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30839
30840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30841
30842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30843
30844 @subsubheading Example
30845 N.A.
30846
30847
30848 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30849 @findex -symbol-info-file
30850
30851 @subsubheading Synopsis
30852
30853 @smallexample
30854 -symbol-info-file
30855 @end smallexample
30856
30857 Show the file for the symbol.
30858
30859 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30860
30861 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30862 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30863
30864 @subsubheading Example
30865 N.A.
30866
30867
30868 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30869 @findex -symbol-info-function
30870
30871 @subsubheading Synopsis
30872
30873 @smallexample
30874 -symbol-info-function
30875 @end smallexample
30876
30877 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30878
30879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30880
30881 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30882
30883 @subsubheading Example
30884 N.A.
30885
30886
30887 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30888 @findex -symbol-info-line
30889
30890 @subsubheading Synopsis
30891
30892 @smallexample
30893 -symbol-info-line
30894 @end smallexample
30895
30896 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30897
30898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30899
30900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30901 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30902
30903 @subsubheading Example
30904 N.A.
30905
30906
30907 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30908 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30909
30910 @subsubheading Synopsis
30911
30912 @smallexample
30913 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30914 @end smallexample
30915
30916 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30917
30918 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30919
30920 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30921
30922 @subsubheading Example
30923 N.A.
30924
30925
30926 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30927 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30928
30929 @subsubheading Synopsis
30930
30931 @smallexample
30932 -symbol-list-functions
30933 @end smallexample
30934
30935 List the functions in the executable.
30936
30937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30938
30939 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30940 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30941
30942 @subsubheading Example
30943 N.A.
30944 @end ignore
30945
30946
30947 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30948 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30949
30950 @subsubheading Synopsis
30951
30952 @smallexample
30953 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30954 @end smallexample
30955
30956 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30957 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30958 ascending PC order.
30959
30960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30961
30962 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30963
30964 @subsubheading Example
30965 @smallexample
30966 (gdb)
30967 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30968 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30969 (gdb)
30970 @end smallexample
30971
30972
30973 @ignore
30974 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30975 @findex -symbol-list-types
30976
30977 @subsubheading Synopsis
30978
30979 @smallexample
30980 -symbol-list-types
30981 @end smallexample
30982
30983 List all the type names.
30984
30985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30986
30987 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30988 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30989
30990 @subsubheading Example
30991 N.A.
30992
30993
30994 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30995 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30996
30997 @subsubheading Synopsis
30998
30999 @smallexample
31000 -symbol-list-variables
31001 @end smallexample
31002
31003 List all the global and static variable names.
31004
31005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31006
31007 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31008
31009 @subsubheading Example
31010 N.A.
31011
31012
31013 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31014 @findex -symbol-locate
31015
31016 @subsubheading Synopsis
31017
31018 @smallexample
31019 -symbol-locate
31020 @end smallexample
31021
31022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31023
31024 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31025
31026 @subsubheading Example
31027 N.A.
31028
31029
31030 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31031 @findex -symbol-type
31032
31033 @subsubheading Synopsis
31034
31035 @smallexample
31036 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31037 @end smallexample
31038
31039 Show type of @var{variable}.
31040
31041 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31042
31043 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31044 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31045
31046 @subsubheading Example
31047 N.A.
31048 @end ignore
31049
31050
31051 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31052 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31053 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31054
31055 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31056 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31057
31058 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31059 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31060
31061 @subsubheading Synopsis
31062
31063 @smallexample
31064 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31065 @end smallexample
31066
31067 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31068 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31069 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31070 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31071 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31072 notification.
31073
31074 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31075
31076 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31077
31078 @subsubheading Example
31079
31080 @smallexample
31081 (gdb)
31082 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31083 ^done
31084 (gdb)
31085 @end smallexample
31086
31087
31088 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31089 @findex -file-exec-file
31090
31091 @subsubheading Synopsis
31092
31093 @smallexample
31094 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31095 @end smallexample
31096
31097 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31098 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31099 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31100 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31101 notification.
31102
31103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31104
31105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31106
31107 @subsubheading Example
31108
31109 @smallexample
31110 (gdb)
31111 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31112 ^done
31113 (gdb)
31114 @end smallexample
31115
31116
31117 @ignore
31118 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31119 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31120
31121 @subsubheading Synopsis
31122
31123 @smallexample
31124 -file-list-exec-sections
31125 @end smallexample
31126
31127 List the sections of the current executable file.
31128
31129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31130
31131 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31132 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31133 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31134
31135 @subsubheading Example
31136 N.A.
31137 @end ignore
31138
31139
31140 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31141 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31142
31143 @subsubheading Synopsis
31144
31145 @smallexample
31146 -file-list-exec-source-file
31147 @end smallexample
31148
31149 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31150 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31151 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31152 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31153
31154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31155
31156 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31157
31158 @subsubheading Example
31159
31160 @smallexample
31161 (gdb)
31162 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31163 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31164 (gdb)
31165 @end smallexample
31166
31167
31168 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31169 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31170
31171 @subsubheading Synopsis
31172
31173 @smallexample
31174 -file-list-exec-source-files
31175 @end smallexample
31176
31177 List the source files for the current executable.
31178
31179 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31180 name) of a source file.
31181
31182 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31183
31184 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31185 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31186
31187 @subsubheading Example
31188 @smallexample
31189 (gdb)
31190 -file-list-exec-source-files
31191 ^done,files=[
31192 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31193 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31194 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31195 (gdb)
31196 @end smallexample
31197
31198 @ignore
31199 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31200 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31201
31202 @subsubheading Synopsis
31203
31204 @smallexample
31205 -file-list-shared-libraries
31206 @end smallexample
31207
31208 List the shared libraries in the program.
31209
31210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31211
31212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31213
31214 @subsubheading Example
31215 N.A.
31216
31217
31218 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31219 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31220
31221 @subsubheading Synopsis
31222
31223 @smallexample
31224 -file-list-symbol-files
31225 @end smallexample
31226
31227 List symbol files.
31228
31229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31230
31231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31232
31233 @subsubheading Example
31234 N.A.
31235 @end ignore
31236
31237
31238 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31239 @findex -file-symbol-file
31240
31241 @subsubheading Synopsis
31242
31243 @smallexample
31244 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31245 @end smallexample
31246
31247 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31248 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31249 produced, except for a completion notification.
31250
31251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31252
31253 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31254
31255 @subsubheading Example
31256
31257 @smallexample
31258 (gdb)
31259 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31260 ^done
31261 (gdb)
31262 @end smallexample
31263
31264 @ignore
31265 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31266 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31267 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31268
31269 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31270
31271 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31272
31273 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31274
31275 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31276
31277 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31278
31279 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31280
31281 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31282
31283 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31284
31285 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31286 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31287 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31288
31289 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31290
31291 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31292
31293 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31294
31295 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31296 @end ignore
31297
31298
31299 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31300 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31301 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31302
31303
31304 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31305 @findex -target-attach
31306
31307 @subsubheading Synopsis
31308
31309 @smallexample
31310 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31311 @end smallexample
31312
31313 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31314 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31315 group, the id previously returned by
31316 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31317
31318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31319
31320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31321
31322 @subsubheading Example
31323 @smallexample
31324 (gdb)
31325 -target-attach 34
31326 =thread-created,id="1"
31327 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31328 ^done
31329 (gdb)
31330 @end smallexample
31331
31332 @ignore
31333 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31334 @findex -target-compare-sections
31335
31336 @subsubheading Synopsis
31337
31338 @smallexample
31339 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31340 @end smallexample
31341
31342 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31343 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31344
31345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31346
31347 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31348
31349 @subsubheading Example
31350 N.A.
31351 @end ignore
31352
31353
31354 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31355 @findex -target-detach
31356
31357 @subsubheading Synopsis
31358
31359 @smallexample
31360 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31361 @end smallexample
31362
31363 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31364 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31365 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31366
31367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31368
31369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31370
31371 @subsubheading Example
31372
31373 @smallexample
31374 (gdb)
31375 -target-detach
31376 ^done
31377 (gdb)
31378 @end smallexample
31379
31380
31381 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31382 @findex -target-disconnect
31383
31384 @subsubheading Synopsis
31385
31386 @smallexample
31387 -target-disconnect
31388 @end smallexample
31389
31390 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31391 generally not resumed.
31392
31393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31394
31395 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31396
31397 @subsubheading Example
31398
31399 @smallexample
31400 (gdb)
31401 -target-disconnect
31402 ^done
31403 (gdb)
31404 @end smallexample
31405
31406
31407 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31408 @findex -target-download
31409
31410 @subsubheading Synopsis
31411
31412 @smallexample
31413 -target-download
31414 @end smallexample
31415
31416 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31417 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31418
31419 @table @samp
31420 @item section
31421 The name of the section.
31422 @item section-sent
31423 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31424 @item section-size
31425 The size of the section.
31426 @item total-sent
31427 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31428 @item total-size
31429 The size of the overall executable to download.
31430 @end table
31431
31432 @noindent
31433 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31434 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31435
31436 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31437 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31438
31439 @table @samp
31440 @item section
31441 The name of the section.
31442 @item section-size
31443 The size of the section.
31444 @item total-size
31445 The size of the overall executable to download.
31446 @end table
31447
31448 @noindent
31449 At the end, a summary is printed.
31450
31451 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31452
31453 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31454
31455 @subsubheading Example
31456
31457 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31458 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31459
31460 @smallexample
31461 (gdb)
31462 -target-download
31463 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31464 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31465 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31466 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31467 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31468 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31469 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31470 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31471 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31472 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31473 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31474 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31475 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31476 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31477 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31478 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31479 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31480 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31481 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31482 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31483 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31484 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31485 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31486 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31487 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31488 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31489 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31490 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31491 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31492 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31493 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31494 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31495 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31496 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31497 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31498 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31499 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31500 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31501 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31502 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31503 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31504 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31505 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31506 write-rate="429"
31507 (gdb)
31508 @end smallexample
31509
31510
31511 @ignore
31512 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31513 @findex -target-exec-status
31514
31515 @subsubheading Synopsis
31516
31517 @smallexample
31518 -target-exec-status
31519 @end smallexample
31520
31521 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31522 not, for instance).
31523
31524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31525
31526 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31527
31528 @subsubheading Example
31529 N.A.
31530
31531
31532 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31533 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31534
31535 @subsubheading Synopsis
31536
31537 @smallexample
31538 -target-list-available-targets
31539 @end smallexample
31540
31541 List the possible targets to connect to.
31542
31543 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31544
31545 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31546
31547 @subsubheading Example
31548 N.A.
31549
31550
31551 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31552 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31553
31554 @subsubheading Synopsis
31555
31556 @smallexample
31557 -target-list-current-targets
31558 @end smallexample
31559
31560 Describe the current target.
31561
31562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31563
31564 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31565 other things).
31566
31567 @subsubheading Example
31568 N.A.
31569
31570
31571 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31572 @findex -target-list-parameters
31573
31574 @subsubheading Synopsis
31575
31576 @smallexample
31577 -target-list-parameters
31578 @end smallexample
31579
31580 @c ????
31581 @end ignore
31582
31583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31584
31585 No equivalent.
31586
31587 @subsubheading Example
31588 N.A.
31589
31590
31591 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31592 @findex -target-select
31593
31594 @subsubheading Synopsis
31595
31596 @smallexample
31597 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31598 @end smallexample
31599
31600 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31601
31602 @table @samp
31603 @item @var{type}
31604 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31605 @item @var{parameters}
31606 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31607 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31608 @end table
31609
31610 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31611 which the target program is, in the following form:
31612
31613 @smallexample
31614 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31615 args=[@var{arg list}]
31616 @end smallexample
31617
31618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31619
31620 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31621
31622 @subsubheading Example
31623
31624 @smallexample
31625 (gdb)
31626 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31627 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31628 (gdb)
31629 @end smallexample
31630
31631 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31632 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31633 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31634
31635
31636 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31637 @findex -target-file-put
31638
31639 @subsubheading Synopsis
31640
31641 @smallexample
31642 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31643 @end smallexample
31644
31645 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31646 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31647
31648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31649
31650 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31651
31652 @subsubheading Example
31653
31654 @smallexample
31655 (gdb)
31656 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31657 ^done
31658 (gdb)
31659 @end smallexample
31660
31661
31662 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31663 @findex -target-file-get
31664
31665 @subsubheading Synopsis
31666
31667 @smallexample
31668 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31669 @end smallexample
31670
31671 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31672 on the host system.
31673
31674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31675
31676 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31677
31678 @subsubheading Example
31679
31680 @smallexample
31681 (gdb)
31682 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31683 ^done
31684 (gdb)
31685 @end smallexample
31686
31687
31688 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31689 @findex -target-file-delete
31690
31691 @subsubheading Synopsis
31692
31693 @smallexample
31694 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31695 @end smallexample
31696
31697 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31698
31699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31700
31701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31702
31703 @subsubheading Example
31704
31705 @smallexample
31706 (gdb)
31707 -target-file-delete remotefile
31708 ^done
31709 (gdb)
31710 @end smallexample
31711
31712
31713 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31714 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31715 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31716
31717 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31718 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31719
31720 @subsubheading Synopsis
31721
31722 @smallexample
31723 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31724 @end smallexample
31725
31726 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31727 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31728 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31729
31730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31731
31732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31733
31734 @subsubheading Result
31735
31736 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31737 defined for each exception:
31738
31739 @table @samp
31740 @item name
31741 The name of the exception.
31742
31743 @item address
31744 The address of the exception.
31745
31746 @end table
31747
31748 @subsubheading Example
31749
31750 @smallexample
31751 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31752 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31753 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31754 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31755 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31756 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31757 @end smallexample
31758
31759 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31760
31761 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31762 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31763 Catchpoint Commands}.
31764
31765
31766 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31767 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31768 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31769
31770 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31771 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31772 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31773 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31774
31775 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31776 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31777 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31778
31779 @subsubheading Synopsis
31780
31781 @smallexample
31782 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31783 @end smallexample
31784
31785 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31786
31787 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31788 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31789 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31790 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31791 dash.
31792
31793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31794
31795 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31796
31797 @subsubheading Result
31798
31799 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31800
31801 @table @samp
31802 @item exists
31803 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31804 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31805
31806 @end table
31807
31808 @subsubheading Example
31809
31810 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31811
31812 @smallexample
31813 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31814 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31815 @end smallexample
31816
31817 @noindent
31818 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31819 to the debugger:
31820
31821 @smallexample
31822 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31823 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31824 @end smallexample
31825
31826 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31827 @findex -list-features
31828 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31829
31830 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31831 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31832 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31833 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31834 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31835 startup.
31836
31837 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31838 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31839 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31840 is given below.
31841
31842 Example output:
31843
31844 @smallexample
31845 (gdb) -list-features
31846 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31847 @end smallexample
31848
31849 The current list of features is:
31850
31851 @ftable @samp
31852 @item frozen-varobjs
31853 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31854 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31855 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31856 @item pending-breakpoints
31857 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31858 command.
31859 @item python
31860 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31861 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31862 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31863 @item thread-info
31864 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31865 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31866 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31867 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31868 @item breakpoint-notifications
31869 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31870 CLI will be announced via async records.
31871 @item ada-task-info
31872 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31873 @item language-option
31874 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31875 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31876 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31877 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31878 @item undefined-command-error-code
31879 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31880 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31881 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31882 @item exec-run-start-option
31883 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31884 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31885 @end ftable
31886
31887 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31888 @findex -list-target-features
31889
31890 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31891 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31892 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31893 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31894 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31895 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31896 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31897 Example output:
31898
31899 @smallexample
31900 (gdb) -list-target-features
31901 ^done,result=["async"]
31902 @end smallexample
31903
31904 The current list of features is:
31905
31906 @table @samp
31907 @item async
31908 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31909 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31910 while the target is running.
31911
31912 @item reverse
31913 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31914 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31915
31916 @end table
31917
31918 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31919 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31920 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31921
31922 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31923
31924 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31925 @findex -gdb-exit
31926
31927 @subsubheading Synopsis
31928
31929 @smallexample
31930 -gdb-exit
31931 @end smallexample
31932
31933 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31934
31935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31936
31937 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31938
31939 @subsubheading Example
31940
31941 @smallexample
31942 (gdb)
31943 -gdb-exit
31944 ^exit
31945 @end smallexample
31946
31947
31948 @ignore
31949 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31950 @findex -exec-abort
31951
31952 @subsubheading Synopsis
31953
31954 @smallexample
31955 -exec-abort
31956 @end smallexample
31957
31958 Kill the inferior running program.
31959
31960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31961
31962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31963
31964 @subsubheading Example
31965 N.A.
31966 @end ignore
31967
31968
31969 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31970 @findex -gdb-set
31971
31972 @subsubheading Synopsis
31973
31974 @smallexample
31975 -gdb-set
31976 @end smallexample
31977
31978 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31979 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31980
31981 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31982
31983 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31984
31985 @subsubheading Example
31986
31987 @smallexample
31988 (gdb)
31989 -gdb-set $foo=3
31990 ^done
31991 (gdb)
31992 @end smallexample
31993
31994
31995 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31996 @findex -gdb-show
31997
31998 @subsubheading Synopsis
31999
32000 @smallexample
32001 -gdb-show
32002 @end smallexample
32003
32004 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32005
32006 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32007
32008 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32009
32010 @subsubheading Example
32011
32012 @smallexample
32013 (gdb)
32014 -gdb-show annotate
32015 ^done,value="0"
32016 (gdb)
32017 @end smallexample
32018
32019 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32020
32021
32022 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32023 @findex -gdb-version
32024
32025 @subsubheading Synopsis
32026
32027 @smallexample
32028 -gdb-version
32029 @end smallexample
32030
32031 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32032
32033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32034
32035 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32036 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32037
32038 @subsubheading Example
32039
32040 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32041 @c box in TeX.
32042 @smallexample
32043 (gdb)
32044 -gdb-version
32045 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32046 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32047 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32048 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32049 ~ certain conditions.
32050 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32051 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32052 ~ details.
32053 ~This GDB was configured as
32054 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32055 ^done
32056 (gdb)
32057 @end smallexample
32058
32059 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32060 @findex -list-thread-groups
32061
32062 @subheading Synopsis
32063
32064 @smallexample
32065 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32066 @end smallexample
32067
32068 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32069 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32070 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32071 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32072 top-level thread groups.
32073
32074 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32075 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32076 available on the target.
32077
32078 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32079 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32080 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32081 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32082 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32083 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32084 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32085 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32086
32087 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32088 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32089 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32090 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32091 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32092 @samp{threads} field.
32093
32094 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32095 the following caveats:
32096
32097 @itemize @bullet
32098 @item
32099 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32100 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32101 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32102
32103 @item
32104 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32105 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32106 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32107 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32108 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32109 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32110
32111 @end itemize
32112
32113 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32114 have the following fields:
32115
32116 @table @code
32117 @item id
32118 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32119 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32120 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32121
32122 @item type
32123 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32124 valid type.
32125
32126 @item pid
32127 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32128 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32129
32130 @item exit-code
32131 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32132 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32133 only if the process is not running.
32134
32135 @item num_children
32136 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32137 absent for an available thread group.
32138
32139 @item threads
32140 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32141 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32142 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32143
32144 @item cores
32145 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32146 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32147 such information is not available.
32148
32149 @item executable
32150 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32151 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32152 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32153
32154 @end table
32155
32156 @subheading Example
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 @value{GDBP}
32160 -list-thread-groups
32161 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32162 -list-thread-groups 17
32163 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32164 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32165 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32166 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32167 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32168 -list-thread-groups --available
32169 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32170 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32171 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32172 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32173 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32174 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32175 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32176 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32177 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32178 @end smallexample
32179
32180 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32181 @findex -info-os
32182
32183 @subsubheading Synopsis
32184
32185 @smallexample
32186 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32187 @end smallexample
32188
32189 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32190 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32191 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32192 of data of that type.
32193
32194 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32195 system.
32196
32197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32198
32199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32200
32201 @subsubheading Example
32202
32203 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32204 like this:
32205
32206 @smallexample
32207 @value{GDBP}
32208 -info-os
32209 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32210 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32211 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32212 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32213 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32214 col2="CPUs"@},
32215 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32216 col2="File descriptors"@},
32217 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32218 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32219 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32220 col2="Message queues"@},
32221 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32222 col2="Processes"@},
32223 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32224 col2="Process groups"@},
32225 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32226 col2="Semaphores"@},
32227 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32228 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32229 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32230 col2="Sockets"@},
32231 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32232 col2="Threads"@}]
32233 @value{GDBP}
32234 -info-os processes
32235 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32236 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32237 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32238 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32239 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32240 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32241 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32242 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32243 ...
32244 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32245 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32246 (gdb)
32247 @end smallexample
32248
32249 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32250 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32251 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32252 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32253 @code{info os} omits it.)
32254
32255 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32256 @findex -add-inferior
32257
32258 @subheading Synopsis
32259
32260 @smallexample
32261 -add-inferior
32262 @end smallexample
32263
32264 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32265 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32266 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32267 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32268 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32269 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32270
32271 @subheading Example
32272
32273 @smallexample
32274 @value{GDBP}
32275 -add-inferior
32276 ^done,inferior="i3"
32277 @end smallexample
32278
32279 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32280 @findex -interpreter-exec
32281
32282 @subheading Synopsis
32283
32284 @smallexample
32285 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32286 @end smallexample
32287 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32288
32289 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32290
32291 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32292
32293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32294
32295 @subheading Example
32296
32297 @smallexample
32298 (gdb)
32299 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32300 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32301 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32302 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32303 ^done
32304 (gdb)
32305 @end smallexample
32306
32307 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32308 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32309
32310 @subheading Synopsis
32311
32312 @smallexample
32313 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32314 @end smallexample
32315
32316 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32317
32318 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32319
32320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32321
32322 @subheading Example
32323
32324 @smallexample
32325 (gdb)
32326 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32327 ^done
32328 (gdb)
32329 @end smallexample
32330
32331 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32332 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32333
32334 @subheading Synopsis
32335
32336 @smallexample
32337 -inferior-tty-show
32338 @end smallexample
32339
32340 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32341
32342 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32343
32344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32345
32346 @subheading Example
32347
32348 @smallexample
32349 (gdb)
32350 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32351 ^done
32352 (gdb)
32353 -inferior-tty-show
32354 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32355 (gdb)
32356 @end smallexample
32357
32358 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32359 @findex -enable-timings
32360
32361 @subheading Synopsis
32362
32363 @smallexample
32364 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32365 @end smallexample
32366
32367 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32368 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32369 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32370 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32371
32372 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32373
32374 No equivalent.
32375
32376 @subheading Example
32377
32378 @smallexample
32379 (gdb)
32380 -enable-timings
32381 ^done
32382 (gdb)
32383 -break-insert main
32384 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32385 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32386 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32387 times="0"@},
32388 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32389 (gdb)
32390 -enable-timings no
32391 ^done
32392 (gdb)
32393 -exec-run
32394 ^running
32395 (gdb)
32396 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32397 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32398 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32399 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32400 (gdb)
32401 @end smallexample
32402
32403 @node Annotations
32404 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32405
32406 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32407 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32408 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32409 relatively high level.
32410
32411 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32412 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32413
32414 @ignore
32415 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32416 @end ignore
32417
32418 @menu
32419 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32420 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32421 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32422 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32423 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32424 * Annotations for Running::
32425 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32426 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32427 @end menu
32428
32429 @node Annotations Overview
32430 @section What is an Annotation?
32431 @cindex annotations
32432
32433 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32434 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32435 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32436 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32437 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32438 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32439 cannot contain newline characters.
32440
32441 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32442 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32443 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32444 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32445 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32446 means those three characters as output.
32447
32448 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32449 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32450 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32451 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32452 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32453 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32454 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32455 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32456 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32457
32458 @table @code
32459 @kindex set annotate
32460 @item set annotate @var{level}
32461 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32462 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32463
32464 @item show annotate
32465 @kindex show annotate
32466 Show the current annotation level.
32467 @end table
32468
32469 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32470
32471 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32472
32473 @smallexample
32474 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32475 GNU gdb 6.0
32476 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32477 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32478 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32479 under certain conditions.
32480 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32481 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32482 for details.
32483 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32484
32485 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32486 (@value{GDBP})
32487 ^Z^Zprompt
32488 @kbd{quit}
32489
32490 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32491 $
32492 @end smallexample
32493
32494 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32495 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32496 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32497 output from @value{GDBN}.
32498
32499 @node Server Prefix
32500 @section The Server Prefix
32501 @cindex server prefix
32502
32503 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32504 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32505 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32506 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32507 a transparent manner.
32508
32509 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32510 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32511 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32512 @code{print} command.
32513
32514 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32515 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32516
32517 @node Prompting
32518 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32519
32520 @cindex annotations for prompts
32521 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32522 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32523 over, etc.
32524
32525 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32526 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32527 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32528 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32529 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32530 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32531 features the following annotations:
32532
32533 @smallexample
32534 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32535 ^Z^Zprompt
32536 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32537 @end smallexample
32538
32539 The input types are
32540
32541 @table @code
32542 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32543 @findex prompt annotation
32544 @findex post-prompt annotation
32545 @item prompt
32546 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32547
32548 @findex pre-commands annotation
32549 @findex commands annotation
32550 @findex post-commands annotation
32551 @item commands
32552 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32553 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32554
32555 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32556 @findex overload-choice annotation
32557 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32558 @item overload-choice
32559 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32560
32561 @findex pre-query annotation
32562 @findex query annotation
32563 @findex post-query annotation
32564 @item query
32565 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32566
32567 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32568 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32569 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32570 @item prompt-for-continue
32571 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32572 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32573 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32574 presence of annotations.
32575 @end table
32576
32577 @node Errors
32578 @section Errors
32579 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32580
32581 @findex quit annotation
32582 @smallexample
32583 ^Z^Zquit
32584 @end smallexample
32585
32586 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32587
32588 @findex error annotation
32589 @smallexample
32590 ^Z^Zerror
32591 @end smallexample
32592
32593 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32594
32595 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32596 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32597 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32598 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32599 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32600 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32601 to the top level.
32602
32603 @findex error-begin annotation
32604 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32605
32606 @smallexample
32607 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32608 @end smallexample
32609
32610 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32611 message.
32612
32613 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32614 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32615 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32616
32617 @node Invalidation
32618 @section Invalidation Notices
32619
32620 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32621 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32622 changed.
32623
32624 @table @code
32625 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32626 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32627
32628 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32629 have changed.
32630
32631 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32632 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32633
32634 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32635 deleted a breakpoint.
32636 @end table
32637
32638 @node Annotations for Running
32639 @section Running the Program
32640 @cindex annotations for running programs
32641
32642 @findex starting annotation
32643 @findex stopping annotation
32644 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32645 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32646
32647 @smallexample
32648 ^Z^Zstarting
32649 @end smallexample
32650
32651 is output. When the program stops,
32652
32653 @smallexample
32654 ^Z^Zstopped
32655 @end smallexample
32656
32657 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32658 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32659
32660 @table @code
32661 @findex exited annotation
32662 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32663 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32664 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32665
32666 @findex signalled annotation
32667 @findex signal-name annotation
32668 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32669 @findex signal-string annotation
32670 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32671 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32672 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32673 annotation continues:
32674
32675 @smallexample
32676 @var{intro-text}
32677 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32678 @var{name}
32679 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32680 @var{middle-text}
32681 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32682 @var{string}
32683 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32684 @var{end-text}
32685 @end smallexample
32686
32687 @noindent
32688 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32689 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32690 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32691 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32692 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32693
32694 @findex signal annotation
32695 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32696 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32697 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32698 terminated with it.
32699
32700 @findex breakpoint annotation
32701 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32702 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32703
32704 @findex watchpoint annotation
32705 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32706 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32707 @end table
32708
32709 @node Source Annotations
32710 @section Displaying Source
32711 @cindex annotations for source display
32712
32713 @findex source annotation
32714 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32715
32716 @smallexample
32717 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32718 @end smallexample
32719
32720 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32721 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32722 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32723 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32724 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32725 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32726 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32727 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32728 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32729 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32730 depend on the language).
32731
32732 @node JIT Interface
32733 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32734 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32735 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32736
32737 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32738 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32739 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32740 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32741
32742 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32743 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32744 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32745 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32746 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32747 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32748
32749 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32750 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32751 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32752 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32753 LLVM JIT.
32754
32755 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32756 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32757 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32758 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32759 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32760 out about additional code.
32761
32762 @menu
32763 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32764 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32765 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32766 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32767 @end menu
32768
32769 @node Declarations
32770 @section JIT Declarations
32771
32772 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32773 implement the interface:
32774
32775 @smallexample
32776 typedef enum
32777 @{
32778 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32779 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32780 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32781 @} jit_actions_t;
32782
32783 struct jit_code_entry
32784 @{
32785 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32786 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32787 const char *symfile_addr;
32788 uint64_t symfile_size;
32789 @};
32790
32791 struct jit_descriptor
32792 @{
32793 uint32_t version;
32794 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32795 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32796 uint32_t action_flag;
32797 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32798 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32799 @};
32800
32801 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32802 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32803
32804 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32805 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32806 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32807 @end smallexample
32808
32809 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32810 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32811 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32812
32813 @node Registering Code
32814 @section Registering Code
32815
32816 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32817
32818 @itemize @bullet
32819 @item
32820 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32821 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32822
32823 @item
32824 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32825 file.
32826
32827 @item
32828 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32829
32830 @item
32831 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32832
32833 @item
32834 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32835 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32836 @end itemize
32837
32838 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32839 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32840 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32841 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32842
32843 @node Unregistering Code
32844 @section Unregistering Code
32845
32846 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32847
32848 @itemize @bullet
32849 @item
32850 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32851
32852 @item
32853 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32854
32855 @item
32856 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32857 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32858 @end itemize
32859
32860 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32861 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32862
32863 @node Custom Debug Info
32864 @section Custom Debug Info
32865 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32866 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32867
32868 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32869 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32870 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32871 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32872 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32873 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32874 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32875 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32876 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32877
32878 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32879 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32880 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32881 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32882 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32883 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32884 compiler.
32885
32886 @menu
32887 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32888 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32889 @end menu
32890
32891 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32892 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32893 @kindex jit-reader-load
32894 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32895
32896 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32897 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32898
32899 @table @code
32900 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32901 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32902 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32903 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32904 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32905 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32906 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32907
32908 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32909 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32910 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32911 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32912 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32913
32914 @item jit-reader-unload
32915 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32916
32917 @end table
32918
32919 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32920 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32921 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32922
32923 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32924 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32925
32926 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32927 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32928 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32929 the system include directory.
32930
32931 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32932 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32933 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32934
32935 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32936 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32937
32938 @findex gdb_init_reader
32939 @smallexample
32940 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32941 @end smallexample
32942
32943 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32944
32945 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32946 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32947 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32948 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32949 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32950 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32951
32952 @smallexample
32953 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32954 @{
32955 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32956 int reader_version;
32957
32958 /* For use by the reader. */
32959 void *priv_data;
32960
32961 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32962 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32963 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32964 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32965 @};
32966 @end smallexample
32967
32968 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32969 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32970
32971 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32972 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32973 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32974 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32975 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32976 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32977 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32978 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32979 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32980 target's address space.
32981
32982 @node In-Process Agent
32983 @chapter In-Process Agent
32984 @cindex debugging agent
32985 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32986 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32987 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32988 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32989 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32990 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32991 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32992 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32993 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32994 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32995 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32996 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32997 behavior without interrupting it.
32998
32999 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33000 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33001 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33002 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33003 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33004 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33005 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33006 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33007 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33008
33009 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33010 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33011 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33012 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33013
33014 @anchor{Control Agent}
33015 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33016 debugging with the following commands:
33017
33018 @table @code
33019 @kindex set agent on
33020 @item set agent on
33021 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33022 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33023 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33024 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33025 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33026 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33027
33028 @kindex set agent off
33029 @item set agent off
33030 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33031 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33032
33033 @kindex show agent
33034 @item show agent
33035 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33036 the in-process agent.
33037 @end table
33038
33039 @menu
33040 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33041 @end menu
33042
33043 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33044 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33045 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33046
33047 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33048 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33049 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33050 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33051 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33052 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33053 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33054 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33055 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33056
33057 @menu
33058 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33059 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33060 @end menu
33061
33062 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33063 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33064 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33065
33066 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33067 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33068
33069 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33070 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33071 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33072 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33073
33074 @enumerate
33075 @item
33076 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33077 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33078 @item
33079 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33080 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33081 the other one.
33082 @end enumerate
33083
33084 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33085
33086 @enumerate
33087 @item
33088 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33089 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33090 @anchor{agent expression object}
33091 @item
33092 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33093 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33094 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33095 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33096 @item
33097 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33098 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33099
33100 @end enumerate
33101
33102 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33103 object:
33104
33105 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33106 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33107 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33108 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33109 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33110 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33111 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33112 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33113 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33114 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33115 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33116 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33117 memory address for collecting.
33118 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33119 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33120 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33121 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33122 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33123 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33124 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33125 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33126 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33127 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33128 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33129 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33130 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33131 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33132 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33133 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33134 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33135 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33136 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33137 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33138 @ref{agent expression object}
33139 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33140 @ref{agent expression object}
33141 @item actions @tab variable
33142 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33143 @end multitable
33144
33145 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33146 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33147 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33148
33149 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33150 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33151
33152 @table @samp
33153
33154 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33155 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33156 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33157 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33158 in IPA finally.
33159
33160 Replies:
33161 @table @samp
33162 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33163 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33164 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33165 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33166 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33167 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33168 @item E @var{NN}
33169 for an error
33170
33171 @end table
33172
33173 @item close
33174 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33175 is about to kill inferiors.
33176
33177 @item qTfSTM
33178 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33179 @item qTsSTM
33180 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33181 @item qTSTMat
33182 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33183 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33184 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33185
33186 Replies:
33187 @table @samp
33188 @item E @var{NN}
33189 for an error
33190 @end table
33191 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33192 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33193 @end table
33194
33195 @node GDB Bugs
33196 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33197 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33198 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33199
33200 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33201
33202 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33203 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33204 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33205 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33206
33207 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33208 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33209
33210 @menu
33211 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33212 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33213 @end menu
33214
33215 @node Bug Criteria
33216 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33217 @cindex bug criteria
33218
33219 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33220
33221 @itemize @bullet
33222 @cindex fatal signal
33223 @cindex debugger crash
33224 @cindex crash of debugger
33225 @item
33226 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33227 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33228
33229 @cindex error on valid input
33230 @item
33231 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33232 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33233 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33234
33235 @cindex invalid input
33236 @item
33237 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33238 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33239 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33240 for traditional practice''.
33241
33242 @item
33243 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33244 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33245 @end itemize
33246
33247 @node Bug Reporting
33248 @section How to Report Bugs
33249 @cindex bug reports
33250 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33251
33252 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33253 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33254 contact that organization first.
33255
33256 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33257 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33258 distribution.
33259 @c should add a web page ref...
33260
33261 @ifset BUGURL
33262 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33263 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33264 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33265 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33266 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33267 be used.
33268
33269 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33270 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33271 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33272 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33273
33274 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33275 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33276 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33277 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33278 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33279 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33280 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33281 bug reports to the mailing list.
33282 @end ifset
33283 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33284 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33285 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33286 @end ifclear
33287 @end ifset
33288
33289 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33290 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33291 fact or leave it out, state it!
33292
33293 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33294 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33295 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33296 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33297 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33298 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33299 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33300 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33301 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33302
33303 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33304 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33305 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33306 self-contained.
33307
33308 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33309 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33310 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33311 bugs properly.
33312
33313 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33314
33315 @itemize @bullet
33316 @item
33317 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33318 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33319 version}.
33320
33321 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33322 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33323
33324 @item
33325 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33326 version number.
33327
33328 @item
33329 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33330 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33331 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33332 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33333
33334 @item
33335 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33336 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33337
33338 @item
33339 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33340 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33341 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33342 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33343 those compilers.
33344
33345 @item
33346 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33347 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33348 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33349 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33350
33351 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33352 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33353
33354 @item
33355 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33356 reproduce the bug.
33357
33358 @item
33359 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33360 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33361
33362 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33363 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33364 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33365 a chance to make a mistake.
33366
33367 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33368 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33369 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33370 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33371 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33372 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33373 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33374 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33375
33376 @pindex script
33377 @cindex recording a session script
33378 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33379 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33380 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33381 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33382
33383 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33384 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33385
33386 @item
33387 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33388 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33389 it by context, not by line number.
33390
33391 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33392 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33393
33394 @end itemize
33395
33396 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33397
33398 @itemize @bullet
33399 @item
33400 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33401
33402 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33403 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33404 changes will not affect it.
33405
33406 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33407 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33408 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33409 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33410
33411 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33412 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33413 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33414 less time, and so on.
33415
33416 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33417 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33418
33419 @item
33420 A patch for the bug.
33421
33422 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33423 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33424 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33425 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33426
33427 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33428 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33429 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33430 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33431
33432 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33433 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33434 help us to understand.
33435
33436 @item
33437 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33438
33439 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33440 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33441 @end itemize
33442
33443 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33444 @c and consists of the two following files:
33445 @c rluser.texi
33446 @c hsuser.texi
33447 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33448 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33449 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33450 @include rluser.texi
33451 @include hsuser.texi
33452 @end ifclear
33453
33454 @node In Memoriam
33455 @appendix In Memoriam
33456
33457 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33458 contributors:
33459
33460 @table @code
33461 @item Fred Fish
33462 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33463 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33464 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33465
33466 @item Michael Snyder
33467 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33468 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33469 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33470 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33471 @end table
33472
33473 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33474 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33475
33476 @node Formatting Documentation
33477 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33478
33479 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33480 @cindex reference card
33481 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33482 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33483 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33484 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33485 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33486 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33487
33488 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33489 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33490
33491 @smallexample
33492 make refcard.dvi
33493 @end smallexample
33494
33495 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33496 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33497 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33498 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33499 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33500
33501 @cindex documentation
33502
33503 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33504 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33505 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33506 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33507 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33508 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33509
33510 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33511 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33512 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33513 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33514 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33515 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33516 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33517 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33518
33519 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33520 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33521 @code{makeinfo}.
33522
33523 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33524 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33525 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33526
33527 @smallexample
33528 cd gdb
33529 make gdb.info
33530 @end smallexample
33531
33532 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33533 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33534 Texinfo definitions file.
33535
33536 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33537 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33538 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33539 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33540 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33541 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33542 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33543
33544 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33545 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33546 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33547 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33548 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33549 directory.
33550
33551 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33552 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33553 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33554 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33555
33556 @smallexample
33557 make gdb.dvi
33558 @end smallexample
33559
33560 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33561
33562 @node Installing GDB
33563 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33564 @cindex installation
33565
33566 @menu
33567 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33568 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33569 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33570 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33571 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33572 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33573 @end menu
33574
33575 @node Requirements
33576 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33577 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33578
33579 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33580 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33581
33582 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33583 @table @asis
33584 @item ISO C90 compiler
33585 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33586 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33587
33588 @end table
33589
33590 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33591 @table @asis
33592 @item Expat
33593 @anchor{Expat}
33594 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33595 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33596 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33597 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33598 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33599 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33600
33601 Expat is used for:
33602
33603 @itemize @bullet
33604 @item
33605 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33606 @item
33607 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33608 @item
33609 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33610 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33611 @item
33612 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33613 @item
33614 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33615 @item
33616 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33617 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33618 @end itemize
33619
33620 @item zlib
33621 @cindex compressed debug sections
33622 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33623 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33624 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33625 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33626 information in such binaries.
33627
33628 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33629 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33630 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33631
33632 @item iconv
33633 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33634 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33635 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33636 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33637
33638 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33639 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33640 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33641 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33642
33643 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33644 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33645 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33646
33647 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33648 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33649 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33650 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33651 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33652 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33653 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33654 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33655 @end table
33656
33657 @node Running Configure
33658 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33659 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33660 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33661 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33662 build the @code{gdb} program.
33663 @iftex
33664 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33665 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33666 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33667 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33668 @end iftex
33669
33670 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33671 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33672 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33673
33674 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33675 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33676
33677 @table @code
33678 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33679 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33680
33681 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33682 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33683
33684 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33685 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33686
33687 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33688 @sc{gnu} include files
33689
33690 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33691 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33692
33693 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33694 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33695
33696 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33697 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33698
33699 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33700 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33701
33702 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33703 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33704 @end table
33705
33706 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33707 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33708 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33709
33710 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33711 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33712 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33713 argument.
33714
33715 For example:
33716
33717 @smallexample
33718 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33719 ./configure @var{host}
33720 make
33721 @end smallexample
33722
33723 @noindent
33724 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33725 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33726 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33727 correct value by examining your system.)
33728
33729 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33730 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33731 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33732 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33733
33734 @need 750
33735 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33736 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33737 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33738
33739 @smallexample
33740 sh configure @var{host}
33741 @end smallexample
33742
33743 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33744 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33745 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33746 @file{configure}
33747 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33748 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33749
33750 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33751 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33752 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33753 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33754 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33755 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33756 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33757 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33758 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33759
33760 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33761 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33762 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33763 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33764 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33765
33766 @node Separate Objdir
33767 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33768
33769 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33770 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33771 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33772 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33773 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33774 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33775 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33776 program specified there.
33777
33778 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33779 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33780 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33781 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33782 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33783 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33784
33785 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33786 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33787
33788 @smallexample
33789 @group
33790 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33791 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33792 cd ../gdb-sun4
33793 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33794 make
33795 @end group
33796 @end smallexample
33797
33798 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33799 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33800 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33801 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33802 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33803 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33804
33805 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33806 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33807 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33808 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33809 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33810
33811 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33812 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33813 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33814 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33815 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33816 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33817
33818 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33819 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33820 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33821
33822 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33823 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33824 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33825 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33826 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33827
33828 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33829 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33830 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33831 with each other.
33832
33833 @node Config Names
33834 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33835
33836 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33837 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33838 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33839 of information in the following pattern:
33840
33841 @smallexample
33842 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33843 @end smallexample
33844
33845 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33846 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33847 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33848
33849 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33850 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33851 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33852 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33853 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33854 abbreviations---for example:
33855
33856 @smallexample
33857 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33858 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33859 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33860 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33861 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33862 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33863 % sh config.sub sun4
33864 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33865 % sh config.sub sun3
33866 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33867 % sh config.sub i986v
33868 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33869 @end smallexample
33870
33871 @noindent
33872 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33873 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33874
33875 @node Configure Options
33876 @section @file{configure} Options
33877
33878 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33879 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33880 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33881 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33882
33883 @smallexample
33884 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33885 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33886 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33887 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33888 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33889 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33890 @var{host}
33891 @end smallexample
33892
33893 @noindent
33894 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33895 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33896 @samp{--}.
33897
33898 @table @code
33899 @item --help
33900 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33901
33902 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33903 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33904 @file{@var{dir}}.
33905
33906 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33907 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33908 @file{@var{dir}}.
33909
33910 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33911 @need 2000
33912 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33913 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33914 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33915 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33916 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33917 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33918 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33919 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33920 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33921 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33922 @var{dirname}.
33923
33924 @item --norecursion
33925 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33926 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33927
33928 @item --target=@var{target}
33929 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33930 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33931 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33932
33933 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33934
33935 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33936 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33937
33938 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33939 @end table
33940
33941 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33942 needed for special purposes only.
33943
33944 @node System-wide configuration
33945 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33946 @cindex system-wide init file
33947
33948 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33949 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33950 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33951
33952 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33953
33954 @table @code
33955 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33956 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33957 @var{file}.
33958 @end table
33959
33960 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33961 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33962
33963 @itemize @bullet
33964 @item
33965 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33966 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33967 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33968 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33969 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33970 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33971
33972 @item
33973 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33974 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33975 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33976 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33977 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33978 @end itemize
33979
33980 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33981 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33982 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33983 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33984 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33985 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33986 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33987 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33988 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33989 reread.
33990
33991 @menu
33992 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33993 @end menu
33994
33995 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33996 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33997 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33998
33999 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34000 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34001 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34002 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34003 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34004 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34005
34006 The following scripts are currently available:
34007 @itemize @bullet
34008
34009 @item @file{elinos.py}
34010 @pindex elinos.py
34011 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34012 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34013 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34014 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34015 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34016 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34017
34018 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34019 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34020 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34021 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34022 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34023 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34024
34025 @end itemize
34026
34027 @node Maintenance Commands
34028 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34029 @cindex maintenance commands
34030 @cindex internal commands
34031
34032 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34033 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34034 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34035 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34036 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34037
34038 @table @code
34039 @kindex maint agent
34040 @kindex maint agent-eval
34041 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34042 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34043 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34044 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34045 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34046 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34047 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34048 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34049 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34050 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34051 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34052 addition and return the sum.
34053 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34054 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34055
34056 @kindex maint agent-printf
34057 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34058 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34059 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34060 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34061 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34062
34063 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34064 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34065 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34066 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34067 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34068 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34069 is shown:
34070
34071 @table @code
34072 @item breakpoint
34073 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34074
34075 @item watchpoint
34076 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34077
34078 @item longjmp
34079 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34080 @code{longjmp} calls.
34081
34082 @item longjmp resume
34083 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34084
34085 @item until
34086 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34087
34088 @item finish
34089 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34090
34091 @item shlib events
34092 Shared library events.
34093
34094 @end table
34095
34096 @kindex maint info btrace
34097 @item maint info btrace
34098 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34099
34100 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34101 @item maint btrace packet-history
34102 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34103 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34104 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34105 recording format.
34106
34107 @table @code
34108 @item bts
34109 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34110 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34111
34112 @table @asis
34113 @item Block number
34114 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34115 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34116 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34117 @end table
34118
34119 @item pt
34120 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34121 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34122 information is printed:
34123
34124 @table @asis
34125 @item Packet number
34126 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34127 @item Trace offset
34128 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34129 @item Packet opcode and payload
34130 @end table
34131 @end table
34132
34133 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34134 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34135 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34136 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34137 needed.
34138
34139 @kindex maint btrace clear
34140 @item maint btrace clear
34141 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34142 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34143
34144 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34145 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34146 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34147 buffer.
34148
34149 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34150 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34151 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34152 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34153 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34154 packet history.
34155
34156 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34157 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34158 @cindex displaced stepping support
34159 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34160 @item set displaced-stepping
34161 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34162 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34163 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34164 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34165 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34166 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34167
34168 @table @code
34169 @item set displaced-stepping on
34170 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34171 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34172
34173 @item set displaced-stepping off
34174 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34175 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34176
34177 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34178 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34179 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34180 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34181 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34182 @end table
34183
34184 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34185 @item maint check-psymtabs
34186 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34187 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34188
34189 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34190 @item maint check-symtabs
34191 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34192
34193 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34194 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34195 Expand symbol tables.
34196 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34197 names matching @var{regexp}.
34198
34199 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34200 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34201 @cindex demangler crashes
34202 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34203 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34204 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34205 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34206 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34207 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34208 option to terminate the current session.
34209
34210 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34211 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34212 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34213
34214 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34215 @item maint cplus namespace
34216 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34217
34218 @kindex maint deprecate
34219 @kindex maint undeprecate
34220 @cindex deprecated commands
34221 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34222 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34223 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34224 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34225 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34226 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34227 the replacement as part of the warning.
34228
34229 @kindex maint dump-me
34230 @item maint dump-me
34231 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34232 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34233 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34234 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34235
34236 @kindex maint internal-error
34237 @kindex maint internal-warning
34238 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34239 @cindex demangler crashes
34240 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34241 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34242 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34243
34244 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34245 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34246 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34247 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34248 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34249 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34250 @value{GDBN} session.
34251
34252 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34253 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34254
34255 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34256
34257 @smallexample
34258 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34259 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34260 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34261 debugging may prove unreliable.
34262 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34263 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34264 (@value{GDBP})
34265 @end smallexample
34266
34267 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34268 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34269 @cindex demangler crashes
34270
34271 @kindex maint set internal-error
34272 @kindex maint show internal-error
34273 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34274 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34275 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34276 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34277 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34278 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34279 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34280 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34281 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34282 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34283 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34284 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34285 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34286 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34287 described in the table below.
34288
34289 @table @samp
34290 @item quit
34291 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34292 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34293
34294 @item corefile
34295 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34296 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34297 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34298 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34299 disabled.
34300 @end table
34301
34302 @kindex maint packet
34303 @item maint packet @var{text}
34304 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34305 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34306 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34307 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34308 checksum.
34309
34310 @kindex maint print architecture
34311 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34312 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34313 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34314
34315 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34316 @item maint print c-tdesc
34317 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34318 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34319 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34320
34321 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34322 @item maint print dummy-frames
34323 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34324
34325 @smallexample
34326 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34327 @dots{}
34328 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34329 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34330 58 return (a + b);
34331 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34332 @dots{}
34333 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34334 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34335 (@value{GDBP})
34336 @end smallexample
34337
34338 Takes an optional file parameter.
34339
34340 @kindex maint print registers
34341 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34342 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34343 @kindex maint print register-groups
34344 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34345 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34346 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34347 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34348 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34349 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34350 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34351
34352 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34353 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34354 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34355 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34356 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34357 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34358 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34359 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34360
34361 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34362 write the information.
34363
34364 @kindex maint print reggroups
34365 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34366 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34367 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34368 information.
34369
34370 The register groups info looks like this:
34371
34372 @smallexample
34373 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34374 Group Type
34375 general user
34376 float user
34377 all user
34378 vector user
34379 system user
34380 save internal
34381 restore internal
34382 @end smallexample
34383
34384 @kindex flushregs
34385 @item flushregs
34386 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34387
34388 @kindex maint print objfiles
34389 @cindex info for known object files
34390 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34391 Print a dump of all known object files.
34392 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34393 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34394 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34395
34396 @kindex maint print user-registers
34397 @cindex user registers
34398 @item maint print user-registers
34399 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34400 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34401 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34402 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34403 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34404 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34405 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34406
34407 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34408 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34409 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34410 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34411 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34412 matching @var{regexp}.
34413 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34414 and the full path if known.
34415 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34416
34417 @kindex maint print statistics
34418 @cindex bcache statistics
34419 @item maint print statistics
34420 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34421 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34422 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34423 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34424 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34425 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34426 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34427 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34428 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34429 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34430 lengths.
34431
34432 @kindex maint print target-stack
34433 @cindex target stack description
34434 @item maint print target-stack
34435 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34436 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34437 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34438 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34439 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34440 address.
34441
34442 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34443 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34444
34445 @kindex maint print type
34446 @cindex type chain of a data type
34447 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34448 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34449 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34450 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34451 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34452 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34453
34454 @kindex maint selftest
34455 @cindex self tests
34456 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34457 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34458
34459 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34460 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34461 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34462 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34463 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34464 information.
34465
34466 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34467 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34468 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34469 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34470 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34471 always see the disassembly form.
34472
34473 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34474
34475 @smallexample
34476 (gdb) info addr argc
34477 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34478 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34479 @end smallexample
34480
34481 For more information on these expressions, see
34482 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34483
34484 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34485 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34486 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34487 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34488 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34489
34490 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34491 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34492 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34493 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34494 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34495 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34496 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34497 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34498 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34499
34500 @kindex maint set profile
34501 @kindex maint show profile
34502 @cindex profiling GDB
34503 @item maint set profile
34504 @itemx maint show profile
34505 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34506
34507 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34508 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34509 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34510 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34511 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34512 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34513 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34514
34515 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34516 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34517
34518 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34519 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34520 @cindex hardware debug registers
34521 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34522 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34523 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34524 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34525 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34526 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34527 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34528
34529 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34530 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34531 @item maint set show-all-tib
34532 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34533 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34534 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34535 command.
34536
34537 @kindex maint set target-async
34538 @kindex maint show target-async
34539 @item maint set target-async
34540 @itemx maint show target-async
34541 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34542 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34543 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34544 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34545
34546 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34547 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34548 @item maint set target-non-stop
34549 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34550
34551 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34552 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34553 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34554 if supported by the target.
34555
34556 @table @code
34557 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34558 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34559 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34560
34561 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34562 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34563 does not indicate support.
34564
34565 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34566 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34567 target supports it.
34568 @end table
34569
34570 @kindex maint set per-command
34571 @kindex maint show per-command
34572 @item maint set per-command
34573 @itemx maint show per-command
34574 @cindex resources used by commands
34575
34576 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34577 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34578
34579 @table @code
34580 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34581 @itemx maint show per-command space
34582 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34583 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34584 took, following the command's own output.
34585 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34586 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34587
34588 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34589 @itemx maint show per-command time
34590 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34591 for each command.
34592 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34593 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34594 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34595 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34596 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34597 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34598 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34599 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34600 spent by the program been debugged.
34601 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34602 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34603
34604 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34605 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34606 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34607 for each command.
34608 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34609
34610 @enumerate a
34611 @item
34612 number of symbol tables
34613 @item
34614 number of primary symbol tables
34615 @item
34616 number of blocks in the blockvector
34617 @end enumerate
34618 @end table
34619
34620 @kindex maint space
34621 @cindex memory used by commands
34622 @item maint space @var{value}
34623 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34624 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34625
34626 @kindex maint time
34627 @cindex time of command execution
34628 @item maint time @var{value}
34629 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34630 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34631
34632 @kindex maint translate-address
34633 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34634 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34635 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34636 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34637 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34638 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34639 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34640
34641 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34642 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34643 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34644
34645 @end table
34646
34647 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34648 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34649
34650 @table @code
34651 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34652 @kindex set watchdog
34653 @cindex watchdog timer
34654 @cindex timeout for commands
34655 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34656 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34657 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34658
34659 @item show watchdog
34660 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34661 @end table
34662
34663 @node Remote Protocol
34664 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34665
34666 @menu
34667 * Overview::
34668 * Packets::
34669 * Stop Reply Packets::
34670 * General Query Packets::
34671 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34672 * Tracepoint Packets::
34673 * Host I/O Packets::
34674 * Interrupts::
34675 * Notification Packets::
34676 * Remote Non-Stop::
34677 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34678 * Examples::
34679 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34680 * Library List Format::
34681 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34682 * Memory Map Format::
34683 * Thread List Format::
34684 * Traceframe Info Format::
34685 * Branch Trace Format::
34686 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34687 @end menu
34688
34689 @node Overview
34690 @section Overview
34691
34692 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34693 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34694 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34695 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34696
34697 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34698 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34699
34700 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34701 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34702 @cindex remote serial protocol
34703 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34704 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34705 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34706 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34707 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34708
34709 @smallexample
34710 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34711 @end smallexample
34712 @noindent
34713
34714 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34715 @noindent
34716 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34717 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34718 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34719
34720 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34721 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34722
34723 @smallexample
34724 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34725 @end smallexample
34726
34727 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34728 @noindent
34729 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34730 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34731 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34732
34733 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34734 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34735 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34736 retransmission):
34737
34738 @smallexample
34739 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34740 <- @code{+}
34741 @end smallexample
34742 @noindent
34743
34744 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34745 once a connection is established.
34746 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34747
34748 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34749 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34750 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34751 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34752 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34753 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34754 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34755
34756 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34757 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34758 exceptions).
34759
34760 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34761 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34762 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34763 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34764
34765 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34766 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34767 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34768
34769 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34770 @anchor{Binary Data}
34771 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34772 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34773 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34774 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34775 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34776 binary data.
34777
34778 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34779 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34780 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34781 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34782 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34783 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34784 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34785 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34786 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34787 (described next).
34788
34789 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34790 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34791 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34792 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34793 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34794 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34795 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34796 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34797 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34798 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34799 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34800 3}} more times.
34801
34802 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34803 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34804 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34805 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34806 @samp{0*"00}.
34807
34808 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34809 error number. That number is not well defined.
34810
34811 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34812 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34813 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34814 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34815 on that response.
34816
34817 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34818 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34819 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34820 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34821 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34822 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34823
34824 @node Packets
34825 @section Packets
34826
34827 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34828 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34829 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34830 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34831
34832 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34833 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34834 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34835 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34836 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34837 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34838 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34839 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34840 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34841 @var{baz}.
34842
34843 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34844 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34845 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34846 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34847 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34848 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34849 pick any thread.
34850
34851 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34852 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34853 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34854 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34855 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34856 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34857 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34858 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34859 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34860 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34861 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34862 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34863 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34864
34865 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34866 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34867 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34868 more information.
34869
34870 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34871 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34872
34873 Here are the packet descriptions.
34874
34875 @table @samp
34876
34877 @item !
34878 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34879 @anchor{extended mode}
34880 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34881 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34882 debugged.
34883
34884 Reply:
34885 @table @samp
34886 @item OK
34887 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34888 @end table
34889
34890 @item ?
34891 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34892 @anchor{? packet}
34893 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34894 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34895 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34896
34897 Reply:
34898 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34899
34900 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34901 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34902 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34903 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34904 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34905
34906 Reply:
34907 @table @samp
34908 @item OK
34909 The arguments were set.
34910 @item E @var{NN}
34911 An error occurred.
34912 @end table
34913
34914 @item b @var{baud}
34915 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34916 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34917 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34918
34919 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34920 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34921 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34922
34923 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34924 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34925 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34926 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34927 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34928
34929 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34930 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34931 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34932 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34933
34934 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34935 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34936
34937 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34938 @anchor{bc}
34939 @item bc
34940 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34941 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34942
34943 Reply:
34944 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34945
34946 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34947 @anchor{bs}
34948 @item bs
34949 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34950 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34951
34952 Reply:
34953 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34954
34955 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34956 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34957 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34958 is omitted, resume at current address.
34959
34960 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34961 packet}.
34962
34963 Reply:
34964 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34965
34966 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34967 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34968 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34969 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34970
34971 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34972 packet}.
34973
34974 Reply:
34975 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34976
34977 @item d
34978 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34979 Toggle debug flag.
34980
34981 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34982 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34983
34984 @item D
34985 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34986 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34987 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34988 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34989 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34990
34991 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34992 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34993 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34994 big-endian hex string.
34995
34996 Reply:
34997 @table @samp
34998 @item OK
34999 for success
35000 @item E @var{NN}
35001 for an error
35002 @end table
35003
35004 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35005 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35006 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35007 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35008 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35009
35010 @item g
35011 @anchor{read registers packet}
35012 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35013 Read general registers.
35014
35015 Reply:
35016 @table @samp
35017 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35018 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35019 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35020 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35021 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35022 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
35023 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35024
35025 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35026 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35027 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35028 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35029 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35030 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35031 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35032 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35033
35034 @smallexample
35035 -> @code{g}
35036 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35037 @end smallexample
35038
35039 @item E @var{NN}
35040 for an error.
35041 @end table
35042
35043 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35044 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35045 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35046 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35047
35048 Reply:
35049 @table @samp
35050 @item OK
35051 for success
35052 @item E @var{NN}
35053 for an error
35054 @end table
35055
35056 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35057 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35058 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35059 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35060 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35061 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35062 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35063 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35064 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35065
35066 Reply:
35067 @table @samp
35068 @item OK
35069 for success
35070 @item E @var{NN}
35071 for an error
35072 @end table
35073
35074 @c FIXME: JTC:
35075 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35076 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35077 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35078 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35079 @c described. For example:
35080 @c
35081 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35082 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35083 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35084 @c
35085 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35086 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35087 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35088
35089 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35090 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35091 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35092 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35093 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35094 step starting at that address.
35095
35096 @item I
35097 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35098 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35099 step packet}.
35100
35101 @item k
35102 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35103 Kill request.
35104
35105 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35106
35107 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35108 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35109
35110 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35111
35112 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35113 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35114 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35115
35116 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35117 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35118 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35119
35120 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35121 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35122 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35123 (@pxref{? packet}).
35124
35125 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35126 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35127 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35128 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35129 any particular boundary.
35130
35131 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35132 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35133 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35134 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35135 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35136 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35137 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35138 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35139
35140 Reply:
35141 @table @samp
35142 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35143 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35144 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35145 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35146 @item E @var{NN}
35147 @var{NN} is errno
35148 @end table
35149
35150 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35151 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35152 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35153 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35154 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35155
35156 Reply:
35157 @table @samp
35158 @item OK
35159 for success
35160 @item E @var{NN}
35161 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35162 written).
35163 @end table
35164
35165 @item p @var{n}
35166 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35167 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35168 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35169 register value is encoded.
35170
35171 Reply:
35172 @table @samp
35173 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35174 the register's value
35175 @item E @var{NN}
35176 for an error
35177 @item @w{}
35178 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35179 @end table
35180
35181 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35182 @anchor{write register packet}
35183 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35184 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35185 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35186 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35187
35188 Reply:
35189 @table @samp
35190 @item OK
35191 for success
35192 @item E @var{NN}
35193 for an error
35194 @end table
35195
35196 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35197 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35198 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35199 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35200 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35201 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35202
35203 @item r
35204 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35205 Reset the entire system.
35206
35207 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35208
35209 @item R @var{XX}
35210 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35211 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35212 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35213
35214 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35215
35216 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35217 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35218 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35219 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35220
35221 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35222 packet}.
35223
35224 Reply:
35225 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35226
35227 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35228 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35229 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35230 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35231 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35232
35233 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35234 packet}.
35235
35236 Reply:
35237 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35238
35239 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35240 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35241 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35242 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35243 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35244
35245 @item T @var{thread-id}
35246 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35247 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35248
35249 Reply:
35250 @table @samp
35251 @item OK
35252 thread is still alive
35253 @item E @var{NN}
35254 thread is dead
35255 @end table
35256
35257 @item v
35258 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35259 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35260
35261 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35262 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35263 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35264 The process ID is a
35265 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35266 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35267 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35268
35269 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35270 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35271 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35272 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35273 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35274 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35275 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35276 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35277
35278 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35279
35280 Reply:
35281 @table @samp
35282 @item E @var{nn}
35283 for an error
35284 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35285 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35286 @item OK
35287 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35288 @end table
35289
35290 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35291 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35292 @anchor{vCont packet}
35293 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35294 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35295 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35296 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35297 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35298 Specifying multiple
35299 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35300 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35301
35302 Currently supported actions are:
35303
35304 @table @samp
35305 @item c
35306 Continue.
35307 @item C @var{sig}
35308 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35309 @item s
35310 Step.
35311 @item S @var{sig}
35312 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35313 @item t
35314 Stop.
35315 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35316 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35317 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35318 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35319 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35320 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35321
35322 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35323 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35324 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35325 jumps to @var{start}).
35326
35327 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35328 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35329 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35330
35331 @end table
35332
35333 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35334 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35335 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35336
35337 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35338 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35339 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35340 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35341 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35342 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35343 as an implementation detail.
35344
35345 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35346 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35347 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35348 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35349 @var{thread-id}.
35350
35351 Reply:
35352 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35353
35354 @item vCont?
35355 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35356 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35357
35358 Reply:
35359 @table @samp
35360 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35361 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35362 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35363 @item @w{}
35364 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35365 @end table
35366
35367 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35368 @item vCtrlC
35369 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35370 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35371 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35372 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35373 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35374 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35375 variant.
35376
35377 Reply:
35378 @table @samp
35379 @item E @var{nn}
35380 for an error
35381 @item OK
35382 for success
35383 @end table
35384
35385 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35386 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35387 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35388 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35389
35390 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35391 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35392 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35393 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35394 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35395 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35396 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35397 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35398 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35399 packet is received.
35400
35401 Reply:
35402 @table @samp
35403 @item OK
35404 for success
35405 @item E @var{NN}
35406 for an error
35407 @end table
35408
35409 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35410 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35411 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35412 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35413 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35414 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35415 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35416 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35417 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35418 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35419 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35420 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35421
35422
35423 Reply:
35424 @table @samp
35425 @item OK
35426 for success
35427 @item E.memtype
35428 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35429 @item E @var{NN}
35430 for an error
35431 @end table
35432
35433 @item vFlashDone
35434 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35435 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35436 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35437 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35438 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35439 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35440 request is completed.
35441
35442 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35443 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35444 @anchor{vKill packet}
35445 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35446 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35447 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35448 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35449
35450 Reply:
35451 @table @samp
35452 @item E @var{nn}
35453 for an error
35454 @item OK
35455 for success
35456 @end table
35457
35458 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35459 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35460 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35461 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35462 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35463 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35464 state.
35465
35466 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35467
35468 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35469
35470 Reply:
35471 @table @samp
35472 @item E @var{nn}
35473 for an error
35474 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35475 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35476 @end table
35477
35478 @item vStopped
35479 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35480 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35481
35482 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35483 @anchor{X packet}
35484 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35485 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35486 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35487 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35488 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35489
35490 Reply:
35491 @table @samp
35492 @item OK
35493 for success
35494 @item E @var{NN}
35495 for an error
35496 @end table
35497
35498 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35499 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35500 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35501 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35502 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35503 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35504 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35505
35506 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35507 separately.
35508
35509 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35510 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35511 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35512 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35513 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35514 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35515
35516 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35517 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35518 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35519 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35520 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35521 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35522
35523 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35524 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35525 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35526 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35527 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35528 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35529 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35530 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35531 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35532 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35533
35534 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35535 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35536
35537 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35538 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35539
35540 @table @samp
35541
35542 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35543 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35544 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35545
35546 @end table
35547
35548 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35549 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35550 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35551 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35552 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35553 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35554 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35555
35556 @table @samp
35557
35558 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35559 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35560 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35561
35562 @end table
35563
35564 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35565
35566 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35567 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35568 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35569 target, is not defined.}
35570
35571 Reply:
35572 @table @samp
35573 @item OK
35574 success
35575 @item @w{}
35576 not supported
35577 @item E @var{NN}
35578 for an error
35579 @end table
35580
35581 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35582 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35583 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35584 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35585 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35586 address @var{addr}.
35587
35588 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35589 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35590 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35591
35592 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35593 movement.}
35594
35595 Reply:
35596 @table @samp
35597 @item OK
35598 success
35599 @item @w{}
35600 not supported
35601 @item E @var{NN}
35602 for an error
35603 @end table
35604
35605 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35606 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35607 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35608 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35609 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35610 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35611
35612 Reply:
35613 @table @samp
35614 @item OK
35615 success
35616 @item @w{}
35617 not supported
35618 @item E @var{NN}
35619 for an error
35620 @end table
35621
35622 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35623 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35624 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35625 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35626 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35627 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35628
35629 Reply:
35630 @table @samp
35631 @item OK
35632 success
35633 @item @w{}
35634 not supported
35635 @item E @var{NN}
35636 for an error
35637 @end table
35638
35639 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35640 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35641 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35642 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35643 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35644 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35645
35646 Reply:
35647 @table @samp
35648 @item OK
35649 success
35650 @item @w{}
35651 not supported
35652 @item E @var{NN}
35653 for an error
35654 @end table
35655
35656 @end table
35657
35658 @node Stop Reply Packets
35659 @section Stop Reply Packets
35660 @cindex stop reply packets
35661
35662 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35663 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35664 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35665 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35666 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35667 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35668 @value{GDBN} source code.
35669
35670 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35671 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35672 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35673 components.
35674
35675 @table @samp
35676
35677 @item S @var{AA}
35678 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35679 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35680 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35681
35682 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35683 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35684 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35685 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35686 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35687 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35688 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35689 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35690
35691 @itemize @bullet
35692 @item
35693 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35694 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35695 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35696 two-digit hex number.
35697
35698 @item
35699 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35700 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35701
35702 @item
35703 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35704 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35705
35706 @item
35707 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35708 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35709 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35710 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35711
35712 @item
35713 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35714 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35715 future.
35716 @end itemize
35717
35718 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35719
35720 @table @samp
35721 @item watch
35722 @itemx rwatch
35723 @itemx awatch
35724 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35725 hex.
35726
35727 @item syscall_entry
35728 @itemx syscall_return
35729 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35730 syscall number, in hex.
35731
35732 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35733 @item library
35734 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35735 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35736 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35737
35738 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35739 @item replaylog
35740 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35741 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35742 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35743 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35744 for more information.
35745
35746 @item swbreak
35747 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35748 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35749 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35750 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35751 part must be left empty.
35752
35753 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35754 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35755 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35756 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35757 address.
35758
35759 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35760 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35761 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35762 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35763 indicating support.
35764
35765 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35766
35767 @item hwbreak
35768 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35769 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35770
35771 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35772 apply.
35773
35774 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35775 @item fork
35776 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35777 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35778 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35779 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35780 fork events.
35781
35782 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35783 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35784 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35785 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35786 indicating support.
35787
35788 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35789 @item vfork
35790 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35791 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35792 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35793 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35794 vfork events.
35795
35796 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35797 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35798 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35799 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35800 indicating support.
35801
35802 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35803 @item vforkdone
35804 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35805 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35806 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35807 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35808 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35809
35810 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35811 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35812 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35813 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35814 indicating support.
35815
35816 @cindex exec events, remote reply
35817 @item exec
35818 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
35819 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
35820 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
35821
35822 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35823 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35824 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35825 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35826 indicating support.
35827
35828 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
35829 @anchor{thread create event}
35830 @item create
35831 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
35832 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
35833 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
35834 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
35835 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
35836
35837 @end table
35838
35839 @item W @var{AA}
35840 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35841 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35842 applicable to certain targets.
35843
35844 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35845 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35846 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35847 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35848
35849 @item X @var{AA}
35850 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35851 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35852
35853 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35854 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35855 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35856 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35857
35858 @anchor{thread exit event}
35859 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
35860 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
35861
35862 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
35863 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
35864 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
35865
35866 @item N
35867 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
35868 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
35869 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
35870 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
35871 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
35872 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
35873 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
35874 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
35875 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
35876 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
35877 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
35878 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
35879 support.
35880
35881 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35882 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35883 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35884 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35885 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35886
35887 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35888 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35889 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35890 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35891 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35892 system calls.
35893
35894 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35895 this very system call.
35896
35897 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35898 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35899 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35900 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35901 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35902 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35903
35904 @end table
35905
35906 @node General Query Packets
35907 @section General Query Packets
35908 @cindex remote query requests
35909
35910 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35911 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35912 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35913 sending information to and from the stub.
35914
35915 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35916 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35917 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35918 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35919 conventions:
35920
35921 @itemize @bullet
35922 @item
35923 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35924 @item
35925 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35926 letter.
35927 @item
35928 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35929 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35930 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35931 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35932 @end itemize
35933
35934 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35935 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35936 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35937 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35938 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35939 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35940 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35941 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35942 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35943 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35944 packet.}.
35945
35946 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35947 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35948 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35949 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35950 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35951
35952 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35953
35954 @table @samp
35955
35956 @item QAgent:1
35957 @itemx QAgent:0
35958 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35959 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35960
35961 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35962 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35963 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35964 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35965 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35966 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35967 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35968 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35969 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35970 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35971 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35972
35973 @item qC
35974 @cindex current thread, remote request
35975 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35976 Return the current thread ID.
35977
35978 Reply:
35979 @table @samp
35980 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35981 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35982 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35983 @item @r{(anything else)}
35984 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35985 @end table
35986
35987 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35988 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35989 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35990 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35991 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35992 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35993 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35994 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35995
35996 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35997 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35998 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35999 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36000 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36001 detect trailing zeros.
36002
36003 Reply:
36004 @table @samp
36005 @item E @var{NN}
36006 An error (such as memory fault)
36007 @item C @var{crc32}
36008 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36009 @end table
36010
36011 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36012 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36013 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36014 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36015 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36016 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36017 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36018 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36019 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36020 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36021 randomization.
36022
36023 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36024
36025 Reply:
36026 @table @samp
36027 @item OK
36028 The request succeeded.
36029
36030 @item E @var{nn}
36031 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36032
36033 @item @w{}
36034 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36035 by the stub.
36036 @end table
36037
36038 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36039 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36040 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36041 address space randomization.
36042
36043 @item qfThreadInfo
36044 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36045 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36046 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36047 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36048 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36049 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36050 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36051 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36052 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36053 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36054
36055 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36056
36057 Reply:
36058 @table @samp
36059 @item m @var{thread-id}
36060 A single thread ID
36061 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36062 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36063 @item l
36064 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36065 @end table
36066
36067 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36068 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36069 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36070 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36071 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36072 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36073 fields.
36074
36075 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36076 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36077 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36078 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36079 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36080
36081 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36082 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36083 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36084 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36085 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36086
36087 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36088 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36089
36090 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36091 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36092 information associated with the variable.)
36093
36094 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36095 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36096 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36097 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36098 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36099 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36100
36101 Reply:
36102 @table @samp
36103 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36104 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36105 local storage requested.
36106
36107 @item E @var{nn}
36108 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36109
36110 @item @w{}
36111 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36112 @end table
36113
36114 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36115 @cindex get thread information block address
36116 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36117 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36118
36119 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36120
36121 Reply:
36122 @table @samp
36123 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36124 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36125 thread information block.
36126
36127 @item E @var{nn}
36128 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36129 address could not be retrieved.
36130
36131 @item @w{}
36132 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36133 @end table
36134
36135 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36136 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36137 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36138 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36139 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36140 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36141 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36142
36143 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36144
36145 Reply:
36146 @table @samp
36147 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36148 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36149 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36150 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36151 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36152 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36153 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36154 @end table
36155
36156 @item qOffsets
36157 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36158 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36159 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36160 image.
36161
36162 Reply:
36163 @table @samp
36164 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36165 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36166 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36167 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36168 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36169 segments by the supplied offsets.
36170
36171 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36172 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36173 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36174
36175 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36176 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36177 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36178 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36179 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36180 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36181 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36182 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36183 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36184 @end table
36185
36186 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36187 @cindex thread information, remote request
36188 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36189 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36190 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36191 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36192
36193 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36194 (see below).
36195
36196 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36197
36198 @item QNonStop:1
36199 @itemx QNonStop:0
36200 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36201 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36202 @anchor{QNonStop}
36203 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36204 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36205
36206 Reply:
36207 @table @samp
36208 @item OK
36209 The request succeeded.
36210
36211 @item E @var{nn}
36212 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36213
36214 @item @w{}
36215 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36216 the stub.
36217 @end table
36218
36219 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36220 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36221 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36222 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36223
36224 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36225 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36226 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36227 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36228 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36229 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36230 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36231
36232 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36233 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36234 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36235
36236 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36237 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36238 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36239 report the requested syscalls.
36240
36241 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36242 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36243
36244 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36245 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36246 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36247 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36248
36249 Reply:
36250 @table @samp
36251 @item OK
36252 The request succeeded.
36253
36254 @item E @var{nn}
36255 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36256
36257 @item @w{}
36258 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36259 the stub.
36260 @end table
36261
36262 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36263 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36264 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36265 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36266
36267 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36268 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36269 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36270 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36271 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36272 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36273 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36274 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36275 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36276 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36277 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36278 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36279 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36280
36281 Reply:
36282 @table @samp
36283 @item OK
36284 The request succeeded.
36285
36286 @item E @var{nn}
36287 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36288
36289 @item @w{}
36290 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36291 the stub.
36292 @end table
36293
36294 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36295 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36296 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36297 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36298
36299 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36300 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36301 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36302 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36303 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36304 Others should be silently discarded.
36305
36306 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36307 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36308 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36309 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36310 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36311 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36312 signals.
36313
36314 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36315 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36316
36317 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36318 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36319 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36320 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36321 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36322
36323 Reply:
36324 @table @samp
36325 @item OK
36326 The request succeeded.
36327
36328 @item E @var{nn}
36329 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36330
36331 @item @w{}
36332 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36333 by the stub.
36334 @end table
36335
36336 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36337 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36338 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36339 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36340
36341 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36342 @item QThreadEvents:1
36343 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36344 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36345 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36346
36347 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36348 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36349 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36350 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36351 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36352 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36353 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36354 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36355 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36356 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36357
36358 Reply:
36359 @table @samp
36360 @item OK
36361 The request succeeded.
36362
36363 @item E @var{nn}
36364 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36365
36366 @item @w{}
36367 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36368 the stub.
36369 @end table
36370
36371 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36372 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36373
36374 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36375 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36376 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36377 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36378 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36379 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36380 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36381 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36382 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36383
36384 Reply:
36385 @table @samp
36386 @item OK
36387 A command response with no output.
36388 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36389 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36390 @item E @var{NN}
36391 Indicate a badly formed request.
36392 @item @w{}
36393 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36394 @end table
36395
36396 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36397 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36398 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36399 packets.)
36400
36401 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36402 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36403 @ifnotinfo
36404 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36405 @end ifnotinfo
36406 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36407 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36408 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36409 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36410 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36411
36412 Reply:
36413 @table @samp
36414 @item 0
36415 The pattern was not found.
36416 @item 1,address
36417 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36418 @item E @var{NN}
36419 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36420 @item @w{}
36421 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36422 @end table
36423
36424 @item QStartNoAckMode
36425 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36426 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36427 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36428 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36429
36430 Reply:
36431 @table @samp
36432 @item OK
36433 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36434 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36435 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36436 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36437 @item @w{}
36438 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36439 @end table
36440
36441 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36442 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36443 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36444 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36445 @anchor{qSupported}
36446 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36447 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36448 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36449 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36450 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36451 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36452 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36453 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36454 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36455 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36456 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36457 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36458 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36459 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36460
36461 Reply:
36462 @table @samp
36463 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36464 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36465 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36466 possible forms).
36467 @item @w{}
36468 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36469 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36470 @end table
36471
36472 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36473 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36474 are:
36475
36476 @table @samp
36477 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36478 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36479 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36480 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36481 @item @var{name}+
36482 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36483 need an associated value.
36484 @item @var{name}-
36485 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36486 @item @var{name}?
36487 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36488 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36489 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36490 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36491 @end table
36492
36493 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36494 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36495 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36496 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36497 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36498
36499 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36500 are defined:
36501
36502 @table @samp
36503 @item multiprocess
36504 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36505 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36506 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36507 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36508 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36509
36510 @item xmlRegisters
36511 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36512 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36513 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36514 description.
36515
36516 @item qRelocInsn
36517 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36518 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36519 instruction reply packet}).
36520
36521 @item swbreak
36522 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36523 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36524
36525 @item hwbreak
36526 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36527 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36528
36529 @item fork-events
36530 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36531 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36532 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36533 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36534
36535 @item vfork-events
36536 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36537 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36538 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36539 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36540
36541 @item exec-events
36542 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36543 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36544 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36545 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36546
36547 @item vContSupported
36548 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36549 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36550 @end table
36551
36552 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36553 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36554 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36555 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36556 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36557 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36558 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36559 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36560 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36561 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36562 all the features it supports.
36563
36564 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36565 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36566
36567 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36568 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36569 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36570 form response.
36571
36572 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36573 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36574 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36575 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36576
36577 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36578 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36579 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36580 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36581 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36582
36583 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36584
36585 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36586 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36587 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36588 @item Feature Name
36589 @tab Value Required
36590 @tab Default
36591 @tab Probe Allowed
36592
36593 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36594 @tab Yes
36595 @tab @samp{-}
36596 @tab No
36597
36598 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36599 @tab No
36600 @tab @samp{-}
36601 @tab Yes
36602
36603 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36604 @tab No
36605 @tab @samp{-}
36606 @tab Yes
36607
36608 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36609 @tab No
36610 @tab @samp{-}
36611 @tab Yes
36612
36613 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36614 @tab No
36615 @tab @samp{-}
36616 @tab Yes
36617
36618 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36619 @tab No
36620 @tab @samp{-}
36621 @tab Yes
36622
36623 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36624 @tab No
36625 @tab @samp{-}
36626 @tab Yes
36627
36628 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36629 @tab No
36630 @tab @samp{-}
36631 @tab Yes
36632
36633 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36634 @tab No
36635 @tab @samp{-}
36636 @tab No
36637
36638 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36639 @tab No
36640 @tab @samp{-}
36641 @tab Yes
36642
36643 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36644 @tab No
36645 @tab @samp{-}
36646 @tab Yes
36647
36648 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36649 @tab No
36650 @tab @samp{-}
36651 @tab Yes
36652
36653 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36654 @tab No
36655 @tab @samp{-}
36656 @tab Yes
36657
36658 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36659 @tab No
36660 @tab @samp{-}
36661 @tab Yes
36662
36663 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36664 @tab No
36665 @tab @samp{-}
36666 @tab Yes
36667
36668 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36669 @tab No
36670 @tab @samp{-}
36671 @tab Yes
36672
36673 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36674 @tab No
36675 @tab @samp{-}
36676 @tab Yes
36677
36678 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36679 @tab No
36680 @tab @samp{-}
36681 @tab Yes
36682
36683 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36684 @tab No
36685 @tab @samp{-}
36686 @tab Yes
36687
36688 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36689 @tab Yes
36690 @tab @samp{-}
36691 @tab Yes
36692
36693 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36694 @tab Yes
36695 @tab @samp{-}
36696 @tab Yes
36697
36698 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36699 @tab Yes
36700 @tab @samp{-}
36701 @tab Yes
36702
36703 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36704 @tab Yes
36705 @tab @samp{-}
36706 @tab Yes
36707
36708 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36709 @tab Yes
36710 @tab @samp{-}
36711 @tab Yes
36712
36713 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36714 @tab No
36715 @tab @samp{-}
36716 @tab Yes
36717
36718 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36719 @tab No
36720 @tab @samp{-}
36721 @tab Yes
36722
36723 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36724 @tab No
36725 @tab @samp{-}
36726 @tab Yes
36727
36728 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36729 @tab No
36730 @tab @samp{-}
36731 @tab Yes
36732
36733 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36734 @tab No
36735 @tab @samp{-}
36736 @tab No
36737
36738 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36739 @tab No
36740 @tab @samp{-}
36741 @tab No
36742
36743 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36744 @tab No
36745 @tab @samp{-}
36746 @tab No
36747
36748 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36749 @tab No
36750 @tab @samp{-}
36751 @tab No
36752
36753 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36754 @tab No
36755 @tab @samp{-}
36756 @tab No
36757
36758 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36759 @tab No
36760 @tab @samp{-}
36761 @tab No
36762
36763 @item @samp{QAgent}
36764 @tab No
36765 @tab @samp{-}
36766 @tab No
36767
36768 @item @samp{QAllow}
36769 @tab No
36770 @tab @samp{-}
36771 @tab No
36772
36773 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36774 @tab No
36775 @tab @samp{-}
36776 @tab No
36777
36778 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36779 @tab No
36780 @tab @samp{-}
36781 @tab No
36782
36783 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36784 @tab No
36785 @tab @samp{-}
36786 @tab No
36787
36788 @item @samp{tracenz}
36789 @tab No
36790 @tab @samp{-}
36791 @tab No
36792
36793 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36794 @tab No
36795 @tab @samp{-}
36796 @tab No
36797
36798 @item @samp{swbreak}
36799 @tab No
36800 @tab @samp{-}
36801 @tab No
36802
36803 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36804 @tab No
36805 @tab @samp{-}
36806 @tab No
36807
36808 @item @samp{fork-events}
36809 @tab No
36810 @tab @samp{-}
36811 @tab No
36812
36813 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36814 @tab No
36815 @tab @samp{-}
36816 @tab No
36817
36818 @item @samp{exec-events}
36819 @tab No
36820 @tab @samp{-}
36821 @tab No
36822
36823 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
36824 @tab No
36825 @tab @samp{-}
36826 @tab No
36827
36828 @item @samp{no-resumed}
36829 @tab No
36830 @tab @samp{-}
36831 @tab No
36832
36833 @end multitable
36834
36835 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36836
36837 @table @samp
36838 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36839 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36840 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36841 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36842 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36843 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36844 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36845 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36846 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36847 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36848
36849 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36850 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36851 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36852
36853 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36854 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36855 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36856
36857 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36858 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36859 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36860
36861 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36862 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36863 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36864
36865 @item qXfer:features:read
36866 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36867 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36868
36869 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36870 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36871 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36872
36873 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36874 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36875 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36876
36877 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36878 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36879 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36880 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36881
36882 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36883 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36884 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36885
36886 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36887 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36888 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36889
36890 @item qXfer:spu:read
36891 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36892 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36893
36894 @item qXfer:spu:write
36895 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36896 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36897
36898 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36899 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36900 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36901
36902 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36903 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36904 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36905
36906 @item qXfer:threads:read
36907 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36908 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36909
36910 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36911 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36912 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36913
36914 @item qXfer:uib:read
36915 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36916 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36917
36918 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36919 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36920 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36921
36922 @item QNonStop
36923 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36924 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36925
36926 @item QCatchSyscalls
36927 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36928 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
36929
36930 @item QPassSignals
36931 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36932 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36933
36934 @item QStartNoAckMode
36935 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36936 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36937
36938 @item multiprocess
36939 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36940 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36941 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36942 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36943 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36944 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36945 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36946 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36947 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36948 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36949 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36950
36951 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36952 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36953 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36954
36955 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36956 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36957 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36958 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36959
36960 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36961 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36962 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36963
36964 @item ReverseContinue
36965 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36966 (@pxref{bc}).
36967
36968 @item ReverseStep
36969 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36970 (@pxref{bs}).
36971
36972 @item TracepointSource
36973 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36974 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36975
36976 @item QAgent
36977 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36978
36979 @item QAllow
36980 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36981
36982 @item QDisableRandomization
36983 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36984
36985 @item StaticTracepoint
36986 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36987 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36988
36989 @item InstallInTrace
36990 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36991 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36992
36993 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36994 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36995 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36996 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36997
36998 @item QTBuffer:size
36999 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37000 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37001
37002 @item tracenz
37003 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37004 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37005 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37006
37007 @item BreakpointCommands
37008 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37009 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37010 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37011
37012 @item Qbtrace:off
37013 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37014
37015 @item Qbtrace:bts
37016 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37017
37018 @item Qbtrace:pt
37019 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37020
37021 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37022 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37023
37024 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37025 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37026
37027 @item swbreak
37028 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37029 breakpoints.
37030
37031 @item hwbreak
37032 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37033 breakpoints.
37034
37035 @item fork-events
37036 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37037
37038 @item vfork-events
37039 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37040 and vforkdone events.
37041
37042 @item exec-events
37043 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37044
37045 @item vContSupported
37046 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37047 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37048
37049 @item QThreadEvents
37050 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37051
37052 @item no-resumed
37053 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37054
37055 @end table
37056
37057 @item qSymbol::
37058 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37059 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37060 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37061 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37062
37063 Reply:
37064 @table @samp
37065 @item OK
37066 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37067 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37068 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37069 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37070 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37071 below.
37072 @end table
37073
37074 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37075 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37076
37077 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37078 target has previously requested.
37079
37080 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37081 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37082 will be empty.
37083
37084 Reply:
37085 @table @samp
37086 @item OK
37087 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37088 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37089 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37090 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37091 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37092 @end table
37093
37094 @item qTBuffer
37095 @itemx QTBuffer
37096 @itemx QTDisconnected
37097 @itemx QTDP
37098 @itemx QTDPsrc
37099 @itemx QTDV
37100 @itemx qTfP
37101 @itemx qTfV
37102 @itemx QTFrame
37103 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37104
37105 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37106
37107 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37108 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37109 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37110 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37111 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37112 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37113 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37114 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37115 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37116 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37117 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37118
37119 Reply:
37120 @table @samp
37121 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37122 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37123 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37124 the thread's attributes.
37125 @end table
37126
37127 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37128 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37129 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37130 packets.)
37131
37132 @item QTNotes
37133 @itemx qTP
37134 @itemx QTSave
37135 @itemx qTsP
37136 @itemx qTsV
37137 @itemx QTStart
37138 @itemx QTStop
37139 @itemx QTEnable
37140 @itemx QTDisable
37141 @itemx QTinit
37142 @itemx QTro
37143 @itemx qTStatus
37144 @itemx qTV
37145 @itemx qTfSTM
37146 @itemx qTsSTM
37147 @itemx qTSTMat
37148 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37149
37150 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37151 @cindex read special object, remote request
37152 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37153 @anchor{qXfer read}
37154 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37155 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37156 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37157 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37158 additional details about what data to access.
37159
37160 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37161 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37162 formats, listed below.
37163
37164 @table @samp
37165 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37166 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37167 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37168 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37169
37170 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37171 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37172
37173 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37174 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37175
37176 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37177 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37178 packet may have one of the following values:
37179
37180 @table @code
37181 @item all
37182 Returns all available branch trace.
37183
37184 @item new
37185 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37186 the last read request.
37187
37188 @item delta
37189 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37190 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37191 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37192 used to stitch traces together.
37193
37194 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37195 @end table
37196
37197 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37198 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37199
37200 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37201 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37202
37203 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37204 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37205
37206 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37207 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37208
37209 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37210 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37211 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37212 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37213 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37214 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37215 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37216
37217 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37218 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37219
37220 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37221 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37222 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37223 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37224 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37225
37226 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37227 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37228
37229 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37230 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37231 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37232 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37233 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37234
37235 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37236 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37237 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37238
37239 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37240 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37241
37242 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37243 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37244 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37245 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37246 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37247 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37248 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37249 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37250
37251 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37252 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37253
37254 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37255 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37256
37257 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37258 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37259 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37260 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37261
37262 @table @code
37263 @item start=@var{address}
37264 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37265 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37266 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37267 chosen as the starting point.
37268
37269 @item prev=@var{address}
37270 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37271 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37272 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37273 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37274 exists prior to the starting point.
37275
37276 @end table
37277
37278 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37279 ignored.
37280
37281 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37282 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37283 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37284 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37285 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37286
37287 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37288 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37289
37290 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37291 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37292
37293 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37294 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37295 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37296 Action Lists}.
37297
37298 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37299 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37300 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37301
37302 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37303 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37304 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37305 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37306 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37307
37308 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37309 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37310 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37311
37312 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37313 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37314 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37315 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37316 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37317 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37318 in that context to be accessed.
37319
37320 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37321 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37322 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37323
37324 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37325 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37326 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37327 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37328 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37329
37330 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37331 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37332
37333 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37334 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37335
37336 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37337 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37338 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37339
37340 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37341 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37342
37343 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37344 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37345
37346 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37347 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37348
37349 This packet is not probed by default.
37350
37351 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37352 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37353 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37354 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37355 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37356
37357 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37358 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37359
37360 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37361 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37362 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37363 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37364
37365 @end table
37366
37367 Reply:
37368 @table @samp
37369 @item m @var{data}
37370 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37371 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37372 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37373 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37374 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37375 request.
37376
37377 @item l @var{data}
37378 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37379 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37380 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37381
37382 @item l
37383 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37384 There is no more data to be read.
37385
37386 @item E00
37387 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37388
37389 @item E @var{nn}
37390 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37391 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37392
37393 @item @w{}
37394 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37395 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37396 @end table
37397
37398 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37399 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37400 @anchor{qXfer write}
37401 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37402 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37403 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37404 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37405 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37406 to access.
37407
37408 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37409 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37410 formats, listed below.
37411
37412 @table @samp
37413 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37414 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37415 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37416 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37417 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37418
37419 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37420 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37421 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37422
37423 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37424 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37425 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37426 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37427 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37428 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37429 in that context to be accessed.
37430
37431 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37432 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37433 @end table
37434
37435 Reply:
37436 @table @samp
37437 @item @var{nn}
37438 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37439 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37440
37441 @item E00
37442 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37443
37444 @item E @var{nn}
37445 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37446 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37447
37448 @item @w{}
37449 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37450 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37451 @end table
37452
37453 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37454 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37455 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37456 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37457 must respond with an empty packet.
37458
37459 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37460 @cindex query attached, remote request
37461 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37462 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37463 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37464 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37465 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37466 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37467 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37468
37469 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37470 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37471 the @code{quit} command.
37472
37473 Reply:
37474 @table @samp
37475 @item 1
37476 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37477 @item 0
37478 The remote server created a new process.
37479 @item E @var{NN}
37480 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37481 @end table
37482
37483 @item Qbtrace:bts
37484 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37485
37486 Reply:
37487 @table @samp
37488 @item OK
37489 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37490 @item E.errtext
37491 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37492 @end table
37493
37494 @item Qbtrace:pt
37495 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37496
37497 Reply:
37498 @table @samp
37499 @item OK
37500 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37501 @item E.errtext
37502 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37503 @end table
37504
37505 @item Qbtrace:off
37506 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37507
37508 Reply:
37509 @table @samp
37510 @item OK
37511 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37512 @item E.errtext
37513 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37514 @end table
37515
37516 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37517 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37518 btrace recording method in bts format.
37519
37520 Reply:
37521 @table @samp
37522 @item OK
37523 The ring buffer size has been set.
37524 @item E.errtext
37525 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37526 @end table
37527
37528 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37529 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37530 btrace recording method in pt format.
37531
37532 Reply:
37533 @table @samp
37534 @item OK
37535 The ring buffer size has been set.
37536 @item E.errtext
37537 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37538 @end table
37539
37540 @end table
37541
37542 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37543 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37544
37545 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37546 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37547 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37548
37549 @menu
37550 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37551 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37552 @end menu
37553
37554 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37555 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37556
37557 @menu
37558 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37559 @end menu
37560
37561 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37562 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37563 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37564
37565 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37566
37567 @table @r
37568
37569 @item 2
37570 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37571
37572 @item 3
37573 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37574
37575 @item 4
37576 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37577
37578 @end table
37579
37580 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37581 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37582
37583 @menu
37584 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37585 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37586 @end menu
37587
37588 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37589 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37590 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37591
37592 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37593 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37594 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37595 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37596 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37597 most-significant -- least-significant.
37598
37599 @table @r
37600
37601 @item MIPS32
37602 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37603 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37604 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37605
37606 @item MIPS64
37607 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37608 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37609 as @code{MIPS32}.
37610
37611 @end table
37612
37613 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37614 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37615 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37616
37617 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37618
37619 @table @r
37620
37621 @item 2
37622 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37623
37624 @item 3
37625 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37626
37627 @item 4
37628 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37629
37630 @item 5
37631 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37632
37633 @end table
37634
37635 @node Tracepoint Packets
37636 @section Tracepoint Packets
37637 @cindex tracepoint packets
37638 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37639
37640 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37641 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37642
37643 @table @samp
37644
37645 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37646 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37647 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37648 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37649 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37650 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37651 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37652 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37653 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37654 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37655 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37656 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37657 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37658 actions.
37659
37660 Replies:
37661 @table @samp
37662 @item OK
37663 The packet was understood and carried out.
37664 @item qRelocInsn
37665 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37666 @item @w{}
37667 The packet was not recognized.
37668 @end table
37669
37670 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37671 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37672 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37673 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37674 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37675 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37676 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37677
37678 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37679 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37680 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37681 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37682 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37683 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37684 tracepoint actions.
37685
37686 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37687 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37688 following forms:
37689
37690 @table @samp
37691
37692 @item R @var{mask}
37693 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37694 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37695 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37696 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37697 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37698
37699 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37700 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37701 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37702 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37703 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37704 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37705 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37706
37707 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37708 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37709 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37710 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37711 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37712 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37713 packet).
37714
37715 @end table
37716
37717 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37718 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37719 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37720 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37721 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37722 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37723 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37724 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37725
37726 Replies:
37727 @table @samp
37728 @item OK
37729 The packet was understood and carried out.
37730 @item qRelocInsn
37731 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37732 @item @w{}
37733 The packet was not recognized.
37734 @end table
37735
37736 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37737 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37738 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37739 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37740 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37741 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37742 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37743 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37744
37745 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37746 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37747 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37748 fit in a single packet.
37749 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37750 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37751
37752 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37753 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37754 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37755 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37756
37757 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37758 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37759 query packets.
37760
37761 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37762 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37763 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37764 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37765 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37766 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37767 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37768 be found.
37769
37770 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37771 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37772 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37773 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37774 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37775 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37776 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37777 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37778 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37779 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37780 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37781 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37782 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37783 variable.
37784
37785 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37786 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37787 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37788 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37789 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37790
37791 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37792 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37793 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37794 one of the following forms:
37795
37796 @table @samp
37797 @item F @var{f}
37798 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37799 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37800 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37801
37802 @item T @var{t}
37803 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37804 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37805
37806 @end table
37807
37808 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37809 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37810 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37811 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37812
37813 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37814 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37815 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37816 is a hexadecimal number.
37817
37818 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37819 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37820 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37821 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37822 numbers.
37823
37824 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37825 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37826 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37827
37828 @item qTMinFTPILen
37829 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37830 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37831 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37832 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37833 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37834 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37835 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37836 arrange for that.
37837
37838 Replies:
37839
37840 @table @samp
37841 @item 0
37842 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37843 @item @var{length}
37844 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37845 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37846 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37847 regardless of size.
37848 @item E
37849 An error has occurred.
37850 @item @w{}
37851 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37852 @end table
37853
37854 @item QTStart
37855 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37856 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37857 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37858 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37859 instruction reply packet}).
37860
37861 @item QTStop
37862 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37863 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37864
37865 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37866 @anchor{QTEnable}
37867 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37868 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37869 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37870 of data from it will resume.
37871
37872 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37873 @anchor{QTDisable}
37874 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37875 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37876 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37877 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37878
37879 @item QTinit
37880 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37881 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37882
37883 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37884 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37885 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37886 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37887 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37888
37889 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37890 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37891 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37892 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37893
37894 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37895 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37896 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37897 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37898 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37899 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37900
37901 @item qTStatus
37902 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37903 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37904
37905 The reply has the form:
37906
37907 @table @samp
37908
37909 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37910 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37911 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37912 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37913
37914 @end table
37915
37916 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37917 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37918
37919 @table @samp
37920
37921 @item tnotrun:0
37922 No trace has been run yet.
37923
37924 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37925 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37926 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37927 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37928 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37929
37930 @item tfull:0
37931 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37932
37933 @item tdisconnected:0
37934 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37935
37936 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37937 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37938
37939 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37940 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37941 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37942 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37943 is hex encoded.
37944
37945 @item tunknown:0
37946 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37947
37948 @end table
37949
37950 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37951 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37952 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37953 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37954 trace.
37955
37956 @table @samp
37957
37958 @item tframes:@var{n}
37959 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37960
37961 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37962 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37963 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37964
37965 @item tsize:@var{n}
37966 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37967
37968 @item tfree:@var{n}
37969 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37970
37971 @item circular:@var{n}
37972 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37973 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37974 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37975 and may fill up.
37976
37977 @item disconn:@var{n}
37978 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37979 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37980 that the trace run will stop.
37981
37982 @end table
37983
37984 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37985 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37986 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37987 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37988 address @var{addr}.
37989
37990 Replies:
37991 @table @samp
37992 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37993 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37994 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37995 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37996 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37997
37998 @end table
37999
38000 @item qTV:@var{var}
38001 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38002 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38003 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38004
38005 Replies:
38006 @table @samp
38007 @item V@var{value}
38008 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38009 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38010 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38011 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38012 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38013 program is running.
38014
38015 @item U
38016 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38017 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38018 was not collected.
38019 @end table
38020
38021 @item qTfP
38022 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38023 @itemx qTsP
38024 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38025 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38026 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38027 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38028 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38029 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38030
38031 @item qTfV
38032 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38033 @itemx qTsV
38034 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38035 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38036 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38037 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38038 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38039 trace state variables.
38040
38041 @item qTfSTM
38042 @itemx qTsSTM
38043 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38044 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38045 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38046 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38047 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38048 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38049 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38050 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38051
38052 Reply:
38053 @table @samp
38054 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38055 A single marker
38056 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38057 a comma-separated list of markers
38058 @item l
38059 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38060 @item E @var{nn}
38061 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38062 @item @w{}
38063 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38064 stub.
38065 @end table
38066
38067 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38068 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38069
38070 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38071 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38072 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38073 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38074 @dfn{last}).
38075
38076 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38077 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38078 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38079 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38080 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38081 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38082 tracepoint markers.
38083
38084 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38085 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38086 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38087 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38088 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38089 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38090
38091 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38092 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38093 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38094 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38095 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38096 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38097 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38098 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38099 available.
38100
38101 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38102 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38103 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38104
38105 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38106 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38107 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38108 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38109 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38110 use whatever size it prefers.
38111
38112 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38113 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38114 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38115 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38116 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38117
38118 @end table
38119
38120 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38121 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38122 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38123 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38124 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38125 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38126 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38127 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38128 it had executed in the original location.
38129
38130 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38131 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38132 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38133 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38134 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38135 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38136 format of the request is:
38137
38138 @table @samp
38139 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38140
38141 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38142 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38143 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38144 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38145 memory starting at @var{to}.
38146 @end table
38147
38148 Replies:
38149 @table @samp
38150 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38151 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38152 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38153 @item E @var{NN}
38154 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38155 relocating the instruction.
38156 @end table
38157
38158 @node Host I/O Packets
38159 @section Host I/O Packets
38160 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38161 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38162
38163 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38164 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38165 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38166 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38167 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38168 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38169 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38170 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38171 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38172 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38173
38174 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38175 its arguments. They have this format:
38176
38177 @table @samp
38178
38179 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38180 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38181 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38182 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38183 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38184 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38185 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38186 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38187 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38188
38189 @end table
38190
38191 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38192
38193 @table @samp
38194
38195 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38196 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38197 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38198 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38199 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38200 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38201 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38202 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38203 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38204 @var{attachment}.
38205
38206 @item @w{}
38207 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38208
38209 @end table
38210
38211 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38212
38213 @table @samp
38214 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38215 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38216 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38217 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38218 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38219 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38220 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38221
38222 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38223 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38224 -1 if an error occurs.
38225
38226 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38227 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38228 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38229 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38230 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38231 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38232 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38233 @var{count} was zero.
38234
38235 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38236 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38237 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38238 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38239 some characters were escaped.
38240
38241 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38242 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38243 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38244 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38245 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38246 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38247 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38248 error occurred.
38249
38250 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38251 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38252 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38253 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38254 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38255 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38256
38257 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38258 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38259 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38260
38261 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38262 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38263 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38264
38265 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38266 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38267 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38268 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38269 some characters were escaped.
38270
38271 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38272 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38273 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38274 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38275 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38276 inferior(s).
38277
38278 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38279 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38280 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38281 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38282 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38283 operation.
38284
38285 @end table
38286
38287 @node Interrupts
38288 @section Interrupts
38289 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38290 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38291
38292 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38293 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38294 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38295 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38296
38297 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38298 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38299 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38300 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38301 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38302
38303 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38304 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38305 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38306 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38307 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38308 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38309 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38310 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38311
38312 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38313 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38314 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38315
38316 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38317 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38318 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38319 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38320 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38321 @code{0x03}.
38322
38323 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38324 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38325 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38326 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38327 currently-executing threads and processes.
38328 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38329 running program, it should send one of the stop
38330 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38331 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38332 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38333 Interrupts received while the
38334 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38335 it is resumed next time.
38336
38337 @node Notification Packets
38338 @section Notification Packets
38339 @cindex notification packets
38340 @cindex packets, notification
38341
38342 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38343 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38344 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38345 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38346 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38347 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38348 is not a problem.
38349
38350 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38351 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38352 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38353 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38354 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38355 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38356 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38357
38358 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38359 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38360
38361 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38362 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38363 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38364 not they understand it.
38365
38366 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38367 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38368 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38369 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38370 recipients.
38371
38372 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38373 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38374 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38375 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38376 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38377
38378 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38379 @table @samp
38380 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38381 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38382 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38383 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38384 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38385 @item @var{ack}
38386 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38387 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38388 @end table
38389
38390 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38391 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38392
38393 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38394 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38395 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38396 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38397 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38398 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38399 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38400 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38401 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38402 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38403
38404 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38405 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38406 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38407 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38408 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38409 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38410
38411 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38412 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38413 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38414 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38415 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38416
38417 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38418 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38419 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38420 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38421 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38422 normally.
38423
38424 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38425 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38426 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38427 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38428 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38429 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38430 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38431 the process shall be repeated.
38432
38433 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38434 following example:
38435 @smallexample
38436 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38437 @code{...}
38438 -> @code{vStopped}
38439 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38440 -> @code{vStopped}
38441 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38442 -> @code{vStopped}
38443 <- @code{OK}
38444 @end smallexample
38445
38446 The following notifications are defined:
38447 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38448
38449 @item Notification
38450 @tab Ack
38451 @tab Event
38452 @tab Description
38453
38454 @item Stop
38455 @tab vStopped
38456 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38457 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38458 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38459 @value{GDBN}.
38460 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38461
38462 @end multitable
38463
38464 @node Remote Non-Stop
38465 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38466
38467 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38468 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38469 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38470 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38471
38472 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38473 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38474 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38475 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38476 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38477 probe the target state after a mode change.
38478
38479 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38480 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38481 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38482 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38483 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38484 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38485 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38486 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38487 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38488 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38489 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38490
38491 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38492 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38493 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38494 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38495 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38496 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38497 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38498 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38499 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38500 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38501 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38502 @samp{OK}.
38503
38504 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38505 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38506 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38507 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38508 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38509 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38510 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38511 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38512 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38513 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38514 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38515 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38516 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38517
38518 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38519 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38520
38521 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38522 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38523 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38524 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38525 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38526 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38527 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38528
38529 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38530 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38531 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38532 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38533 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38534
38535 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38536 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38537 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38538 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38539
38540 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38541 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38542 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38543 @pxref{qSupported}.
38544 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38545 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38546 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38547 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38548 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38549 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38550 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38551
38552 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38553 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38554 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38555 connection.
38556 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38557 new connection is established,
38558 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38559 for the current connection, once disabled.
38560
38561 @node Examples
38562 @section Examples
38563
38564 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38565 does not get any direct output:
38566
38567 @smallexample
38568 -> @code{R00}
38569 <- @code{+}
38570 @emph{target restarts}
38571 -> @code{?}
38572 <- @code{+}
38573 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38574 -> @code{+}
38575 @end smallexample
38576
38577 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38578
38579 @smallexample
38580 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38581 <- @code{+}
38582 -> @code{s}
38583 <- @code{+}
38584 @emph{time passes}
38585 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38586 -> @code{+}
38587 -> @code{g}
38588 <- @code{+}
38589 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38590 -> @code{+}
38591 @end smallexample
38592
38593 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38594 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38595 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38596
38597 @menu
38598 * File-I/O Overview::
38599 * Protocol Basics::
38600 * The F Request Packet::
38601 * The F Reply Packet::
38602 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38603 * Console I/O::
38604 * List of Supported Calls::
38605 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38606 * Constants::
38607 * File-I/O Examples::
38608 @end menu
38609
38610 @node File-I/O Overview
38611 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38612 @cindex file-i/o overview
38613
38614 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38615 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38616 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38617 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38618 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38619 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38620
38621 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38622 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38623 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38624 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38625 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38626
38627 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38628 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38629 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38630 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38631 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38632 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38633 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38634
38635 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38636 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38637 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38638 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38639 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38640
38641 @smallexample
38642 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38643 <- target requests 'system call X'
38644 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38645 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38646 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38647 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38648 @end smallexample
38649
38650 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38651 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38652 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38653 system are not supported by this protocol.
38654
38655 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38656
38657 @node Protocol Basics
38658 @subsection Protocol Basics
38659 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38660
38661 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38662 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38663 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38664 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38665 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38666 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38667 to call the appropriate host system call:
38668
38669 @itemize @bullet
38670 @item
38671 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38672
38673 @item
38674 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38675 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38676 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38677 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38678
38679 @end itemize
38680
38681 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38682
38683 @itemize @bullet
38684 @item
38685 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38686 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38687 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38688 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38689 packet.
38690
38691 @item
38692 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38693 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38694
38695 @item
38696 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38697
38698 @item
38699 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38700
38701 @item
38702 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38703 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38704 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38705 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38706 packet.
38707
38708 @end itemize
38709
38710 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38711 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38712
38713 @itemize @bullet
38714 @item
38715 Return value.
38716
38717 @item
38718 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38719
38720 @item
38721 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38722
38723 @end itemize
38724
38725 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38726 the latest continue or step action.
38727
38728 @node The F Request Packet
38729 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38730 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38731 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38732
38733 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38734
38735 @table @samp
38736 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38737
38738 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38739 This is just the name of the function.
38740
38741 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38742 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38743 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38744 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38745 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38746 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38747 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38748
38749 @end table
38750
38751
38752
38753 @node The F Reply Packet
38754 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38755 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38756 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38757
38758 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38759
38760 @table @samp
38761
38762 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38763
38764 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38765
38766 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38767 representation.
38768 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38769
38770 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38771 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38772 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38773
38774 @smallexample
38775 F0,0,C
38776 @end smallexample
38777
38778 @noindent
38779 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38780
38781 @smallexample
38782 F-1,4,C
38783 @end smallexample
38784
38785 @noindent
38786 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38787
38788 @end table
38789
38790
38791 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38792 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38793 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38794
38795 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38796 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38797 the target should behave as if it had
38798 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38799 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38800 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38801 packet.
38802
38803 It's important for the target to know in which
38804 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38805
38806 @itemize @bullet
38807 @item
38808 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38809
38810 @item
38811 The system call on the host has been finished.
38812
38813 @end itemize
38814
38815 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38816 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38817 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38818 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38819 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38820 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38821
38822 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38823 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38824 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38825 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38826 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38827 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38828 or the full action has been completed.
38829
38830 @node Console I/O
38831 @subsection Console I/O
38832 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38833
38834 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38835 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38836 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38837 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38838 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38839 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38840 conditions is met:
38841
38842 @itemize @bullet
38843 @item
38844 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38845 @code{read}
38846 system call is treated as finished.
38847
38848 @item
38849 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38850 newline.
38851
38852 @item
38853 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38854 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38855
38856 @end itemize
38857
38858 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38859 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38860 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38861 is stopped at the user's request.
38862
38863
38864 @node List of Supported Calls
38865 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38866 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38867
38868 @menu
38869 * open::
38870 * close::
38871 * read::
38872 * write::
38873 * lseek::
38874 * rename::
38875 * unlink::
38876 * stat/fstat::
38877 * gettimeofday::
38878 * isatty::
38879 * system::
38880 @end menu
38881
38882 @node open
38883 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38884 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38885
38886 @table @asis
38887 @item Synopsis:
38888 @smallexample
38889 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38890 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38891 @end smallexample
38892
38893 @item Request:
38894 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38895
38896 @noindent
38897 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38898
38899 @table @code
38900 @item O_CREAT
38901 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38902 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38903 are concerned.
38904
38905 @item O_EXCL
38906 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38907 an error and open() fails.
38908
38909 @item O_TRUNC
38910 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38911 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38912 truncated to zero length.
38913
38914 @item O_APPEND
38915 The file is opened in append mode.
38916
38917 @item O_RDONLY
38918 The file is opened for reading only.
38919
38920 @item O_WRONLY
38921 The file is opened for writing only.
38922
38923 @item O_RDWR
38924 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38925 @end table
38926
38927 @noindent
38928 Other bits are silently ignored.
38929
38930
38931 @noindent
38932 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38933
38934 @table @code
38935 @item S_IRUSR
38936 User has read permission.
38937
38938 @item S_IWUSR
38939 User has write permission.
38940
38941 @item S_IRGRP
38942 Group has read permission.
38943
38944 @item S_IWGRP
38945 Group has write permission.
38946
38947 @item S_IROTH
38948 Others have read permission.
38949
38950 @item S_IWOTH
38951 Others have write permission.
38952 @end table
38953
38954 @noindent
38955 Other bits are silently ignored.
38956
38957
38958 @item Return value:
38959 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38960 occurred.
38961
38962 @item Errors:
38963
38964 @table @code
38965 @item EEXIST
38966 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38967
38968 @item EISDIR
38969 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38970
38971 @item EACCES
38972 The requested access is not allowed.
38973
38974 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38975 @var{pathname} was too long.
38976
38977 @item ENOENT
38978 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38979
38980 @item ENODEV
38981 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38982
38983 @item EROFS
38984 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38985 write access was requested.
38986
38987 @item EFAULT
38988 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38989
38990 @item ENOSPC
38991 No space on device to create the file.
38992
38993 @item EMFILE
38994 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38995
38996 @item ENFILE
38997 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38998 has been reached.
38999
39000 @item EINTR
39001 The call was interrupted by the user.
39002 @end table
39003
39004 @end table
39005
39006 @node close
39007 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39008 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39009
39010 @table @asis
39011 @item Synopsis:
39012 @smallexample
39013 int close(int fd);
39014 @end smallexample
39015
39016 @item Request:
39017 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39018
39019 @item Return value:
39020 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39021
39022 @item Errors:
39023
39024 @table @code
39025 @item EBADF
39026 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39027
39028 @item EINTR
39029 The call was interrupted by the user.
39030 @end table
39031
39032 @end table
39033
39034 @node read
39035 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39036 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39037
39038 @table @asis
39039 @item Synopsis:
39040 @smallexample
39041 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39042 @end smallexample
39043
39044 @item Request:
39045 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39046
39047 @item Return value:
39048 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39049 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39050 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39051
39052 @item Errors:
39053
39054 @table @code
39055 @item EBADF
39056 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39057 reading.
39058
39059 @item EFAULT
39060 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39061
39062 @item EINTR
39063 The call was interrupted by the user.
39064 @end table
39065
39066 @end table
39067
39068 @node write
39069 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39070 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39071
39072 @table @asis
39073 @item Synopsis:
39074 @smallexample
39075 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39076 @end smallexample
39077
39078 @item Request:
39079 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39080
39081 @item Return value:
39082 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39083 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39084 is returned.
39085
39086 @item Errors:
39087
39088 @table @code
39089 @item EBADF
39090 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39091 writing.
39092
39093 @item EFAULT
39094 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39095
39096 @item EFBIG
39097 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39098 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39099
39100 @item ENOSPC
39101 No space on device to write the data.
39102
39103 @item EINTR
39104 The call was interrupted by the user.
39105 @end table
39106
39107 @end table
39108
39109 @node lseek
39110 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39111 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39112
39113 @table @asis
39114 @item Synopsis:
39115 @smallexample
39116 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39117 @end smallexample
39118
39119 @item Request:
39120 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39121
39122 @var{flag} is one of:
39123
39124 @table @code
39125 @item SEEK_SET
39126 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39127
39128 @item SEEK_CUR
39129 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39130 bytes.
39131
39132 @item SEEK_END
39133 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39134 bytes.
39135 @end table
39136
39137 @item Return value:
39138 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39139 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39140 value of -1 is returned.
39141
39142 @item Errors:
39143
39144 @table @code
39145 @item EBADF
39146 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39147
39148 @item ESPIPE
39149 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39150
39151 @item EINVAL
39152 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39153
39154 @item EINTR
39155 The call was interrupted by the user.
39156 @end table
39157
39158 @end table
39159
39160 @node rename
39161 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39162 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39163
39164 @table @asis
39165 @item Synopsis:
39166 @smallexample
39167 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39168 @end smallexample
39169
39170 @item Request:
39171 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39172
39173 @item Return value:
39174 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39175
39176 @item Errors:
39177
39178 @table @code
39179 @item EISDIR
39180 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39181 directory.
39182
39183 @item EEXIST
39184 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39185
39186 @item EBUSY
39187 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39188 process.
39189
39190 @item EINVAL
39191 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39192 of itself.
39193
39194 @item ENOTDIR
39195 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39196 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39197 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39198
39199 @item EFAULT
39200 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39201
39202 @item EACCES
39203 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39204
39205 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39206
39207 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39208
39209 @item ENOENT
39210 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39211
39212 @item EROFS
39213 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39214
39215 @item ENOSPC
39216 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39217 directory entry.
39218
39219 @item EINTR
39220 The call was interrupted by the user.
39221 @end table
39222
39223 @end table
39224
39225 @node unlink
39226 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39227 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39228
39229 @table @asis
39230 @item Synopsis:
39231 @smallexample
39232 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39233 @end smallexample
39234
39235 @item Request:
39236 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39237
39238 @item Return value:
39239 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39240
39241 @item Errors:
39242
39243 @table @code
39244 @item EACCES
39245 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39246
39247 @item EPERM
39248 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39249
39250 @item EBUSY
39251 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39252 being used by another process.
39253
39254 @item EFAULT
39255 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39256
39257 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39258 @var{pathname} was too long.
39259
39260 @item ENOENT
39261 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39262
39263 @item ENOTDIR
39264 A component of the path is not a directory.
39265
39266 @item EROFS
39267 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39268
39269 @item EINTR
39270 The call was interrupted by the user.
39271 @end table
39272
39273 @end table
39274
39275 @node stat/fstat
39276 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39277 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39278 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39279
39280 @table @asis
39281 @item Synopsis:
39282 @smallexample
39283 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39284 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39285 @end smallexample
39286
39287 @item Request:
39288 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39289 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39290
39291 @item Return value:
39292 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39293
39294 @item Errors:
39295
39296 @table @code
39297 @item EBADF
39298 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39299
39300 @item ENOENT
39301 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39302 path is an empty string.
39303
39304 @item ENOTDIR
39305 A component of the path is not a directory.
39306
39307 @item EFAULT
39308 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39309
39310 @item EACCES
39311 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39312
39313 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39314 @var{pathname} was too long.
39315
39316 @item EINTR
39317 The call was interrupted by the user.
39318 @end table
39319
39320 @end table
39321
39322 @node gettimeofday
39323 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39324 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39325
39326 @table @asis
39327 @item Synopsis:
39328 @smallexample
39329 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39330 @end smallexample
39331
39332 @item Request:
39333 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39334
39335 @item Return value:
39336 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39337
39338 @item Errors:
39339
39340 @table @code
39341 @item EINVAL
39342 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39343
39344 @item EFAULT
39345 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39346 @end table
39347
39348 @end table
39349
39350 @node isatty
39351 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39352 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39353
39354 @table @asis
39355 @item Synopsis:
39356 @smallexample
39357 int isatty(int fd);
39358 @end smallexample
39359
39360 @item Request:
39361 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39362
39363 @item Return value:
39364 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39365
39366 @item Errors:
39367
39368 @table @code
39369 @item EINTR
39370 The call was interrupted by the user.
39371 @end table
39372
39373 @end table
39374
39375 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39376 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39377 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39378 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39379 needed.
39380
39381
39382 @node system
39383 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39384 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39385
39386 @table @asis
39387 @item Synopsis:
39388 @smallexample
39389 int system(const char *command);
39390 @end smallexample
39391
39392 @item Request:
39393 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39394
39395 @item Return value:
39396 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39397 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39398 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39399 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39400 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39401 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39402 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39403
39404 @item Errors:
39405
39406 @table @code
39407 @item EINTR
39408 The call was interrupted by the user.
39409 @end table
39410
39411 @end table
39412
39413 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39414 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39415 the host is simplified before it's returned
39416 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39417 is discarded, and the return value consists
39418 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39419
39420 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39421 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39422 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39423
39424 @table @code
39425 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39426 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39427 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39428 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39429
39430 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39431 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39432 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39433 protocol.
39434 @end table
39435
39436 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39437 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39438 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39439
39440 @menu
39441 * Integral Datatypes::
39442 * Pointer Values::
39443 * Memory Transfer::
39444 * struct stat::
39445 * struct timeval::
39446 @end menu
39447
39448 @node Integral Datatypes
39449 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39450 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39451
39452 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39453 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39454 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39455
39456 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39457 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39458
39459 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39460
39461 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39462 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39463
39464 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39465
39466 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39467 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39468 byte order.
39469
39470 @node Pointer Values
39471 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39472 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39473
39474 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39475 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39476 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39477 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39478
39479 @smallexample
39480 @code{1aaf/12}
39481 @end smallexample
39482
39483 @noindent
39484 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39485 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39486 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39487 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39488
39489 @smallexample
39490 @code{123456/d}
39491 @end smallexample
39492
39493 @node Memory Transfer
39494 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39495 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39496
39497 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39498 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39499 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39500 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39501 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39502 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39503 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39504
39505
39506 @node struct stat
39507 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39508 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39509
39510 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39511 is defined as follows:
39512
39513 @smallexample
39514 struct stat @{
39515 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39516 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39517 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39518 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39519 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39520 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39521 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39522 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39523 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39524 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39525 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39526 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39527 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39528 @};
39529 @end smallexample
39530
39531 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39532 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39533 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39534
39535 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39536 range of values.
39537
39538 @table @code
39539
39540 @item st_dev
39541 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39542
39543 @item st_ino
39544 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39545
39546 @item st_mode
39547 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39548 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39549
39550 @item st_uid
39551 @itemx st_gid
39552 @itemx st_rdev
39553 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39554
39555 @item st_atime
39556 @itemx st_mtime
39557 @itemx st_ctime
39558 These values have a host and file system dependent
39559 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39560 support exact timing values.
39561 @end table
39562
39563 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39564 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39565 continuing.
39566
39567 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39568 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39569 get truncated on the target.
39570
39571 @node struct timeval
39572 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39573 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39574
39575 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39576 is defined as follows:
39577
39578 @smallexample
39579 struct timeval @{
39580 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39581 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39582 @};
39583 @end smallexample
39584
39585 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39586 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39587 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39588
39589 @node Constants
39590 @subsection Constants
39591 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39592
39593 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39594 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39595 values before and after the call as needed.
39596
39597 @menu
39598 * Open Flags::
39599 * mode_t Values::
39600 * Errno Values::
39601 * Lseek Flags::
39602 * Limits::
39603 @end menu
39604
39605 @node Open Flags
39606 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39607 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39608
39609 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39610
39611 @smallexample
39612 O_RDONLY 0x0
39613 O_WRONLY 0x1
39614 O_RDWR 0x2
39615 O_APPEND 0x8
39616 O_CREAT 0x200
39617 O_TRUNC 0x400
39618 O_EXCL 0x800
39619 @end smallexample
39620
39621 @node mode_t Values
39622 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39623 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39624
39625 All values are given in octal representation.
39626
39627 @smallexample
39628 S_IFREG 0100000
39629 S_IFDIR 040000
39630 S_IRUSR 0400
39631 S_IWUSR 0200
39632 S_IXUSR 0100
39633 S_IRGRP 040
39634 S_IWGRP 020
39635 S_IXGRP 010
39636 S_IROTH 04
39637 S_IWOTH 02
39638 S_IXOTH 01
39639 @end smallexample
39640
39641 @node Errno Values
39642 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39643 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39644
39645 All values are given in decimal representation.
39646
39647 @smallexample
39648 EPERM 1
39649 ENOENT 2
39650 EINTR 4
39651 EBADF 9
39652 EACCES 13
39653 EFAULT 14
39654 EBUSY 16
39655 EEXIST 17
39656 ENODEV 19
39657 ENOTDIR 20
39658 EISDIR 21
39659 EINVAL 22
39660 ENFILE 23
39661 EMFILE 24
39662 EFBIG 27
39663 ENOSPC 28
39664 ESPIPE 29
39665 EROFS 30
39666 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39667 EUNKNOWN 9999
39668 @end smallexample
39669
39670 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39671 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39672
39673 @node Lseek Flags
39674 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39675 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39676
39677 @smallexample
39678 SEEK_SET 0
39679 SEEK_CUR 1
39680 SEEK_END 2
39681 @end smallexample
39682
39683 @node Limits
39684 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39685 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39686
39687 All values are given in decimal representation.
39688
39689 @smallexample
39690 INT_MIN -2147483648
39691 INT_MAX 2147483647
39692 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39693 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39694 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39695 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39696 @end smallexample
39697
39698 @node File-I/O Examples
39699 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39700 @cindex file-i/o examples
39701
39702 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39703 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39704
39705 @smallexample
39706 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39707 @emph{request memory read from target}
39708 -> @code{m1234,6}
39709 <- XXXXXX
39710 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39711 -> @code{F6}
39712 @end smallexample
39713
39714 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39715 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39716
39717 @smallexample
39718 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39719 @emph{request memory write to target}
39720 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39721 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39722 -> @code{F6}
39723 @end smallexample
39724
39725 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39726 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39727
39728 @smallexample
39729 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39730 -> @code{F-1,9}
39731 @end smallexample
39732
39733 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39734 host is called:
39735
39736 @smallexample
39737 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39738 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39739 <- @code{T02}
39740 @end smallexample
39741
39742 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39743 host is called:
39744
39745 @smallexample
39746 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39747 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39748 <- @code{T02}
39749 @end smallexample
39750
39751 @node Library List Format
39752 @section Library List Format
39753 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39754
39755 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39756 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39757 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39758 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39759 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39760 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39761 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39762 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39763 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39764 are loaded.
39765
39766 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39767 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39768 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39769 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39770
39771 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39772 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39773 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39774 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39775 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39776 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39777
39778 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39779 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39780
39781 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39782 offset, looks like this:
39783
39784 @smallexample
39785 <library-list>
39786 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39787 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39788 </library>
39789 </library-list>
39790 @end smallexample
39791
39792 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39793 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39794
39795 @smallexample
39796 <library-list>
39797 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39798 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39799 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39800 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39801 </library>
39802 </library-list>
39803 @end smallexample
39804
39805 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39806
39807 @smallexample
39808 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39809 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39810 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39811 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39812 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39813 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39814 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39815 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39816 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39817 @end smallexample
39818
39819 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39820 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39821 section for each library.
39822
39823 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39824 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39825 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39826
39827 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39828 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39829 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39830 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39831
39832 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39833 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39834 target, the following parameters are reported:
39835
39836 @itemize @minus
39837 @item
39838 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39839 @code{struct link_map}.
39840 @item
39841 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39842 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39843 @item
39844 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39845 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39846 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39847 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39848 @item
39849 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39850 @end itemize
39851
39852 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39853 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39854 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39855
39856 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39857 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39858
39859 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39860 looks like this:
39861
39862 @smallexample
39863 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39864 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39865 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39866 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39867 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39868 </library-list-svr>
39869 @end smallexample
39870
39871 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39872
39873 @smallexample
39874 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39875 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39876 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39877 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39878 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39879 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39880 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39881 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39882 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39883 @end smallexample
39884
39885 @node Memory Map Format
39886 @section Memory Map Format
39887 @cindex memory map format
39888
39889 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39890 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39891 memory map.
39892
39893 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39894 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39895 lists memory regions.
39896
39897 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39898 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39899
39900 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39901
39902 @smallexample
39903 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39904 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39905 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39906 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39907 <memory-map>
39908 region...
39909 </memory-map>
39910 @end smallexample
39911
39912 Each region can be either:
39913
39914 @itemize
39915
39916 @item
39917 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39918 bytes from there:
39919
39920 @smallexample
39921 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39922 @end smallexample
39923
39924
39925 @item
39926 A region of read-only memory:
39927
39928 @smallexample
39929 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39930 @end smallexample
39931
39932
39933 @item
39934 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39935 bytes in length:
39936
39937 @smallexample
39938 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39939 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39940 </memory>
39941 @end smallexample
39942
39943 @end itemize
39944
39945 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39946 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39947 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39948
39949 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39950
39951 @smallexample
39952 <!-- ................................................... -->
39953 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39954 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39955 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39956 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39957 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39958 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39959 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39960 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39961 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39962 and its type, or device. -->
39963 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39964 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39965 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39966 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39967 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39968 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39969 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39970 @end smallexample
39971
39972 @node Thread List Format
39973 @section Thread List Format
39974 @cindex thread list format
39975
39976 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39977 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39978 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39979 the following structure:
39980
39981 @smallexample
39982 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39983 <threads>
39984 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
39985 ... description ...
39986 </thread>
39987 </threads>
39988 @end smallexample
39989
39990 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39991 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39992 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39993 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
39994 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
39995 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
39996 auxiliary information.
39997
39998 @node Traceframe Info Format
39999 @section Traceframe Info Format
40000 @cindex traceframe info format
40001
40002 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40003 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40004 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40005 collected in a traceframe.
40006
40007 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40008 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40009
40010 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40011 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40012
40013 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40014
40015 @smallexample
40016 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40017 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40018 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40019 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40020 <traceframe-info>
40021 block...
40022 </traceframe-info>
40023 @end smallexample
40024
40025 Each traceframe block can be either:
40026
40027 @itemize
40028
40029 @item
40030 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40031 @var{length} bytes from there:
40032
40033 @smallexample
40034 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40035 @end smallexample
40036
40037 @item
40038 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40039 collected:
40040
40041 @smallexample
40042 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40043 @end smallexample
40044
40045 @end itemize
40046
40047 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40048
40049 @smallexample
40050 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40051 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40052
40053 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40054 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40055 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40056 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40057 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40058 @end smallexample
40059
40060 @node Branch Trace Format
40061 @section Branch Trace Format
40062 @cindex branch trace format
40063
40064 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40065 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40066 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40067 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40068
40069 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40070 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40071
40072 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40073 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40074
40075 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40076
40077 @smallexample
40078 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40079 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40080 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40081 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40082 <btrace>
40083 block...
40084 </btrace>
40085 @end smallexample
40086
40087 @itemize
40088
40089 @item
40090 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40091 and ending at @var{end}:
40092
40093 @smallexample
40094 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40095 @end smallexample
40096
40097 @end itemize
40098
40099 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40100
40101 @smallexample
40102 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40103 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40104
40105 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40106 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40107 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40108
40109 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40110
40111 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40112
40113 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40114 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40115 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40116 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40117 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40118
40119 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40120 @end smallexample
40121
40122 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40123 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40124 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40125
40126 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40127 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40128 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40129
40130 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40131 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40132
40133 @table @code
40134 @item bts
40135 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40136 @table @code
40137 @item size
40138 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40139 @end table
40140 @item pt
40141 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40142 PT}) format.
40143 @table @code
40144 @item size
40145 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40146 @end table
40147 @end table
40148
40149 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40150 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40151
40152 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40153
40154 @smallexample
40155 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40156 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40157
40158 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40159 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40160
40161 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40162 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40163 @end smallexample
40164
40165 @include agentexpr.texi
40166
40167 @node Target Descriptions
40168 @appendix Target Descriptions
40169 @cindex target descriptions
40170
40171 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40172 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40173 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40174 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40175 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40176 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40177 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40178
40179 @itemize @bullet
40180 @item
40181 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40182 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40183 @item
40184 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40185 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40186 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40187 @item
40188 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40189 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40190 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40191 @end itemize
40192
40193 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40194 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40195 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40196 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40197 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40198
40199 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40200 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40201
40202 @menu
40203 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40204 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40205 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40206 descriptions.
40207 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40208 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40209 @end menu
40210
40211 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40212 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40213
40214 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40215 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40216 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40217 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40218 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40219 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40220 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40221 Format}.
40222
40223 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40224 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40225 specify a file are:
40226
40227 @table @code
40228 @cindex set tdesc filename
40229 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40230 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40231
40232 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40233 @item unset tdesc filename
40234 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40235 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40236
40237 @cindex show tdesc filename
40238 @item show tdesc filename
40239 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40240 @end table
40241
40242
40243 @node Target Description Format
40244 @section Target Description Format
40245 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40246
40247 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40248 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40249 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40250 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40251 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40252 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40253 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40254
40255 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40256 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40257 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40258 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40259 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40260
40261 Here is a simple target description:
40262
40263 @smallexample
40264 <target version="1.0">
40265 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40266 </target>
40267 @end smallexample
40268
40269 @noindent
40270 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40271 the x86-64 architecture.
40272
40273 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40274 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40275 are explained further below.
40276
40277 @smallexample
40278 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40279 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40280 <target version="1.0">
40281 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40282 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40283 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40284 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40285 </target>
40286 @end smallexample
40287
40288 @noindent
40289 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40290 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40291 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40292 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40293 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40294 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40295 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40296 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40297 the version mismatch.
40298
40299 @subsection Inclusion
40300 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40301 @cindex XInclude
40302 @ifnotinfo
40303 @cindex <xi:include>
40304 @end ifnotinfo
40305
40306 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40307 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40308 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40309 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40310 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40311
40312 @smallexample
40313 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40314 @end smallexample
40315
40316 @noindent
40317 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40318 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40319 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40320 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40321 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40322 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40323 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40324 original description.
40325
40326 @subsection Architecture
40327 @cindex <architecture>
40328
40329 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40330
40331 @smallexample
40332 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40333 @end smallexample
40334
40335 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40336 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40337
40338 @subsection OS ABI
40339 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40340
40341 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40342 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40343
40344 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40345
40346 @smallexample
40347 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40348 @end smallexample
40349
40350 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40351 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40352
40353 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40354 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40355
40356 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40357 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40358
40359 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40360
40361 @smallexample
40362 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40363 @end smallexample
40364
40365 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40366 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40367
40368 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40369 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40370 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40371 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40372 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40373 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40374 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40375
40376 @smallexample
40377 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40378 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40379 @end smallexample
40380
40381 @subsection Features
40382 @cindex <feature>
40383
40384 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40385 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40386 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40387 has this form:
40388
40389 @smallexample
40390 <feature name="@var{name}">
40391 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40392 @var{reg}@dots{}
40393 </feature>
40394 @end smallexample
40395
40396 @noindent
40397 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40398 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40399 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40400 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40401
40402 @subsection Types
40403
40404 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40405 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40406 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40407 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40408 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40409 and enum types.
40410
40411 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40412 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40413 Types must be defined before they are used.
40414
40415 @cindex <vector>
40416 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40417 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40418 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40419 @var{count}:
40420
40421 @smallexample
40422 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40423 @end smallexample
40424
40425 @cindex <union>
40426 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40427 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40428 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40429 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40430
40431 @smallexample
40432 <union id="@var{id}">
40433 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40434 @dots{}
40435 </union>
40436 @end smallexample
40437
40438 @cindex <struct>
40439 @cindex <flags>
40440 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40441 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40442 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40443 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40444 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40445 specified.
40446
40447 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40448
40449 @smallexample
40450 <struct id="@var{id}">
40451 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40452 @dots{}
40453 </struct>
40454 @end smallexample
40455
40456 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40457 No implicit padding is added.
40458
40459 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40460
40461 @smallexample
40462 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40463 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40464 @dots{}
40465 </struct>
40466 @end smallexample
40467
40468 @smallexample
40469 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40470 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40471 @dots{}
40472 </flags>
40473 @end smallexample
40474
40475 The @var{name} value is required.
40476 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40477 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40478 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40479
40480 The @var{start} value is required, and @var{end} and @var{type}
40481 are optional.
40482 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40483 and zero represents the least significant bit.
40484 The default value of @var{end} is @var{start}, a single bit field.
40485
40486 The default value of @var{type} depends on whether the
40487 @var{end} was specified. If @var{end} is specified then the default
40488 value of @var{type} is an unsigned integer. If @var{end} is unspecified
40489 then the default value of @var{type} is @code{bool}.
40490
40491 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
40492
40493 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40494 defining them with @samp{struct}:
40495
40496 @itemize @bullet
40497 @item
40498 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40499 @item
40500 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40501 @end itemize
40502
40503 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40504 defining them with @samp{flags}:
40505
40506 @itemize @bullet
40507 @item
40508 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40509
40510 @smallexample
40511 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40512 $1 = 42
40513 @end smallexample
40514
40515 @end itemize
40516
40517 @subsection Registers
40518 @cindex <reg>
40519
40520 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40521
40522 @smallexample
40523 <reg name="@var{name}"
40524 bitsize="@var{size}"
40525 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40526 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40527 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40528 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40529 @end smallexample
40530
40531 @noindent
40532 The components are as follows:
40533
40534 @table @var
40535
40536 @item name
40537 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40538
40539 @item bitsize
40540 The register's size, in bits.
40541
40542 @item regnum
40543 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40544 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40545 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40546 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40547 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40548 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40549 in order of increasing register number.
40550
40551 @item save-restore
40552 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40553 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40554 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40555 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40556 ABI.
40557
40558 @item type
40559 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40560 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40561 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40562 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40563 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40564 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40565
40566 @item group
40567 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40568 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40569 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40570 in @code{info registers}.
40571
40572 @end table
40573
40574 @node Predefined Target Types
40575 @section Predefined Target Types
40576 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40577
40578 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40579 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40580 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40581 types. The currently supported types are:
40582
40583 @table @code
40584
40585 @item bool
40586 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40587
40588 @item int8
40589 @itemx int16
40590 @itemx int32
40591 @itemx int64
40592 @itemx int128
40593 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40594
40595 @item uint8
40596 @itemx uint16
40597 @itemx uint32
40598 @itemx uint64
40599 @itemx uint128
40600 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40601
40602 @item code_ptr
40603 @itemx data_ptr
40604 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40605 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40606 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40607 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40608 may be marked as data pointers.
40609
40610 @item ieee_single
40611 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40612
40613 @item ieee_double
40614 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40615
40616 @item arm_fpa_ext
40617 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40618
40619 @item i387_ext
40620 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40621
40622 @item i386_eflags
40623 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40624
40625 @item i386_mxcsr
40626 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40627
40628 @end table
40629
40630 @node Enum Target Types
40631 @section Enum Target Types
40632 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
40633
40634 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
40635 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
40636
40637 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
40638
40639 @smallexample
40640 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40641 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
40642 @dots{}
40643 </enum>
40644 @end smallexample
40645
40646 Enums must be defined before they are used.
40647
40648 @smallexample
40649 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
40650 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
40651 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
40652 </enum>
40653 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
40654 <field name="X" start="0"/>
40655 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
40656 </flags>
40657 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
40658 @end smallexample
40659
40660 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
40661 would be printed as:
40662
40663 @smallexample
40664 (gdb) info register flags
40665 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
40666 @end smallexample
40667
40668 @node Standard Target Features
40669 @section Standard Target Features
40670 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40671
40672 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40673 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40674 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40675 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40676 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40677 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40678 can recognize them.
40679
40680 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40681 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40682 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40683 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40684 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40685 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40686 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40687 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40688
40689 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40690 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40691 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40692
40693 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40694 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40695 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40696 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40697
40698 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40699 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40700 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40701
40702 @menu
40703 * AArch64 Features::
40704 * ARM Features::
40705 * i386 Features::
40706 * MicroBlaze Features::
40707 * MIPS Features::
40708 * M68K Features::
40709 * Nios II Features::
40710 * PowerPC Features::
40711 * S/390 and System z Features::
40712 * TIC6x Features::
40713 @end menu
40714
40715
40716 @node AArch64 Features
40717 @subsection AArch64 Features
40718 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40719
40720 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40721 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40722 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40723
40724 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40725 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40726 and @samp{fpcr}.
40727
40728 @node ARM Features
40729 @subsection ARM Features
40730 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40731
40732 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40733 ARM targets.
40734 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40735 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40736
40737 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40738 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40739 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40740 and @samp{xpsr}.
40741
40742 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40743 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40744
40745 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40746 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40747 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40748 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40749
40750 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40751 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40752 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40753 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40754 halves of the double-precision registers.
40755
40756 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40757 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40758 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40759 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40760 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40761 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40762
40763 @node i386 Features
40764 @subsection i386 Features
40765 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40766
40767 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40768 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40769
40770 @itemize @minus
40771 @item
40772 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40773 @item
40774 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40775 @item
40776 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40777 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40778 @item
40779 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40780 @item
40781 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40782 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40783 @end itemize
40784
40785 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40786
40787 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40788 describe registers:
40789
40790 @itemize @minus
40791 @item
40792 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40793 @item
40794 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40795 @item
40796 @samp{mxcsr}
40797 @end itemize
40798
40799 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40800 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40801 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40802
40803 @itemize @minus
40804 @item
40805 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40806 @item
40807 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40808 @end itemize
40809
40810 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
40811 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40812
40813 @itemize @minus
40814 @item
40815 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40816 @item
40817 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40818 @end itemize
40819
40820 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40821 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40822
40823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40824 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40825 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40826
40827 @itemize @minus
40828 @item
40829 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40830 @end itemize
40831
40832 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40833
40834 @itemize @minus
40835 @item
40836 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40837 @end itemize
40838
40839 It should
40840 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40841
40842 @itemize @minus
40843 @item
40844 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40845 @item
40846 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40847 @end itemize
40848
40849 It should
40850 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40851
40852 @itemize @minus
40853 @item
40854 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40855 @end itemize
40856
40857 @node MicroBlaze Features
40858 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40859 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40860
40861 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40862 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40863 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40864 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40865 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40866
40867 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40868 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40869
40870 @node MIPS Features
40871 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40872 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40873
40874 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40875 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40876 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40877 on the target.
40878
40879 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40880 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40881 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40882
40883 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40884 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40885 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40886 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40887
40888 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40889 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40890 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40891 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40892
40893 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40894 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40895 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40896
40897 @node M68K Features
40898 @subsection M68K Features
40899 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40900
40901 @table @code
40902 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40903 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40904 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40905 One of those features must be always present.
40906 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40907 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40908 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40909 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40910
40911 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40912 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40913 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40914 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40915 @end table
40916
40917 @node Nios II Features
40918 @subsection Nios II Features
40919 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40920
40921 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40922 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40923 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40924 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40925 @samp{mpuacc}).
40926
40927 @node PowerPC Features
40928 @subsection PowerPC Features
40929 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40930
40931 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40932 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40933 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40934 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40935
40936 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40937 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40938
40939 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40940 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40941 and @samp{vrsave}.
40942
40943 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40944 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40945 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40946 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40947 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40948 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40949
40950 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40951 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40952 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40953 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40954 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40955 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40956 user.
40957
40958 @node S/390 and System z Features
40959 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40960 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40961 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40962
40963 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40964 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40965 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40966 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40967 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40968 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40969 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40970 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40971 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40972
40973 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40974 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40975 @samp{fpc}.
40976
40977 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40978 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40979
40980 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40981 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40982 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40983 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40984 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40985 32-bit wide.
40986
40987 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40988 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40989 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40990
40991 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40992 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40993 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40994 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40995 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40996 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40997 @samp{v31}.
40998
40999 @node TIC6x Features
41000 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41001 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41002 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41003 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41004 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41005 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41006
41007 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41008 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41009 through @samp{B31}.
41010
41011 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41012 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41013
41014 @node Operating System Information
41015 @appendix Operating System Information
41016 @cindex operating system information
41017
41018 @menu
41019 * Process list::
41020 @end menu
41021
41022 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41023 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41024 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41025 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41026 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41027 on a different aspect of target.
41028
41029 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41030 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41031 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41032 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41033
41034 @node Process list
41035 @appendixsection Process list
41036 @cindex operating system information, process list
41037
41038 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41039 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41040 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41041 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41042
41043 An example document is:
41044
41045 @smallexample
41046 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41047 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41048 <osdata type="processes">
41049 <item>
41050 <column name="pid">1</column>
41051 <column name="user">root</column>
41052 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41053 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41054 </item>
41055 </osdata>
41056 @end smallexample
41057
41058 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41059 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41060 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41061 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41062 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41063 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41064 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41065
41066 @node Trace File Format
41067 @appendix Trace File Format
41068 @cindex trace file format
41069
41070 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41071 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41072
41073 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41074 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41075 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41076 in the future.
41077
41078 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41079 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41080 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41081 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41082 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41083 of this section.
41084
41085 @table @code
41086 @item R @var{size}
41087 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41088 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41089 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41090 a single trace file.
41091
41092 @item status @var{status}
41093 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41094 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41095 file.
41096
41097 @item tp @var{payload}
41098 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41099 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41100 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41101 reply packets.
41102
41103 @item tsv @var{payload}
41104 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41105 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41106 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41107 reply packets.
41108
41109 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41110 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41111 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41112 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41113 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41114 file. Includes are not allowed.
41115
41116 @end table
41117
41118 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41119 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41120 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41121 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41122 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41123 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41124 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41125 endianness.
41126
41127 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41128
41129 @table @code
41130 @item R @var{bytes}
41131 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41132 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41133 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41134
41135 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41136 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41137 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41138 @var{length} bytes.
41139
41140 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41141 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41142 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41143
41144 @end table
41145
41146 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41147 of blocks.
41148
41149 @node Index Section Format
41150 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41151 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41152 @cindex index section format
41153
41154 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41155 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41156 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41157 description.
41158
41159 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41160 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41161 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41162 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41163 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41164 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41165
41166 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41167
41168 @enumerate
41169 @item
41170 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41171 unless otherwise noted:
41172
41173 @enumerate
41174 @item
41175 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41176 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41177 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41178 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41179 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41180 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41181 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41182
41183 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41184 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41185 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41186 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41187
41188 @item
41189 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41190
41191 @item
41192 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41193 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41194 to the next offset.
41195
41196 @item
41197 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41198
41199 @item
41200 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41201
41202 @item
41203 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41204 @end enumerate
41205
41206 @item
41207 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41208 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41209 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41210 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41211 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41212 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41213 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41214 CU indices.
41215
41216 @item
41217 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41218 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41219 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41220 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41221
41222 @item
41223 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41224 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41225
41226 @enumerate
41227 @item
41228 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41229
41230 @item
41231 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41232 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41233
41234 @item
41235 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41236 @end enumerate
41237
41238 @item
41239 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41240 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41241
41242 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41243 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41244 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41245 constant pool.
41246
41247 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41248 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41249 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41250
41251 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41252 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41253 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41254 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41255 index version:
41256
41257 @table @asis
41258 @item Version 4
41259 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41260
41261 @item Versions 5 to 7
41262 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41263 @end table
41264
41265 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41266
41267 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41268 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41269 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41270 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41271 collision.
41272
41273 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41274 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41275 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41276 the code.
41277
41278 @item
41279 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41280 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41281 strings.
41282
41283 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41284 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41285 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41286 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41287 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41288 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41289
41290 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41291 @end enumerate
41292
41293 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41294 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41295 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41296
41297 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41298 (bit 0 = LSB):
41299
41300 @table @asis
41301
41302 @item Bits 0-23
41303 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41304 @item Bits 24-27
41305 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41306 @item Bits 28-30
41307 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41308
41309 @table @asis
41310 @item 0
41311 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41312 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41313 with previous versions of the index.
41314 @item 1
41315 The symbol is a type.
41316 @item 2
41317 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41318 @item 3
41319 The symbol is a function.
41320 @item 4
41321 Any other kind of symbol.
41322 @item 5,6,7
41323 These values are reserved.
41324 @end table
41325
41326 @item Bit 31
41327 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41328
41329 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41330 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41331 @value{GDBN} sources.
41332
41333 @end table
41334
41335 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41336 global/static attributes in the index.
41337
41338 @smallexample
41339 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41340 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41341 switch (die->tag)
41342 @{
41343 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41344 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41345 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41346 kind = TYPE;
41347 is_static = 1;
41348 break;
41349 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41350 kind = VARIABLE;
41351 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41352 break;
41353 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41354 kind = FUNCTION;
41355 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41356 break;
41357 case DW_TAG_constant:
41358 kind = VARIABLE;
41359 is_static = ! is_external;
41360 break;
41361 case DW_TAG_variable:
41362 kind = VARIABLE;
41363 is_static = ! is_external;
41364 break;
41365 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41366 kind = TYPE;
41367 is_static = 0;
41368 break;
41369 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41370 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41371 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41372 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41373 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41374 kind = TYPE;
41375 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41376 break;
41377 default:
41378 assert (0);
41379 @}
41380 @end smallexample
41381
41382 @node Man Pages
41383 @appendix Manual pages
41384 @cindex Man pages
41385
41386 @menu
41387 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41388 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41389 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41390 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41391 @end menu
41392
41393 @node gdb man
41394 @heading gdb man
41395
41396 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41397
41398 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41399 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41400 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41401 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41402 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41403 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41404 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41405 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41406 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41407 @c man end
41408
41409 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41410 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41411 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41412 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41413
41414 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41415 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41416
41417 @itemize @bullet
41418 @item
41419 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41420
41421 @item
41422 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41423
41424 @item
41425 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41426
41427 @item
41428 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41429 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41430 @end itemize
41431
41432 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41433 Modula-2.
41434
41435 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41436 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41437 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41438 by using the command @code{help}.
41439
41440 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41441 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41442 executable program as the argument:
41443
41444 @smallexample
41445 gdb program
41446 @end smallexample
41447
41448 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41449
41450 @smallexample
41451 gdb program core
41452 @end smallexample
41453
41454 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41455 to debug a running process:
41456
41457 @smallexample
41458 gdb program 1234
41459 gdb -p 1234
41460 @end smallexample
41461
41462 @noindent
41463 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41464 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41465 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41466
41467 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41468
41469 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41470 @table @env
41471 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41472 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41473
41474 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41475 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41476
41477 @item bt
41478 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41479
41480 @item print @var{expr}
41481 Display the value of an expression.
41482
41483 @item c
41484 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41485
41486 @item next
41487 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41488 function calls in the line.
41489
41490 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41491 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41492
41493 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41494 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41495
41496 @item step
41497 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41498 function calls in the line.
41499
41500 @item help [@var{name}]
41501 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41502 about using @value{GDBN}.
41503
41504 @item quit
41505 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41506 @end table
41507
41508 @ifset man
41509 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41510 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41511 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41512 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41513 @end ifset
41514 @c man end
41515
41516 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41517 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41518 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41519 encountered with no
41520 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41521 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41522 Many options have
41523 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41524 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41525 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41526 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41527 more usual convention.)
41528
41529 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41530 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41531 option is used.
41532
41533 @table @env
41534 @item -help
41535 @itemx -h
41536 List all options, with brief explanations.
41537
41538 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41539 @itemx -s @var{file}
41540 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41541
41542 @item -write
41543 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41544
41545 @item -exec=@var{file}
41546 @itemx -e @var{file}
41547 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41548 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41549 dump.
41550
41551 @item -se=@var{file}
41552 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41553 file.
41554
41555 @item -core=@var{file}
41556 @itemx -c @var{file}
41557 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41558
41559 @item -command=@var{file}
41560 @itemx -x @var{file}
41561 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41562
41563 @item -ex @var{command}
41564 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41565
41566 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41567 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41568 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41569
41570 @item -nh
41571 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41572
41573 @item -nx
41574 @itemx -n
41575 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41576
41577 @item -quiet
41578 @itemx -q
41579 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41580 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41581
41582 @item -batch
41583 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41584 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41585 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41586 commands in the command files.
41587
41588 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41589 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41590 more useful, the message
41591
41592 @smallexample
41593 Program exited normally.
41594 @end smallexample
41595
41596 @noindent
41597 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41598 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41599
41600 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41601 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41602 instead of the current directory.
41603
41604 @item -fullname
41605 @itemx -f
41606 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41607 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41608 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41609 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41610 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41611 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41612 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41613 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41614
41615 @item -b @var{bps}
41616 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41617 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41618
41619 @item -tty=@var{device}
41620 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41621 @end table
41622 @c man end
41623
41624 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41625 @ifset man
41626 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41627 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41628 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41629
41630 @smallexample
41631 info gdb
41632 @end smallexample
41633
41634 @noindent
41635 should give you access to the complete manual.
41636
41637 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41638 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41639 @end ifset
41640 @c man end
41641
41642 @node gdbserver man
41643 @heading gdbserver man
41644
41645 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41646 @format
41647 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41648 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41649
41650 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41651
41652 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41653 @c man end
41654 @end format
41655
41656 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41657 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41658 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41659
41660 @ifclear man
41661 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41662 @end ifclear
41663 @ifset man
41664 Usage (server (target) side):
41665 @end ifset
41666
41667 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41668 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41669 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41670 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41671
41672 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41673 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41674 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41675
41676 @smallexample
41677 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41678 @end smallexample
41679
41680 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41681
41682 @smallexample
41683 @ifset man
41684 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41685 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41686 @end ifset
41687 @ifclear man
41688 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41689 @end ifclear
41690 @end smallexample
41691
41692 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41693 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41694 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41695
41696 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41697
41698 @smallexample
41699 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41700 @end smallexample
41701
41702 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41703 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41704 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41705 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41706 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41707 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41708 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41709 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41710 print an error message and exit.
41711
41712 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41713 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41714
41715 @smallexample
41716 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41717 @end smallexample
41718
41719 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41720 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41721
41722 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41723 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41724 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41725 the program you want to debug.
41726
41727 @smallexample
41728 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41729 @end smallexample
41730
41731 @ifclear man
41732 @subheading Usage (host side)
41733 @end ifclear
41734 @ifset man
41735 Usage (host side):
41736 @end ifset
41737
41738 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41739 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41740 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41741 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41742 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41743 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41744 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41745 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41746 descriptor. For example:
41747
41748 @smallexample
41749 @ifset man
41750 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41751 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41752 @end ifset
41753 @ifclear man
41754 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41755 @end ifclear
41756 @end smallexample
41757
41758 @noindent
41759 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41760
41761 @smallexample
41762 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41763 @end smallexample
41764
41765 @noindent
41766 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41767 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41768 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41769 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41770 `Connection refused'.
41771
41772 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41773 described in
41774 @ifset man
41775 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41776 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41777 @end ifset
41778 @ifclear man
41779 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41780 @end ifclear
41781 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41782
41783 @smallexample
41784 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41785 @end smallexample
41786
41787 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41788 case.
41789 @c man end
41790
41791 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41792 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41793
41794 @itemize @bullet
41795
41796 @item
41797 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41798
41799 @smallexample
41800 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41801 @end smallexample
41802
41803 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41804 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41805 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41806 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41807 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41808 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41809 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41810
41811 @item
41812 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41813 program:
41814
41815 @smallexample
41816 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41817 @end smallexample
41818
41819 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41820 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41821 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41822 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41823
41824 @item
41825 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41826
41827 @smallexample
41828 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41829 @end smallexample
41830
41831 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41832 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41833 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41834 debug several processes in the same session.
41835 @end itemize
41836
41837 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41838
41839 @table @env
41840
41841 @item --help
41842 List all options, with brief explanations.
41843
41844 @item --version
41845 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41846
41847 @item --attach
41848 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41849
41850 @smallexample
41851 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41852 @end smallexample
41853
41854 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41855 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41856
41857 @item --multi
41858 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41859 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41860 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41861 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41862
41863 @smallexample
41864 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41865 @end smallexample
41866
41867 @item --debug
41868 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41869 process.
41870 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41871 the developers.
41872
41873 @item --remote-debug
41874 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41875 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41876 the developers.
41877
41878 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41879 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41880 of debugging output.
41881 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41882
41883 @item --wrapper
41884 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41885 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41886 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41887 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41888
41889 @item --once
41890 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41891 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41892 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41893 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41894
41895 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41896
41897 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41898 @c QDisableRandomization.
41899
41900 @end table
41901 @c man end
41902
41903 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41904 @ifset man
41905 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41906 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41907 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41908
41909 @smallexample
41910 info gdb
41911 @end smallexample
41912
41913 should give you access to the complete manual.
41914
41915 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41916 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41917 @end ifset
41918 @c man end
41919
41920 @node gcore man
41921 @heading gcore
41922
41923 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41924
41925 @format
41926 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41927 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41928 @c man end
41929 @end format
41930
41931 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41932 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41933 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41934 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41935 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41936 running without any change.
41937 @c man end
41938
41939 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41940 @table @env
41941 @item -o @var{filename}
41942 The optional argument
41943 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41944 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41945 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41946 @end table
41947 @c man end
41948
41949 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41950 @ifset man
41951 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41952 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41953 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41954
41955 @smallexample
41956 info gdb
41957 @end smallexample
41958
41959 @noindent
41960 should give you access to the complete manual.
41961
41962 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41963 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41964 @end ifset
41965 @c man end
41966
41967 @node gdbinit man
41968 @heading gdbinit
41969
41970 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41971
41972 @format
41973 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41974 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41975 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41976 @end ifset
41977
41978 ~/.gdbinit
41979
41980 ./.gdbinit
41981 @c man end
41982 @end format
41983
41984 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41985 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41986 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41987 described in
41988 @ifset man
41989 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41990 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41991 @end ifset
41992 @ifclear man
41993 @ref{Sequences}.
41994 @end ifclear
41995
41996 Please read more in
41997 @ifset man
41998 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41999 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42000 @end ifset
42001 @ifclear man
42002 @ref{Startup}.
42003 @end ifclear
42004
42005 @table @env
42006 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42007 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42008 @end ifset
42009 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42010 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42011 @end ifclear
42012 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42013 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42014 See more in
42015 @ifset man
42016 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42017 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42018 @end ifset
42019 @ifclear man
42020 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42021 @end ifclear
42022
42023 @item ~/.gdbinit
42024 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42025 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42026
42027 @item ./.gdbinit
42028 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42029 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42030 See more in
42031 @ifset man
42032 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42033 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42034 @end ifset
42035 @ifclear man
42036 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42037 @end ifclear
42038 @end table
42039 @c man end
42040
42041 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42042 @ifset man
42043 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42044
42045 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42046 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42047 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42048
42049 @smallexample
42050 info gdb
42051 @end smallexample
42052
42053 should give you access to the complete manual.
42054
42055 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42056 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42057 @end ifset
42058 @c man end
42059
42060 @include gpl.texi
42061
42062 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42063 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42064 @include fdl.texi
42065
42066 @node Concept Index
42067 @unnumbered Concept Index
42068
42069 @printindex cp
42070
42071 @node Command and Variable Index
42072 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42073
42074 @printindex fn
42075
42076 @tex
42077 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42078 % meantime:
42079 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42080 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42081 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42082 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42083 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42084 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42085 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42086 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42087 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42088 \page\colophon
42089 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42090 @end tex
42091
42092 @bye
This page took 1.077073 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.